- Macquarie University ResearchOnline

Transcription

- Macquarie University ResearchOnline
Don’t Say All Religions Are Equal Unless You Really Mean It:
John Hick, the Axial Age, and the Academic Study of Religion
A Dissertation Submitted for the Degree of
Doctor of Philosophy
To the Department of Ancient History
In the Faculty of Arts
at
Macquarie University
Sydney
by
Jack Tsonis
Primary Supervisor: Dr Stephen Llewelyn
July 2013
Synopsis
Don’t Say All Religions Are Equal Unless You Really Mean It:
John Hick, the Axial Age, and the Academic Study of Religion
Jack Tsonis
2013
This dissertation undertakes a critical analysis of the “pluralist” view of religious diversity,
which holds that all religions are responses to the same transcendent reality. Although the
pluralist ideal has a long history in western thought, primary focus is placed on recent
articulations of the argument as represented by figures such as John Hick, Huston Smith,
and Wilfred Cantwell Smith. Particular focus is placed upon the philosophical theory of
religion offered by Hick in 1989. The aim of this work is to show that despite the intention
of pluralist thinkers to move beyond the Eurocentric categories that have traditionally
pervaded the western study of religion, their arguments invariably remain predicated on the
problematic “world religions” paradigm, as well as a number of other discourses that have
their root in the cultural hierarchies of the nineteenth century. I therefore suggest that in
spite of their egalitarian ideals, the pluralist theory of religions ultimately reifies and
reinforces many of the Eurocentric assumptions about “religion” that it seeks to overcome.
This argument is made by employing a discourse-analytical reading of Hick’s theory,
building upon numerous critical works in religious studies that have addressed the
problematic history of the world religions paradigm. After providing a detailed introduction
to the pluralist perspective and its place in contemporary debate, attention turns to the
various criticisms that have been levelled at the world religions paradigm, focusing
particularly on the cultural hierarchies that are implied by the seemingly benign rhetoric of
“great” traditions and “world” religions. Focus then returns to Hick’s argument with these
problems in view, paying attention primarily to his use of the “Axial Age” metanarrative,
which serves as the historical backbone of his argument. As will become clear, by following
Karl Jaspers’ division of religions into “pre-axial” and “post-axial”, Hick reproduces a form
of civilizational exceptionalism that stems directly from nineteenth-century race theory and
other paradigms of cultural difference by which European imperialism was justified. I show
that Hick’s argument replicates at least six standard tropes of colonial discourse with regard
to the non-urban (i.e. “primitive”) other, and claim that this undermines his clearly stated
methodological and ethical goals. This dissertation therefore also begins to outline a much
needed critique of the Axial Age construct, something so far missing from critical literature
in the field. The final chapter provides a detailed survey of recent historiographical trends
that render the key assumptions of the Axial Age narrative empirically untenable; but in the
interests of constructive critique, this discussion is also used to sketch out some alternative
approaches to emplotting long-term religious history that are more in line with current
historiographical standards.
The Conclusion looks at how these issues impact on the pluralist theory, as well as
the larger question of how they relate to contemporary debates about the place of pluralism
and theological essentialism in the academic study of religion. Although I suggest that it
seems impossible to reconcile traditional theological pluralism with contemporary critical
standards, my ultimate contention is that if these issues continue to be addressed, then
opportunities will be presented to develop an increasingly sophisticated vocabulary for the
treatment of long-term religious history that could bring together many strands of recent
scholarship and move the academic study of religion in exciting new directions.
For
Vicki, Con, and Toby
Preface
I, James George McLean Tsonis, hereby declare that I am the sole author of this work,
which is being submitted under my preferred name of Jack. No part of this dissertation has
been published or submitted to any other university or institution. All sources of
information have been duly cited. Whilst the body of the work can be read entirely on its
own, the footnotes provide substantiation for all relevant claims, and often gesture towards
topics that are beyond the scope of the main discussion. In general, works are cited in full
the first time they appear in a chapter, in shorthand thereafter. In addition to the main
bibliography, a supplementary bibliography has been provided for reasons that are
explained within. It primarily includes works that are not discussed in the body of the text,
but which are relevant to one of the central methodological concerns of the analysis and
informed much of the research.
Jack Tsonis
Sydney
July 2013
Acknowledgements
I firstly wish to thank my family for their love and support. This work is dedicated to
them with gratitude and affection. I also express sincere thanks to the Department of
Ancient History at Macquarie University for giving me the space to pursue this
somewhat idiosyncratic project, and for trusting that it would come together. Thanks
also go to Trevor Evans for his facilitation of the Department’s weekly seminars, at
which early versions of chapters 4 and 5 were presented and profitably critiqued.
My supervisorial team has been outstanding. Stephen Llewelyn, as primary
supervisor, has been an invaluable mentor and dialogue partner for five years now, and
his unfailing patience allowed me to follow my nose and find my own way to the
argument. I also wish to acknowledge Stephen’s tireless support of all his students,
which stands as a model of engaged and responsible pedagogy.
I have had the privilege of working with three exceptional associate supervisors
over the last four years. Brent Nongbri read all of the chapters in draft, and his feedback
always helped to sharpen my thinking. Cavan Concannon provided important guidance
in the early stages of my candidature, when the plan for this dissertation resembled little
more than a plate of dropped spaghetti. I also acknowledge the support of Professor
Larry Welborn, who set me upon many fruitful paths in the early stages, and whose
enthusiasm was infectious. Further thanks go to Professor Edwin Judge, who took the
time on several occasions to provide detailed feedback on a number of my proposals.
Yet while I am deeply indebted to each of them, it goes without saying that all
conclusions offered in this work are mine alone.
I have also been fortunate to receive advice and guidance from a host of generous
scholars over the past four years. I particularly wish to thank Ward Blanton for his kind
hospitality on a visit to Glasgow in 2011, during which trip (and our many
conversations) the foundations of this dissertation snapped into place. Another person
who has given me a good deal of her time is Carole Cusack of Sydney University, who
regularly suggested readings that kept me moving in fresh directions, and whose
eagerness to help has been little short of heroic. I further thank Professor Dale Martin
for making time to chat in New Haven whenever I have been in the neighbourhood,
and for helping to facilitate a number of useful connections with other scholars.
Amongst my student colleagues, I give special mention to Bernard Doherty, whose
willingness to share ideas and books made all the difference at the start, and whose
diabolical sense of humour always kept me laughing. Similar thanks go to Sean Durbin
for his facilitation of the Religion Reading Group at Macquarie, which put me in touch
with many works that ultimately played an important role in my argument. Sean also
provided helpful feedback on a section of the draft. I also enjoyed regular conversations
with Brad Bitner, whose warmth and erudition have been greatly appreciated by all
students in HDR3, as well as David Baker, who was ever ready to share his expertise on
big history.
In my wider life, I am lucky to have a funny, intelligent, and vivacious set of friends. I
single out for particular mention the Esteemed Esquires of the Atterton Academy –
Jimbo, Weebs, Nicko and Dravid – who enrich my life immeasurably, and who inspire
me always with their own passions and insights. In the game of not taking life too
seriously, these are co-conspirators of the highest order.
Finally I thank Sofia Eriksson, the sweetest of Swedes, who has the remarkable
capacity of being relentlessly critical while constantly supportive. Not only did she read
everything that I put in front of her, but her incessant concern with the nature of
discourse has been an unwavering source of stimulation. Without her, the successful
completion of this work is unthinkable to me.
Table of Contents
Synopsis …………………………………………………………………………………. iii
Preface …………………………………………………………………………………… vii
Acknowledgements ……………………………………………………………………… ix
CHAPTER 1
Theological Pluralism and the “World Religions”: Sketching Out the Issues ………
Pluralism and the Inescapable Presence of the Other
Pluralism in the Shadow of Colonialism
The Critical Shape of this Work
1
10
20
36
CHAPTER 2
John Hick and the Pluralist Theory of Religions ………………………………………
The Modern Enterprise of Theories of Religion
The Pluralistic Hypothesis
The Traditional Criticisms of Pluralism
Summary: What’s the Problem with Pluralism?
51
54
64
75
95
CHAPTER 3
Historicizing the Rhetoric of Great Traditions: A Genealogy of the World Religions
Paradigm ………………………………………………………………………………….
The Pre-Nineteenth Century Background
World Religions and Primitive Culture in the Nineteenth Century
The Consolidation of the World Religions Paradigm in the Twentieth Century
99
106
119
141
CHAPTER 4
From Hegel to Hick: Pluralism and Problem of the Axial Age ……………………….
From Hegel to Hick: A Brief Genealogy of the Axial Age
Amplifying the Subtext: Beneath the Positive Affirmations of Pluralism
The Discourse Made Him Do It
155
156
170
182
CHAPTER 5
Beyond the Great Traditions: Towards a Redescription of the Axial Age ……………
The Demotion of the Document
The Changing Shape of Prehistory
Communications History
Unstitching the Axial Age: Elements of a Redescription
189
191
198
215
230
CONCLUSION
Don’t Say All Religions Are Equal Unless You Really Mean It: Theological Pluralism and
the Academic Study of Religion ………………………………………………………… 245
Bibliography ……………………………………………………………………………… 267
Supplementary Bibliography ……………………………………………………………. 289
Chapter 1
Theological Pluralism and the “World Religions”:
Sketching Out the Issues
The topic of the dissertation is the claim that all religions are equally valid responses to the
same “transcendent reality”. Although not a majority view in statistical terms, this
theological but non-hierarchal orientation to religious diversity has become increasingly
significant in recent decades, and has assumed a central place in both academic and public
debates about religion. It is a view today most commonly called “pluralism”.1
The general pluralist idea has a long history (a short version of which I will provide
soon), but it rose to the level of a widespread paradigm in theology and academic
scholarship on religion only from the middle of the twentieth century onwards. One of the
early statements came with Huston Smith’s 1958 textbook The Religions of Man, which
catalyzed a new paradigm that revolved around a canonical set of “great” religions –
Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism, Taoism, Islam, Judaism, and Christianity – a set
increasingly being called “the world religions”. In what was becoming the chief refrain of
the pluralist discourse, these great religions were all held to bear witness to a “higher
transcendent truth”, upon which no single tradition could make a uniquely authoritative
claim.2 Although the same idea had been articulated at various times over the centuries,
Despite the prevalence of the phrase “religious pluralism” and its seemingly self-evident meaning, the term is
actually rather tricky when its broad usage is scrutinized, and can mean substantially different things: (a) the
mere fact of religious diversity; (b) a positive ethos of engagement between different cultures in a civic
context; and (c) a theological attitude that argues for the transcendent unity of all religions. Yet despite these
important semantic differences, very little attention is typically paid to this issue and the consequences it has
for contemporary debates on religion. Unfortunately this is something I will not have space to discuss, and a
full genealogy of the term remains a desideratum in contemporary scholarship. However, the reader should be
aware that at no stage in this work do I use “pluralism” and its cognates to mean either (a) empirical
cultural/religious diversity, or (b) an ethos for the negotiation of cultural difference. It is always used to
designate a theological attitude, hence my regular recourse to the relatively uncommon phrase “theological
pluralism” throughout the dissertation. I wish to stress this point given the general promiscuity of the term in
contemporary discourse.
1
Smith, H., The Religions of Man (New York: Harpers & Brothers, 1958). I have slightly paraphrased the
quotation. For one of Smith’s clearest statements of this view from a philosophical standpoint, cf. his
laudatory introduction to Frithjof Schuon’s The Transcendent Unity of Religions (Wheaton, IL: Quest, 1984), ix2
1
Huston Smith represents the period at which this liberal discourse began to take root at a
much wider academic and public level.3
Wilfred Cantwell Smith’s influential 1962 classic The Meaning and End of Religion was
another agenda-setting articulation of the pluralist view of religious history, one that had a
particularly important impact on the development of religious studies as an academic
discipline. Cantwell Smith not only urged that religious history must today be treated in
global comparative terms, but that the analytically “reified” entities known as “the religions”
all reflected, at a much deeper level, “man’s variegated and evolving encounter with
transcendence”.4
This was part of a broad push by liberal Christian scholars and theologians to move
beyond traditional readings of religious history that treated Christianity as the highest or
most “fully developed” religion.5 Although this perspective received growing support from
the 1960s onwards in both academic and theological contexts, the pluralist view of religious
history was given its most systematic articulation in the philosophical theory of British
philosopher of religion John Hick. In his landmark 1989 work, An Interpretation of Religion,
xxxiv, e.g: “There is a unity at the heart of religions. More than moral it is theological, but more than
theological it is metaphysical in the precise sense of the word: that which transcends the world. The fact that it
is thus transcendent, however, means that it can be univocally described by none and concretely apprehended
by few” (xxii). The Religions of Man has since been republished as The World’s Religions: Our Great Wisdom
Traditions (San Francisco: Harper SanFrancisco, 1991).
The spread of the world religions paradigm is discussed in Chapter 3. A good survey of the paradigm’s midtwentieth century emergence is provided in Katherine K. Young, “World Religions: A Category in the
Making?” in Religion in History: The Word, the Idea, the Reality (ed. M. Despland & G. Vollée; Ontario: Wilfred
Laurier University Press, 1992), 111-130. I will discuss Tomoko Masuzawa’s important analysis of the
nineteenth-century background of the world religions paradigm shortly.
3
Cantwell Smith, W., The Meaning and End of Religion (New York: Harper & Row, 1978 [1962]), 134. Cantwell
Smith developed this argument over the rest of his career, especially in works such as Questions of Religious Truth
(New York: Charles Scribner’s Sons, 1967) and Towards a World Theology: Faith and the Comparative History of
Religion (Philadelphia: The Westminster Press, 1981). For Cantwell Smith’s influential role in promulgating this
view at a wide level, see Young’s essay cited above.
4
For a good discussion of the general trends of this reorientation, see George Lindbeck, The Nature of Doctrine:
Religion and Theology in a Postliberal Age (Philadelphia: The Westminster Press, 1984). Lindbeck opens the work
by stating that “This book is the product of a quarter of century of growing dissatisfaction with the usual ways
of thinking about those norms of communal belief and action which are generally spoken of as the doctrines
or dogmas of churches.”
5
2
Hick not only emphasized the fundamental unity of religions as Huston Smith and Wilfred
Cantwell Smith had before him, but he attempted to make that argument historically
plausible by placing it within an over-arching metanarrative that would make historical
sense of the profound similarities across “the great faiths of mankind”.6 The narrative that
he adopted was the notion of the so-called “Axial Age”, first articulated by Karl Jaspers in
1949.7 According to the Axial Age narrative, the pivotal point in humanity’s religious history
was the 1st millennium BCE, when new forms of religion arose independently in Greece,
Israel, India and China that all bore a new “transcendent” dimension in comparison to the
relatively “world accepting” character of the “primitive” and “archaic” religions that had
preceded them. The Axial Age was construed as the birth of the world religions, the birth of
history, and the point at which the foundations of the modern world were laid. There will
be more to say about the Axial Age below, much of it critical, but Jaspers was likewise
trying to move beyond forms of Christian and European triumphalism and to recast world
history into a globally unified narrative. Hick followed him, but with a slightly more
theological inflection: he construed the Axial Age as “the movement away from archaic
religion and the birth of the religions of salvation and liberation”.8 For Hick, Jaspers, and
Hick, J., An Interpretation of Religion (New Haven & London: Yale University Press, 1989). The work is an
expanded version of Hick’s Gifford Lectures of 1986-87. Hick also wrote the Foreword to the 1978 edition of
The Meaning and End of Religion and regularly cited the influence of Cantwell Smith on his thought, at one stage
calling him “the father of contemporary religious pluralism, rightly so regarded by critics as well as by friends
and colleagues” (Hick, J., John Hick: An Autobiography [Oxford: Oneworld, 2002], 259.)
6
The work was originally published as Vom Ursprung und Ziel der Geschichte (Zurich: Artemis, 1949), and was
translated into English as On the Origin and Goal of History (trans. M. Bullock; London: Routledge & Kegan
Paul, 1953). I explore some of the prehistory of the Axial Age construct in Chapter 4 below. For a good
survey of statements about the religious transformations of the 1st millennium BCE that predate Jaspers
(going back to the late eighteenth century), see Hans Joas, “The Axial Age Debate as Religious Discourse” in
The Axial Age and Its Consequences (ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas; Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2012),
9-29. A comprehensive bibliography of both primary and secondary treatments of the Axial Age can be found
at the end of the work (469-537). [NB: Jaspers first publicized the concept of the Axial Age at a conference in
Geneva in 1946, published soon after as Vom Europäischen Geist. (Post-examination edit.)]
7
8 This is not a direct quotation from Hick but a paraphrase employing language that recurs throughout his
argument (cf. e.g. An Interpretation of Religion, 21-33).
3
most other pluralists, the “soteriological” post-axial traditions represent “religion” in its
most highly developed form.
Hick remains an influential philosopher of religion to this day, and his theory is still
the most comprehensively argued of any pluralist reading of religious history.9 But the basic
pluralist viewpoint also extends well beyond its explicit formulations (which today includes
figures such as Karen Armstrong and Tariq Ramadan) and represents a significant current
in contemporary religious thought.10 Christian theologian Harold Netland has described the
situation:
Pluralistic views on the religions are deeply entrenched in certain academic circles,
especially in religious studies. But it is not merely the latest academic fad; pluralist
themes are common among ordinary people who have never heard of John Hick or
the academic debate on other religions. Although pluralism finds increasingly
sophisticated expression among scholars, it is also a perspective that is widely accepted
in rudimentary form throughout popular culture, and its influence is increasingly felt
within the church as well.11
The fact that Hick’s position reflects such a widespread popular logic has important
implications that will be considered at the close of this work. Netland also points here to
the fact that the field of religious studies contains a deeply entrenched element of pluralism.
This link has already been suggested above in regard to Wilfred Cantwell Smith and Huston
Smith, and the discussion below will demonstrate that Netland’s assertion is correct in
There is a legitimate question about whether Hick’s argument can even be called a “theory” of religion, with
some critics suggesting it is little more than ecumenical theology operating under the guise of “philosophy of
religion”. I qualify my use of the term at the start of Chapter 2 and address the issues there. But to anticipate, I
do not have trouble saying that Hick is offering a “theory” in the sense of a “sustained philosophical
argument”.
9
See e.g. Armstrong, K., The Great Transformation: The Beginning of Our Religious Traditions (New York: A. A.
Knopf, 2006), which is the most popularly-oriented account of the Axial Age; and Ramadan, T., The Quest for
Meaning: Developing a Philosophy of Pluralism (London: Allen Lane, 2010). Although these works are of a
somewhat different character, they resonate strongly with each other in their overall message. See for example
Armstrong’s review of Ramadan’s book, “Tariq Ramadan’s ‘Quest for Meaning’” in the Financial Times Online,
http://www.ft.com/cms/s/2/85ac8582-9b62-11df-8239-00144feab49a.html#axzz1PGBzaDFS (July 31 2010;
last accessed June 24, 2013).
10
11 Netland, H., Encountering Religious Pluralism: The Challenge to Christian Faith and Mission (Downers Grove, IL;
InterVarsity Press, 2001) p. 24. Netland also discusses how the pluralist trend is also clearly apparent outside
of western contexts, but this is an issue which unfortunately falls beyond the scope of this dissertation.
4
important ways. Particularly relevant will be the towering influence of Mircea Eliade and the
“phenomenology of religion” view that all religions throughout history have been
“manifestations of the sacred”.12 This position is often called “essentialism” because of the
way that it posits an essence of religion – i.e. “the sacred” or “the transcendent” – which
stands at the core of all religions, and which is not reducible to anything else.
This, then, is a rough outline of the discursive tradition that will be under focus in this
dissertation. In my view, the various pluralist historians and theologians have made
admirable attempts to rethink the question of religious diversity in the context of the newly
globalized and inter-cultural world. They have come to the view that earlier forms of
Christian exceptionalism cannot be reasonably sustained upon a broad, comparative
examination of human religious history, and that significant paradigm shifts are therefore
required at both the methodological and the metaphysical levels. Hick epitomizes this
perspective in the opening dictum from An Interpretation of Religion, where he says that “a
philosopher of religion today must take account not only of the thought and experience of
the tradition within which he or she happens to work, but in principle of the thought and
experience of the whole human race”.13 Moreover, all pluralists explicitly advocate an ethos
of social justice, and invariably offer their contributions with a view toward more
harmonious social relations at both a local and a global level.14 Regardless of the specifics of
their argument, these are laudable goals in a world wracked by ideological conflict and
cultural misunderstanding.
See e.g. two of Eliade’s most widely read works, The Sacred and the Profane: The Nature of Religion (trans. W.
Trask; Orlando, FL: Harcourt, 1959 [1957]), and Patterns in Comparative Religion (trans. R. Sheed; New York:
Sheed & Ward, 1958 [1949]).
12
13
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, xiii.
14 A paradigmatic example of this is the introductory chapter to Huston Smith’s The Religions of Man, where
“increased understanding” is championed as the central aim of the work.
5
However, this dissertation is not a valorization of the pluralist view of religious diversity. In
fact, it is precisely the opposite. Attention has already been drawn to the way in which the
pluralist perspective is typically structured around a set of “world religions”. Despite the
way that this seems to “make sense” as a simple descriptive phrase to refer to the major
religious traditions of the world, the world religions paradigm has received growing
criticism in recent decades for the way that its ostensibly pluralistic orientation is
nevertheless predicated upon a very Eurocentric notion of what counts as “authentic”
religion. An illustrative example of this can be seen in Wilfred Cantwell Smith’s assertion
that “the living world religions” constitute “religion’s highest and truest development”,15 a
view which carries the unstated implication that “primitive”, oral, indigenous, and other
small-scale traditions are not “fully developed” examples of what religion “really is”. The
Axial Age narrative employs a similar logic, and Hick therefore bases his argument upon the
same notion, valorizing “post-axial” religions over “pre-axial” religion. Huston Smith even
admitted late in his life that at the time The Religions of Man was published he “dismissed”
such religions as “unimportant” (hence their exclusion from the 1958 edition).16 This
hierarchy was also reflected more widely in European scholarship and the sharp
methodological partition between history and anthropology, whose domains were
“civilizational culture” and “primitive culture” respectively. In turn, these assumptions –
which were prevalent even into late twentieth century, and still linger today – are predicated
on a series of now-indefensible tropes about non-civilizational cultures that stem directly
from the racist and imperialist discourses of the nineteenth century.
15 Cantwell Smith, W., “Comparative Religion: Whither and Why?” in The History of Religion: Essays in
Methodology (ed. J. Kitigawa & M. Eliade; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1959), 31-59, here 38.
16 See A Seat At The Table: Huston Smith in Conversation with Native Americans on Religious Freedom (Berkeley & Los
Angeles: University of California Press, 2006), 2. I discuss Smith’s comments to this effect in Chapter 4.
6
Therefore, whilst I respect and in many cases admire the general thrust of the pluralist
mood, the primary argument of this dissertation is that despite the egalitarian ethos of people such
as Hick, the pluralist theory of religions ultimately reifies and reinforces many of the Eurocentric
assumptions that it seeks to overcome. I will suggest that this contradiction is important to address
for several reasons: (a) because of the seriousness of the discrepancy between the pluralist
ethos and what most pluralists have actually argued (which becomes clear once the
subtextual implications of their arguments are brought to the foreground); (b) because of
the high critical standards that all pluralists advocate, which renders this discrepancy all the
more problematic; (c) because the pervasiveness of the pluralist mood in contemporary
culture means that any critique of its key assumptions has wide-ranging implications well
beyond the academy; and (d) because if these issues continue to be addressed, then
opportunities will be presented to develop an increasingly sophisticated vocabulary for the
treatment of long-term religious history that could bring together many strands of recent
scholarship and move the academic study of religion in exciting new directions. My aim is
to convince the reader of these claims by the end of this work.
The specific approach taken in what follows is to scrutinize the pluralist perspective by
focusing on the philosophical theory of John Hick. Every pluralist has their own
idiosyncratic formulation of the position, so instead of attempting a sweep of theological
pluralism in toto, this work looks closely at one influential example of it. But Hick is a good
candidate here for a number of more important reasons. Firstly, as mentioned, Hick’s body
of work constitutes the most comprehensive argument for, rather than simply statement of, the
pluralist position. By treating Hick and not others, I will be attempting to critique pluralism
in its most rigorously argued form. Moreover, in advocating what he calls his “religious but
non-confessional interpretation of religion”, Hick was explicit such a theory needed to be
fully engaged with academic forms of knowledge, saying
7
I shall therefore attempt to construct a comprehensive hypothesis which takes full
account of the data and theories of the human sciences but which uses them to show
how it is that the response to a transcendent reality has taken the bewildering plurality
of forms that history records.17
It is precisely this statement of intent to harmonize his argument with non-theological
scholarship that causes the undermining contradictions that have already been mapped out;
but the fact that Hick positions himself in this way also means that the perspectives adopted
in this work are fully consonant with the critical standards that he deemed necessary when
considering the “total” religious history of humanity. Again, this is work intended as a
serious critique, not a diatribe against a straw man.
Secondly, aside from the fact that he was (and remains) significantly influential, Hick
represents better than any other person the confluence of the major elements of theological
pluralism: namely the theological and academic elements. I have already highlighted his
links to Wilfred Cantwell Smith and the trends in world ecumenical theology, but Hick was
also clear that his view of the history of religions was informed at the empirical level by the
tradition of scholarship represented by Eliade, the phenomenology of religion. Indeed, the
first two footnotes of An Interpretation of Religion are specific references to the programs of
Eliade and Cantwell Smith, and a firm endorsement of their perspectives. As I hope to
show, this means that a critique of Hick has important implications for evaluating all forms
of theological discourse and academic scholarship that are predicated on the assumptions of
theological essentialism.
Thirdly, Hick is a useful case study because he explicitly employs the narrative of the
Axial Age. Although not all pluralist positions are predicated on this metanarrative (Huston
Smith and Eliade being examples), the Axial Age construct reflects a broader kind of “great
17 Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 2. Huston Smith similarly argued that his presentation in The Religions of Man
was carried out “against the backdrop of critical scholarship” (ix).
8
traditions pluralism” that was prevalent throughout much of the twentieth century and
which still has currency in contemporary scholarship.18 Yet despite its continued salience,
there has been little in the way of sustained critique of the Axial Age paradigm, so the focus
on Hick serves as a useful foil to begin mapping out why such a critique is necessary, and
what it might offer in terms of new research directions. This is another central concern of
this work, and will be discussed in more detail below.
Fourthly, as will become clear, Hick is a perfect illustration of the problems with
theological pluralism that have already been pointed out – i.e. the undermining
contradiction between his methodological and ethical statement of intent versus what his
theory actually winds up implying when its subtextual implications are brought into focus.
Highlighting this tension in Hick’s argument thus serves as a solid platform from which to
make a more general argument about the non-viability of theological pluralism in any form
of scholarship that aspires to credibility within the context of critical academic discourse, a
claim I will return to in the Conclusion.
Finally, a sustained focus on Hick is justified by the fact that despite his widespread
popularity, his theory of religion has never been subjected to the kind of discourseanalytical scrutiny that I undertake in this dissertation. As will be clear in Chapter 2,
although Hick has been the object of extensive criticism since he began advocating
pluralism in the early 1980s, this critique has almost invariably come from theological and
philosophical quarters and has not paid attention to the way in which he unwittingly
reproduced many of the foundational assumptions that he was trying to move beyond. And
18 Huston Smith’s position is predicated more properly on the tradition of the perennilaism and esoterism,
represented most prominently in the twentieth century by René Guénon and Frithjof Schuon (cf. n. 2 above),
but also famously figures such as Aldous Huxley (cf. also Smith’s major statement of perennialism in Forgotten
Truth: The Primordial Tradition [New York: Harper & Row, 1976]). Eliade is similar in the view that all of the
world’s religions point to the same sacred core, although he provided his own idiosyncratic formulation of the
idea that will be discussed below. Both of these positions will be considered at the end of this work in light of
the discussion of Hick. An implicit example of the Axial Age idea is Cantwell Smith’s argument that the major
living faiths of the world constitutes religion’s “highest and truest development”. An explicit example is Karen
Armstrong’s The Great Transformation.
9
although Hick has occasionally been implicated in the extensive discourse-analytical critique
that has been conducted with regard to scholars such as Eliade and the theological
underpinnings of much academic scholarship on religion, he has only ever been mentioned
in passing.19 This dissertation therefore fills an important gap in contemporary critical
scholarship on religion.
Pluralism and the Inescapable Presence of the Other
One of the central methodological commitments of this dissertation is the motto: “always
historicize”.20 Indeed, the inadvertent pluralist reproduction of Eurocentric forms of
thought has come about precisely because most pluralist writers have not sufficiently
attended to the conceptual baggage that their categories bring with them. So before
outlining more fully the critical concerns of this work, it will help to situate the pluralist
discourse a little more thoroughly in its historical context. This is particularly important for
bringing into focus the motivation of contemporary pluralists above and beyond their specific
arguments, which will be a crucial issue when later discussing why I think theological
pluralism is marked by these problems.
See e.g. McCutcheon, R., Manufacturing Religion: The Discourse on Sui Generis Religion and the Politics of Nostalgia
(New York: Oxford University Press, 1997), 122, 147; and Critics not Caretakers: Redescribing the Public Study of
Religion (Albany: SUNY Press, 2001), 117. See also Randall Styers, Making Magic: Religion, Magic, & Science in the
Modern World (New York: Oxford University Press, 2003), 95f., 197. Styers’ linkage of Hick with the
intellectual heritage of the nineteenth century has had a particularly important impact on my thinking over the
course of this dissertation, and my work is in many ways an attempt to expand on the brief aside on Hick in
Making Magic.
19
This motto is the opening slogan of Fredric Jameson’s The Political Unconscious: Narrative as a Socially Symbolic
Act (London: Routledge, 1981), although he employs it in a slightly different sense than I do (namely as the
historiographical cornerstone of dialectical materialism). My reading of the motto is more akin to the analytical
strategies advocated by Bruce Lincoln in his famous “Theses On Method” (first published in 1996; it can be
found in his recent collection Gods and Demons, Priests and Scholars: Critical Explorations in the History of Religions
[Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2012], 1-3). The other figure instantly brought to mind by this motto is
J. Z. Smith, who urges that students of religion must always “be able to articulate why ‘this’ rather than ‘that’
has been chosen as an exemplum”, which he elsewhere calls being “historically and anthropologically
responsible” (cf. the introduction to Smith’s Imagining Religion: From Babylon To Jonestown [Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1982], xi-xii). For other fine examples of this approach, see Smith’s Relating Religion: Essays in the
Study of Religion (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2004).
20
10
The central component of the pluralist position is the prioritization of experience over
doctrine. In other words, whilst most of the formal doctrines of the world’s religions are
mutually exclusive with regard to their fundamental truth claims (e.g., was the final
revelation Christ or the Qur’an?), pluralists typically hold these doctrinal elements to be
fallible human accretions to a universal experience of “the transcendent” that has taken
place within every major religious tradition throughout history. This means that pluralism
generally functions as a redescription of humanity’s religious history in ways that contradict
the self-understanding of many people within the various traditions. This is an important
issue that will be addressed in Chapter 2.
The modern discourse of “religious experience” has its roots in the Protestant
liberalism of the early nineteenth century. Certainly there were a number of similar views in
the mystical, esoteric, and hermetic traditions of medieval and early modern Europe,
represented by figures such as Pseudo Dionysius, Meister Eckhart, Marsilio Ficino, and
Giordano Bruno.21 Other notable precursors to contemporary pluralism (even if not all
strictly pluralistic themselves) can also be found in people such as Nicolas of Cusa, Michael
Servetus, Sebastian Castellio, the Socinian and Unitarian traditions of Christianity, as well as
English deism.22
Although these were four quite different thinkers, they all represent forms of religiosity that moved beyond
the traditional doctrinal framework of Christianity. For a good discussion of Pseudo Dyonisius and Meister
Eckhart in this context, see e.g. Abhayanada, S., History of Mysticism: The Unchanging Testament (3rd ed [1987]; the
2007 ebook version I possess appears to be self-published), 163-170 and 286-295. On Ficino, who represents
well the proto-pluralist tendencies of Renaissance neoplatonism, see e.g. Marsilio Ficino: his Theology, his
Philosophy, his Legacy (ed. M. Allen, V. Rees, and M. Davies; Leiden: Brill, 2002). On Bruno’s hermetic thought
(and his fascinating life) see e.g. Ingrid Rowland, Giordano Bruno: Philosopher/Heretic (Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 2008). I stress that I am only considering western intellectual history (and very briefly at that);
fuller treatments of mystical and esoteric forms of religious thought typically consider a much wide range of
examples, generally a selection from traditions both “East and West” (Abhayananda’s History of Mysticism is a
good example of the general scope).
21
22 On Nicolas of Cusa in the context of theological pluralism (as well as other early figures such as Peter
Abelard and Ramon Llull), see Veli-Matti Kärkkäinen, An Introduction to the Theology of Religions: Biblical,
Historical, and Contemporary Perspectives (Illinois: InterVarsity Press, 2003), 84f. For a good discussion of Servetus,
Castellio, and the passage of their ideas to the Socinians and Unitarians, see Marrian Hillar, “Sebastian
Castellio and the Struggle For Freedom of Conscience”, Essays in the Philosophy of Humanism 10 (2002): 31-56.
11
But the specific discursive tradition of emphasizing “religious experience” is
typically traced back to the so-called “father of Protestant liberalism”, Friedrich
Schleiermacher, and his defence of Christianity in the face of Enlightenment rationalism at
the beginning of the nineteenth century. Whilst Schleiermacher was not a pluralist himself,
clearly placing Christianity at the top of a developmental trajectory of religious history, his
argument that the rationality of religious belief was grounded in Gefühl, “feeling” – the
apprehension of an infinite mystery that touched one’s soul – became a key motif for many
liberal theologians and scholars in his wake.23
In the latter stages of the nineteenth century, the most influential proponent of this
view was William James, whose famous work The Varieties of Religious Experience (1902)
represents a fully-formed version of “proto-pluralism” that is homologous with the
arguments of twentieth-century liberals such as Hick. Craig Martin has provided an
impressive synthesis of the basic Jamesian view presented in The Varieties:
1) All religions start with a “direct personal communication with the divine” (38); 2)
The experiences constitute the “essential” (433) “nucleus” (432) of religion; 3)
Institutional religion is a secondary thing created by “disciples” and “sympathizers”
with a “lust for dogmatic rule” (293); 4) Institutional religion “contaminate[s] the
originally innocent thing,” and becomes tied up with “hypocrisy and tyranny and
meanness” (293); 5) Institutional religion expresses a “tribal instinct,” and all
“fanaticism” produced by this is external to “the purely interior life” (296); 6)
Institutional religion requires “exclusive devotion” and “idealizes the devotion itself”
(298); 7) The excessiveness or fanatical nature of institutional religion can be judged by
“common sense” (297); 8) Institutional religion is the same for “every church” (38), for
these things are “almost always the same” (433).24
Hillar has published a number of other informative pieces on Servetus (two of which are noted in the
bibliography). On deism, see e.g. Peter Gay, Deism: An Anthology (Princeton, NJ: D. van Nostrand, 1968).
Schleiermacher’s Über die Religion: Reden an die Gebildeten unter ihren Verächtern (“On Religion: Speeches to its
Cultured Despisers”) went through three editions (1799, 1806, and 1821), all bearing a slightly different
emphasis and becoming more conservative (i.e. less pantheistic) as Schleiermacher matured into Germany’s
greatest living theologian. For an excellent discussion of the work in its times, see the detailed introduction by
Richard Crouter to his translation, On Religion: Speeches to Its Cultured Despisers (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1988), 1-73. For a critical genealogy of the category of experience and Schleiermacher’s
foundational role here (including references to other such genealogies), see Robert Sharf, “Experience” in
Critical Terms for Religious Studies (ed. M. Taylor; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1998), 94-115.
23
24 Martin, C., “William James in Late Capitalism: Our Religion of the Status Quo” in Religious Experience: A
Reader (ed. C. Martin & R. McCutcheon; Sheffield, Equinox 2012), 177-196, here 187.
12
As Martin notes, the binary distinction between “religious experience” and “religious
institutions” continues right down to the present day, not just in liberal religious thought,
but also in the widespread “spiritual but not religious” discourse and other modern variants
of “private religion”.25
But in terms of theology, which is the trajectory out of which Hick and pluralism
would emerge, the pivotal decade was the 1960s. On the Catholic side, this was reflected in
the watershed transformations that came out of the Second Vatican Council (1964-1968).
In the documents which emerged from the Council, the Catholic Church formally rescinded
its centuries-old axiom that extra ecclesiam nulla salus – outside the Church no salvation –
replacing this exclusivist view with a far more inclusive message about the positive value of
the other great religious traditions of the world and the possibility of salvation from within
them.26 The primary document in this respect was Nostra Aetate (the “Declaration on the
Relation of the Church to Non-Christian Religions”, 1965), which explicitly states that the
Church “rejects nothing that is true or holy in these religions”.27
The Protestant world was undergoing a similar shake-up, and began redirecting its
long tradition of liberalism toward a new engagement with the other living faiths of the
Martin also discusses the way that these discourses valorize the good aspects of human behaviour as
“religious” (e.g. love, charity), while the bad aspects are said to be “distortions” of “true religion” (e.g. hatred,
aggression). He gives an interesting example about how the actions of al-Qaeda are generally regarded by
liberal discourses as “perversions” of the “true” message of Islam, rather than the more nuanced approach of
seeing al-Qaeda as representing a theological permutation of the Islamic tradition that has arisen in the context
of American neo-imperialism.
25
The history of the extra ecclesiam nulla salus formula is often discussed by contemporary theologians. For a
good survey, see Jacques Dupuis, Toward A Christian Theology of Religious Pluralism (Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1999),
84-109.
26
27 Nostra Aetate 2. The other conciliar document often cited in addition to NA is Lumen Gentium (“Dogmatic
Constitution of the Church”). The documents of the Council (totalling 16) can be found in Walter Abbott, The
Documents of Vatican II (New York: Guild, 1966). Many of the documents are also available at the Vatican’s
website (www.vatican.va; see the Resource Library). The story of the Council is obviously highly complex, and
the influence of different ideas and different theologians is much debated. It should also go without saying
that while there was a new push towards theological openness, conservative voices represented a significant
part of the Council.
13
world. This was signaled perhaps most famously by Paul Tillich’s work Christianity and the
Encounter of the World Religions (1962). Tillich argued that Christianity was in the midst of a
kairos, a revolutionary point in time that is qualitatively different from the normal
progression of time (chronos).28 His work, like that of many theologians and churchmen of
the time, began to permeate the thought of a public which was increasingly seeing the
effects of globalization, multiculturalism, and (perceived) secularization play themselves out
in civic life.29
This marked the beginning of a movement by many in the Protestant traditions
away from the kind of exclusivism represented so influentially by Karl Barth, whose neoorthodox position had since the 1930s displaced the influence of Protestant liberalism and
set the agenda for much subsequent theology and mission.30 The World Council of
Churches also began to make movements similar to those of Vatican II, and in 1971
officially endorsed a more open attitude toward other religious traditions, publishing in
1979 its Guidelines on Dialogue With People of Living Faiths and Ideologies.31
This nascent but enthusiastic engagement with other traditions – of which, it must
be emphasized, the above examples represent only a tiny fraction of relevant events – had a
number of important consequences. On the one hand, there was a “growing ecumenical
Tillich, P., Christianity and the Encounter of the World Religions (New York: Columbia University Press, 1963),
being the publication of lectures given in 1961/2. Even more commonly cited is the final lecture Tillich
delivered before his death, “The Significance of the History of Religions for the Systematic Theologian” in The
Future of Religions (ed. J. C. Brauer; New York: Harper & Row, 1966), 80-94; see 85f. for his discussion of
kairoi.
28
I say “perceived” secularization because whilst there was certainly an impression in the mid-twentieth
century that society was becoming less and less religious, this has ultimately not proven to be the case, and the
“secularization thesis” that held sway at the time has now been widely (if not completely) repudiated. This is,
however, a debate I cannot explore here. For a good summary of the issues, see Rodney Stark, “Secularization,
R.I.P.”, Sociology of Religion 60 (1999): 249-273.
29
30 On Barth and Kraemer see Kärkkäinen, Introduction to the Theology of Religions, 174-186. I am not discussing
the long counter-tradition of German liberalism at present, suffice it to note that this is what Barth was
reacting against. Yet although displaced, liberal voices still played an important role, with figures such as Ernst
Troeltsch and Rudolf Bultmann being pivotal for the later thought of Jaspers and Tillich.
31 See Paul Knitter, No Other Name?: A Critical Survey of Christian Attitudes Toward the World Religions (Maryknoll,
NY: Orbis, 1985), 138ff.
14
consensus” of many Christian churches in regard to the need for Christianity to
acknowledge the value of other traditions, as well as the need to address the now global
situation and reassert itself positively as an active partner in the project of world-building.32
This led to a second development, namely a new emphasis on inter-religious dialogue.
While internal Christian ecumenism had a well-established history and was simply given
fresh impetus by globalization, a new recognition emerged about the necessity of engaging
positively with other traditions if Christianity was to redefine itself in the global age.33 But the
most important development for the present discussion was the beginning of what came to
be called “the theology of religions”, a term first used in 1965 for a new field in which
theologians attempted to account for the presence of other religions and explore their
relationship to Christianity.34 The perspectives taken on this topic naturally varied widely,
from highly conservative to highly liberal, but the theology of religions swiftly began to
present itself as the primary issue facing most contemporary theological endeavours. As the
years progressed, three positions crystalized in the theology of religions, and in 1983 Alan
Race first introduced a typology that is still prevalent today: that of exclusivism, inclusivism,
and pluralism.35
Ibid., 135. See also FitzGerald, T. E., The Ecumenical Movement: an Introductory History (Westport, CT: Praeger,
2004).
32
The literature on inter-religious dialogue is massive, although most of it is effectively “guidelines” for
dialogue, rather than sociological treatments of the phenomenon. For a good recent treatment of the issues,
see Interreligious Dialogue and Cultural Change (ed. C. Cornille & S. Corigliano; Eugene, OR: Wipf & Stock, 2012).
Young also discusses the “dialogcial” character of the emerging world religions paradigm as it gained traction
(see “World Religions: A Category in the Making?”).
33
A major landmark which announced the arrival of this field was Heinz Robert Schlette, Towards a Theology of
Religions (New York: Herder & Herder, 1965). For an extensive overview of the theology of religions, see
Kärkkäinen, An Introduction to the Theology of Religions. An excellent survey of trends in the first two decades of
the movement is also provided in Knitter, No Other Name?, 73-167.
34
Race, A., Christians and Religious Pluralism (London: SCM, 1983). A number of theologians have since called
into question the utility of this typology, arguing, amongst other things, that it either does not adequately
represent the variety of configurations that theological positions can assume with regard to the central issues;
or that there are not really three options, but one: exclusivism, because pluralism and inclusivism are simply
different types of exclusivism that impose their own universal narrative, however “tolerant” they may be. But
for a comprehensive recent discussion of this debate that defends the typology, see Perry Schmidt-Leukel’s
essay “Exclusivism, Inclusivism, Pluralism: The Tripolar Typology––Clarified and Reaffirmed” in The Myth of
35
15
Exclusivism is a position which effectively affirms the old Augustinian maxim, extra
ecclesiam, nulla salus. This means that “other traditions are excluded as possible paths to
salvation, for salvation comes only through the atoning merit of Christ, which is made
available exclusively through the Christian Church”.36 Some of the most prominent
examples of this perspective are Karl Barth and Hendrik Kraemer.
Inclusivism is a variant of exclusivism, although it is characterized by a much more
open and positive attitude to the soteriologial potentiality contained in other traditions. This
position generally holds that “the full light of divine revelation is given to Christianity; but it
is inclined to be more generous in recognizing the revelatory works of God and instances of
truth outside Christianity. It thus concludes that other traditions are included in God’s plan
of salvation for the world, although salvation must somehow finally be accomplished
through the atoning work of Christ”.37 Prominent examples of the inclusivist position are
Jacques Dupuis and Hans Küng.38
In marked contrast to these positions is pluralism, which constitutes “a move away
from the insistence on the superiority or finality of Christ and Christianity towards a
recognition of the independent validity of other ways”, specifically emphasizing the way
that all religions are legitimate “responses to the transcendent”.39 As Hick and others have
Religious Superiority (ed. P. Knitter; Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 2003), 13-27. Listing 8 objections to the typology
that he has discerned in the literature, Schmidt-Leukel acknowledges that many of the concerns are wellfounded but argues convincingly that the typology still has good theological utility once certain issues are
clarified.
36
Plantinga, R., Christianity and Plurality: Classic and Contemporary Readings (Oxford: Blackwell, 1999), 5.
37
Ibid.
38 On Dupuis and Küng, see Kärkkäinen, An Introduction to the Theology of Religions, 197-215. Note that the title
of Dupuis’ work (Toward a Christian Theology of Religious Pluralism) uses “pluralism” in its descriptive sense (i.e.
meaning “Towards Making Sense of Religious Diversity from a Christian Perspective”) rather than the
theological sense (which, if it were pluralist according to the exclusivism–inclusivism–pluralism typology, would
be more like “Toward a Christian Theology that Decentres the Role of Christ”). Dupuis’ language is liable to
confusion here, making this one kind of example of the problems hinted at in the first footnote of this
chapter.
Knitter, P., “Preface” in The Myth of Christian Uniqueness: Towards a Pluralistic Theology of Religions (ed. J. Hick &
P. Knitter; Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1987), viii. This collection represents the first multi-authored advocacy of
39
16
suggested, this is a genuine “theological Rubicon” that calls for a total reappraisal of the
Christian tradition in a way that inclusivism does not, primarily because of the shift in focus
from doctrine to experience.40
Aside from their very substantial differences, all theologians engaged in the theology of
religions were responding to the same new pressure: intensified globalization and the
intensified immediacy of cultural difference. A productive way to see the emergence of
pluralist thought in this context is to consider the sociological analysis offered by Peter
Berger in his famous work of 1967, The Sacred Canopy. Berger’s basic perspective was that
the “social construction of reality” is constituted by a threefold dialectic.41 Berger describes
the way in which the continued functioning of this dialectic (occasional upheavals
notwithstanding) is what gives a symbolic universe its taken-for-granted facticity, something
he also calls its “plausibility structure”. He then used this perspective to address
contemporary secularization, i.e. the way in which the rationalist-capitalist political order of
modern industrialized societies had increasingly undermined the plausibility structures of
much traditional religion.42 The rationalist elements of western society had already posed a
the pluralist perspective in the theology of religions, and was pivotal in the consolidation of “pluralism” as
theological category. I mention several other relevant works in Chapter 2.
40 Ibid. For a survey of prominent theologians in the pluralist sector of contemporary Christian thought, see
Kärkkäinen, An Introduction to the Theology of Religions, 282-317. Again I stress that for reasons of scope I am not
considering other cultural traditions, even though many examples could be enumerated. Most commonly cited
are international figures such as Ghandi, the Dalai Lama, and Tich Nat Hahn.
41 Berger, P., The Sacred Canopy (New York: Anchor Books, 1967). Berger’s view was more fully elaborated in
his work with Thomas Luckmann, The Social Construction of Reality (New York: Anchor Books, 1966). In a
nutshell, the dialectic comprises externalization: “the outpouring of the human being into the world”;
objectification: “the attainment by the products of this activity of a reality that confronts its original producers as
a facticity external to and other than themselves” (i.e. the process by which society becomes “a reality sui
generis”); and internalization: “the reappropriation of this same reality”, which is transformed once again through
the processes of externalization.
Berger was one of the key proponents of the secularization thesis in the mid-twentieth century (see e.g.
chapter 5 of The Sacred Canopy for an influential discussion). Yet he too has completely repudiated the thesis
and accepts that is has been “empirically falsified”. See “The Desecularization of the World: A Global
Overview” in The Desecularization of the World: Resurgent Religion and World Politics (ed. P. Berger; Ethics and
Public Policy Centre: Washington, 1999), 1-18; see n. 29 above. It should be noted that Berger still accepts
42
17
profound challenge to traditional religious worldviews since the eighteenth century, but
when this was combined with the intensified immediacy of cultural difference in the postWWII era, traditional plausibility structures came under even greater pressure:
One of the most obvious ways in which secularization has affected the man in the
street is a “crisis of credibility” in religion. Put differently, secularization has resulted in
a widespread collapse of the plausibility of traditional religious definitions of reality. …
Objectively, the man in the street is confronted with a wide variety of religious and
other reality-defining agencies that compete for his allegiance or at least attention, and
none of which is in a position to coerce him into allegiance.43
I have already pointed out how theology was increasingly dominated by this pressure, and
Berger says that these developments “were practically begging for popularization” in
cultural mood of the postwar period.44 One of the most obvious consequences was that
more and more people began adopting a pluralistic attitude to the question of religious
diversity, even if only at the “rudimentary” level described by Netland above. Thus, put
simply, pluralism is what happened to many religious liberals as a result of globalization – i.e. when the
religious other was no longer a hypothetical question but neighbourly reality (whether in the
local or the global sense). Huston Smith’s introduction to The Religions of Man is an eloquent
and representative example of this emphasis on the new global consciousness of human
culture.
In an interesting appendix to The Sacred Canopy, Berger turned explicitly to the
challenges faced by theology. Recalling that these comments were made in the mid-1960s, it
is worth citing his prescient analysis:
many aspects of his earlier analysis of contemporary religious belief, but he is no longer of the view that
modernity leads to the “loss” of religious belief altogether.
43
Berger, The Sacred Canopy, 127.
44
Ibid., 165.
18
If one shares this inability to hoist oneself onto an epistemologically safe platform,
then no privileged status with regard to relativizing analyses can be accorded to
Christianity or any other historical manifestation of religion. The contents of
Christianity, like those of any other religious tradition, will have to be analyzed as
human projections similar in kind to other religious projections, grounded in specific
infrastructures and maintained as subjectively real by the specific processes of
plausibility-generation. It seems that once this is really accepted by a theologian, …
[then] what he is left with, I think, is the necessity for a step-by-step re-evaluation of
the traditional affirmations.45
As will become clear in Chapter 2, this is a perfect sociological prognosis of what happened
to Hick. This is because Hick’s autobiography bears out the fact that his argument for
pluralism was a direct response to his experience of multiculturalism in the vibrant
metropolis of Birmingham, where he developed new relationships with people from other
faith traditions and became actively involved in social justice campaigns.46 His theory was,
therefore, more than anything else, an attempt to explain the profound sense of unity he
perceived amongst the world’s “great faiths”.
Attention has been drawn to this issue because recognizing the sociological
underpinnings of the pluralist mood is important in the context of my overall argument. As
will be suggested later, I think that a large part of the reason why contemporary pluralists
such as Hick have continued to replicate problematic aspects of nineteenth-century thought
is because of the positively-charged affective sentiment of pluralism, and its ostensible “fit”
with contemporary democratic sensibilities, which has blinded them to the serious problems
inherent in the subtextual assumptions of their affirmations. But to make this argument, I
need to discuss those problems in a little more detail.
45 Ibid., 184. The appendix is called “Sociological and Theological Perspectives”. Berger explored these issues
in greater detail in his next major work on the sociology of religion, The Heretical Imperative: Contemporary
Possibilities of Religious Affirmation (New York: Anchor Books, 1979).
46
See Hick, J., John Hick: An Autobiography (Oxford: OneWorld, 2002).
19
Pluralism in the Shadow of Colonialism
The phrase “world religions” had an interesting journey to the centre of the cultural lexicon.
It first appeared in the work of late nineteenth century scholars to designate “universal”
religions as opposed to “national” religions, and referred only to Christianity, Islam, and
Buddhism. Yet by the mid-twentieth century, it had come to designate all of the “great
traditions”, generally meaning the major “living faiths” of the world treated by Huston
Smith: Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism, Taoism, Islam, Judaism, and Christianity.
Other religions often included in this group are Jainism, Sikhism, Shinto; sometimes Greek
philosophy; sometimes Zoroastrianism.47 As will be explained in Chapter 3, the shift in
meaning from a universal religion to simply any of the major religions is a substantial one
which indicates that new taxonomic criteria had come into play; yet it came about with
virtually no theoretical reflection. The issue is put nicely by Tomoko Masuzawa:
Poor grammar, fuzzy semantics, or uncertain orthography can never stop a phrase
from gaining currency if there is enough practical demand for it in the spirit of the
times. In our times, the term “world religions” testifies to this general truth.48
Here too we see the affective sentiment of pluralism at play, the way in which nuanced
analysis takes second place to a broader emphasis on unity. As Masuzawa and others have
argued, this self-evidency syndrome has done more than just result in analytic fuzziness
regarding “world religions” as a category of classification: it also allowed a host of
nineteenth-century assumptions about religious history to shape the twentieth-century
discourse on religion without anybody seeming to notice. Masuzawa has explored these
Young charts the increased emphasis on “living” faiths in the mid-twentieth century (see “World Religions:
A Category in the Making” esp. 113ff). On which cultural traditions have generally gained inclusion in lists of
“world religions” see Tomoko Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions: Or, How European Universalism was
Preserved in the Language of Pluralism (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2005), e.g. 2-6.
47
Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 1. Masuzawa’s observation would apply equally well, if not better,
to the word “pluralism”, especially because of the strong affective resonance that the word has gained in
recent decades.
48
20
issues in her important work, The Invention of World Religions; Or, How European Universalism
was Preserved in the Language of Pluralism. The title of the work provides a tight summary of her
thesis: that while the world religions paradigm reflected a conscious effort to move away
from earlier understandings of Christianity as the normative religion against which others
should be compared, many of the problematic assumptions about what constitutes “fully
developed” religion remain in the background of the new egalitarian approach.49
A concrete example will illustrate this point. One of the early motivations of this
dissertation was to explore both how and why someone with such staunchly stated ethical
and methodological commitments as Hick, whose concern was to develop a nontriumphalist theory based on an examination of “the whole human race”, could say the
following even in the year 1980 (in a lecture to a Jewish audience):
We may say of the early twilight period that men had, in virtue of the natural religious
tendency of their nature, a dim and crude sense of the Eternal One, an awareness
which took what are, from our perspective as Jews or as Christians, at best childish and
at worst appallingly brutal and bloodthirsty forms, but which nevertheless constituted
the womb out of which the higher religions were to be born. Here, I would say, there
was more human projection than divine disclosure. However, the demands which the
primitive consciousness of the divine made upon man’s life were such as to preserve
and promote the existence of human societies, from small drifting groups to large
nation-states. Religion was above all a force of social cohesion. There was at this stage
no startlingly challenging impact of the Eternal One upon the human spirit, but rather
that minimum presence and pressure which was to provide a basis for positive
moments of revelation when mankind was ready for them.50
Admittedly, this is not Hick’s finest moment, and his argument was significantly polished in
his paradigmatic statement of the pluralistic hypothesis a few years later in An Interpretation
It is important to note that Masuzawa only explores the nineteenth-century background of the world
religions paradigm, closing her investigation in the early twentieth century with the liberal theologian, Ernst
Troeltsch, an interesting precursor to theological pluralism that I cannot examine here. But a good treatment
of Troeltsch’s importance in this context can be found in Hick’s essay “The Non-Absoluteness of
Christianity”, in The Myth of Christian Uniqueness, 16-36.
49
50 Hick, J., God Has Many Names: Britain’s New Religious Pluralism (Philadelphia: Westminster Press, 1980), 44f.
One could be forgiven for thinking that 1980 is a misprint for 1880 – but shockingly, the date is correct.
21
of Religion.51 But the raw nineteenth-century logic of the above quotation is nevertheless still
the foundational logic of his more sophisticated argument for pluralism – and is indeed the
foundational logic of almost the entire pluralist paradigm. At the heart of this logic are
deeply questionable notions about what constitutes “true” religion, which reflect precisely
the problems that Masuzawa and others have pointed out in regard to the discourse on
“world” religions.
Masuzawa draws attention to a relevant issue. After explaining how the typology of
world religions generally includes five to ten traditions, she remarks offhand: “though what
makes them great remains unclear…”. Aside from the fact that they are all textual religions,
a crucial issue to which I will return, one of the most insightful answers to this question had
already been offered by Jonathan Z. Smith:
It is impossible to escape the suspicion that a world religion is simply a religion like
ours, and that it is, above all, a tradition that has achieved sufficient power and
numbers to enter our history and form it, interact with it, or thwart it. We recognize
both the unity within and the diversity among the world religions because they
correspond to important geopolitical entities with which we must deal. All
“primitives,” by way of contrast, may be lumped together, as may the “minor
religions” because they do not confront our history in any direct fashion. From the
point of view of power, they are invisible.52
Smith’s comment is in reference to traditions of classification in scholarship on religion
more broadly, and I will expand on his analysis in Chapter 3. But his observation already
goes a long way to explaining the reason why someone like Hick could make such a firm
distinction between “primitive religion” and “the great world faiths” – i.e., because these are
the discursive pressures of the world religions paradigm, which reflect in a very important
way the history of western power at a geopolitical level.
51
Cf. Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 21-33.
52
Smith, J. Z., “Religion, Religions, Religious” in Relating Religion, 179-196, here 191-2.
22
In recent times, as postcolonial concerns have arrived in the study of religion
(somewhat belatedly, it must be said), these tendencies have come under increased critical
pressure, especially in the context of the new advocacy of “indigenous” traditions.53 The
issue is framed well in the opening comment from Jacob Olupona’s preface to Beyond
Primitivism: Indigenous Religious Traditions and Modernity, which arose as the result of a
conference in which scholars were called “to respond to a perceptible lack in Western
institutions in the study of ‘indigenous’ religions.” Olupona writes that:
This lack is especially indicated in the history of religion programs offered at many US
universities. Western religious scholarship, generally the world over, has privileged
“world” religions by an absolute linguistic separation into two classes of religious
studies: “indigenous” religions and “world” religions. This arbitrary and capricious
bifurcation of religious scholarship fails to acknowledge the universality of religious
systems of belief across the globe. It fails to acknowledge the very sacred spiritual
traditions of Africa, the Americas, Asia, and wherever indigenous people inhabit the
earth. With the advent of global secular ideologies, based on technological innovation,
many indigenous traditions will continue to confront their own decline. The privileging
of “world” religions is largely informed by a particular academic orientation of
scholars, whose traditions developed out of the “axial age” civilization paradigm.54
I will expand on the issue of the Axial Age below, but for now the important point to pick
up in Olupona’s comment is that in addition to the problems noted by Masuzawa, the
53 Despite the widespread reaction to Edward Said’s Orientalism since its publication in 1979, religious studies
has arrived rather late to these discussions – owing, as critics like Russell McCutcheon have argued, to the
generally non-theoretical bent of the phenomenology of religion and the continuation of this trend into the
discipline of religious studies. Aside from the work of J. Z. Smith, which had moved in a general postcolonial
direction since the 1980s (cf. Map Is Not Territory [Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1978], esp. 278-304),
see more recently: Beyond Primitivism: Indigenous Religious Traditions and Modernity (ed. J. Olupona; New York &
London: Routledge, 2004); James Cox, From Primitive to Indigenous: The Academic Study of Indigenous Religions
(Hampshire: Ashgate, 2007); and Richard King, Orientalism and Religion: Postcolonial Theory, India, and ‘The Mythic
East’ (London: Routledge, 1999). King represents the fullest attempt to establish a postcolonial agenda in
religious studies. See esp. ch. 9 of the work for how the discipline might begin to move more substantively
“Beyond Orientalism”.
Olupona, J. K., “Preface” in Beyond Primitivism: Indigenous Religious Traditions and Modernity (ed. J. Olupona;
New York & London: Routledge, 2004), xiv. The conference was held in 1996, and “sought to extend a
discussion to all areas in which indigenous religions maintain a strong presence, in an effort to enhance our
understanding of indigenous traditions around the world and to make a compelling case to integrate
indigenous traditions into teaching and religious studies” (Olupona, “Introduction”, 1). I pass over at present
the fact that Olupona’s comment contains a number of problematic tropes itself, but see below, ch. 3, n. 145.
54
23
world religions paradigm also continues to make implicit judgments about contemporary
human communities, not just those from the “archaic” past.
I will flesh out some of the postcolonial issues more fully below, but the language of “world
religions” is not the only element of the western study of religion that has received
sustained criticism in recent decades. It has already been mentioned that the
phenomenology of religion has also been subjected to extensive critique, and here the
importance of Eliade and the issue of theological essentialism can be addressed.
Eliade’s oeuvre is massive and complex, but the central assumption underpinning his
work was that the history of religions represents the history of “manifestations of the
sacred”, and that this sacred reality was not reducible to anything else. In a key passage,
Eliade asserted that
a religious phenomenon will only be recognized as such if it is grasped at its
own level, that is to say, if it is studied as something religious. To try to grasp
the essence of such a phenomenon by means of physiology, psychology,
sociology, economics, linguistics, art or any other study is false; it misses the
one unique and irreducible element in it – the element of the sacred.55
There will be more to say about the tradition of non-reductive theories of religion in
Chapter 2, but another famous example of this position is that of Rudolf Otto, whose
notion that “the Holy” – which is homologous with Eliade’s “sacred” as well as the pluralist
conception of a “transcendent reality” – was something “wholly other” (ganz andere) to the
rest of existence.56 Eliade also subscribed to this idea with the firm ontological distinction
Eliade, Patterns in Comparative Religion, xi. For a good discussion of the non-reductive emphasis of Eliade,
albeit from a polemical point of view, see Robert Segal, “In Defence of Reductionism”, in Religion and the Social
Sciences: Essays on the Confrontation (Atlanta: Scholars Press, 1989), 1-36. I discuss Russell McCutcheon’s critique
of Eliade below.
55
56 Otto’s major work was Das Heilige: Über die Irrationale in der Idee des Göttlichen und sein Verhältnis zum Rationalen
(Breslau: Trewendt und Gramier, 1917). The work went through many editions and was swiftly translated into
both English (by J. Harvey as The Idea of the Holy [orig. 1923; rep. New York: Galaxy, 1958]) and, curiously,
Japanese, by a certain Professor Minami (Otto notes this in the preface to the 1921 edition). As an ardent
24
he posited between “the sacred” (meaningful, eternal) and “the profane” (contingent,
chaotic). Hick fits into the same non-reductive tradition when he affirms the view that “the
intentional object of religious devotion is not illusory”.57
This form of essentialism is predicated on a peculiarly western manner of thinking,
whereby “religion” is not only distinct from the “secular” realm (however much they
interpenetrate), but it is also a “genus” of which there are many “species”.58 In the
phenomenological tradition, the common way of describing this was the distinction
between “essence and manifestation”, language that we can see at play with Eliade. One of
the most strident critics of the essence/manifestation paradigm has been Russell
McCutcheon, who calls it “the discourse on sui generis religion”. He describes that
What these strategies [of Eliade, Otto, etc.] have in common is the assumption
that certain portions of human culture and experience are somehow distinct
from historical pressures and influences. The primary vehicle for articulating
this assumption is the long-held claim that religious experiences are sui generis,
that they are their own cause and belong to a unique category.59
As McCutcheon demonstrates, this form of theological essentialism was the central
methodological presupposition of religious studies as an academic discipline in the
follower of Schleiermacher (and even an editor of his works), Otto famously emphasized the non-rational
ground of religious belief, i.e. the “numinous” mysterium at the heart of reality, which lived “at the core” of “all
religions worthy of the name” (ET, 6). Eliade discusses Otto at the opening of The Sacred and the Profane. For a
comprehensive treatment of Otto’s thought, see Philip Almond, Rudolf Otto: An Introduction to his Philosophical
Theology (Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1984).
57
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 8.
58 I do not discuss the history of the modern category “religion” in this dissertation, although I have been
heavily informed by work on this topic, which has guided much of my research into the discursive history of
theological pluralism. Amongst the most informative works (aside from those of Masuzawa and J. Z. Smith), I
note Cantwell Smith’s classic etymology of the term in ch. 2 of The Meaning and End of Religion; Talal Asad,
Genealogies of Religion: Disciplines and Reasons of Power in Christianity and Islam (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins
University Press, 1993); Peter Harrison, ‘Religion’ and the Religions in the English Enlightenment (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1990); David Chidester, Savage Systems: Colonialism and Comparative Religion in
Southern Africa (Charlottesville, VA: University of Virginia Press); and most recently the comprehensive
account provided by Brent Nongbri in Before Religion: A History of a Modern Concept (New Haven: Yale
University Press, 2013).
59
McCutcheon, R., Manufacturing Religion (New York: Oxford University Press, 1997), 34f.
25
twentieth century – something that can be detected not just in the many overt statements of
the “reality of the transcendent” from numerous important scholars,60 but also in the
correspondingly apolitical and nontheoretical forms of analysis that the discipline has
promulgated at the pedagogical level over many decades.61 He similarly draws attention to
the way in which the notion of a sui generis “sacred” constituted a discursive strategy that
elevated the analytical techniques of Eliade & co. as the only heuristic approach capable of
grasping the “true” meaning of religion vis-à-vis approaches in other branches of the
human sciences.62 This position constitutes what McCutcheon calls “the distinctive
character of much of the modern discourse on religion”.63 He continues that:
Around this sui generis position orbits an elaborate web of undisclosed claims
and judgments that hold religion and the essence of all religious experience to
be distinctive, irreducible, independent, autochthonous, ahistorical, generically
distinctive, self-evident, unevolvable, an a priori category of the mind, original
and underivable, unique, primary, necessary, universal, a fundamental structure
of the human psyche, an archetypal element, and autonomous from
sociopolitical influences.64
Highlighting the major problem with this view and its unproblematic use of such categories,
McCutcheon states that:
The danger of this method is that it fails to acknowledge the socially
entrenched judgment of the researcher concerning what is and what is not
religious – a judgment that remains unarticulated and therefore undefended
because of the presumably self-evident authority of sui generis religion … the
sui generis assumption is [therefore] a useful means for camouflaging political
60 One example McCutcheon provides is the Marburg Declaration at the tenth International Congress of the
History of Religions in 1960 (signed by Eliade and others) that experiences of transcendence are “undoubtedly
empirical facts of human existence and history” (Manufacturing Religion, 41).
61
See e.g. ch. 4, “The Poverty of Theory in the Classroom”.
For a clear statement of Eliade’s prioritzation of the history of religions approach over social-scientific
forms of scholarship, see the foreword to Shamanism: Archaic Techniques of Ecstasy (Bollingen Series LXXVI;
Princeton University Press, 1964). A quotation is provided below, see ch. 2, n. 33.
62
63
McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 55.
64
Ibid.
26
statements as if they were neutral, factual, and purely descriptive statements of
supposedly self-evident meaning and value.65
In other words, the naturalization of what are actually historically-constituted standards of
judgment leads scholars such as Eliade to accept “insider” accounts of religious action as
authoritative, a view that totally occludes the way in which religious ideologies feed into
patterns of social power, and the way in which they legitimate various aspects of human
behaviour as if they stemmed from an ultimate, transcendent source.66 Moreover, it totally
overlooks some of the major differences between religions because it is more fundamentally
motivated to harmonize them in the face of what was perceived as the growing “rejection”
of religion in industrialized rationalist societies. As McCutcheon notes, that this relates to
the intellectual battles which began with Schleiermacher’s critique of the Enlightenment is
more than obvious.
Pursuing similar concerns in relation to the disciplinary autonomy claimed by many
scholars of religion, Robert Brown suggests that the sui generis claim is instrumental in
preventing “the dissolution of the discipline by erecting a barrier to social scientific efforts
to ‘explain away’ religion as merely a natural and cultural phenomenon”.67
This points to what is effectively the most important methodological divide in the
contemporary study of religion, namely the divide between “sympathetic” or “religiously
65
Ibid., 57, 71.
As McCutcheon notes, “[Eliade’s] findings that myths communicate Being is not strictly limited to
phenomenological description (e.g., ‘my informants report that myths narrate what they consider to be
authoritative, archetypical events of the distant past’) but constitutes advocacy of a normative interpretation of
these human essences and events” (38), stating elsewhere that “the conceptual tools used by scholars of
religion (e.g., the sacred, religion an sich, faith, power, the holy) are [therefore] rather interesting constructions
with far-reaching and significant discursive and sociopolitical implications” (17). For a series of incisive
analyses of how different cultures have adopted similar strategies regarding “the instrumentalization of the
past”, see Bruce Lincoln’s Discourse and the Construction of Society: Comparative Studies of Myth, Ritual, and
Classification (New York: Oxford University Press, 1989). On the “insider” issue, see also The Insider/Outsider
Problem in the Study of Religion: a Reader (ed. R. McCutcheon; London: Cassell, 1999). This issue is also addressed
in Chapter 2 below.
66
67
Cited in McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 69.
27
motivated” scholars who defend in various ways the “value” of “religion” vis-à-vis the
growing critical challenges of “scientific” modernity; and “critical” or “social-scientific”
scholars who seek to interpret religious phenomena according to the same theoretical and
methodological approaches by which they would study any other aspect of human
behaviour. Admittedly this is an oversimplified caricature; but in asking what characterizes
the discourse on sui generis religion, particularly as found in “contemporary comparative
religion texts”, McCutcheon suggests that
it generally consists in the use of vaguely defined and subjective comparative
categories (e.g., the ultimate, the sacred, feelings, mystery); a methodology that
can be characterized as sympathetic, or descriptive, hermeneutical intuitivism;
an emphasis on the study of personalistic and non-falsifiable contents of
religious experience; a prioritized insider’s perspective – all of which
contribute to an ecumenical theology of religious pluralism. It is a perspective
that privileges religious phenomena by removing them from the realm of
theoretical and materialist analysis. And in large part it is a perspective that has
not changed appreciably since the nineteenth century.68
This much therefore gives a rough outline of the nature of theological essentialism, as well
as some of the major issues that its critics have articulated. It will become more apparent
later how these issues feed into a critique of theological pluralism. Chief amongst my
contentions will be that it seems almost impossible to reconcile theological essentialism
with new evolutionary readings of human history. However exploring this claim is
something reserved for the Conclusion.
But aside from issues pertaining to claims about the sui generis nature of religion, the
phenomenology of religion is another area that has recently received sustained criticism
from the perspective of postcolonial theory, something of even greater interest in this study.
As already suggested, the major problem with theological pluralism and the world religions
68
Ibid., 124.
28
paradigm is the way in which they unwittingly perpetuate assumptions about what religion
“really is” that have their root in the racist cultural hierarchies of the nineteenth century.
Although scholars such as McCutcheon help in drawing attention to such issues, by far the
most exhaustive treatment of the phenomenology of religion from a postcolonial
perspective is Tim Murphy’s work, The Politics of Spirit.69
Contrary to the common view that behind the phenomenology of religion
enterprise lies the figure of Husserl (the founder of phenomenology in its philosophical
guise), Murphy convincingly demonstrates that it was in fact Hegel who provided the
foundation for the modern study of religion as represented by Eliade.70 Hegel’s thought is
even more complex to deal with than Eliade’s, and his impact upon western intellectual
history is surpassed by few others.71 This is particularly the case when it comes to western
views of world history, the specific aspect of Hegel most relevant for my purposes.
One of the most important concepts in Hegel’s arsenal was the notion of Geist, or
Spirit, a secularized version of God that he construed as the transcendental force guiding
the flow of history. The opposite of Geist was Natur, or Nature, and in Hegel’s view the
history of humanity was the history of Geist’s progressive self-revelation and the
corresponding elevation of human culture out of “the conditions of mere nature” towards
69
Murphy, T., The Politics of Spirit: Phenomenology, Genealogy, Religion (Albany: SUNY Press, 2010).
For an example of an otherwise excellent critical treatment of the phenomenology of religion that overlooks
Hegel and over-emphasizes the importance of Husserl, see James Cox, An Introduction to the Phenomenology of
Religion (London: Continuum, 2010), esp. 24-29. For Murphy’s convincing argument about the importance of
Hegel over Husserl (“more than but not instead of”), see The Politics of Spirit, esp. 4-10. Hegel’s influence on
the twentieth century phenomenology of religion is also clear throughout Murphy’s entire discussion. As will
become clear in Chapter 3, it was especially through the conduit of C. P. Tiele that the study of religion in the
twentieth century inherited the Hegelian structures.
70
For this reason Hegel has also been the product of a vast secondary literature that cannot be surveyed here.
Over the course of researching this work I have learned most from three particular sources: Murphy’s The
Politics of Spirit; Shawn Kelly’s Racializing Jesus: Race, Ideology and the Formation of Modern Biblical Scholarship
(London: Routledge, 2002); and the volume Hegel and History (ed. W. Dudley; Albany: SUNY Press, 2009). For
a good general treatment of Hegel, see e.g. Horst Althaus, Hegel: An Intellectual Biography (trans. M. Tarsh;
Cambridge: Polity Press, 2000 [1992]).
71
29
“freedom” and self-determination.72 Hegel could therefore make the distinction between
Kulturvölker, i.e. peoples in whom Geist was active as witnessed in their cultural products
such as religion, philosophy, and politics; and Naturvölker, i.e. peoples still living in the
conditions of mere nature with no discernible political organization or traditions of
philosophical thought. In turn, this corresponded to the dichotomy between “civilizational
cultures” and “primitive cultures”, one of the most enduring conceptual oppositions of the
western historiographical imagination. Murphy spells out the implications of the hierarchy,
which he calls a violent “economy of privilege”:
one of the heinous outcomes of … the structural relation between Geist and
Natur, Spirit and Nature, becomes evident when it is applied to human beings,
some of whom are classified as Naturvölker, while the correlation between
Kultur and objectiv[er] Geist is elevated to both a methodological and a
metaphysical principle. The result is that “civilized” peoples are inherently free
and Naturvölker are, as Nature/Matter itself, inherently dependent, having their
telos and purpose outside of themselves. This is, of course, a legitimation for
the colonization of the latter by the former.73
Murphy goes on to demonstrate the way in which this Hegelian distinction between Geist
and Natur provided the foundational structure of nineteenth-century Religionswissenschaft,
which transmuted seamlessly into the twentieth-century phenomenology of religion. It can
be seen in the nineteenth-century distinction between “ethical” religions and “nature”
religions, sometimes construed as the “higher” and “lower” religions – the former being
represented by textual, civilizational religions (which, nota bene, equate to the contemporary
list of “world” religions); the latter being constituted by the “primitive” religions of nonurban cultures, which were thought to be devoid of any form of ethical consciousness.
Such is the view presented, for example, in Hegel’s Lectures on the Philosophy of History (orig. 1833). I will
discuss the “conditions of mere nature” a little more in Chapter 4. On the role of freedom and selfdetermination in Hegel’s system, see Michael Inwood, A Hegel Dictionary (Oxford: Blackwell, 1992), s.v.
“freedom” (110-112).
72
73
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 13.
30
Murphy’s analysis is particularly valuable here because he not only relates these
strategies of representation to the concurrent imperial expansion taking place at the time,
but he also ties them to twentieth-century disciplinary practices:
we cannot ignore the relationship between the phenomenology of religion and
the historical phenomenon of European colonialism and imperialism. The set
of representations produced by the phenomenology of religion, despite all
protests to the contrary, … turn out to have a very strong resemblance to the
system of colonial representations as described by colonial/postcolonial
discourse theory. … [Therefore,] the phenomenology of religion, and the field
of Religious Studies insofar as it is based upon this school, are complicit in the
legitimation and reproduction of colonial representations of Europe’s
Other(s).74
Here we can see the concerns of Masuzawa, J. Z. Smith, and Olupona being more fully
elaborated, i.e. concerns about the unacknowledged (and even unrecognized) legacy of racist
nineteenth-century thought and its profound influence on twentieth-century discourses on
religion. And to see an example of this, I refer again to Hick’s comments above about the
preparatory, “childish”, and “bloodthirsty” character of pre-civilizational religion, which
illustrates perfectly Murphy’s claim about the continued reproduction of colonial discourses
even in the late twentieth century.
This leads to the final preliminary area of concern I want to highlight, which will help to
bring the above considerations together: namely how these issues relate to the
metanarrative of the Axial Age, upon which Hick grounds his reading of religious history.
Karl Jaspers was one of the last philosophers in the grand tradition of German idealism,
Ibid., 33. This obviously links with McCutcheon’s critique of Eliade and the twentieth-century study of
religion in important ways. For other important critiques of the questionable analytic legacy of the
phenomenology of religion, and its continued widespread influence, see Cox, An Introduction to the Phenomenology
of Religion, and Timothy Fitzgerald, The Ideology of Religious Studies (New York: Oxford University Press, 2000).
However I reiterate that Murphy’s is by far the most thoroughgoing treatment of the issues from a
postcolonial lens, which is what interests me most in this dissertation.
74
31
and he was especially influenced by Plato and Hegel.75 He was also a proponent of political
and theological liberalism, convictions that were galvanized by his torrid experiences in
Germany during the Second World War, where he lived in often desperate circumstances
with his Jewish wife, Gertrud.76 In Vom Urspung und Ziel der Geschichte, the first postwar
philosophy of history in Europe, Jaspers sought to explore the roots of human civilization
in an attempt to find the foundations for peaceful global relations as humanity stood at a
new threshold in world history.77 These roots he found in the 1st millennium BCE, which
he termed the Achsenzeit, the Axial Age, i.e. the “pivot point” at which humanity had first
developed the spiritual and intellectual resources that lay at the heart of the modern world
(resources that Jaspers believed must be utilized to rebuild that now-broken world). As
mentioned above, Jaspers’ treatment of this period was far more philosophically than
theologically (or historically) oriented, although he nevertheless recognized that it was in the
context of the major religious transformations of Greece, Israel, India and China that these
developments had taken place. As described by the editors of his writings,
Jaspers [saw] in the renewal of the unfinished task of reason mankind’s vast
and only chance of stemming the forces of totalitarianism that threaten to gain
the upper hand and to destroy freedom … Jaspers [developed] the theory of
the axial times when the impulse of reason first arose in humanity.78
For a detailed treatment of Jaspers’ life, which brings out his major ideas in a more accessible way than
perusing his writings alone, see Suzanne Kirkbright Karl Jaspers: A Biography: Navigations in Truth (New Haven:
Yale University Press, 2004). On the importance of Hegel, see e.g. 215 (“Jaspers stood in awe of Hegel”); on
the importance of Plato, see e.g. 206 (for Jaspers’ “ardent defence of Plato’s doctrine of Ideas”). For the best
collection of Jaspers’ writings, which ties his ouevre together well, see Karl Jaspers: Basic Philosophical Writings (ed.
E. Ehrlich, L. H. Ehrlich, & G. B. Pepper; Amherst, NY: Humanity Books, 1986).
75
76
See Kirkbright, Karl Jaspers, 142ff. See also Joas, “The Axial Age as Religious Discourse”, esp. 22.
77
Kirkbright, Karl Jaspers, 213f.
Ehrlich et al., Karl Jaspers: Basic Philosophical Writings, 381. They also comment that “to Jaspers the sense of
the study of history lies in recalling the ancient power of reason and enacting it in its communicative mode”
(382). Jaspers’ emphasis on the concept of “communication” (which he construed as a “loving struggle” for
Truth) was crucial to his program, but to treat it even in outline would necessitate too lengthy a digression.
78
32
As with the theological pluralists, Jaspers’ intentions are to be admired. But upon closer
scrutiny, his view that “reason” first emerged with civilizational culture is part of precisely
the same reading of world history that Hegel had offered with the metanarrative of Geist. In
line with virtually all nineteenth-century historical thought, the Axial Age narrative was
predicated on an interlocking set of assumptions about the differences between textual,
civilizational cultures, and non-textual, non-urban cultures: civilizational cultures were
dynamic, rational, and ethical; primitive cultures were static, irrational, and devoid of ethical
principles.79
There are certainly major differences between Jaspers’ reading of world history and
the Hegelian view: where Hegel asserted a clear teleological hierarchy in which Geist passed
from East to West culminating in enlightened, Protestant Europe, Jaspers pluralized the
relationship between the world’s major cultures and argued (explicitly contra Hegel) that it
was across all of them that “Man, as we know him today, came into being”.80 Yet while this
statement was intended as a positive affirmation, it also replicates perfectly the Hegelian
distinction between Kulturvölker and Naturvölker, one of the many permutations of the
civilized/primitive dichotomy that infused nineteenth-century thought. So again, just like
the pluralists, even though Jaspers’ aim was “the greatest inclusiveness and the most
categoric unity of human history”,81 he reproduced a form of historical emplotment that
valorizes civilizational culture in a way that continues to perpetuate the racist and generally
ill-informed perceptions of non-urban peoples by which European imperialism was
justified.
For a good inventory of the tropes I am talking about, and how they have survived in academic, popular,
and political discourses well beyond the collapse of colonialism itself, see David Spurr’s The Rhetoric of Empire:
Colonial Discourse in Journalism, Travel Writing, and Colonial Administration (Durham: Duke University Press, 1993).
These issues are addressed in Chapter 4 below.
79
80
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 1.
81
Ibid., xvi.
33
When Hick adopts the Axial Age narrative, he picks up all of this baggage. I refer to
both the comment above about the preparatory nature of archaic religion, as well as the fact
that the Axial Age narrative is Hick’s point of departure in An Interpretation of Religion.82
Enough has already been said enough about the discrepancy between the implications of
this view of history and Hick’s methodological and ethical commitments, so it is sufficient
for now simply to point out Hick’s relation to the Axial Age construct. But it should be
clear that the Axial Age narrative is also beset by the other problems outlined above: the
axial religions are the “world” religions; the axial religions constitute the highest
manifestations of the “essence” of religion (i.e. “transcendence”); and the whole “axial”
idea is another instantiation of the structures of colonial discourse and their reproduction
even into the twentieth century.
It must also be noted that since Jaspers’ original formulation, the Axial Age idea has
been developed by scholars other than Hick. Much of Jaspers’ historical analysis was based
upon the comparative historical sociology of Max Weber, and in Jaspers’ wake that line of
scholarship was continued.83 Initially, the work was led by S. N. E. Eisenstadt and Eric
Voegelin, who began to map out a more comprehensive historical comparison of the axial
civilizations, Eisenstadt in particular spearheading a number of multi-specialist collections
dedicated to that task.84 Although philosophical questions have always remained important
The first chapter of An Interpretation of Religion after the introduction is entitled “The Soteriological Character
of Post-Axial Religion” (21-35).
82
83 In addition to Hegel and Plato, Jaspers also idolized Weber tremendously, as is clear from much of his
private correspondence (cf. e.g. Kirkbright 251, where Jaspers says in a letter to his parents of 1910 that
Weber “ist die klügste Mann, mit dem ich bis jetzt gesprochen habe”, a reverential view he maintained 10
years later upon the sad news of Weber’s death [cf. 254]). See also Karl Jaspers on Max Weber (ed. J. Dreijmanis;
trans. R. J. Whelan; New York: Paragon, 1989), which brings together Jaspers’ numerous published writings
on Weber and reveals the extraordinary extent of his reverence. Jaspers even called him the “Galilei of the
Geisteswissenschaften” (xvi), and emphatically regretted that Weber’s brilliance had not been more widely
appreciated.
84 Amongst other important works, Voegelin wrote a Japserian-influenced treatment of world history called
Order and History (5 vols; Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1956-1987). Eisenstadt’s individual
contributions include Revolution and Transformation of Societies: A Comparative Study of Civilizations (New York: Free
Press, 1978) and “The Axial Age: The Emergence of Transcendental Visions and the Rise of Clerics”,
34
in this trajectory, the primary focus has instead been on social-scientific forms of analysis.
Most recently, this trajectory has led to the magnum opus of Robert Bellah, Religion in
Human Evolution: From The Paleolithic to the Axial Age (2011), a work that represents a true
watershed in the academic study of religious history.85
Unfortunately, proper consideration of this body of work falls outside the scope of
this dissertation. Certain elements of Bellah’s contribution will be considered in Chapter 5
and the Conclusion, but a full treatment would take things too far afield. Suffice it to say,
however, that while Bellah has laid the ground for an evolutionary treatment of religion that
moves well beyond the methodological divides of the nineteenth and twentieth centuries,
the fact that he and his interlocutors still talk in terms of an “axial” age shows that many of
the older assumptions continue to play an important role even in the more sophisticated
contemporary paradigm.86 Whilst a few of these issues have been mentioned in critical
asides from some of those involved in the current discussion, there is yet to be any
sustained interrogation of the central categories of the Axial Age discourse that brings to
light the way in which they continue to perpetuate discursive structures that have been
rejected in most other academic contexts.87 Therefore, although I will confine my critique to
European Journal of Science 23 (1982): 294-314. His three important edited publications are The Origins and
Diversity of Axial Age Civilizations (Albany: SUNY Press, 1986); Kulturen der Achsenzeit (5 vols; Frankfurt am
Main: Suhrkamp, 1987-1992), and (with J. P. Arnason and B. Wittrock) Axial Civilizations and World History
(Leiden: Brill, 2005).
Bellah, R., Religion in Human Evolution: From the Paleolithic to the Axial Age (Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press, 2011). I will mention again later why I think Bellah’s work is so much more productive than
the typical evolutionary approaches, but in summary it is because he opens space for a more inclusive
conversation that can bridge the methodological gap between scholars who approach the question of religion
evolutionarily, anthropologically, and via traditional means of philological and archaeological analysis. This
quality is missing from virtually all other contemporary evolutionary treatments of religion (see n. 95 below).
85
86 By “Bellah’s interlocutors” I mean primarily the scholars who contributed to the 2012 volume The Axial Age
and Its Consequences (see n. 7 above), which is the companion volume to Religion in Human Evolution and was the
result of a 2008 conference in which draft chapters of Bellah’s work were precirculated as stimulus to the
discussion. For the way in which the intellectual legacy of the nineteenth century still has uncritical currency in
the contemporary debate, see Jack Tsonis, “Review: The Axial Age and Its Consequences” in the Alternative Religion
and Spirituality Review 3 (2012): 262-267.
Of particular critical value are the essays in The Axial Age and Its Consequences by Jan Assmann, “Cultural
Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age” (366-407); José Casanova, “Religion, the Axial Age, and Secular
87
35
the Axial Age as deployed by Jaspers and Hick, this begins to address another lacuna in
contemporary scholarship on religion and lays the platform for a much more thorough
investigation. Some directions that might be taken in this critique will be discussed near the
end of this work, as they have important bearing on my overall argument about the
problems inherent in using theological essentialism within an evolutionary view of human
history.
Having now outlined these concerns and their relation to a number of major critical
trends in the academic study of religion, it remains only to explain the way in which the
argument will unfold.
The Critical Shape of this Work
This dissertation is fundamentally a work of discourse analysis, one that is based upon a
rigorous historicization of the conceptual paradigms that inform theological pluralism. It
situates Hick in relation to a long European tradition of talking about religious history,
examines the way in which he unreflectively relied on a number of problematic ideas, and
amplifies the subtextual implications of these ideas to bring out the way in which they
fundamentally undermine the pluralistic ethos that animated his life and work.88 It therefore
relies on the strategies of analysis pioneered by figures such as Barthes, Foucault, Derrida,
Said, Butler, and many others, including those who have specifically addressed the western
Modernity in Bellah’s Theory of Religious Evolution” (191-221); and Björn Wittrock, “The Axial Age in
Global History: Cultural Crystallizations and Societal Transformations” (102-125).
For an excellent outline of the principles of discourse analysis that reflect the approach taken here, see
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, especially the methodological orientation of chapter 2. I treat Hick particular
along the lines of Murphy’s distillation that “[a] text cannot be seen as a self-contained system of
signifiers/signifieds, for its system of meanings draws upon a series of pre-existent meanings, formulae,
tropes, clichés, conventions, genres, taxonomies, myths, characters, histories, ideologems, and other historicocultural-linguistic items” (50).
88
36
discourse on religion such as Masuzawa, J. Z. Smith, McCutcheon, and Murphy.89 Yet in my
critique of the Axial Age construct, and particularly when considering different explanatory
paradigms that might be developed to account for the cultural transformations of the
period in ways that do not rely on ideas like Geist, I am also heavily informed by various
forms of anthropology and evolutionary history. This dissertation therefore traverses a
number of distinct disciplinary domains, but I hope to show that this somewhat
unconventional approach can open up new conceptual space in which to interrogate one of
the most important currents of contemporary religious thought. The argument proceeds as
follows.
Chapter 2 begins with a detailed but non-critical exposition of John Hick and the
pluralist theory of religions. By “non-critical” I simply mean a reading that does not yet
engage the above concerns, and instead focuses on establishing the structure of Hick’s
argument. Not only will this lay a base for the subsequent chapters, but introducing Hick in
this way is consistent with my attempt to avoid over-simplifying his claims. The chapter
begins by addressing the question of whether Hick’s argument can be called a “theory” in
the proper sense of the term. Although I am sympathetic to scholars like McCutcheon who
reserve the term only for “non-religious” explanations of religion, I use the term in a
slightly broader sense of “sustained philosophical argument”. I justify doing so by first
providing an overview of the modern enterprise of theories of religion – mapping out first
the history of naturalistic theories, and then the counter-discourse of “religious” theories,
which extend from Schleiermacher, through Otto and Eliade, to Hick.
Following this, attention turns to the biographical context in which Hick’s theory of
pluralism emerged, namely the way in which it grew out of his first-hand experience of
Bruce Lincoln is another scholar who has made excellent use of the discourse-analytical approach in the
study of religion, and his work is constantly cited in critical studies in the discipline. Yet he has focused more
on the discursive construction of society than on the concept-historicization approach of someone like J. Z.
Smith, hence why I spend more time with Smith in this work (cf. n. 20 above).
89
37
multiculturalism. Keeping the biographical context of Hick’s theory in view is important,
because it highlights the broader ethos that he tried to promote throughout his life,
something that will be important to consider later. This will leave things in a good position
to then offer a detailed examination of the argument of An Interpretation of Religion,
particularly the way that Hick augments his ethos at the methodological level via (a) an
argument for epistemological perspectivism, and (b) a comparison of the ethical and
experiential similarities amongst the traditions. The final section of the chapter provides an
extended examination of the traditional criticisms that have been leveled against theological
pluralism, outlining what I discern to be the five most common complaints. Aside from
helping to demonstrate the distinct contribution of this dissertation, which revolves issues
different from those raised in the traditional criticisms, this is important for two reasons:
firstly because it defends Hick’s theory against a host of criticisms that have typically
misread the way in which his argument works (something again in line with the non-critical
approach of the chapter); and secondly, because by making this defence I establish a much
more justifiable ground from which to launch my own critique.90
Chapter 3 shifts gears into a more critical mode, and turns from Hick to the discourse
on world religions at a broader level. The particular concern here will be to historicize the
rhetoric of “great traditions” that permeates Hick’s work, bringing to light the host of
unstated assumptions about the apparently not-so-great traditions that are implied in this
discourse.91 In other words, the aim of this chapter is to bring to the foreground the host of
90 It is important to mention that Hick responded to 15 years of criticism in the preface to the second edition
of An Interpretation of Religion (2nd ed.; New Haven: Yale University Press, 2004), xvii-xli. In my view, Hick
offers a reasonable defence of most challenges that he addresses. But two things must be noted: 1) almost all
of the 15 criticisms Hick lists are variations on the theme of pluralism’s formal philosophical validity; and thus
2), none of them revolve around the issues raised in the following chapters. As such, rather than survey Hick’s
points of defence, I offer my own assessment of the traditional criticisms in a way that allows me to raise
methodological issues that will become important throughout the rest of this work.
91 The rhetoric of “great traditions” is effectively homologous to the phraseology of “world religions”, and it
seems to me that Hick preferred the former mainly on account of its slightly more lyrical flourish.
38
historically embedded assumptions that constitute the world religions discourse,
assumptions that usually operate well below the level of explicit formulation because of the
positive sentiment of most pluralist arguments. Specifically, I want to bring into focus (a)
the qualitative hierarchy that existed between textual religions and non-textual religions in
the period before the twentieth century; and (b) how even in the pluralistic world religions
paradigm of the twentieth century, the dominant categories of the discourse continued to
perpetuate the racist hierarchies of the nineteenth century in subtle but foundational ways,
despite the fact that those hierarchies were denounced at the explicit level.
These issues are brought into focus by tracing changing forms of classification in the
western study of religion from the sixteenth century through to the mid-twentieth century,
the time at which Hick and Cantwell Smith were writing. The chapter begins by establishing
the pre-nineteenth century background of European knowledge about other religious
traditions, and the fourfold typology of classification in this period – i.e. the typology of
Christianity, Judaism, Islam, and Everything Else (usually a category such as “paganism” or
“idolatry”). The second section then surveys the momentous intellectual transformations of
the nineteenth century, mapping two specific trajectories: firstly the emergence of the
comparative “Science of Religion”, which was grounded in textually-focused philological
scholarship and brought about the conceptual differentiation of a number of distinct major
religions; and secondly, the concurrent emergence of anthropology as the disciplinary
domain for the treatment of “primitive” cultures. As will become clear, this methodological
divide was foundational in the discursive circumscription of non-textual religions even in
the twentieth century. The third section of the chapter then charts the consolidation of the
world religions paradigm in the mid-twentieth century, focusing first on its transmutation
from Religionswissenschaft into the phenomenology of religion, and then on the influential role
of scholars such as Eliade, Huston Smith, and Wilfred Cantwell Smith in the wide diffusion
of the paradigm as “religious studies” became a distinct discipline in the period after the
39
1960s. The chapter concludes by synthesizing a number of theoretical concerns about the
world religions paradigm that have recently been voiced by scholars such as J. Z. Smith,
Masuzawa, Olupona, and Murphy, many of which have already been signalled above.
Having brought into focus the major problems that pertain to the discourse of world
religions at a general level, Chapter 4 returns to Hick’s theory with these concerns in mind
and subjects his strategies of representation to detailed critical scrutiny. This is done by
focusing on his use of the Axial Age narrative, because it is here that Hick’s reproduction of
the nineteenth century inheritance is most clear. The first section of the chapter charts the
trajectory that the Axial Age construct took from Hegel to Hick, focusing particularly on
Jaspers’ original formulation and its indebtedness to the Hegelian narrative of world history.
After showing the numerous points at which Hick explicitly reproduces this baggage, I then
identify at least six standard tropes of colonial discourse with regard to “primitive” culture
that are seamlessly woven into his argument – at which point attention is drawn to the fact
that these views necessarily pertain not just to “archaic” religions, but also to the many nonworld religions that still exist today (something about which critics like Olupona are rightly
indignant).92
Once this tension is in full view, it becomes clear just how greatly the Axial Age
narrative conflicts with Hick’s staunch advocacy of anti-racist causes in his wider life – and
thus the way it conflicts with the liberal, democratic, non-hierarchal ethos that underpins
theological pluralism in virtually all of its contemporary manifestations. The chapter
concludes by then reflecting on the question: what would Hick have said if faced with these
92 The treatment of Australian Aboriginal groups is one illustrative example of the way in which nineteenthcentury ideas can still have major political consequences in a twentieth-century context. For a cogent
discussion of how Aboriginal attempts to gain legal rights over certain sacred and spiritual sights were for a
very long time confounded – firstly by long-entrenched European attitudes about the “undeveloped” nature
of Aboriginal culture, and then by lingering confusions about the nature of “Aboriginal religion” once
attitudes did begin to shift – see Marion Maddox, For God and Country: Religious Dynamics in Australian Federal
Politics (Canberra: Department of the Parliamentary Library, 2001), esp. ch. 6, “ Sacred Sites and the Public
Square”, 245-283.
40
criticisms? I will consider the example of Huston Smith mentioned above, who describes
the way in which he initially had no regard for “primitive” religions, but then after an
encounter with Native American culture beginning in the 1970s he began to argue that even
indigenous and oral traditions bore witness to the same profound truth as all of the great
religions.93 Hick never faced the same impetus to address this issue, but everything about
his life suggests that he would have broadly assented to Huston Smith’s perspective had
anyone pressed him on the question.
However, given that Hick (d. 2012) cannot respond to this challenge, attention turns to
the more productive question about why, in spite of his wider commitments, he ultimately
articulated a comprehensive theory of religion that reinforced the racially-based Eurocentric
narrative of world history that he was trying to overcome, a narrative whose implications
are completely counter to the ethos of his life and work. The answer I am proposing is: the
discourse made him do it. The intellectual formations inherited by Hick – his great-traditionscentrism, the developmental view of world history, non-civilizational cultures as static and
unethical – all of these inherited formations caused him to think this way, and made his
theory seem like an unproblematic and even egalitarian reading of history.94 However, I
want to stress now, as I will stress later, that I am not accusing Hick of racism – I am accusing
him of reproducing racist discourse. This is a very different charge, as it keeps the attack ad
theorem and not ad hominem. Moreover, by focusing on the discourse, i.e. the way in which
scholars have traditionally talked about certain ideas, space opens up for a more productive
conversation to take place once the problems have been properly brought to the table.
Yet I will need to make good on this promise, for at this stage the analysis will only
have been deconstructive. As such, the final chapter explores some constructive directions
93
See n. 16 above.
94 I note again the way in which Murphy describes any text as necessarily participating in a much larger
economy of meaning (see n. 88 above).
41
that could be taken in the religious history of “the entire human race” that are not
predicated on the discourses employed by Hick and Jaspers – because the fact remains that
despite the untenable assumptions embedded in the original idea of the Axial Age, there
were remarkable and far-reaching intellectual transformations across a wide range of
geographical locations around the time of the 1st millennium BCE, which set the
foundation for some of the most enduring cultural traditions of human history. How are
these transformations to be explained? If the old idealist view is no longer sufficient, what
alternative explanatory paradigms might be constructed? I will come to that shortly.95 But
up to this point, it will only have been assumed that the tropes of the Axial Age are
incommensurable with contemporary historiographical practice and contemporary political
sensibilities. Just because many of its ideas about non-textual cultures are unpalatable to
modern democratic sensibilities, does that mean they are incorrect?
In Chapter 5, I make a sustained case that the key assumptions of the Axial Age can be
convincingly rejected by examining a number of shifts in western historiographical practice
over the past century, particularly since the 1960s. The reader should be aware that
discussion in this chapter will range quite broadly before bringing things back to the Axial
Age, although the perspectives generated will be extremely useful when considering
explanatory options that seem to avoid many of the traditional problems. Focus is placed
Let me point out here that Chapter 5 does not deal with the standard evolutionary “explanations” of
religion represented by partisans of the atheist movement such as Pascal Boyer, Daniel Dennett, and Scot
Atran (even though their scholarship obviously has merit in many respects – particular, in my view, the wideranging work of Atran). See esp. Boyer, Religion Explained: The Evolutionary Origins of Religious Thought (New
York: Basic Book, 2001); Dennett, Breaking the Spell: Religion as a Natural Phenomenon (New York: Penguin,
2006); and Atran, In Gods We Trust: The Evolutionary Landscape of Religion (New York: Oxford University Press,
2002). Instead, I want to take the more interesting approach of keeping focus on how one might explain the
religious transformations of the 1st millennium BCE without the scaffolding of the Geist metanarrative, a
question which involves a totally different body of scholarship. For an excellent overview of the major
contemporary theories of religion (including the three abovementioned), see Michael Stausberg’s edited
collection, Contemporary Theories of Religion: A Critical Companion (London: Routledge, 2009). However as noted
above, I regard Robert Bellah’s recent Religion in Human Evolution as surpassing all of the scholarship surveyed
in Stausberg’s volume – not just in its explanatory potential, but also because it takes a far less hostile tone to
traditional forms of religion, thereby inviting a more productive conversation amongst specialists from
different fields (see n. 85 above).
95
42
on three different trajectories of historiographical change. The first is the slow movement
away from the textocentric paradigm of documentary history that informed the nineteenth
and much of the twentieth century. Understanding this shift is essential given that Jaspers
accepts a fundamental dividing line between history and prehistory, holding the standard
view that “History extends as far back as linguistic [i.e. written] evidence … History has
therefore lasted about 5000 years”.96 After a glance at how this position was represented by
Leopold von Ranke, I survey several of the major critical challenges to this view that
emerged in the twentieth century: Annales historiography, British marxist historiography,
social history, and then feminism and post-structuralism.
The second historiographical shift examined is the changing shape of prehistory, i.e.
the complete reconfiguration of the depth and complexity of knowledge about the human
past since Darwin’s Origin of Species and other works of geology that eroded the old
chronological parameters of Christian sacred history. Published in 1859, Darwin’s work
coincided with a number of other important archaeological findings which were placing
beyond doubt that “the antiquity of man” extended into the deep geological past. The next
major development came in the mid-twentieth century with what David Christian has called
“the chronometric revolution”, in which methods were finally attained for the absolute
dating of material traces of the past that allowed for a global (rather than regional) synthesis
of the long period of human history before the epoch of written documents.97 The most
recent major development in the evolutionary paradigm came in the latter stages of the
twentieth century with the advent of genetic analysis, which was opened up by the
discovery of DNA. In conjunction with the growing archaeological record, this meant that
96
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 28.
See e.g. Christian, D., “The Return of Universal History”, History and Theory, 49 (2010): 6-27, here 17. For
elaboration of the issues, see Christian, D., Maps of Time: An Introduction to Big History (Berkeley: University of
California Press, 2004), 65-67, 494-495.
97
43
scholars could finally construct defensible chronologies of hominid evolution and establish
the place of Homo sapiens in the hominid line, as well as posit a rough outline of the patterns
of migration out of Africa.
This has led to a form of viewing long-term human history that has only been
consolidated since the 1990s and is still very much carving out discursive space. David
Christian has been one scholar at the forefront of this historiographical expansion, and is
the architect of the paradigm he calls “big history” – a form of universal history that unites
cosmological, geological, biological, and cultural trajectories into an over-arching historical
narrative, effectively representing a massively expanded version of the longue durée
perspective developed by Braudel and the Annales historians.98 Another version of the
evolutionary historiographical paradigm is represented by Daniel Lord Smail and the
concept of “deep history”, which focuses specifically on hominid history over the last 2.2
million years.99 The work of Smail and Christian represents a new intellectual agenda in the
study of human history, one that resonates with earlier attempts at (in Jaspers’ words) “the
greatest inclusiveness and the most categoric unity” of our species, but which is grounded
in a new paradigm of biological and cultural change that is based upon a hugely enlarged
empirical and analytical database.
The third and final historiographical reorientation to be discussed concerns recent
developments in what I loosely term “communications history”.100 Here I address one of
the most important questions that arises in the new evolutionary view: namely, what
98 Christian discusses his project in relation to Braudel’s longue durée in e.g. “The Return of Universal History”,
7. William McNeill was one of the pioneers of “world history”, which carried a similar emphasis to the Annales
school; see esp. his The Rise of the West: A History of the Human Community (Chicago: Chicago University Press,
1963).
99 See Smail, D., On Deep History and the Brain (Berkeley: University of California Press, 2008). For a defence of
the deep history paradigm and several case studies of its application, see also Deep History: The Architecture of
Past and Present (ed. D. Smail & A. Shyrock; Berkeley: University of California Press, 2011).
The supplementary bibliography has been provided primarily for this section of the dissertation. The reader
will be directed to it via the footnotes at various stages of the discussion.
100
44
accounts for the astonishing acceleration of human cultural development over the last
100,000 years when no other species on earth has been able to break out of the slow
processes of biological change over evolutionary time? While this may seem like an odd
question to ask, it is absolutely crucial in the context of my argument, and cannot be
avoided in any serious attempt to challenge the idealist theory of the Axial Age – because if
Geist is not the principal agent of change in human history, then how do we account for
that change? Traditionally Geist, or something like it, has been the only real answer that
scholars have offered. But the possibilities of a convincing new answer have begun to
emerge: the key factor in the rapidity of cultural change in Homo sapiens is the powerful
capacity for collective learning inherent in modern human language. After surveying David
Christian’s argument to this effect and providing some illustrative examples of the
foundational role of communications technologies in major periods of historical change, I
make clear how this relates to the issue of the Axial Age.101 The difference traditionally
posited between the axial religions and the pre-axial religions is the “transcendent”
character of the former versus the “world accepting” character of the latter. My question
therefore becomes: is there a manner of accounting for these (perceived) differences
sociologically by paying attention to the different ideational dynamics inherent in the textuallybased religions of sedentary agrarian cultures vis-à-vis the cultural systems of small-scale
oral societies?102
101 The examples are: modern human language, the invention of writing, the invention of alphabetic
typography in early modern Europe, and then the development of global information networks opened up by
the mastering of electricity in the nineteenth century. Whilst this represents an unusually broad spread,
viewing these different moments synoptically helps to bring out the utter fundamentality of such technologies
in all other historical change. (But I note that these comments should be balanced with those in n. 106 below
on the importance of ecological factors in the rise of large urban societies.)
102 Let me be clear that “ideational dynamics” refers to the notion of “ideation”, i.e. the formation of thought.
Therefore ideational dynamics are the pressures and tendencies by which groups develop, maintain, and engage with
traditions of thought.
45
Although this question could be addressed from a number of angles, I approach it by
turning to evolutionary psychologist Merlin Donald, whose scheme of human cognitive
evolution is extremely useful in this regard, particularly because it has been used by Bellah
as the narrative backbone of Religion in Human Evolution.103 I outline Donald’s scheme by
focusing on the three major shifts he posits in the development of modern human
cognition: (1) “mimetic” culture, a form of precise voluntary motor control that emerged
with Homo habilis over 2 million years ago, which laid the ground for symbolic
representation long before modern language; (2) “mythic” culture, by which he means the
use of narrative to frame and understand human life, something that emerged with modern
language somewhere between 250,000-100,000 years ago and still plays a central role in
human cognition; and (3) “theoretic” culture, a form of collective intellectual activity that
becomes possible with the use of writing, i.e. when individuals and groups have access to
vast networks of externalized human communication.104 This last point is particularly
relevant in the present context: prior to the invention of writing, human memory was
almost wholly contained within biological limits. But once durable systems for the external
representation of language had been developed, a completely new dynamic opened up
between past and present in all cultures that adopted the new technology, a change that was
Donald’s two key works are Origins of the Modern Mind: Three Stages in the Evolution of Culture and Cognition
(Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1991), and A Mind So Rare (New York: Norton, 2001). I cannot
fully discuss Bellah’s use of Donald, although a basic outline comes through in the discussion of Chapter 5
below.
103
Donald is clear throughout his works that one stage does not “replace” the other. Rather, the transitions
are long processes that involve a complex overlapping in which we retain key elements of our biological
heritage, and he calls us “hybrid minds”. For instance, whilst everybody in the world today is affected
somehow by networks of external information, we remain highly mimetic creatures (which helps to
understand the way in which different cultures operate with shared forms of emotive embodiment, learned in
the earliest years, which are virtually impossible to communicate to foreigners); and we also remain
fundamentally oral and narratival creatures despite the manifold ways in which our forms of communication,
memory, and culture have been augmented by external devices.
104
46
intensified by the vastly different existential pressures entailed in the new situation of
stratified, urban societies.105
This is precisely the kind of thing that has been overlooked in the traditional idealist
reading of the 1st millennium BCE, so I elaborate Donald’s examples by drawing in other
scholars who have focused on the forms of culture he describes: namely the work of
anthropologists on the psychodynamics of oral cultures, and then historians of early
civilization who have focused on the foundational role of writing and the massive changes
that resulted in the dynamics of cultural memory. This will leave things well placed to return
to the Axial Age in the final section of the chapter. I begin by outlining the way in which all
of the above developments entail the forceful rejection of the major tropes of the Axial Age
narrative, which are untenable at an empirical level even aside from the serious moral issues
inherent in the reproduction of nineteenth-century racism and the structures of colonial
discourse. Considering that the Axial Age construct still has currency in contemporary
scholarship, these issues are particularly important to call to attention.
Discussion then returns to the fundamental question posed above about possible
explanatory paradigms that are not predicated on idealism and which pay much more
attention to the material factors underpinning the momentous shifts of the period. I will
follow Donald as well as Jan Assmann, the primary theorist of cultural memory, who both
redescribe the period as one in which the transgenerational dynamics of cultural memory
opened up by writing, as well as the new pressures of stratified urban societies, engendered
new creative tensions between past and present which resulted in the radically new
character of the major textual religions vis-à-vis their smaller oral counterparts. If this
I rely greatly here on the analysis of Jan Assmann and his work on the concept of “cultural memory” (aside
from “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, see Cultural Memory and Early Civilization [Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 2012 (1992)]). However I have also been heavily influenced by the work of
Walter Ong (see e.g. Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word [London: Routledge, 1982]), as well as the
numerous other figures listed in the supplementary bibliography.
105
47
reading is found even broadly persuasive, then the Axial Age loses its transcendental lustre
as the pivotal point in human religious history, and becomes simply another fascinating
example of how some of the most far-reaching changes in human culture over time have
been related to major revolutions in how we communicate with each other.106
In the Conclusion, I reflect on what all of this means for theological pluralism. As has
been stressed, all pluralists advocate the highest standards of critical scholarship. Indeed,
Hick and Jaspers opened their major works with clear acknowledgements that the ground
was continually shifting, and that their theories might need to be revised as new information
came to light. Moreover, they both welcomed attempts to come up with better theories if
the need could be demonstrated.107 I think it is safe to say that, in light even of the
discussion so far, such a need can indeed been demonstrated, and that the traditional
idealist reading of human religious history is simply not tenable in the context of
contemporary academic discourse. The implications here are far-reaching, but I will save
further comment until the argument has been made in full.
I want to be clear that I do not place the same importance on technologies of communication in the wider
issue of the rise of large urban societies, as other ecological factors played a much greater role in this early
development. Aside from factors at the geological level (especially the end of the ice age and the expansion of
habitable worldzones), the other foundational developments were those to do with the invention of
agriculture, which allowed larger population densities, therefore a greater division of labour, and thus the
creation of a host of new social role unknown in smaller societies. As such, the invention of writing is very
much a by-product of those developments, not their cause, as argued cogently by Hans J. Nissen in The Early
History of the Ancient Near East, 9000-2000 B.C. (trans. E. Lutzeier & K. J. Northcott; Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1988 [1983]); see also Massimo Livi-Bacci’s A Concise History of World Population (Cambridge,
MA: Blackwell, 1992), esp. ch. 3 (thanks go to my colleague David Baker here for pointing me in the direction
of these works). However, let me stress that writing is the most important factor when examining the
emergence of the “axial” religions, as will become clear when returning to the work of Assmann and Donald.
106
See Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, xiii; and Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 18. Their comments
are considered more fully in the Conclusion.
107
48
Chapter 2
John Hick and the Pluralist Theory of Religions
So far Hick’s argument has been referred to as a “theory” of religion without calling to
attention some of the problems with using this term. As was made clear in the previous
chapter, Hick stands in the tradition of phenomenological essentialism, which advocates a
“non-reductive” approach to religion. Russell McCutcheon has therefore taken issue with
Hick’s use of the term “theory” to describe his argument, because he understands the
concept to designate an analytical approach that explains a set of data using critical
paradigms, whereas a phenomenological approach such as Hick’s merely “interprets” that
data set along relatively non-critical lines.1 At stake here is a debate about the proper
methods that should pertain to the (allegedly) non-theological discipline of religious studies,
and McCutcheon’s complaint stems from his view that the academic study of religion
should be comprised of the same methods that constitute the other social sciences. In other
words, because McCutcheon rejects the notion that “religion” is an irreducible, sui generis
phenomenon, then he rejects as “theological” (rather than “theoretical”) all approaches that
are based on essentialism, such as those of Hick and Eliade. McCutcheon sees no place for
these approaches in the academic study of religion, and has been a vocal critic on the issue.2
As will become clear at the end of this work, I am sympathetic to McCutcheon’s
concerns and I agree with many of his methodological proposals. Yet as indicated in the
1 Although he has made this point in numerous places, see esp. “‘My Theory of the Brontosaurus…’:
Postmodernism and ‘Theory’ of Religion” in Critics not Caretakers: Redescribing the Public Study of Religion (Albany:
SUNY Press, 2001), 103-121. Here he suggests that use of the word “theory” to describe arguments such as
Hick’s rely on a loose, common parlance sense of the term which “now denotes anything from a hypothesis to
a conjecture” (111).
In addition to Critics Not Caretakers, see also Manufacturing Religion (New York: Oxford University Press,
1997); and The Discipline of Religion: Structure, Meaning, Rhetoric (New York: Routledge, 2003). This call has been
echoed by many other critics, see e.g. Timothy Fitzgerald, The Ideology of Religious Studies (New York: Oxford
University Press, 2000); and Donald Wiebe The Politics of Religious Studies: the Continuing Conflict with Theology and
the Academy (New York: St Martin’s Press, 1999).
2
51
previous chapter, my aim here is to introduce Hick’s argument without yet highlighting any
points of complaint, in order to lay a base for the following chapters. As a first step of this
non-critical reading, I want to avoid a protracted semantic debate about precisely how to
categorize Hick’s argument. On the one hand, he is not offering a theory in McCutcheon’s
strict, “naturalistic” sense of the term. On the other hand, he is offering a rigorously
justified philosophical argument, one that he hoped would be subjected to scrutiny from
well beyond the confines of theological debate. Moreover, while McCutcheon views
“theory” as inherently “non-religious”, if we take his basic position that a theory “goes
beyond mere self-reports” in explaining the behaviour of individual and groups,3 then
Hick’s argument – whose redescriptive nature will be discussed in detail below – can easily
be classed as a theory, because it is a clear attempt to explain pan-human religiosity in ways
not fully reconcilable with the self-understanding of each tradition.4 Furthermore, to say
that any explanation which does not result in a “non-religious” conclusion is the only thing
that can be called a theory is surely foreclosing the debate a little too quickly, even if I (like
McCutcheon) ultimately find those explanations inadequate. And as suggested earlier,
treating Hick in this way (rather than simply treating him as engaging in crypto-theology) is
consonant with the approach he advocated, given that he attempted to “take full account of
the data and theories of the human sciences” and harmonize his views with non-theological
scholarship. I will therefore treat Hick as offering a theory of religion in the broader sense
3 McCutcheon, The Discipline of Religion, 23. I should add that while I do not have a problem with treating
Hick’s argument as a theory in the context of this dissertation, I certainly agree with McCutcheon that this
would not appropriate in a pedagogical context, which is the main contention in “‘My Theory of the
Brontosaurus…’”.
Other works on theories of religion do sometimes call Hick’s argument a theory, simply a
“transcendentalist” as opposed to “non-transcendentalist” one. See e.g. the discussion of Michael Stausberg,
“There Is Life in the Old Dog Yet: An Introduction to Contemporary Theories of Religion” in Contemporary
Theories of Religion: A Critical Companion (ed. M. Stausberg; London: Routledge, 2009), 1-21, here 11f. See also
the following two footnotes.
4
52
of a “sustained philosophical argument”, and simply examine the contents of that
argument.
But to get a better perspective on this issue, the chapter begins with a brief overview
of the modern enterprise of theories of religion. It first surveys naturalistic theories from
the sixteenth century through to contemporary scientific theories, and then trace the
counter-discourse of “religious” theories of religion, which stem from Friedrich
Schleiermacher and include figures such as Otto, Eliade, and Hick.5 Situating Hick more
thoroughly within this trajectory will help to establish the methodological suppositions of
his argument without getting bogged down in precise classification.
The middle section of the chapter then undertakes a detailed examination of the
“pluralistic hypothesis” presented in Hick’s major work, An Interpretation of Religion, looking
first at the biographical details that motivated its production, then at the methodological
operations by which Hick defends his claims. The final section examines the critical
response to Hick’s work, looking at what I discern to be the five main criticisms that have
been leveled against it. This will serve as a literature review, and will thus make clear the
specific contribution of this dissertation. Yet because of the inadequacies I perceive in the
current body of criticism, in this chapter I will actually defend Hick’s argument from the
challenges thusfar posed to it. Not only is this consistent with my attempt to avoid attacking
a straw man version of pluralism, but it will also leave me well placed to scrutinize the real
problem with pluralism for the rest of this work.
These figures are often included in surveys of theories of religion. See e.g. Daniel Pals, Seven Theories of
Religion (New York: Oxford University Press, 1996) [discusses Eliade]; James Thrower, Religion: The Classical
Theories (Washington, D.C.: Georgetown University Press, 1999) [discusses Schleiermacher, Otto, William
James, and others]; and Seth Kunin, Religion: The Modern Theories (Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University
Press, 2003) [discusses Schleiermacher, Eliade, van der Leeuw, and others].
5
53
The Modern Enterprise of Theories of Religion
Theories of religion have a long history, and fall into one of two broad classes: naturalistic
(or “reductionist”), and religious (“non-reductionist” or “essentialist”).6 Naturalistic theories
attempt to “explain” religion by reducing it to other causal factors – whether sociological,
psychological, economic, or evolutionary – and thus treat “religion” as simply another
aspect of human culture that can be studied by the normal means of intellectual inquiry.
This is the only approach that counts as a “theory” in McCutcheon’s view. Nonreductionist theories, by contrast, try to explain the variety of humanity’s religious beliefs as
different responses to an autonomous reality – God/the Sacred/the Transcendent – i.e.
something that is sui generis and thus not reducible to other causal factors. This means that, in
the essentialist view, reductionist theories essentially miss the point of what religion “is all
about” by explaining it as something other than a relationship with an actual transcendent
Reality. As suggested, Hick’s argument is a non-reductive theory, and is one of only a few to
have been offered in the post-Enlightenment period. The majority of theories have been
naturalistic and social-scientific, and it has, moreover, been in response to these naturalistic
theories that non-reductionist theories have typically been offered. So before justifying why
Hick’s argument can be treated as a theory in this broad sense of the term, it is necessary to
provide a brief history of naturalistic theories of religion.
Like the idea of “religion” itself (i.e. a generic concept), theories about religion begin
roughly with the emergence of the modern state in the wake of the post-Reformation
religious wars in early modern Europe.7 Some of the earliest non-theological attempts to
6 In making this distinction I am following the categorization of scholars such as Stausberg, Thrower, Kunin,
and indeed Hick himself. Stausberg (11) catalogues other terms used in recent scholarship to describe these
two broad classes: Christian vs. secular; theological/insider vs. non-theological/outsider; believers vs. nonbelievers; theological vs. naturalist; religious vs. social-scientific. (To this list one should also add emic vs. etic.)
As noted later, however, not every theory that is redescriptive is necessarily reductive. This is precisely the case
with someone like Hick.
Here I follow the narrative of J. Samuel Preus, who charts the rise of naturalistic theories of religion from
Jean Bodin in the late sixteenth century; see Explaining Religion: Criticism and Theory From Bodin To Freud (New
7
54
account for the origin and diversity of religious belief were those of Jean Bodin (15301596), Herbert of Cherbury (1583-1648), and especially David Hume (1711-1776).8 As the
Enlightenment gathered pace through the eighteenth century, religion was also redescribed
in non-theological terms by thinkers such as Kant and Hegel, both of whom attempted to
subsume “religion” (identified mainly with folk superstition or dogmatic theology) under
“philosophy” (a more “mature” system of understanding the world that had little time for
divine revelation or the authority of tradition).9
However, with the exception of Hume, most thinkers of the period were not
offering what we know today as theories of religion. The first such modern theory, i.e. the
first fully-fledged reductionist account of religion after Hume, came in 1841 with Ludwig
Feuerbach’s The Essence of Christianity, which famously argued that “God” was just an
idealized projection of the human subject, but one that had been misrecognised and treated
as if it were an independent reality – meaning that all theology was really anthropology,
Haven: Yale University Press, 1987). On the modern concept of “religion” see n. 58, ch.1 above. The
simultaneous emergence of “religion” and “theories of religion” is more than a coincidence, as Peter Harrison
has suggested: “Paradoxical though it may sound, it is evident from the philosophy of science that objects of
study are shaped to a large degree by the techniques which are used to investigate them. If we apply this
principle to the history of ‘religion’, it can be said that the very methods of the embryonic science of religion
determined to a large extent what ‘religion’ was to be” (‘Religion’ and the Religions in the English Enlightenment
[Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1991], 2). Richard King has also helpfully described this as the
“iatrogenic” effect of secularism in the study of religion (Religion and Orientalism: Postcolonial Theory, India, and
‘The Mythic East’ [London: Routledge; 1999], 41-44).
8 Bodin’s most important work in this respect was the Colloquium of the Seven about Secrets of the Sublime, which
Preus sees as representing a paradigm shift whereby “reason” was elevated above “revelation” in the treatment
of various religious traditions. Here Bodin’s driving concern was to demote confessional authority in the
interests of social stability and religious toleration. Herbert of Cherbury is known as the father of deism,
whose key tract, De Veritate (1622), argued that there were five “common notions” amongst the various
religions, meaning that all share an essential core. David Hume was the first systematic naturalistic
reductionist, whose basic view was that (in Preus’ words) “religion is what happens when persons attempt to
cope with life, especially the fears and hopes engendered in the encounter with the most disturbing
phenomena of the external world: superior and unknown powers that determine one’s fate and future”. The
literature on these figures is rich, but see Preus, Explaining Religion, 3-39 and 84-103 (quotation from 207).
On Kant and Hegel, see e.g. Thrower, Religion: The Classical Theories, 74-90. He notes that rather than
providing reductive theories of religion, Kant and Hegel were attempting to make religion acceptable to
Enlightenment thinkers. The modern subsumption of religion under philosophy actually began a century
earlier than Kant with Spinoza, especially his Theological-Political Treatise of 1670; see esp. Preus, Spinoza and the
Irrelevance of Biblical Authority (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2001).
9
55
because to study God was to study man.10 Shortly after, the Darwinian theory of evolution
emerged and was (amongst many other things) swiftly reconfigured by a number of thinkers
in support of developmental models of religious history. These models were teleological
constructs, in which the categories of fetishism, superstition, totemism, animism, and magic
were variously employed as precursors to “the real thing” – i.e. “religion”, which itself was
often split into the two categories of polytheism/idolatry/paganism on the one hand, and
monotheism on the other.11 Anthropological theories of a similar evolutionary kind were
offered in the late nineteenth century by E. B. Tylor and J. G. Frazer, which were important
spurs to the industry of theorizing about the “origin” of religion in human society.12 During
this period, F. Max Müller also inaugurated the so-called “Science of Religion”, soon to
become the field known as comparative religion, which (in principle, even if rarely in
practice) sought to analyze the various religions of the world with a self-professed
“scientific” rigour.13 These figures are discussed in Chapter 3.
The twentieth century saw no decrease in reductionist theories of religion, with the
most prominent of the early decades coming from Émile Durkheim (religion is society
10 Feuerbach stated that “Consciousness of God is self-consciousness, knowledge of God is self-knowledge.”
See Feuerbach, L., The Essence of Christianity (Dover Publications: New York, 2008 [1841]), here iii. The
translation is from the second edition of Das Wesen des Christentums by George Eliot in 1881. Feuerbach’s
critique of Hegelian idealism also had a major influence on Marx and Engels, see ibid., iv. A modern version of
the anthropomorphic theory has been offered by Stewart Guthrie (see Faces in the Clouds: A New Theory of
Religion [New York: Oxford University Press, 1993]), although observations about the anthropomorphic
tendencies of religious thought go back at least to the Greek philosophers (such as Xenophanes and Aristotle,
see e.g. Aristotle’s Politics 1.2.7). See also Thrower, Religion: The Classical Theories, 93-98.
For an early yet authoritative discussion of theories that employed different versions of the developmental
path, see E. E. Evans-Pritchard’s Theories of Primitive Religion (Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1965), where
he characterizes all such approaches as little more than fanciful speculation of the “if I were a horse” type (see
e.g. 24f.). I will return to the problems of the developmental models in Chapters 3 and following, as there are
still vestiges of this in Hick’s understanding of religious history. For another useful treatment of early
evolutionary theories, see Randall Styers, Making Magic: Religion, Magic, & Science in the Modern World (New
York: Oxford University Press, 2004), 73-95.
11
12 Tylor is associated primarily with the concept of animism, and Frazer is associated with the evolutionary
trajectory of magicreligionscience. Both figures were widely influential, and are treated in most histories
of theories of religion (see e.g. Pals, Seven Theories of Religion, 16-53). I discuss Tylor in particular in the
following chapter.
13 I discuss comparative religion in more detail in the following chapter. The standard history of the topic is
Eric Sharpe’s Comparative Religion: A History (2nd ed.; London: Duckworth, 1986 [1975]).
56
worshipping itself), and even more famously from Sigmund Freud (religion is the
obsessional neurosis of humanity).14 With the founding of the sociological and the
psychoanalytic methods by these two thinkers, coupled with the continued growth of
anthropology, the reductionist mode of “explaining” religion became a major part of the
twentieth-century social-scientific tradition.15 Indeed, by the end of the twentieth century
and the onset of the twenty-first, theories of religion have never been more prevalent, and
virtually all have been reductionist or naturalistic in emphasis. Michael Stausberg notes that
when compared to the “classical” theories of religion (of the Durkheim/Freud kind),
contemporary theories of religion from the 1990s onwards have increasingly borne the
hallmarks of major advances in the natural, evolutionary, and behavioural sciences (hence
their often staunch opposition to religious theories). In recent times, some of the most
prominent such theorists have been Daniel Dennet, Sam Harris, Scot Atran, Pascal Boyer,
and Richard Dawkins.16
Whilst there has been little consensus amongst the various theorists over the course
of this long tradition (aside from their basic rejection of “religious” accounts of religion),
their work has driven the academic study of religion in important ways. However, as was
made clear in the last chapter, the field of religious studies has actually been underpinned not
by these reductionist approaches (hence the frustrated proposals of people such as
Obviously these are oversimplified distillations, but they capture the general thrust of their positions. Freud
and Durkheim are likewise treated in any history of theories of religion, see e.g. the works of Preus, Thrower,
Pals and Kunin already cited. Regarding Freud’s reductionism, I once heard a colleague quip in frustration to
an unsuspecting undergraduate class that “According to Freud, if you’re religious then you want to fuck your
mother and kill your father – honestly, just go read The Future of an Illusion. That’s all he says.”
14
15 Mention should also be given to Max Weber for the consolidation of sociological paradigms for the study of
religion, even though he was not as heavily reductive as Durkheim (on Weber in this context, see e.g. Kunin,
Religion: The Modern Theories, 35-43). One could also discuss the developments in anthropology with
Malinowski, Evans-Pritchard, Geertz, and others, but my aim here has only been to provide a brief overview.
16 See Stausberg, “There is Life in the Old Dog Yet”, 8-9. Stausberg’s edited survey of contemporary theories
covers over twenty scholars, making it an invaluable synopsis of an ever-burgeoning field.
57
McCutcheon and J. Samuel Preus),17 but rather by the notion that religion is something
unique and thus demands its own unique method of comprehension, and that there is,
moreover, a fundamental “transcendent unity” between the various ideational traditions
called “religions”.
The root of these non-reductive approaches goes back to the first major critique of
Enlightenment rationalism, namely German Romanticism of the late eighteenth century,
and specifically to its theological spokesman, Friedrich Schleiermacher.18 Writing especially
against the recent work of Kant, who had not only brought religion under philosophy but
had also reduced it to basic morals and metaphysics, Schleiermacher’s On Religion (1799)
provided the central component of all future non-reductionist theories: that religion was
not morals, was not metaphysics, was not theological systems or dogmas (for which
Schleiermacher had little time). Rather, religion was about feeling – the ultimate pervading
the finite, bringing with it a sense of awe and absolute meaning.19 In other words, religion
was all about experience, the experience of a mysterious but profound reality.
Although Schleiermacher was primarily conducting religious apologetic against the
rationalism and scorn of the Enlightenment (rather than mapping out a fully fledged
theory), the category of experience began to play a crucial role in subsequent non-reductive
theories of religion.20 The first systematic extrapolation of Schleiermacher’s perspective was
offered roughly a century later by Rudolf Otto in his well-known work, Das Heilige (1917),
17
See McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, and Preus, Explaining Religion.
Early German Romanticism is mentioned briefly in Chapter 3 in relation to Volk theory and its impact on
the comparative study of religion in the nineteenth century.
18
See the references provided above in Chapter 1 (n. 23). As noted, the 1799 edition of On Religion was more
strongly pantheistic than its later iterations, and bore the hallmarks of the Moravian pietism in which
Schleiermacher was raised. In addition to Richard Crouter’s introduction to On Religion, see his other useful
study, Friedrich Schleiermacher: Between Enlightenment and Romanticism (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
2005).
19
20 For an incisive discussion of the concept of “experience”, see Robert Sharf, “Experience” in Critical Terms
for Religious Studies (ed. M. Taylor; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1998), 94-115.
58
where he famously described “the Holy” as the mysterium tremendum fascinans et augustum: the
awful, terrifying, but seductive mystery.21 The Holy was something totally Other and sui
generis, the mysterious reality to which the entire history of religions bore witness (even in
the “primitive” stage). Otto even said that “There is no religion in which it does not live as
the real innermost core and without it no religion would be worthy of the name”.22 He also
coined the word “numinous” (from Latin numen, “deity”) to describe this otherwise
ineffable transcendent force. In Das Heilige, Otto combined Schleiermacher’s emphasis on
non-reducible religious experience with a revised Kantian notion of the religious a priori: in
other words, the Holy was something that humanity had an innate capacity to experience,
but while it had “rational” elements (i.e. could be schematized in concepts), it was more
fundamentally a non-rational (i.e. non-schematizable) aspect of human existence.23 To put it
differently, the numinous Holy – the core of being – could be grasped conceptually to a
certain degree, but was more fully grasped in religious experience, i.e. when one was
overwhelmed by the mysterium tremendum and pervaded with a sense of the infinite (note the
clear influence of Schleiermacher). In this way, Otto attempted – quite explicitly – to locate
21 Das Heilige (Breslau: Trewendt und Gramier, 1917) was published in English in 1923 as The Idea of the Holy,
and was reprinted with new translator’s preface in 1958 (trans. J. W. Harvey; Oxford: Oxford University Press,
1958 [1923]). The German work went through many editions, and eventually contained an overflowing
amount of appendixes. The English translation is from the 9th German edition, and has remained popular ever
since its first appearance.
22
Ibid., 6.
23 The full title is instructive here: Das Heilige: Über das Irrationale in der Idee des Göttlichen und sein Verhältnis zum
Rationalen (The Holy: On the Irrational in the Idea of the Divine and its Relation to the Rational). The
contours of Otto’s philosophy are extremely complex: while he operated within a broad Kantian framework,
the specific framework he adopted was the revised Kantian program of Jakob Fries. I pass over Fries and the
role his system played in Otto’s understanding of the Holy; but see the expert treatment of these issues by
Philip Almond in Rudolf Otto: An Introduction to His Philosophical Theology (Chapel Hill: The University of North
Carolina Press, 1984), where Otto’s connections to Kant, Schleiermacher, and Fries are mapped out
extensively.
59
the source of religious experience outside of rational or naturalist inquiry while still claiming
that it existed as an actual, sui generis force.24
It should be noted that while Otto’s perspective was a kind of theory, given that it
operated with a primarily philosophical framework and counted in its scope the entire
religious history of humanity, his project was ultimately theological. It is thus no surprise
that he considered Christianity to be the “superior” religion, which had most fully grasped
the nature of the Holy (Protestant Christianity in particular, and Lutheranism especially).25
However I will return to this issue in a later chapter and continue for now with a basic
descriptive account.
The other major theoretical perspective that could be described as “religious” was
the essentialist method encapsulated in the phenomenology of religion scholarship of the
early twentieth century, which was based on a very similar premise to Otto’s about the
autonomous nature of the sacred.26 To distill a complex approach, phenomenologists such
as Gerhardus van der Leeuw (most famous for his 1933 Religion in Essence and Manifestation)
held that one must “bracket” one’s own beliefs when studying the religion of others, so that
reductive, naturalist assumptions which automatically ruled out the reality of “the
transcendent” were not imposed by the scholar.27 While this methodological rule was, in
Almond explains that Otto’s claim about “the qualitative distinctness of the numinous feelings” is not
argued, “but is [rather] the presupposition of his whole theory of religion.” (ibid., 81. Notice Almond’s use of
the term “theory” in this context.)
24
25 Ibid., 129ff. Almond notes that, in the end, “the Christian believer overpowers the philosophical
theologian”. Indeed, Otto’s estimation is that Christianity “stands out in complete superiority to her sister
religions” (The Idea of the Holy, 142.). See also Tim Murphy, The Politics of Spirit (Albany, NY: SUNY Press,
2010), esp. 176f. for a range of similar statements made by Otto. I return to this aspect of Otto’s thought
from a postcolonial perspective in Chapter 4.
For a comprehensive discussion of the phenomenological approach see e.g. James Cox, A Guide to the
Phenomenology of Religion: Key Figures, Formative Influences, and Subsequent Debates (London: Continuum, 2006), as
well as his more recent work, An Introduction to the Phenomenology of Religion (London: Continuum, 2010).
26
Van der Leeuw advocated Husserl’s interpretive tactic of epòché, which he called “intellectual suspense” (see
Religion In Essence and Manifestation [2 vols; New York: Harper & Row, 1963 (1933)], 683-689). On epòché; see
Ninian Smart, “Foreword” to the reissue of van der Leeuw’s Religion in Essence and Manifestation (New Jersey:
27
60
theory, also applied to overt theological perspectives (which would automatically interpret
the other using one’s own theological categories), the primary emphasis of those such as
van der Leeuw was the rejection of reductionist interpretations of religious belief and
practice because they gave too little credit to perspective of believers. This represents the
core of the debate known as the insider/outsider problem, an important methodological
issue that will be addressed shortly when considering the criticisms of the pluralist theory.
However the non-reductive phenomenologist par excellence was Mircea Eliade, one of
the most influential scholars of religion in the twentieth century, who was responsible more
than any other individual scholar for the methodological orientation of the modern
discipline of religious studies.28 As noted earlier, the central assumption underpinning his
work was that the history of religions represents the history of manifestations of the sacred, and
that this sacred reality was not reducible to anything else (making “the sacred” a basic
equivalent of Otto’s “Holy”). To repeat the key passage cited in the previous chapter,
Eliade stated that
a religious phenomenon will only be recognized as such if it is grasped at its own level,
that is to say, if it is studied as something religious. To try to grasp the essence of such
a phenomenon by means of physiology, psychology, sociology, economics, linguistics,
art or any other study is false; it misses the one unique and irreducible element in it –
the element of the sacred.29
Princeton University Press, 1986), ix-xix. On the Husserlian underpinnings of the phenomenology of religion,
see e.g. Cox, An Introduction to the Phenomenology of Religion, 25-36.
28 For a thorough discussion of Eliade’s foundational influence on the contemporary discipline of religious
studies, as well as a critical survey of the rich secondary literature on his life and scholarship, see McCutcheon,
Manufacturing Religion.
Eliade, M., Patterns in Comparative Religion (trans. R. Sheed; Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1996
[1958]), xvii. See also Eliade, M., The Sacred and the Profane: The Nature of Religion (trans. W. R. Trask; New York:
Harcourt & Brace, 1959 [1957]), which serves as a basic introduction to his whole program. For another
critical appraisal of this approach that links with McCutcheon’s concerns, see the classic essay by Robert Segal,
“In Defence of Reductionism” in Religion and the Social Sciences: Essays in the Confrontation (Atlanta: Scholars
Press, 1989), 5-36.
29
61
This is a virtual manifesto for the non-reductive approach that extends from
Schleiermacher all the way to the contemporary discipline of religious studies. Eliade also
stated at the beginning of his three-volume History of Religious Ideas that the sacred “is an
element in the structure of consciousness, and not a stage in the history of consciousness”,
a claim to which I will return in the Conclusion.30 His position has thus been described as
being that “Religion is based on a universal experience of the sacred and is common to all
human beings at any time or place”.31
Eliade’s perspective was less triumphalist than Otto’s, in that it did not (ostensibly,
at least) privilege any single manifestation of the sacred or any specific religious tradition;
rather, Eliade’s main concern was to reinject an appreciation of the sacred into what he saw
as the desacralized modern west.32 Moreover, because the sacred was a sui generis reality, the
comparative phenomenological approach was, in his view, able to provide the unique
hermeneutical key for understanding the sacred and making it accessible again in the
modern world. It is for this reason that Eliade was so influential in the formative stages of
creating religious studies as an autonomous discipline, the establishment of which was
justified on grounds that it provided perspectives not attainable through the methods of
other established disciplines.33
Eliade, M., A History of Religious Ideas, vol. 1 (trans. W. R. Trask; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1978
[1976]), xiii.
30
31
Kunin, Religion: The Modern Theories, 127.
32 For a discussion of Eliade’s disenchantment with the modern world and his consequent “politics of
nostalgia”, see McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 27-51 et passim, esp. 73.
See ibid.; see also Segal, “In Defence of Reductionism”. For a clear statement of Eliade’s prioritization of
the history of religions approach over forms of social-scientific scholarship, see the foreword to Shamanism:
Archaic Techniques of Ecstasy (Bollingen Series LXXVI; Princeton University Press, 1964), esp. xv: “Certainly, the
psychologist, the sociologist, the ethnologist and even the philosopher or the theologian will have their
comment to make, each from the viewpoint and in the perspective that are properly his. But it is the historian
[sc. the phenomenologist] of religions who will make the greatest number of valid statements on a religious
phenomenon as a religious phenomenon – and not as a psychological, social, ethnic, philosophical, or even
theological phenomenon.”
33
62
This, then, is a brief review of non-reductive theories of religion – theories that are
not based on traditional theological or confessional models, but which nevertheless hold
that all religions (and all religious experience) are responses to a sui generis sacred, holy, or
transcendent reality. They have been far less numerous than naturalistic theories of religion
in a statistical sense, but the non-reductive paradigm has been the dominant one in the field
of religious studies, with the alternative naturalistic discourse playing a vociferous but
comparatively minor role in shaping the questions asked in the discipline – particularly at a
pedagogical level, where the descriptive, phenomenological approach still dominates the
curricula of many university religious studies departments.34
And it is in this non-reductive tradition that Hick’s pluralist theory fits. Indeed, the
opening paragraph of An Interpretation of Religion notes that while there have been many
confessional (i.e. theological) and naturalistic theories of religion, “The one type of theory
that has seldom been attempted is a religious but not confessional interpretation of religion in its
plurality of forms” – and the first footnote of the book even cites the above Eliade
quotation as representative of his approach.35
Therefore, regardless of whether or not one calls his argument a “theory” (as I do in
much of this work), understanding Hick within this trajectory situates the approach he took
to the question of religious diversity and enables a detailed understanding of his argument.
While much of my critique in later chapters will be directed towards Hick’s use of the Axial
Age paradigm and his focus on the “great traditions”, I will return in the Conclusion to
some of the problems with the essentialist position voiced by critics like McCutcheon. But
before any further discussion is possible, Hick’s argument requires detailed elaboration.
34
See esp. Fitzgerald, The Ideology of Religious Studies. This issue will be picked up in the Conclusion.
35
Hick, J., An Interpretation of Religion, 1, xiii (italics added). Eliade is quoted p. 15, n. 1.
63
The Pluralistic Hypothesis
In the last chapter we saw that Hick was among those who, following the lead of Wilfred
Cantwell Smith, believed that the new situation of global awareness demanded a total
perspective on the unified religious history of humanity. Yet before developing his pluralist
theory, Hick was a conservative Christian who held that explicit faith in Christ was required
for salvation.36 While the seeds of his later pluralism, i.e. his perspectivist religious
epistemology, were sown early in his career, it was not until the late 1960s that his views
began to change.37 As Hick describes it, the catalyst was his relocation to the city of
Birmingham, a vibrant metropolis with a heavy immigrant population.38 Here the religious
other was not a hypothetical question, but a confronting reality. After being invited to join
the religious education panel of the Birmingham Community Relations Committee, Hick
swiftly became involved in issues of interreligious dialogue.39 This led, among other things,
to his strong public opposition to the neo-fascist National Front in the coalition group All
Faiths For One Race.40 But this co-operation with members of other religious traditions
also had a profound effect on Hick at a philosophical level, and with such increased contact
he came to believe that in the places of worship within all of the great faiths,
36
Hick, J., John Hick: An Autobiography (Oxford: Oneworld, 2002). See esp. 27ff.
Hick’s perspectivist epistemology was the theme of his first major publication, Faith and Knowledge (London:
Macmillan, 1957). Yet one can see the seeds of these views even in aphorisms that he recorded as an 18 yearold (see John Hick: An Autobiography, 32).
37
Birmingham is the second largest city in the United Kingdom, and assumed major importance in the late
eighteenth century as a leading site of manufacturing and the development of technologies of industrialization.
Immigration increased rapidly in the middle of the twentieth century, and by 1991 Birmingham had the largest
immigrant percentage of any city in the UK. See Christopher Upton, A History of Birmingham (Hampshire:
Philimore & Co., 2011), inc. 206ff. on the city’s diverse cultural landscape.
38
39
Hick, Autobiography, 159ff.
Ibid., 169-192. Hick was actively involved in the group for its 15 year existence, and he states that their
driving motivation was that “we were angry – angry about the injustices of racism” (173). The reader should
bear this comment in mind for the analysis of Chapter 4 below, when the racialized structures of Hick’s theory
are made clear.
40
64
men and women were coming together under the auspices of some ancient, highly
developed tradition which enables them to open their hearts and minds ‘upwards’
toward a higher divine reality which makes a claim on the living of their lives.41
Hick would elsewhere say in a similar vein that “When I meet a devout Jew, or Muslim, or
Sikh, or Hindu, or Buddhist in whom the fruits of openness to the divine reality are
gloriously evident, I cannot realistically regard the Christian experience of the divine as
authentic and their non-Christian experiences as inauthentic”.42
This intuition shaped all of Hick’s subsequent work. In 1973 he published God and
the Universe of Faiths, arguing for a “Copernican revolution” in theology and the decentering
of Christianity as the highest form of religious faith. In 1976 he completed the crosscultural study Death and Eternal Life, which had a very pluralistic flavour and did not take
salvation through Christ to be the normative goal. In 1977 he was the driving force behind
The Myth of God Incarnate, which sought to bring the debates into the public domain and
caused great controversy in Anglican circles. And in 1980 he produced God Has Many
Names, the first attempt at a fuller philosophical argument for the non-superiority of any
single tradition.43 Throughout the 1980s Hick continued to write on these topics, and began
to more thoroughly familiarize himself with the content of other traditions.44 After editing
the pivotal publication of The Myth of Christian Uniqueness in 1987, which formally announced
41
Hick, Autobiography, 160.
42 Hick, J., Problems of Religious Pluralism (London: Macmillan, 1985), 91. I note again that Hick’s “conversion”
to a pluralistic worldview mirrors precisely the scenario Berger predicted in The Heretical Imperative. It is these
comments in particular that led to my assessment in the previous chapter that theological pluralism has
generally been the result of globalization and the inescapable presence of the religious other.
43 Hick, J., God and the Universe of Faiths (New York: St Martins, 1973); Hick, J. Death and Eternal Life (London:
Macmillan, 1976); The Myth of God Incarnate (ed. J. Hick; London: SCM, 1977); Hick, J., God Has Many Names
(London: Macmillan, 1980).
Aside from Hick’s appointment to Claremont Graduate School in California, where he taught widely on the
world’s religions and also had a sustained “encounter with eastern Buddhism”, he also spent time in India and
Sri Lanka engaging with Hindu and Sikh culture, taking his first trip to India at age 48. See Hick, Autobiography,
193-226 (on India) and 250-310 (on Claremont and Buddhism). Indeed, Hick states that “I’m not sure I would
have been able to write [An Interpretation] if I had not gone to Claremont with its pervasive spirit of openness
to the global reality of religion” (Autobiography, 259).
44
65
the arrival of “pluralism” as a theological position, he finally delivered a systematic
philosophical theory of pluralism in 1989 with his magnum opus, An Interpretation of Religion.
It is this work I will summarize in what follows.45
Hick’s purpose in An Interpretation of Religion is to offer a “field theory of religion from a
religious [and not a naturalistic] point of view”. Its scope is defined at the outset when Hick
states that:
a philosopher of religion today must take account not only of the thought and
experience of the tradition within which he or she happens to work, but in principle of
the religious experience and thought of the whole human race.46
He calls his theory “the pluralistic hypothesis”. When stripped to its essentials, the
pluralistic hypothesis argues: a) that the world’s major religious traditions are different
culturally-conditioned responses to the same ultimate, transcendent Reality (which he calls
“the Real” as a tradition neutral term47); b) that none of these traditions have superior
access to, or a uniquely special relationship with, this Ultimate Reality; and c) that this can
be judged by the fact that all traditions enshrine love and compassion in their basic
teachings, with none having clearly displayed more love and compassion than any other. To
put it another way, Hick follows Cantwell Smith’s perspective that religious truth is not
propositional – i.e. it is not about doctrine – but is about a personal relationship with
The Myth of Christian Uniqueness: Toward a Pluralistic Theology of Religions (ed. J. Hick & P. Knitter; Maryknoll,
NY: Orbis, 1987). As noted earlier, An Interpretation of Religion is the revised version of Hick’s Gifford Lectures
of 1986-7. It is also worth noting that The Myth of Christian Uniqueness is the volume that formally crystallized
the term “pluralism” as a theological position within the theology of religions after Alan Race had proposed
the threefold typology in 1983 (see above, ch. 1, pp. 15ff.). In the context of my comments in the first
footnote of Chapter 1 above, this theological meaning of pluralism was thus by far the latest in the western
cultural lexicon, as other usages of the term stem from the early twentieth century. Again, a proper genealogy
of the term remains a desideratum of contemporary scholarship, especially given the term’s widespread
cultural currency and its often highly charged resonance.
45
46
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, xiii.
47
For Hick’s justification of “the Real” vis-à-vis possible alternatives, see An Interpretation of Religion, 9ff.
66
transcendence which manifests itself in a life-transforming attitude of love, openness, and
sincerity.48
Hick’s field of focus in developing this hypothesis is “the great world faiths”, also
called the “post-axial” traditions throughout the work. As discussed in the previous chapter,
Hick construes the Axial Age as the period in which a movement began from archaic,
localised religious traditions to the great religions of “salvation and liberation” (i.e. the
“soteriological” traditions), which Hick also calls the religions of “transcendence”. These
comprise the Semitic traditions (Judaism, Christianity, Islam), the Indian traditions
(Hinduism and Buddhism; often also Jainism and Sikhism), and generally also include the
Asian (Confucianism, Taoism, Shinto), Persian (Zoroastrianism) and Greek (philosophical
rationalism) traditions; but Hick confines himself primarily to the Big Five of Judaism,
Christianity, Islam, Buddhism, and Hinduism. He contrasts these post-axial traditions to
pre-axial or “archaic” traditions, which are more concerned with “keeping life on an even
keel” than the idea of transcendence, human transformation, or “the possibility of a
limitlessly better future”.49 For Hick, this distinction between post-axial and pre-axial
religion is crucial, and is the basis of the whole theory he goes on to develop. This will
become clear in what follows. But as was established at length in Chapter 1, it is precisely
this form of classification that is under scrutiny in this dissertation, because – on my reading
at least – this demarcation effectively undermines Hick’s entire argument. However, I
refrain from such criticism at this point and simply note that beyond these initial comments,
Hick says little about pre-axial religion. His focus in An Interpretation of Religion is on the
In addition to the three works cited above in Chapter 1 (n. 4), Cantwell Smith made this argument in works
such as The Faith of Other Men (New York: Harper & Row, 1962). On Smith’s role as a theologian, rather than
his contributions as a historian of religion (in which connection he is usually discussed), see Philip Almond,
“Wilfred Cantwell Smith as Theologian of Religions”, Harvard Theological Review 76 (1983): 335-342.
48
See An Interpretation of Religion, 21-69. The term “archaic” religions is grounded in Eliade’s usage. Hick also
sometimes refers to the pre-axial religions as “primal” religions, a term popular in the late twentieth century.
The history of this term is noted briefly below (ch. 4, n. 80). I discuss the shifting appellation of terminology
to describe such groups in more detail in Chapter 3.
49
67
“great world faiths”, which he argues share a higher transcendental unity beyond their
phenomenal differences.
Hick begins his argument by noting what he calls “the religious ambiguity of the
universe”, i.e. the fact that no argument for or against the existence of God – whether
naturalistic, philosophical or theological – is logically infallible in the mathematical sense,
and that the world can thus legitimately be experienced in both religious and naturalistic
ways.50 The perspective one takes will simply be the result of the kind of experiences one
has had: so that if one consciously experiences their life “in relation to the transcendent”,
then one is justified in trusting those experiences and holding religious beliefs (note again
the influence of Cantwell Smith); whereas “it is likewise rationally proper for those who do
not participate in any way in the wide field of religious experience to reject, pro tem, all belief
in the transcendent”.51 By highlighting the religious ambiguity of the universe, Hick is
arguing for the rationality of religious belief, and therefore for the legitimacy of his
“religious but non-confessional” attempt to make sense of the diversity of religious beliefs
that mark human history.
However, Hick is also aware that the numerous ways in which people have claimed
that they live in a relationship with a transcendent Reality are so different and mutually
contradictory that they cannot all be unquestionably correct – and it is precisely for this
reason that he develops the pluralistic hypothesis as what he calls a “middle way” between
naturalistic reductionism and dogmatic theological exclusivism (and even theological
inclusivism, which still retains Christ as the normative centre). This redescriptive element of
Hick’s argument was already noted above, and will be important to revisit when addressing
50
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 73ff.
51
Ibid., 13.
68
the bulk of the criticism of the pluralist theory, as it seems to be one of the least appreciated
(or most overlooked) aspects of Hick’s justification for the pluralistic hypothesis.
Beyond this general justification for the rationality of religious belief, the pluralistic
hypothesis has two primary components: epistemological perspectivism and the
soteriological/ethical criteria. The question of religious epistemology had been Hick’s
primary concern from his first major publication in 1957, Faith and Knowledge, and was the
cornerstone of his religious philosophy.52 To summarize his view, Hick contends that while
the object of religious awareness is something unique and special, “its basic epistemological
pattern is that of all our knowing”, i.e. schematized through culturally-conditioned ways of
seeing and understanding things.53 This leads Hick to the basic but crucial distinction,
famously articulated by Kant, between a thing as it is in human perception, and a thing as it
is “in itself” (an sich) – i.e. the phenomenon/noumenon distinction.54 Like Kant, Hick
argues that we can never perceive a thing “purely” as it exists, because it is always
schematized through our culturally-conditioned faculties of perception and cognition. Hick
applies this directly to the transcendent Real and argues, vis-à-vis both naturalism and
theological exclusivism, that “the great post-axial faiths constitute different ways of
experiencing, conceiving and living in relation to an ultimate divine Reality which
transcends all our varied versions of it”.55 In other words, by adopting this basic Kantian
framework, Hick can postulate (like Eliade and Otto) the existence of an ultimate,
transcendent, sui generis Divine Reality, but can likewise assert that no single interpretation
52
See above, n. 37.
53
Hick, Faith and Knowledge, 97; cf. An Interpretation of Religion, 129-152, esp. 151.
Kant, I., The Critique of Pure Reason, B69 (trans. N. K. Smith; London: Palgrave Macmillan, 2007 [1927]), 88.
See Hick’s discussion of the Kantian model in An Interpretation of Religion, 240ff. Interestingly, Hick notes
Rudolf Otto as the most prominent Kantian philosopher of religion, but distances himself from Otto’s
specific use of Kant (250, n. 10).
54
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 235-6. This quotation is key to understanding the self-consciously
redescriptive element of Hick’s pluralistic hypothesis, as will become clear shortly.
55
69
of it is uniquely authoritative or superior. Notice again the redescriptive nature of Hick’s
theory.
Hick is well aware of the difficulty posed by the fact that some conceptualizations of
the Real are personalistic (e.g. Allah, or the Heavenly Father), whereas other traditions
conceive of the Real as a non-personal absolute (e.g. Brahman, or the Dharmakaya of
Mahayana Buddhism). He therefore provides a detailed phenomenological comparison of
the personae and the impersonae of the Real in order to argue that it “is so rich in content that
it can only be finitely experienced in partial and inadequate ways”.56 In a useful analogy,
Hick compares the apparent discrepancy between personae and impersonae to the way in which
light appears differently – either as waves or as particles – when observed in different
manners: the point being that something we don’t fully understand can appear in ways that
initially seem mutually exclusive.57
A final important aspect of Hick’s perspectivist approach is his awareness of the
extent to which “human factors manifestly enter into the formation of religious concepts
and into the ways in which the transcendent is believed to be encountered”.58 Not only does
he refer to the fact that “it is abundantly evident today that each tradition has been deeply
influenced by cultural forces which rest in turn on a complex of geographical, climatic,
economic and political factors”,59 but he also notes the way in which the “tribal” tendencies
of human thought have conspired to shape the self-understanding of the various religions
such that “each has come over the centuries to regard itself as uniquely superior to others,
seeing them either as lying outside the sphere of salvation, or as earlier stages in an
56
Ibid., 247; see also 255-296.
57
Ibid., 245.
58
Ibid., 8.
59
Ibid., 7.
70
evolution of which it is the culmination, or as less full and authentic versions of itself”.60
Yet Hick argues that this “cannot be sustained on impartial grounds” in “our consciously
pluralistic twentieth and twenty-first centuries”.61
The above are the epistemological foundations of the pluralistic hypothesis: they allow Hick
to argue for the rationality of religious belief vis-à-vis naturalism, and to make the claim that
all religions are culturally-conditioned responses to the Transcendence that have taken place
within different contexts. To build on these foundations and strengthen his argument that
all traditions have the same Divine referent, Hick turns to his other fundamental
components, the soteriological and ethical criteria (both covered in the “Criteriological”
section of An Interpretation of Religion).62
The soteriological criterion hinges on Hick’s specific definition of “salvation”
(which he extends to the more inclusive term “salvation/liberation”), as meaning “the
transformation of human existence from self-centredness to Reality-centredness” (another important
redescription).63 Hick states clearly that “the function of post-axial religion is to create
contexts in which [such] transformation … can take place”.64 This leads him to say that the
basic evaluative criterion “must be soteriological”, arguing that “Religious traditions and
their various components – beliefs, modes of experience, scriptures, rituals, disciplines,
ethics and lifestyles, social rules and organisations – have greater or lesser value according as they
60
Ibid., 2.
61
Ibid., 2, 6.
62
Ibid., 297-376.
Ibid., 303 (italics added). Notice that “salvation/liberation” is another attempt at an inclusive but traditionneutral term like “the Real”.
63
64
Ibid., 300.
71
promote or hinder the salvific transformation”.65 In other words, a religious tradition’s “value” can
be judged by the way in which it promotes the movement from self-centered egoism to a
relationship with Ultimate Reality that manifests itself in an outpouring of love and
compassion (as above when Hick saw “the divine reality” as “gloriously evident” in his
devout friends from other traditions).
Here Hick’s similarity with William James and the tradition of pragmatism can be
seen, because he argues that the way one can judge the degree to which a tradition provides
an “authentic context of salvation/liberation” is the extent and quality of the “moral and
spiritual fruits” it produces.66 He argues that while this “soteriological transformation” takes
place to some degree with most people who participate in a religious tradition, it is
especially obvious in those who have been recognized as “saints”, Hick’s general term for
those in other traditions called bodhisattvas, gurus, mahatmas, masters, etc. – i.e.
“individuals in whom the signs of salvation and liberation are strikingly visible”, something
manifested in their selflessness, compassion, and the way they seem to radiate the divine
Real.67 However, while this soteriological transformation is more conspicuous in some, it is
the path traveled by those in all religious traditions when they connect with the Real (in
whatever way their tradition mediates that contact, e.g. through mediation, prayer, etc.).
Moreover, Hick says that on any reading of human history, “It is not possible, as an
unbiased judgment with which all rational persons could be expected to agree, to assert the
65 Ibid. (italics added). This is a crucial statement that will be scrutinized in Chapter 4, as it clearly has major
implications for the evaluation of pre-axial traditions – which are, in Hick’s view, not “soteriological” in the
same manner as their post-axial counterparts.
66 Ibid., 301; see also Hick, J., “The Non-Absoluteness of Christianity” in The Myth of Christian Uniqueness, 1636, esp. 23. James famously said that one must “be ready to judge the religious life by its results exclusively”
(James, W., The Varieties of Religious Experience, in William James: Writings 1902-1910 [Library of America: New
York, 1987], 1-477; here 28). I must confess a measure of surprise at how little Hick discusses James in An
Interpretation of Religion, given (a) the similarity of their positions, and (b) the degree to which Hick admired
James (see e.g. his Autobiography, 262).
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 301. Although he does not mention him directly in this context, Hick seems
to especially have in mind figures such as Desmond Tutu, with whom he enjoyed a long friendship (see e.g.
Hick, Autobiography, 240ff.).
67
72
overall moral superiority of any one of the great religious traditions of the world”.68 In other
words, no tradition has a moral monopoly: each has produced its fair share of saints and
sinners, and if we are to judge a tradition by its fruits – the fundamental measure that Hick
suggests that we take – then all traditions appear to be very similar to each other.
In addition to arguing that all religions offer authentic paths to the transformative
salvation/liberation of the human individual, Hick says that “From a religious point of view
we must … assume the rooting of moral norms in the structure of our human mind and the
rooting of that nature in our relationship to the Real”.69 This observation is particularly
grounded in Hick’s perception of the universality of “the Golden Rule”, i.e. the fact that all
traditions share the ethical core encapsulated in the maxim “do unto others as you would
have done unto you”. Hick offers examples of this basic ethical maxim from all of the great
traditions, which for him is further evidence for his argument that they are all in contact
with the same Ultimate Reality, which imparts its ultimately loving and compassionate
essence into the structure of the human mind.70
Then, in a procedural step that is crucial for the whole pluralistic hypothesis, Hick
extends his observation about the Golden Rule by applying it to his argument for the
rationality of one’s own religious belief. He argues, as we saw, that it is rational and entirely
acceptable for people in different traditions to trust their own religious experience as a
gauge for the truth of their convictions. Hick therefore says that
what it is reasonable for a given person at a given time to believe depends in large part
upon what we may call, in the cybernetic sense, his or her information or cognitive
input. And the input that is most centrally relevant in this case is religious experience.
Here I have in mind particularly the fact that people report their being conscious of
68
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 357.
69
Ibid., 312ff.
Ibid., 313. Hick cites examples within Buddhism (Dharmmapada, 10:2); Confucianism (Analects, XII:2);
Daoism (Thai Shang, 3); Zoroastrianism (Dadistan-i-dinik, 94:5); Christianity (Luke 6:13); Judaism (Babylonian
Talmud, 31a); and Islam, where the Rule is well attested in the Hadith.
70
73
existing in God’s presence and of living in a personal relationship of mutual awareness
with God.71
He continues by stating – and this is the crux of his entire argument for the non-superiority of
Christianity – that:
[we cannot] reasonably claim that our own form of religious experience, together with
that of the tradition of which we are a part, is veridical whilst others are not. We can of
course claim this; and indeed virtually every religious tradition has done so, regarding
alterative forms of religion as either false or as confused and inferior versions of itself.
But the kind of rational justification [he has set forth in an earlier chapter] for treating
one’s own form of religious experience as a cognitive response – though always a
complexly conditioned one – to a divine reality must … apply equally to the religious
experience of others. In acknowledging this we are obeying the intellectual Golden Rule of granting
to others a premise on which we rely ourselves. Persons living within other traditions, then, are
equally justified in trusting their own distinctive religious experience and in forming
their beliefs on the basis of it. For the only reason for treating one’s tradition
differently from others is the very human, but not very cogent, reason that it is one’s
own!72
Here we have the essence of the pluralist theory of religions: the grounds by which one’s
own beliefs are justified, i.e. the reality and profundity of religious experience, must be
granted to others by accepting that their beliefs are likewise grounded in religious
experiences of a similar kind. Hick effectively suggests that to do anything else is to employ
a hopelessly arbitrary double standard that has far more to do with fear than love. And
when one considers the basic fact that no tradition can claim any kind of moral monopoly
on love or compassion, but that these ideals are enshrined in them all, the hypothesis
suggests itself that this is because all of the great traditions are, in their own way, in contact
with the same Divine Reality – an idea that, for Hick, is becoming increasingly plausible as
the global age continues to bring the various traditions of humanity into contact as never
before. Indeed, in Hick’s view, not only is the pluralistic hypothesis becoming ever more
71
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 211.
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 235 (italics added). For a similar sentiment, cf. Problems of Religious Pluralism,
103.
72
74
plausible as formerly isolated cultures continue to learn about each other, but he argues
throughout the work that this kind of tolerant, pluralistic view of religious diversity is
becoming every more necessary as the age of global integration continues to tie together the
fate of all human cultures.73
It is clear from the foregoing survey that Hick has, regardless of what one makes of
his theory, been true to his fundamental insight from the late 1960s: that his friends in
Birmingham who belonged to other traditions lived their lives in relationship with the same
Transcendent Reality that Hick himself had worshipped in the context of Christianity, and
indeed that all people within all of the great traditions participate, in their own way, in the
salvific quest from self-centeredness to Reality-centeredness. It is also clear, however, that
the theory Hick propounds is deeply contestable from many angles, and that it is replete
with assumptions – about both “religion” in general and the specific traditions themselves –
that many people find completely untenable. Thus, before beginning my own critical
appraisal of Hick’s theory, it is first necessary to consider the body of criticism that has
been leveled at it.
The Traditional Criticisms of The Pluralist Argument
In reviewing the wide range of challenges critics have offered to the pluralist theory, I have
discerned roughly five distinct criticisms. While I make no claim to be exhaustive, these five
are the most commonly occurring in the critical response to pluralism.74 I characterize these
criticisms as follows: 1) pluralism is philosophically incoherent; 2) pluralism is relativism; 3)
73
See especially the Epilogue of An Interpretation of Religion, 377-380.
There is a substantial theological literature on this question, which cannot be covered adequately here. For a
good entry to the theological critique of pluralism, see Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered (ed. G. D’Costa;
Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1990), the volume which answered the proposals offered by Hick et al. in The Myth of
Christian Uniqueness.
74
75
pluralism is surreptitious universalism; 4) pluralism is inadequate as a Christian theological
position; and 5) religions do not share a common core, and to argue that they do is to
obscure their very real differences. Often these criticisms overlap, are bundled together, or
are framed slightly differently, but they represent the general problems that have been put
forth by critics who have challenged Hick’s argument. 75
It is important to note that none of these criticisms address the issues that being
explored in this dissertation. Moreover, whilst I have my own complaints, I believe that the
five main criticisms have all been made against an oversimplified version of the pluralist
theory. Even those that do raise valid concerns – such as the claim of theological
inadequacy or the lack of clarity Hick has provided regarding the redescriptive nature of his
theory – do not actually challenge the fundamental points of his argument. Thus, if I am
going to offer my own rejection of the pluralist theory, I believe it is good academic practice
to defend it first against this host of insufficient criticisms.
Criticism 1: Pluralism is Philosophically Incoherent.
In the years after The Myth of Christian Uniqueness and An Interpretation of Religion there was,
understandably, a strong response to the pluralist movement. In a detailed review article
from 1990, Sumner Twiss discussed all of the criticisms that had by that point been
leveled.76 One of the least impressive criticisms Twiss documents is George Netland’s
challenge to Hick’s postulate of the divine noumenon (the Real), which he argues is a
75 Other slightly different distillations of the critique (both of which identify 4 main criticisms) include David
Ray Griffin, “Religious Pluralism: Generic, Identist, and Deep” in Deep Religious Pluralism (ed. D. Griffin;
Louisville: Westminster John Knox Press, 2005), 3-39; and Sumner B. Twiss, “The Philosophy of Religious
Pluralism: A Critical Appraisal of John Hick and His Critics”, The Journal of Religion 70 (1990): 533-568. See also
Chapter 1 above (n. 90) for why I pass over Hick’s own response to his critics. I note that the same reasons
apply for not engaging with the recent festschrift dedicated to Hick, Religious Pluralism and the Modern World: An
Ongoing Engagement with John Hick (ed. S. Sugirtharajah; New York: Palgrave Macmillan, 2012), which likewise
fails to raise any discourse-analytical issues.
76
Twiss, “The Philosophy of Religious Pluralism”.
76
philosophically problematic notion.77 As discussed above, Hick postulates that there exists a
noumenal, transcendent Reality, and that the various conceptualizations of this Ultimate
Reality – e.g. God, Allah, Brahman, Nirvana – are simply different culturally-conditioned
articulations of this noumenal reality. This reality is unknowable in “pure” form (an sich),
and has therefore been conceived differently by the limited apparatus of individual and
collective human consciousness. Netland’s criticism boils down to the fact that these
varying conceptualizations of the Real are so different from each other that there is serious
doubt as to whether they refer to the same Ultimate Reality, especially considering the
discrepancy between personal and impersonal conceptualizations of this reality. To use
Twiss’ paraphrase, Netland is asking, in short, if the postulate of the divine noumenon is
really “anything more than an elaborate hypothesis developed to avoid concluding that
perhaps all religions are not in touch with the same divine reality”.78
This seems to be an almost willful misunderstanding of Hick’s argument. Twiss
concurs, and provides a detailed refutation of Netland’s objection, noting two main points
Netland appears to have ignored. The first is Hick’s analogy with physics and the suggestion
that, as with light, our imperfect and always-limited understanding of the Real, in
conjunction with its own incomprehensible complexity, means that it has been
conceptualized in various ways that appear apparently contradictory to our finite human
understanding. In other words, “What Hick is proposing in this phase [of his argument] is
perfectly conceivable and coherent, and what he is proposing seems justified (internally)
from the perspective of the pluralist hypothesis. Other and stronger reasons must … await
Hick’s defense of his hypothesis as a whole”.79
77
Twiss cites George A. Netland, “Professor Hick on Religious Pluralism”, Religious Studies 22 (1986): 249-61.
78
Twiss, “The Philosophy of Religious Pluralism”, 554.
79
Ibid., 556.
77
To summarize the point, Hick’s postulate of the divine noumenon is internally
coherent within his argument and serves as the basis of making sense of religious diversity
without naturalistic reductionism. Netland’s basic objection that personal and impersonal
conceptualizations of the Real are mutually contradictory more or less totally ignores the
complex justification Hick has offered for this postulate. It is still possible, of course, to
find the pluralist theory unpersuasive; but it cannot be written off for the reason that
Netland suggests.
Criticism 2: Pluralism Is Relativism.
A second objection leveled against the pluralist theory of religions, which is likewise
founded on an unfair reading of Hick’s position, is that pluralism, like postmodernism in
general, is self-defeating relativism, in that because it denies the possibility of objective truth
it thereby undermines its own claims.
In a representative example, Andrew Kirk argues that because pluralism is an
epiphenomenon of postmodernism, then if postmodernism can be shown to be inadequate,
so can the pluralist theory of religions.80 The title of the essay itself, “Pluralism as an
Epiphenomenon of Postmodern Perspectivism”, is actually an excellently distilled
description of Hick’s theory; but unfortunately this is where the critical value of the essay
ends. Kirk trades in the standard refutation of postmodernism, namely its self-contradictory
nature, i.e. that “its own critical stance is dependent on assumptions that are, in turn,
undermined by its own critique”.81 He goes on discuss that while postmodernism rejects
grand narratives, it operates itself with its own master narrative that “has dismissed the
Kirk, A. J., “Religious Pluralism as an Epiphenomenon of Postmodern Perspectivism” in Theology and the
Religions: A Dialogue (ed. V. Mortensen; Grand Rapids: Eerdmans, 2003), 430-442.
80
81
Ibid., 439.
78
possibility of encountering truly objective reality”.82 He concludes the short essay by noting
that with regard to postmodernism, “there is little point” of persuading people to adopt
different views “if there is no right or wrong, truth or falsity left”. He continues by asking:
“Could the same not be said for all pluralist theories of religion? Why should we believe
them or persuade others to share our views? … Is it not high time to abandon pluralist
theories of religion as mere epiphenomena of a culturally transient, morally dangerous, and
ultimately intellectually absurd ‘condition’?”83
Allow me to paraphrase Kirk’s argument: Pluralism is an outgrowth of
postmodernism; postmodernism’s relativism is incoherent and self-defeating; therefore the
pluralist theory of religions is incoherent. To put it bluntly, this a lazy syllogism that totally
undersells both the pluralist theory of religions and the cluster of critical movements
generally called postmodernism. Postmodern theory does not deny that objective reality
exists, but argues (among other things) that no description of this reality is free from the
constraints of human conceptualization, and that all systems of meaning are discursively
constructed in response to various cultural pressures. Further, postmodern critics argue that
all human thought and social action is embedded within complex networks of power
relations, meaning that all representations have political implications, even if they are often
disguised or indirect.84 With regard to historical metanarratives, postmodernism is not vapid
relativism that bemoans “the end of meaning”. Rather, one does better to follow Foucault’s
distinction between “total history” and “general history”: total history is the old master
narrative (whether theological, Marxist, etc.), which claims to be the ultimate story of human
existence – and it is this view that “postmodernism” challenges; whereas general history, by
82
Ibid., 440.
83
Ibid., 442.
See e.g. Michel Foucault, Power/Knowledge: Selected Interviews and Other Writings 1972-1977 (trans. C. Gordon et
al.; ed. C. Gordon; New York: Vintage, 1980).
84
79
contrast, still attempts to depict reality external to the human subject in a persuasive
manner, but in the awareness that the construal of any such narrative will be a “fiction”
intimately related to the questions, motivations, and presuppositions brought to the
representation, and thus that all narratives are more fundamentally related to human
concerns than any “pure” depiction of wie es eigentlich gewesen.85 This point could further be
bolstered by considering J. Z. Smith’s cogent observation that the project of the humanities
is not concerned with “processes of proof”, but rather with “rhetorics of persuasion”.86
Similarly untenable is Kirk’s assertion that the pluralist theory is a form of
relativism. What Hick offers is not a vapid narrative in which “everyone is right” and thus
that there is really “no hope for truth”;87 rather – and this is a fundamental point I will
develop over the rest of this chapter – the pluralist theory offers a redescription of the religious
history of humanity. In other words, Hick’s argument is a self-conscious attempt to generate a
plausible theory of pan-human religious experience that rejects (a) the normativity each
tradition has conventionally ascribed to its own interpretation of reality; and (b) forms of
naturalistic reductionism that deem the object of religious experience to be an illusion. Kirk
even recognizes this redescriptive tactic himself, but without realizing that it should
invalidate his relativistic critique – because he also stresses that pluralism is not as “open” or
“accommodating” as it tries to present itself, because its “conviction that the ethical
teaching and practice of all the major religion are equivalent [requires] a nonpluralist,
See Foucault, M., The Archaeology of Knowledge (trans A. M. S. Smith; London: Routledge, 2002 [1972]), 10-11.
On the concept of all historiography being “fictional” to a degree, see Hayden White, The Tropics of Discourse:
Essays in Cultural Criticism (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1978), esp. “Interpretation in History”,
51-80. I discuss Foucault, White, and a number of other important theorists in Chapter 5. Leopold von
Ranke’s famous comment is also noted there.
85
Smith, J. Z., “Connections”, On Teaching Religion (ed. C. Lehrich; New York: Oxford University Press, 2012),
49-63, here 54.
86
A similarly misguided critique has been made by Miroslav Volf in an otherwise cogent essay, “A Voice of
One’s Own: Public Faith in a Pluralistic World” in Democracy and the New Religious Pluralism (ed. T. Banchoff;
New York: Oxford University Press, 2007), 271-281; see esp. 276, where he calls the pluralist theory
“incoherent”. For a more sophisticated (yet equally unpersuasive) version of the critique, see Leslie Newbigin,
The Gospel in a Pluralist Society (London: SPK, 1989).
87
80
unconditional, noncontextual, unequivocal account of the right and the good”.88 Certainly it
does, and this is the next issue that will be considered; but here Kirk contradicts his
assertion that pluralism is relativism, because it clearly argues for its own ultimate narrative
and does not entail the need to “indiscriminately affirm anything and everything” (to use
Miroslav Volf’s characterization).89
Simply put, pluralism is either vapid, “debilitating” relativism, or it takes a
standpoint from which it judges other interpretations of human religiosity to be
unpersuasive. It cannot be both. And given pluralism’s insistence that exclusivist and
inclusivist theologies are wrong in asserting the unique veridicality of their own experience
of the transcendent Real, and that naturalistic, social-scientific reductionism is unacceptable,
then pluralism clearly takes a firm standpoint. This brings us to a far more important
criticism of the pluralist theory.
Criticism 3: Pluralism is Surreptitious Universalism.
The charge that pluralism is actually “not at all pluralistic” is the most common problem
raised with regard to Hick’s position, and has been mentioned by virtually all of his major
critics. Although the critique is offered in various forms (e.g. those above), the following is
a neat encapsulation of the complaint. Commenting on the essays in The Myth of Christian
Uniqueness, Gavin D’Costa says:
[it is] ironic that some of the proposals put forward are as triumphalist and imperialist
as the old solutions being criticized. For example, in the attempt to affirm the
“independent validity of other ways,” it seemed that many who did so necessarily
employed implicit or explicit criteria for what was deemed “valid,” thereby replacing
the particularity of Christian criteria with the particularity of other criteria. It is not
clear why the replacement of one set of criteria with another, both with their own sorts
of problematic exclusivity, was deemed less theologically imperialist. Furthermore …
88
Kirk, “Religious Pluralism as an Epiphenomenon of Postmodern Perspectivism”, 441.
89 Volf, “A Voice of One’s Own”, 276. Newbigin also falls into this contradiction despite the greater nuance
of his critique (see n. 87 above).
81
the “system” of pluralism [seems to many] to operate in curiously absolutist fashion,
proposing to incorporate religions on the system’s own terms rather than on keeping
with the self-understanding of the religions. 90
This critique contains two main points that need to be addressed: firstly, pluralism falsely
pretends to a neutrality from which it can judge all of the great traditions as having different
but equal salvific efficacy; secondly, pluralism disregards any theological affirmation which
does not square with its own understanding of religious diversity, thereby contradicting the
self-understanding of the majority of people within each different tradition. There is clearly
much more meat in these two criticisms than the specious charge of relativism or
philosophical incoherence; yet neither of them ultimately undermine Hick’s actual
argument. Let me address them in turn.
Firstly: “It is not clear why the replacement of one set of criteria with another, both with their own
sorts of problematic exclusivity, was deemed less theologically imperialist”. Critics have certainly been
correct to challenge the often naively presented “openness” of the pluralist theory, and one
does get a sense when reading the pluralist literature that the pluralists feel themselves to be
somehow transcending partisanship. D’Costa has elsewhere stated that:
Despite [the pluralists’] intentions to encourage openness, tolerance, and equality they
fail to attain these goals (on their own definition) because of the tradition-specific
nature of their positions. Their particular shaping tradition is the Enlightenment …
The Enlightenment, in granting a type of equality to all religions, ended up denying
public truth to any and all of them.91
The result is that “their god is modernity’s god”, and thus even though the pluralists present
themselves as being “brokers to disputed parties”, they actually conceal the fact “that they
represent yet another party which invites disputants to leave their parties and join the
90
D’Costa, G., “Preface”, Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered, ix. See also Griffin, “Religious Pluralism”, 30f.
91 D’Costa, G., The Meeting of Religions and the Meeting of the Trinity (Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 2000), 1. This is
Miroslav Volf’s main issue with the pluralist theory.
82
pluralist one”. For this reason, D’Costa argues that pluralism is actually its own form of
exclusivism, and he calls Hick’s view an example of “liberal intolerance”.92
D’Costa raises a valid concern here; but I would respond to his question about why
pluralism is considered by Hick to be less theologically imperialist as follows: it is because
of the way that pluralism understands all religious experience to be authentically grounded
in the Real, and that no tradition-specific conceptualization of the Real thus has unique
authority. That is to say, Hick deems conventional Christian approaches as theologically
imperialist because they have sought to ground the supremacy of Christianity in a revelation
that is allegedly uniquely authoritative, whereas Hick himself deems no such experience of
the divine as more authoritative than any other. As noted above, the crux of the whole
pluralist theory is Hick’s assertion that “we cannot reasonably claim that our own form of
religious experience, together with that of the tradition of which we are a part, is veridical
whilst others are not.” One may not agree with him, but that would be his reason. So while
Hick is positing with equal “imperialism” that his view of the Real is correct, he has, unlike
most Christian thinkers, attempted to ground this view on a broader consideration of the
“experience and thought of the whole human race”.
This brings up the second aspect of the complaint: that pluralism seems “to incorporate
religions on the system’s own terms rather than in keeping with the self-understanding of the religions”. A
similar charge has been made by Kennith Surin in one of the more sophisticated critiques of
pluralism, when he argues that “monological pluralism sedately but ruthlessly domesticates
and assimilates the other – any other – in the name of world ecumenism”.93
These critics are correct in noting that the pluralist theory redescribes the history of
religions in terms that are irreconcilable with the self-understanding of each tradition, and
92
Ibid., 2.
93 Surin, K., “A ‘Politics of Speech’: Religious Pluralism in the Age of the McDonald’s Hamburger” in
Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered, 192-212, here 200.
83
here too Hick has been less clear that he ought.94 Here we come to the important issue of
the insider/outsider debate: i.e. whether statements about religion are valid if they do not conform to the
adherent’s own understanding. This question is based upon the methodological difference
between description (what someone says/thinks about themselves) versus redescription (what
one says about a person/group using a second-order theoretical perspective).95 This has
been one of the most important debates of recent times in the academic study of religion,
and we saw earlier that the question was already at stake in the development of the
phenomenological method represented by van der Leeuw and Eliade. An important point
to stress before addressing the issue is that a theory of religion can be “redescriptive”
without being “reductive” – which is precisely the case with the arguments of figures such
as Otto, Eliade, and Hick. This distinction will become clear as the discussion continues.
One of the most famous contributions to this debate is Wilfred Cantwell Smith’s
claim that “no statement about a religion is valid unless it can be acknowledged by that
religion’s believers”.96 This was asserted even more clearly by an earlier phenomenologist,
Wilhelm Brede Kristensen:
Let us never forget that there exists no other religious reality than the faith of the
believer. If we really want to understand religion, we must refer exclusively to the
believer’s testimony. What we believe, from our point of view, about the nature or
value of other religions, is a reliable testimony to our own understanding of religious
faith; but if our opinion about another religion differs from the opinion and evaluation
94 While Hick addressed this squarely with relation to his own tradition by tackling the doctrine of the
Incarnation in The Myth of God Incarnate, he never discussed analogous fundamental claims within other
traditions that need to be rejected in the pluralist view – e.g. the claim that the Qur’an is the final revelation of
God’s will. Presumably Hick wanted to tread a sensitive path with regard to his comments about other
traditions, even if he was willing to confront his own tradition in this way. But the point remains that
theological pluralists generally seem shy about facing up to this issue.
95 Much of this debate hinges on the issues broached at the start of this chapter regarding McCutcheon’s
argument about what counts as “theory”, with his claim being that descriptive portrayals which do not
redescribe religious actors cannot count as such.
96 Cantwell Smith, W., “The Comparative Study of Religion: Whither—and Why?” in The History of Religions:
Essays in Methodology (ed. M. Eliade & J. Kitagawa; Chicago: University of Chicago Press), 31–58, here 49.
Cantwell Smith asserted this view in a number of his works, see e.g. Toward a World Theology (esp. 60).
84
of the believers, then we are no longer talking about their religion. We have turned
aside from historical reality and are concerned only with ourselves.97
Russell McCutcheon has termed this approach “the methodological rule concerning the
interpretive and descriptive authority of the insider”.98 The contributions to this debate are
too complex and diverse to consider fully here, so in the interests of staying focused I will
only comment on how this idea relates to the question of the validity of the pluralist
theory.99
No theory about religion commands universal assent, meaning that every theory or
theology is a redescription of human life that would not be accepted by most people whom
the theory/theology purports to describe. This means that it is futile to demand that a
theory be acceptable to all whom it purports to describe: for not only is this an impossible
condition, especially for theories concerning the ultimate meaning of human life; but to
follow this maxim would spell the end of all second-order theorizing that attempts to
understand human behaviour in terms that the object of study is either unaware of or does
not agree with.100 In other words, if the descriptive authority of the insider is given the
status of ultimate heuristic authority, then there can be no possible attempt to provide
explanations or interpretations of human behaviour that take into account factors other
than the agents under consideration do.101 When put this way, one sees how analytically
Kristensen, W. B., Religionshistorisk Studium (Oslo: O. Norli, 1954), 17. Cited in Eric Sharpe, Comparative
Religion, 228. See also McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 101ff.
97
98
McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 115.
99 For an extensive discussion, see The Insider/Outsider Problem in the Study of Religion: a Reader (ed. R.
McCutcheon; London: Cassell, 1999).
100 On this point, see J. Z. Smith, “A Matter of Class: Taxonomies of Religion” in Relating Religion (Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 2004), 160-178.
101 There is a reasonable point in McCutcheon’s somewhat churlish question: “Are we only able to say nice
things about those who have already said something nice about us? Or, as our parents might have taught us, if
we cannot say something nice about someone, should we just keep our scholarly mouths shut?”. This issue is
explored provocatively in his piece “‘It’s a Lie. There’s No Truth in It! It’s a Sin!’: On the Limits of the
Humanistic Study of Religion and the Costs of Saving Others from Themselves”, Journal of the American
85
vacuous the idea of the descriptive authority of the insider is – and it seems impossible to
escape the conclusion that it is little more than a poorly thought out reaction against the
pressures of secularism and naturalistic reductionism.
A similar observation was made recently by J. Z. Smith in an interview that
appeared in The Chicago Maroon. It is worth citing in full Smith’s amusingly frustrated
perspective on the issue:
If you want one word from me I’m a translator. That’s what I do. I translate in both
directions. I’m translating other folks’ translations of who they think they are or what
some figure said, or for that matter I’m translating the translation of the figure who
said it. And so, you’re always in the middle, because translation’s always in the middle.
It can’t impose its language on someone else’s language. On the other hand, if it just
repeats the other person’s language, it ain’t translated. I have colleagues in the religion
business who think that’s what we ought to do. We ought to repeat their language. We
ought to get them to sign off on our version of their language. Nonsense! Translation
changes things, there’s no doubt about it. I can’t imagine any author has been fully
satisfied with a translation of their work, even if they translated it themselves. So if I
can’t get the author to sign off on their own translation, why the hell—and who am I
going to ask?
There’s an example, of a great scholar, also named Smith—Wilfred Cantwell Smith,
just died a couple years ago—that was his fundamental principle. His specialty was
particularly in Islam, and he held that if he said something about Islam, they had to
sign off on it. And I said “Wilfred, the difference between you and me is that I’m at
Harvard and you’re at Chicago. You’re rich, I’m poor. Who are you calling up? My
God, what a phone bill! I mean, you’re calling up the entire Muslim world, and asking
what they think of your sentence? Because if not, I want to know how you picked out
the person you asked. And I suspect you picked him out because he talks just like
you!” And then you’re asking a mirror, “How do I look today?” I mean, it’s a crazy
idea. Call up the whole world and ask them, “What do you think about what I was
about to say? Every sentence?” I mean good lord, what a bill. I think even with the cell
phones, I see all the ads say “unlimited”—I don’t think they had that in mind. So no.
… You get in trouble anyway in this business. Sooner or later, you do something
someone’s not going to like. … It’s the glory and the problem of speech.102
In other words, the assertions of Cantwell Smith and Kristensen are simply not valid
methodological rules, because otherwise we could say nothing at all about anybody whose
views we were not merely repeating or elaborating. As such, to maintain the descriptive
Academy of Religion 74 (2006): 720-750, quotation 732.
102 Sinhababu, S., “Interview with J. Z. Smith”, The Chicago Marron, June 2, 2008
(http://chicagomaroon.com/2008/06/02/full-j-z-smith-interview/). Accessed May 21, 2013. (I note that the
transcription has perhaps mistaken the fact that J. Z. Smith was at Chicago, and Cantwell Smith at Harvard.)
86
authority of the insider is to maintain a series of contradictory assertions about human life
and the nature of reality – and that is something far closer to the vapid relativism of which
pluralism has so often been accused.
What does this mean in relation to the pluralist theory? It simply means that just
because Hick and the pluralists argue for a theory of human religiosity that contradicts the
fundamental self-understanding of the great traditions, this does not rule out its plausibility
as a redescripive theory. In fact, this is the entire point of why Hick constructs his pluralistic
hypothesis – for as has been repeated throughout this chapter, pluralism is self-consciously
an attempt to provide a theory of humanity’s religious history which holds, pace traditional
confessional understandings, that all of the great traditions are in contact with the same
transcendent Reality in equally valid ways, but that the fallible and often “tribal” nature of
human thought has resulted in a countless attempts to “limit the sphere of salvation” to
those within one specific cultural or confessional group. Just because Hick has not been
particularly clear about the redescriptive aspect of his approach, nor about the many
traditional claims that he thus has to reject (such as the unique revelatory status of the
Qur’an or the “chosen” status of the Jewish people), his theory cannot be dismissed simply
because it is redescriptive. Other reasons must be offered that go to the heart of his
argument, few of which, however, have been forthcoming from any direction. And just
because it makes its own universal truth-claims, this too does not rule out the fact that it
may actually provide a more plausible account of religious diversity and the profundity of
experience across all cultures than are found in any of the traditional confessional narratives
(i.e. the narratives endorsed by many of his critics). Twiss has provided a good articulation
of this point:
It is to be expected that a higher-order theoretical account would identify deeper (and
perhaps common) explanatory factors that the more limited traditional perspectives
would not have in view. On this reading, Hick simply takes (or assumes) first-order
descriptions of soteriological processes and goals as the phenomena or data for which
87
he now seeks an explanation in more comprehensive theoretical terms. That this might
be seen as explanatory reduction is no objection at all.103
To summarize, critics have been right to point out that pluralism makes its own universal
truth claims; but they are wrong to suggest that this somehow invalidates the theory. They
may still find it unpersuasive because it does not conform to their own experience of the
world, but the argument remains plausible and coherent. Indeed, while pluralism leaves
open the question of how it can be justified given the extent to which it contradicts the selfunderstanding of each tradition (something for which Hick attempts to provide
comprehensive justification), a conventional inclusivist or exclusivist Christian view, for
example, similarly leaves open the question how and why every human ideational
community throughout history has held conflicting views about the ultimate nature of
reality with the same level of conviction and with the same degree of self-evidency as
Christians. This is, however, a question that Hick’s Christian interlocutors typically do not
address. So, if I am to offer my own redescription, the primary reason that all critics so far
mentioned reject the pluralist theory is not because of a formal incoherence in an otherwise
persuasive theory, but because they deem it insufficient as a Christian position.
Criticism 4: Pluralism is Inadequate as a Christian Theological Position.
All critics so far mentioned are Christian theologians, as have been most direct critics of
Hick. This fact is of importance when assessing the criticisms that they have leveled at the
pluralist theory of religions. So far the charges documented – of philosophical incoherence,
relativism, and universalism – have been shown to not actually undermine the basic
argument Hick makes, which simply offers a redescription of humanity’s religious history
103
Twiss, “The Philosophy of Religious Pluralism”, 544.
88
that does not square with a traditional Christian understanding of that history.104 This has
led me to the view that the primary problem of these critics is actually that Hick’s pluralism
is an insufficient base for a genuinely Christian theology. Addressing the question of
pluralism’s theological adequacy is inappropriate in the context of this dissertation, but I do
want to make a general observation about the issue.
While pluralism is undoubtedly an insufficient base for Christianity from a
conservative or orthodox perspective (given that it does not place Christ at the centre of
human history), the pluralist view has been defended by a number of liberal Christians as
providing an adequate base for a genuinely Christian position. Although it could fairly be
argued that pluralists are trying to have their cake and eat it too – to maintain the old
Christian symbols (of God, Christ, salvation etc.) while arguing for a view that radically
undermines the premises on which these traditional symbols were founded – there do on
the other hand exist a number of well justified proposals for the theological legitimacy of
theocentric models of Christian faith and fellowship.105
The issue, in other words, seems to boil down to what has already been mentioned
with respect to Hick and Cantwell Smith: whether one regards doctrine as ultimately
authoritative, or whether one regards religious experience as ultimately authoritative. In the
doctrinal view, pluralism is hopelessly inadequate and represents a capitulation to the
pressures of Enlightenment modernity. But in the latter view, pluralism provides by far a
stronger explanation for pan-human religiosity than any inclusivist or exclusivist Christian
approach, both of which seem to offer little explanation for the depth of conviction held by
See Chester Gillis’ defence of Hick in this context, where he argues that Hick’s theory has been widely
misread at an attempt at Christian theology, when in fact the argument of An Interpretation of Religion is
fundamentally philosophical, not theological (“John Hick: Theologian or Philosopher of Religion?” in Religious
Pluralism and the Modern World, 137-151). Although as both Gillis and Twiss note, Hick is certainly culpable for
blurring the lines between his role as a philosopher and a theologian in certain publications.
104
105 The most eloquent attempt at this I have seen is Wilfred Cantwell Smith’s Towards A World Theology, esp.
152-179. At one stage he declares that his proposal is “unabashedly theocentric” (177).
89
those in other traditions other than a generalized notion that notion that the Spirit is
universally operative and that all religions have a part to play in the economy of salvation.106
Hick certainly wants pluralism to be an adequate basis for Christian theology and he
uses it as such himself; but even if it is deemed insufficient as a theological base, this does
not actually challenge the basic argument of pluralism qua redescriptive theory of religion.
As such, all that its theological critics can ultimately say is that they are not persuaded by
Hick’s argument because it is not Christian enough – but this offers no substantive
challenge to the specific claims that he makes.
This point needs to be emphasized: theological critics seem to have spent far more
time trying to refute Hick’s argument than trying to offer alternate answers for the
profound similarities to be found across all religious traditions – and given that their
rejection usually entails a quiet (or sometimes loud) affirmation of the central truths of
Christian doctrine, one is surely justified in asking how they respond to Hick’s central claim that
they are trusting their own form of religious experience as somehow uniquely authoritative
vis-à-vis the claims of other traditions, which are patently grounded in experiences of the
same sincerity and profundity. To put it more concretely: Do they have, for example, a
sociological explanation for the conviction of the Islamic community regarding the
revelatory status of the Qur’an? Is there a psychological explanation for this claim, revolving
perhaps around the human desire for objective certainty, or the power of charisma? If so,
why do these reductive explanations not apply to Christian claims? These questions are
simply not addressed by the theological critics of pluralism, even though their rejection of
Jacques Dupuis is a good example of this tendency. His response to Hick and the pluralists is theologically
complex, but entirely self-referential within established Catholic discourses. He therefore in no way addresses
the wider body of non-theological knowledge that lies behind Hick’s argument (see Toward A Christian Theology
of Religious Pluralism [Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1999]). The same holds, mutatis mutandis, for most theological
critics of pluralism.
106
90
Hick’s argument – which does attempt to explain the conviction of the Islamic claim,
however imperfectly – surely requires that they address such issues.
Criticism 5: There is No Common Essence Amongst Religions.
The final criticism is similar to the issues already raised, especially the problem of
pluralism’s redescriptive universalism, but it is treated separately here because it is the only
regular criticism I have discerned in the non-theological literature (even though some
theologians have made the same claim). A prominent recent example of this complaint
comes from Stephen Prothero in his book God Is Not One.107 Prothero starts by noting the
long history of the view that “all religions are one”. In recent times this view has been
expressed by figures such as Gandhi, the current Dalai Lama, Karen Armstrong, and
Huston Smith. Prothero gives special consideration to Smith and the perennial philosophy,
which he sees as the prime contemporary manifestation of the belief that all religions share
the same core.108 It should be noted that he does not consider Hick and the theological
pluralist discourse; yet pluralism and perennialism are very similar ideas, so his criticism
applies equally to Hick’s argument.109
After citing a number of versions of the view that the only difference in religions is
their external trappings and that they all share the same core (especially the Golden Rule),
Prothero says “This is a lovely sentiment but it is dangerous, disrespectful, and untrue”.110
107
Prothero, S., God Is Not One: The Eight Rival Religions That Run The World (New York: HarperOne, 2010).
Although Aldous Huxely is the figure most commonly associated with perennialism, Smith’s major
influence was the Swiss scholar and mystic, Frithjof Schuon (see ch. 1, n. 2 above). For a good introduction to
Schuon, see The Essential Frithjof Schuon (ed. S. H. Nasr; Indiana: World Wisdom, 2005), esp. the detailed
introduction by Seyyed Hossein Nasr (1-64).
108
109 I am unaware of any comparative treatment of pluralist theology and perennialist thought. The two
positions are broadly homologous, but have different discursive histories and so have rarely been in
conversation. Huston Smith’s easy convergence with Hick’s perspective is a good example to support the
point, but a fuller comparative study of the two schools of thought would be interesting (even if only from the
perspective of intellectual history).
110
Prothero, God Is Not One, 2.
91
He says that “no religion … sees ethics alone as its reason for being”, and that “For more
than a generation we have followed scholars and sages down the rabbit hole into a fantasy
world in which all gods are one”.111 The reason he argues this is that, contrary to the
intentions of these pluralists, by not taking religious differences at face value this “naive
theological groupthink … has made the world more dangerous by blinding us to the clashes
of religions that threaten us worldwide”.112 Prothero therefore characterizes the differencemuting approach of Huston Smith et al. as “pretend pluralism”, and he says that while the
sentiment is admirable, what the world needs now is more “realism” than “idealism” in our
reflections on religious diversity.113
This is all true enough, at least from the pragmatic perspective of the civic
negotiation of cultural difference. But the problem with Prothero’s argument as an actual
criticism of the pluralist theory is that he bluntly advocates that all we should do is remain at
the descriptive level and deal with religious traditions as they understand themselves. Because the
world’s religious traditions patently “do not share the same goals”, he decries the way in
which the perennial philosophers (and by implication Hick and the theological pluralists)
“conscript outsiders into their tradition quite against their will”.114
The problem with this approach was made clear above in the discussion regarding
the insider/outsider debate: what this approach implies is that any attempt to think about
traditions in terms other than those with which they describe themselves is ruled out as
unacceptable – but this cannot be a valid methodological rule to which scholars should
adhere. Prothero is effectively saying: “don’t think about the evolutionary origins of
religious and cultural diversity, don’t speculate about the phenomenological similarities
111
Ibid., 2-3.
112
Ibid., 3.
113
Ibid., 5 -7.
114
Ibid., 6.
92
amongst the traditions and how these might be understood using the intellectual advances
of the past century, and don’t say anything with which the adherents themselves would not
agree – that is a waste of time, it is unethical, and it stops us getting on with the job of
getting along”. But this criticism rests on an oversimplified understanding of the pluralist
argument, and recapitulates the untenable logic of Cantwell Smith’s view that nothing about
a religion is true unless confirmed by the believers themselves. How can a scholar deny the
right of other scholars the attempt to think about human history in ways that try to make
sense of so many otherwise incompatible accounts? If Prothero does not wish to do that in
pursuit of other interests, then that is of course a reasonable choice. But to deny the
legitimacy of this in toto is nothing less than bad scholarship.
In other words, Prothero’s criticism fails to take account of the redescriptive nature
of the pluralist perspective, and he writes it off far too quickly simply because it attempts to
delve beyond the descriptive level (i.e. the level at which mutually contradictory assertions
about the human condition abound). Prothero is obviously correct that many people will
not be convinced by the pluralist theory, and that time might thus be better spent on other
forms of fostering peaceful intercultural relations. But he offers no argument against
pluralism itself other than the fact that it goes beyond the descriptive level – which is to say
he offers no argument at all.
A final version of the “no common core” critique worth noting is from Russell
McCutcheon, which relates to his critique of essentialism that was mapped out in the
previous chapter. As noted, McCutcheon charges that there is no common essence because
he adopts a naturalistic understanding of “religion” that views the cluster of activities
usually held to be “religious” as explicable through normal modes of social-scientific
explanation. He further charges that the discourse on sui generis religion has subtle but
serious political implications, especially in terms of the assumptions about “human nature”
93
that it makes normative. For example, McCutcheon argues that Eliade’s call for the
establishment of a “new humanism”
ostensibly proclaims the radical equality of all human religious experience. However,
such talk of abstract sameness can effectively overlook the differences that most often
define actual lived experience. No doubt some aspects of the discourse on sui generis
religion may be commendable, but the social scientific analysis that today confronts
religious experiences and behaviours does not seek to dissolve such states into
monocausal origins, as was characteristic of earlier analyses, but to understand better
and explain human behaviors and beliefs utilizing multiple points of view, theories, and
scales. To continue to promote the analytical usefulness of autonomous religious
experience, as opposed to the polymethodic approach, fails to identify the complexity
of human actions entrenched in their contexts.115
McCutcheon’s driving concern in this observation is to explicate “the role played by the
category of sui generis religion in excluding sociopolitical analysis from much scholarship
on religion”.116 This is clearly a rather different issue from all of the abovementioned
criticisms of pluralism, even though it also challenges the way that the pluralist
understanding of religion mutes difference. But McCutcheon is not trying to offer a
philosophical argument against pluralism; he is rather assuming the inadequacy of Hick’s
argument and instead seeking to explore the sociopolitical implications of the discourse on
sui generis religion.
Thus, rather than McCutcheon offering a specific critique of pluralism that can be
discussed here, his approach instead hinges on what suppositions should guide the
academic study of religion. As is clear, his main concern is to advocate for a more
polymethodic approach than the still heavily descriptive/phenomenological approach that
dominates contemporary religious studies. This is an important issue, but is of a different
nature than the primary questions being investigated in the bulk of this dissertation. But as
noted, I return to McCutcheon’s reservations at the end of this work when reflecting on the
115
McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 23.
116
Ibid., 27.
94
wider methodological and pedagogical implications that are entailed in rejecting Hick’s
argument.
Summary: What’s the Problem With Pluralism?
The purpose of this chapter has been to provide a detailed introduction to the pluralist
theory of religions so that its core assumptions can be subjected to critical scrutiny in the
rest of this work. After qualifying my use of the term “theory” to describe Hick’s argument,
situating him within the trajectory of non-reductive theories that have their root in
Schleiermacher and the tropes of “experience” and a “sui generis” sacred, and then outlining
his theory in detail, I addressed the five traditional criticisms leveled against it. My argument
was that all of them, perhaps with the exception of McCutcheon’s (which revolves around a
quite different issue), do not present a fundamental challenge to Hick’s argument. The
charge of philosophical incoherence did not seem to understand Hick’s postulation of the
noumenal Real and how this was a justifiable hypothesis to account for the religious
diversity of humanity. The charge of relativism was equally flimsy – not only did it rest on a
reading of pluralism that seemingly wanted to reject it at first chance rather than to reflect
seriously on what Hick was saying, but critics who charge relativism also accuse pluralism of
being surreptitious universalism. The latter claim is more accurate, but it effectively
undermines the argument that pluralism simply affirms that “everything is true” – which of
course it does not. Thus the third charge, that pluralism is its own universalist narrative
despite the agreeable character it tries to project, was a more important criticism. Yet the
basic issue at stake here was that pluralism redescribed the religious history of humanity in
terms not reconcilable with the self-understanding of each tradition (at least, most strands
within the traditions) – and I argued at length that this is simply beside the point as an
actual critique of the argument. To reject pluralism because it is not reconcilable with an
95
adherent’s own view of their tradition is a specious criticism, especially when made by
theologians, because they too hold views that are not reconcilable with the selfunderstanding of others. I was thus forced to conclude that it seems far more likely that the
theological critics of pluralism simply find the pluralist theory “not Christian enough”, and
then attack it for superficial reasons without ever actually addressing the challenge Hick poses to them
about why their faith experiences are somehow uniquely authoritative. The Christian rejection of
pluralism is therefore thoroughly unconvincing. The final charge that religions do not share
a common core was similar to the charge of redescriptive universalism, but was the only
criticism offered by non-theological critics. Yet as was clear in the discussion of Prothero,
he offers no challenge at all to the actual argument, and while he is certainly justified to
pursue more pragmatic concerns, he is not justified in declaring “disrespectful”, “unethical”
and “unhelpful” the attempts of those such as Hick who are trying to make sense of how a
species with unitary biological origins could come to develop such diverse and
irreconcilable accounts of human existence and the nature of reality.117 Thus, when these
five criticisms are all considered, I believe it is clear that the challenges they pose to the
pluralist theory fail to seriously undermine the argument that Hick makes.
But as has also been made clear, I believe there is major tension in Hick’s argument
that he (along with his critics) has failed to notice. So, what’s the problem with pluralism?
The problem is that in his valorization of the “great traditions” and their “soteriological”
goals, something reflected particularly in his use of the Axial Age paradigm, Hick
reproduces a host of problematic views regarding what counts as “authentic” religion that
have their root in the Eurocentric discourses that he is trying to overcome. I will
demonstrate this at length in Chapter 4. But to do this, it is first necessary to establish how
117
Prothero uses these terms in God Is Not One, 3.
96
these assumptions play out in the broader discourse in which Hick operated: the world
religions paradigm.
97
Chapter 3
Historicizing the Rhetoric of “Great Traditions”:
A Genealogy of the World Religions Paradigm
When Hick deploys the concept of the “Axial Age” and the corresponding distinction
between “pre-axial” and “post-axial” religions, he is picking up some heavily freighted
baggage. As will be demonstrated in the next chapter, the Axial Age construct is ultimately
grounded in a Hegelian view of world history that saw modern, Protestant Europe as the
culmination of the religious history of humanity. Even though Karl Jaspers’ twentiethcentury construal of the Axial Age is a more “pluralized” version of the Hegelian narrative,
rejecting Hegel’s developmental logic and incorporating the full range of “world” religions
into the fold, it nevertheless remains fundamentally Eurocentric in the categories it employs
and the meaning it ascribes to the historical process. This is especially visible in the way that
Jaspers omits any “minor” and “primitive” religions from his narrative about the dawning
of “authentic” religious consciousness, regarding them in Hegelian fashion as immobile,
static, and thus non-participants in historical development. This is the conceptual baggage
that Hick picks up: and it means that despite his egalitarian position, he participates in – and
indeed actively reproduces – a universe of discourse in which world religions are “higher”
than local religions, in which “civilization” is the antithesis of “savagery”, and in which
“primitive” culture represents the childhood of the human race – precisely the logic of the
European triumphalism that he so strenuously tries to renounce. The central claim I am
making in this dissertation is that this fundamentally undermines the pluralistic ethos that
animates Hick’s work.
Yet the Axial Age is only one specific permutation of a wider field of discourse, and
Hick’s theory is the product of a number of other discursive pressures that shaped the mid-
99
twentieth century study of religion.1 Focus will be placed on Jaspers, Hick and the Axial
Age in the following chapter, where I offer a re-reading of Hick’s argument more critically
attuned to the questionable assumptions that pervade his work, especially the two-fold
division of the world’s religions into “pre-” and “post-” axial. But in order to lay the ground
for that analysis, this chapter looks at the broader issue of how the classification of the
world’s religions has taken place in western scholarship over the past five centuries, with a
particular focus on the formalization of comparative religion in the nineteenth century and
how this transformed into the twentieth-century study of religion.2
Readers will have noticed that Hick generally employs the phraseology of “great
traditions” to refer to the major textual religions of the world. As indicated in the first
chapter, this is effectively the same as referring to them as “world religions”. As such, this
chapter looks at two specific issues: 1) the multiple forms of classification that underlie and
culminate in the pluralistic world religions paradigm of the twentieth century; and especially
2) the concomitant place of the “primitive” and other non-world religions in these schemes
of classification. This chapter will therefore historicize the rhetoric of “great traditions”
used by Hick and bring into the foreground the host of problematic assumptions implied by
this language. Thus, by establishing the historically embedded assumptions of the world
religions paradigm and the way in which it consistently operated with an implicit hierarchy
that devalued all “lower”, “minor”, and “primitive” religions, I will be able to return to
Hick’s pluralistic hypothesis in the next chapter to more clearly highlight and then challenge
its formative logic.
To use the parlance of post-structuralism, the Axial Age is a specific act of parole formulated from within the
langue of European discourses on religion.
1
I use “comparative religion” to designate the broad field of scholarship treated by Eric Sharpe in his classic
study, Comparative Religion: A History (2nd ed.; London: Duckworth, 1986). Noting the generic nature of the
term, Sharpe explains that comparative religion “is now subdivided into the history of religions, the
psychology of religion, the sociology of religion, the phenomenology of religion and the philosophy of religion
(not to mention a host of auxiliary disciplines) … Each of [which] has its own approaches and its own
appropriate methods” (xiii). All of these areas exerted influence on Hick.
2
100
I examine the history of the world religions paradigm in three stages, attempting to
track shifting patterns of classification in European scholarship from the sixteenth century
through to the contemporary pluralistic model. The story, in short, is that forms of
classification kept changing due to increased accumulation of data.3 The aim is to examine
important examples of classification from each century over this period, demonstrating (a)
how they relate to the continued accumulation of ethnographic evidence about nonEuropean cultures, (b) what they reveal about attitudes to the non-European other, and (c)
how they fit into the broader intellectual currents that sustained ideologies of European and
Christian exceptionalism, such as ideas about progress, evolution, race, and nationalism.
These ideologies reach their apex in the late nineteenth century, although it will be clear that
the pluralistic world religions model has by no means expunged their influence in the way
that it categorizes the various religions of the world. For a model that prides itself on its
liberal egalitarianism, this is an unacceptable state of affairs.
I first establish the pre-nineteenth century background, beginning in the sixteenth
century with the European response to the new problem of cultural diversity thrown up by
the discovery of the Americas.4 In this period of epistemic rupture, when many a brow was
furrowed trying to establish how the peoples of the New World could be fit into the general
order of things (that is, the Scholastic order of things), the operative form of classification
was the fourfold typology of Christianity, Judaism, Islam, and Paganism (the latter being
one of many “residual” categories that would mark the western tradition of classification).
This model in fact persists even into the nineteenth century, although Christian theology
This is a paraphrase of a comment made by J. Z. Smith in “Religion, Religions, Religious”, a piece that was
deeply influential in directing the early stages of research for this dissertation (Smith, J. Z., Relating Religion,
[Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2004] 179-196, here 186). Indeed, the present chapter is in many
respects a re-run of the narrative Smith charts regarding the classification of religions in western scholarship,
albeit one that has been tailored to suit my own specific interests.
3
4 Amongst the many works on the impact of the discovery of the Americas, see J. H. Elliot, The Old World and
the New: 1492-1650 (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1970).
101
also furnished other taxonomic categories (such as “natural” versus “revealed” religion, or
“true” versus “false”), which were often simultaneously employed.5 After examining some
important examples of the fourfold taxonomy from the sixteenth and seventeenth
centuries, attention turns to the advent of formal scientific classification instigated by the
publication of Carl Linnaeus’ System of Nature in 1735. Not only did Linnaeus settle longrunning questions regarding the place of “primitive” peoples in the Great Chain of Being by
officially accepting them as a variety of the species Homo sapiens, but his system also laid the
base for the future division of peoples in European scientific discourse by the controversial
category of race.
This leads to the nineteenth century, which was a profoundly transformative time in
the western study of religion: at the start of the century, the fourfold typology was still more
or less in place; by the end of the century, a very different model had been consolidated that
looks much more like the twentieth century world religions paradigm (albeit one that was
still heavily Eurocentric and Christian-apologetic). In order to maintain focus on
classification and not get lost in the mass of detail that makes up nineteenth-century history,
the analysis is restricted to two main issues: philology and the invention of world religions,
and anthropology and the invention of primitive culture.6 While these two disciplines
occasionally overlapped, for the most part they were carried out in relative isolation from
On the categories of “natural” and “revealed” religion, which gained currency especially in the late
seventeenth century, see Peter Harrison, ‘Religion’ and the Religions in the English Enlightenment (Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1990), 24 (inc. n. 19, p. 185). As Harrison notes, the “truth or falsity” of
particular “religions” is a concept that gained increasing traction once piety became tied to “propositional”
forms of faith which focused upon “articles of belief” (26). This point was, of course, famously made earlier
by Wilfred Cantwell Smith (The Meaning and End of Religion [orig. 1962; New York: Harper & Row, 1978)],
upon whose study Harrison builds. On the shift to “belief”, see also Smith, J. Z., “Religion, Religions,
Religious”, 181ff. A useful frame for understanding these important semantic shifts is provided in Brent
Nongbri, Before Religion: A History of a Modern Concept (New Haven: Yale University Press, 2013).
5
Here I deliberately echo two important works that are utilized below: Tomoko Masuzawa, The Invention of
World Religions: Or, How European Universalism was Preserved in the Language of Pluralism (Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 2005); and Adam Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society: Transformations of an Illusion (London:
Routledge, 1988). Obviously “invention” here is synonymous with “discursive construction”.
6
102
each other, and need to be tracked separately in order to understand their different
contributions to the problems embedded in the twentieth-century model.
I begin with philology in the late eighteenth century, discussing how European
colonial expansion into the Near East (represented especially by the watershed Napoleonic
invasion of Egypt and the British colonization of India) was responsible for the so-called
“Oriental Renaissance”, i.e. the European discovery of eastern religious texts that formed
the basis of the closely-related disciplines of philology, linguistics, and comparative religion.
These enterprises were fueled by a desire to recover a newly conceived Indo-European past,
and the textual accumulation of this period laid the ground for one of the most important
concepts in nineteenth-century thought: the establishment of Aryan and Semitic as racial
categories. This framework received articulation in the new “Science of Religion”
inaugurated by Friedrich Max Müller in the 1860s, whose organization of the world’s
religions according to the linguistic categories of Aryan, Semitic and Turanian represents
the first in a series of major shifts from the fourfold scholastic typology towards the
contemporary world religions model. Yet Müller’s approach, whilst highly influential, was
quickly superseded by models that were less linguistically oriented and were instead
structured around the notion of evolutionary development, wherein the primary distinction was
between “natural” and “ethical” religions. This new model was represented in the taxonomy
of Cornelis Petrus Tiele, whose work in the 1870s established a new status quaestionis
regarding the classification of the world’s religions in light of the vast expansion in
European knowledge (and power) over the preceding century. An important instantiation
of this was the 1893 World’s Parliament of Religions in Chicago, which reflects almost
perfectly the way in which the fourfold scholastic typology had, by the end of the
nineteenth century, been replaced with a new model in which each “world” religion (i.e.
each textual, “historical” religion) was accorded its own legitimate place as an authentic
103
species of religion – but also how the entire model was still underpinned by a quite overt
hierarchy in which Protestant Christianity was unquestionably at the top.
The 1893 World’s Parliament of Religions is also instructive for the way in which it
totally excludes all of the “lower” religions from its field of vision, so at this stage the
discussion return to Linnaeus and traces the alternate tradition of ethnography and the
place of “primitive” culture in European thought of the nineteenth century, focusing
especially on how these cultures fared in the new formal taxonomies of the comparative
religion enterprise. After looking briefly at the way in which “fetishism” had become the
prominent label for all primitive religion by the early eighteenth century, attention is
primarily paid to the major shifts that occurred after the epoch-making publication of
Darwin’s On the Origin of Species in 1859. While this had an enormous influence in the
philologically-oriented discipline of comparative religion (as will be clear when looking at
Tiele’s focus on religious development), its impact on the study of early human history was
even more pronounced, with the discipline of anthropology swiftly emerging as the primary
locus for the study of human culture in an evolutionary context.7 Beginning with the
(somewhat curious) interest in primitive culture by legal historians, I then explore the work
of E. B. Tylor, the “father of anthropology”, whose concept of “animism” was to supplant
“fetishism” as the major term of classification for the earliest stages of religious history.
Having traced these two nineteenth century trajectories, the final section examines
the consolidation of the world religions model in the twentieth century. One of the themes
that will be emphasized is how the disciplinary separation of anthropology and philology in
the nineteenth century fundamentally shaped the discourse on religion in the twentieth
century, playing a key role in the problems I have identified with Hick and the Axial Age
7 Although it is not possible to explore wider historical ramifications of Darwin’s work, see for example Mike
Hawkins’ excellent study, Social Darwinism in European and American Thought: Nature as Model and Nature as Threat
(Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1997).
104
narrative. The section begins by noting how this separation is reflected in the two most
important scholars of religion of the early twentieth century, Max Weber and Émile
Durkheim: Weber representing the trajectory of philology and its focus on the textual
“world” religions, and Durkheim representing the trajectory of anthropology and its
construction of primitive culture as the “elementary form” of human society. There was
little cross-fertilization between these two fields, and in the twentieth-century study of
religion, the philologically-grounded world religions paradigm proved the dominant one,
with non-civilizational cultures being almost totally relegated to the discipline of
anthropology. This is demonstrated by looking at a number of prominent examples of the
new world religions model that emerges in the era after the Second World War, when the
Christian triumphalism of the nineteenth century was explicitly repudiated in favour of a
more pluralistic model with no (ostensible) hierarchy. Looking first at Huston Smith’s
widely popular 1958 work, The Religions of Man, which was a major catalyst in bringing the
world religions paradigm to popular attention, I show how the model employed by Smith
(which he later acknowledged gave no value to the “lower” religions) was reproduced again
and again over the ensuing decades, something that James Cox has noted “continues
unabated into the twenty-first century”.8 Attention is also paid to how the chief engine of
this reproduction was the creation of religious studies as an academic discipline in the
1960s, which was heavily imbued with the subtle theological agenda of the phenomenology
of religion and was thus resistant to the theoretical challenges posed by the different strands
of postmodern and postcolonial critique that were reshaping so many other fields.9
The chapter concludes by synthesizing the concerns voiced by scholars surrounding
the persistent usage of the world religions model in the contemporary study of religion.
8
Cox, J., From Primitive to Indigenous: The Academic Study of Indigenous Religions (Hampshire: Ashgate, 2007), 51.
9
Critical theory is discussed further in Chapter 5.
105
Using the insights of J. Z. Smith as a starting point, I look at how scholars of religion in the
late twentieth century began applying the strategies of critical discourse analysis not just to
the world religions paradigm, but to the entire discipline of religious studies itself. Much of
this criticism has been directed towards the phenomenological orientation of the discipline,
demonstrating the way in which it effectively ignores a host of pressing moral and political
concerns, particularly regarding the place of local and indigenous peoples in the discourse
on religion, and thus how it perpetuates the Eurocentric legacy of great-traditions-centrism
despite its avowedly “liberal” orientation. The chapter closes by looking at the more explicit
postcolonial turn of the last decade. The major agendum here has been to highlight the
historical marginalization of “indigenous” religions, both politically and discursively, and to
undertake a fundamental restructuring of the study of religion in order to more effectively
dismantle the colonialist legacy of the world religions paradigm. Thus, by the end of this
chapter, a firm base will have been laid from which to revisit Hick and bring into view
untenable assumptions that lie beneath the seemingly egalitarian surface of the pluralist
theory of religions and its valorization of “the great traditions of mankind”.
The Pre-Nineteenth Century Background
The sixteenth century was a turbulent time in Europe. Society was changing rapidly, and the
world was growing bigger.10 Driving these changes was a host of technological
developments, foremost amongst which being the astonishing new pace of communication
opened up by the printing press, which served as the central engine of the intellectual
Aside from the numerous works cited below, my understanding of this period has also been informed by
the broader treatments of Immanuel Wallerstein, The Modern World System (4 vols; 2nd ed.; Berkeley: University
of California Press, 2011); Fernand Braudel, Civilization and Capitalism: 15th – 18th Century (trans. S. Reynolds; 3
vols; London: Fontana, 1981-1984); and William McNeill, The Rise of the West: A History of the Human Community
(Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1963).
10
106
transformations that took place in the early modern period.11 The massive upheavals of the
Reformation had shattered the idea of unified Christendom, creating new religious
ideologies and conflicts, and intensifying the consolidation of a new form of social order
centered around the political state.12 Meanwhile, colonial expansion – especially the
discovery of the Americas – had opened up vast conceptual and geographical horizons that
were deeply troubling for European thinkers.13 Whilst all of these themes are of
fundamental importance for the history of comparative religion, given my interest in the
specific issue of classification (and the brevity I am attempting to maintain in this chapter), I
restrict my focus in this section to geographic expansion and the growth of ethnography
that ensued.
From the beginning of European colonial expansion in the early fifteenth century, a
fresh mass of data began accumulating about the world and its peoples that needed to be
worked into European schemes of knowledge. The new accessibility of printed books had
Some might find this claim a bit exaggerated, but in my view it is difficult to overestimate the role of print
technology in the raft of social and intellectual developments that followed it. See e.g. Elizabeth Eisenstein’s
excellent study, The Printing Press as an Agent of Change: Communications and Cultural Transformations in Early-Modern
Europe (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1979); see ch. 1 of the work (“The Unacknowledged
Revolution”) on the historic neglect of the role played by print technology in European historiography. As
noted earlier, the issue of communications technologies and cultural change will become a central issue in
Chapter 5 when discussing the Axial Age, and it will be interesting to recall the impact of print against this
larger evolutionary backdrop. Works that complement Eisenstein’s study can be found in the supplementary
bibliography.
11
A good account of the rise and consolidation of the political state in early modern Europe can be found in
Quentin Skinner, The Foundations of Modern Political Thought (2 vols; Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1978). On the importance of the Reformation in this context, see William T. Cavanaugh, “‘A Fire Strong
Enough to Consume the House’: The Wars of Religion and the Rise of the State”, Modern Theology 11 (1995),
397-420. On the impact of these events on the modern category of “religion”, see Nongbri, Before Religion,
97ff.
12
13 In addition to Elliot’s The Old World and the New, a useful survey of documentary sources on the impact of
the American discovery on European thought is provided in Anthony Grafton, New Worlds, Ancient Texts: The
Power of Tradition and the Shock of Discovery (Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1992). For a helpful
overview of cartographic changes in the period, see David Woodward, “Cartography and the Renaissance:
Continuity and Change” in the impressive University of Chicago series, The History of Cartography (3 vols [6
projected]; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2007), 3.1: 3-25. See the supplementary bibliography for full
details of the series.
107
increased the appetite for knowledge by the early sixteenth century,14 and works soon
appeared that tried to synthesize the wide-ranging material and offer readers a survey of the
varieties of human behviour, generally under the rubric of “manners and customs”.15 One
of the most influential example was Omnium Gentium Mores, Leges, & Ritus ex Multis
Clarissimis Rerum Scriptorum by the German Hebraist Johann Boemus, first published in 1520
and reprinted many times over, being translated into English as The Fardle of Façions in
1555.16 Boemus’ intentions in this work were twofold: to make the variety of human
behaviour accessible to the ordinary reader (arranged according to a geographical plan); and
to improve the political morality of his readers by making them familiar with the laws and
governments of other peoples.17 As Margaret Hodgen describes, Boemus represents a new
phase in ethnography that began in the latter stages of the fifteenth century, in which
authors no longer strove to present a generic account of “all customs” of “all men”, and
instead began to use more specialized taxonomies of different categories of customs and
manners, such as “the rites, ceremonies and beliefs associated with religion; the rites and
regulations associated with marriage, and caring for a family, the ceremonies and beliefs
On the rise of books and reading in the post-Gutenberg era, see Lucien Febvre & Henri-Jean Martin, The
Coming of the Book: the Impact of Print 1450–1800 (trans. D. Gerard; London: Verso, 1997 [1958]). See also A
History of Reading in the West (ed. C. Cavello & R. Chartier; Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1999).
Further relevant works are provided in the supplementary bibliography.
14
In what follows I am deeply indebted to Margaret T. Hodgen’s work, Early Anthropology in the Sixteenth and
Seventeenth Centuries (Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1964). On this new form of ethnography
and its wider public audience, see 162-206. I also note that Hodgen’s work is not discussed by J. Z. Smith in
“Religion, Religions, Religious”, even though it seems inescapable to me that he had not read it, given how
many of the figures treated by Hodgen are also discussed in Smith’s genealogy.
15
16 Ibid., 131. For a lengthy discussion of The Fardle of Façions, which Hodgen describes as “an instant success”
that was “widely consulted for well over a hundred years” (132), see 111-161. The full title of the English
translation was The Fardle of Façions; conteining the aunciente maners, customs, and lawes, of the peoples enhabiting the two
parts of the earthe, called Affrike and Asie (London: Jhon Kingstone & Henry Sutton, 1555).
17 As such, Boemus’ work fits into the popular “handbook” genre of the early modern period, the most
famous example of which being Machiavelli’s Prince. See Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 132.
108
accompanying the disposition of the dead; the customs of political organization; the
customs of shelter, dress and diet, etc.”18
Naturally, given the salience of theological disputes in this period, especial interest
was given to the religion of unfamiliar peoples.19 Whenever this topic was broached, the
scholastic model of classification naturally imposed itself, i.e. the division of the world into
Christianity, Judaism, Islam, and Paganism/Idolatry/Etc.20 Boemus uses this basic model,
although he also reflects the tendency to use other categories as well, discussing not only
“the problem and origin of idolatry”,21 but also the varieties of polytheism and their
differences with monotheism.22 It should be noted that Boemus was not trying to generate a
new form of classification for “the religions” of the world – itself a concept virtually nonexistent at this time; his taxonomic efforts were instead directed more broadly at bringing
together customs, manners, and social institutions under manageable frameworks.23 But the
importance of his work lies in the large influence it exerted in the swiftly expanding
ethnographic tradition of this period, which furnished the materials with which subsequent
European scholars would continue to construct an image of the less familiar peoples of the
18
Ibid., 168.
19 I note again that my concern here is not to discuss the history of the modern category of “religion”,
although ethnographies such as Boemus’ were certainly important in driving the semantic shifts documented
by Nongbri and Harrison, et al. (see above, ch. 1, n. 58).
For a detailed discussion of the history of this typology, see Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 47-64.
As many scholars have noted (including Harrison and J. Z. Smith), the fourth category (variously: idolatry,
paganism, polytheism, heathenism) was inherently unstable, given that it effectively encompassed every known
tradition that was not one of the three “revealed” religions. Yet as Masuzawa notes, “Despite, or perhaps
because of the mutability and instability of the categories, the four-way system endured and remained useful
… recur[ring] in book after book with little variation from at least the early seventeenth up to the first half of
the nineteenth century” (58-9).
20
21
See Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 140ff., 169ff.; also 354-385.
Boemus made barely any mention of Islam, although he does call the religion of the Turks and the Saracens
“the brainesicke wickednesse of a countrefeicte prophete” [sic] (ibid., 140).
22
23
Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 61.
109
world, thus serving as important forerunners to nineteenth-century comparative religion.24
However, even though Boemus was writing almost three decades after the Columbian
voyages, his work did not include any mention of the newly discovered peoples and lands
of the Americas, and was still structured around the old tripartite world that comprised of
“thre partes, Affrique, Asie, and Europe”.25 Yet this was changing rapidly, and Boemus
represents the last gasp of this medieval paradigm, with writers almost immediately after
him beginning to pay much more attention to the new material at their disposal.26
This is clearly apparent in works similar to Boemus’ that appeared roughly a century
after his Omnium Gentium Mores, two important examples being Purchas His Pilgrimage by
Samuel Purchas (1613), and Enquiries Touching the Diversity of Languages and Religions through the
Chiefe Parts of the World by Edward Brerewood (1614), works that were also structured with a
primarily geographic focus.27 Without wishing to engage in an extended analysis of these
texts, a few things are worth mentioning. The most conspicuous difference between these
works and that of Boemus is the inclusion of America in their descriptions of the world. As
Hodgen describes Purchas vis-à-vis Boemus, he was “a far more sophisticated man than his
German predecessor”, who “knew of the existence in Europe, Asia, Africa and the
Americas of peoples Boemus had never heard of” – and the encyclopaedic scope of
Purchas’ massive work is truly something to behold in the context of its times, as are the
24
Sharpe discusses pre-nineteenth century ethnography in this context in Comparative Religion, 1-26.
25 This attests to the somewhat delayed impact that the discovery of the Americas had on European thought
in the initial stages. See e.g. Elliot, The Old and the New, 8-27.
26 Hodgen gives special mention to Michel de Montaigne as the first man to “deliberately [break] with
scholastic epitomizations and with the type of cultural data to be found in classical literature”, noting in
particular his famous essay of c.1580, “Of Cannibals” (Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 191).
27 Brerewood, E., Enquiries Touching the Diversity of Languages and Religions through the Chiefe Parts of the World
(London: Printed for S. S,, J. M., & H. H, 1674 [1614]); on America, see 94-96. Purchas, S., Purchase His
Pilgrimage: Or, Relations of the World and the Religions Observed in all Ages and in all Places Discovered, from the Creation
unto this Present; In Foure Parts (London: Printed by William Stansby for Henrie Fetherstone, 1614 [1613]); on
the “relations, discoveries, regions, and religions of the New World”, see 717-817. See the full title of Purchas’
work in the bibliography. Both of these figures are discussed by Hodgen (see e.g. 218f. and 171 respectively),
and were by no means the only authors of such works in the period.
110
statistical efforts of Brerewood in attempting to discern the religious demography of the
population of the entire known world.28
Yet despite the major changes in how Europeans were beginning to conceive of the
world, there were several significant continuities in how the new information was
conceptualized. While the discovery of the Americas had severely shaken the European
understanding of global geography, the narrative of universal history remained completely
grounded in the framework of sacred history and its roughly 6000 year chronology. This
meant that cultural difference was understood as the result of a historical process of
degeneration, because the explanations offered by all writers of this period were fit somehow
or other into the narrative provided by Genesis 1-11 – the historical sequence of Creation,
Eden, the Fall, the first peopling of the earth from the stock of Adam, the purification of
the Flood, and the second peopling of the earth from the stock of Noah.29 This sequence
provided the authoritative record of early human history in European thought at the period,
and allowed scholars to construct elaborate hypotheses about the historical origins of newly
discovered heathen groups in Africa and the Americas (even if “many of the efforts to
insert these newcomers to into the Adamic lineage were ludicrous in the extreme”).30 Here
is not the place for a detailed discussion of degeneration theory, although it will come up
28 Purchas’ impressive Pilgrimage amounts to almost 1000 pages of tightly packed text. For Brerewood’s
discussion of global demographics, see Enquiries, 81-131, esp. 105-111 on “the Sundry Regions of the World
Inhabited by Idolaters”.
Hodgen notes that “as shown by Purchas’ Pilgrimage, Grafton’s Chronicles, Ralegh’s History of the world, and
every other inquiry which, at that time, took mankind as its object of interest, no one embarked upon a
substantial piece of work in which the problem of cultural diversity was at issue without taking into account
both Genesis and the commentators on Genesis” (227). See further Peter Harrison, The Fall of Man and the
Foundations of Science (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2007).
29
30 Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 231. In a nutshell, degeneration theory held Cain and Ham to be the authors of
all irreligion and heathenism; therefore all idolatrous peoples were traced in some manner back to these
dubious forefathers, generally through speculative narratives of travel and cultural diffusion (see Hodgen,
Early Anthropology, 254-269; and Harrison, ‘Religion’ and the Religions, 101-112). Another theory of cultural
difference that enjoyed notable influence was that of environmentalism, according to which political and
ethnic diversities were ascribable primarily to differences in topography and climate. Jean Bodin was a notable
proponent of this view. In addition to Hodgen and Harrison, see the comprehensive treatment of
environmentalism by Clarence Glacken, Traces on the Rhodian Shore: Nature and Culture in Western Thought from
Ancient Times to the End of the Eighteenth Century (Berkeley: University of California Press, 1973).
111
again below when considering how “heathens” and “idolaters” began to shift into
“primitives” as the narrative turned from degeneration to development in the nineteenth
century. It will suffice for now simply to note that while the continually growing number of
peoples who could not be fit easily into any Noachian lineage caused considerable anxiety
for men such as Boemus and Purchas, the problems were not sufficient to call the biblical
worldview into doubt at any fundamental level.
Thus, even though European thought had suffered a rude shock with the discovery
of the Americas, the fourfold classification of the world’s religions remained firmly in tact
throughout the seventeenth century (particularly in ethnographic works), and every group
of people who were not Christian, Jewish, or Mahometan, were either idolaters, heathens,
pagans, or polytheists.31 This typology is clearly reflected in both Brerewood and Purchas:
Brerewood stating that “There are four sorts or Sects of Religion, observed in the sundry
regions of the World: namely, Idolatry, Mahumatenism, Judaisme, and Christianity” (with
Idolatry making up two-thirds of the world in his reckoning); and Purchas declaring on the
title-page of his Pilgrimage that he would investigate “the Ancient Religions before the
Floud” and “the Heathenish, Jewish, and Saracenicall in all Ages since”.32
As mentioned, this form of categorizing the world’s religions persists until well into
the nineteenth century, despite the fact that there was sometimes a wide differentiation
within the fourth category (i.e. the recognition of different forms of idolatry across the
globe), and despite the fact that in theological treatises the primary distinction was more
commonly between “natural” and “revealed” religion (or other similar binaries).33 Yet it is
The history of appellation for the tradition now called “Islam” and the people now called “Muslims” is a
complicated one. Without going into detail, see for example the etymological information in the Oxford English
Dictionary, s.v. *Islam (n. 1613); *Islamic (adj. 1747); *Mahometan (n. 1529); Mahometanism (n. 1613);
Mahometism (n. 1584); Mahomite (n. 1559); Muslimite (adj. 1829); Mahometry (n. 1481); *Muslim (n. 1615,
adj. 1777). Asterisks indicate the most important entries; the list is far from exhaustive.
31
32
Brerewood, Enquiries, 96; Purchas, Pilgrimage, title page.
33
See n. 5 above. I note again that I am not concerned here to track theological categories.
112
important to emphasize that while the fourfold typology was widely employed by
ethnographers in this period, it by no means had the character of a rigorous “scientific”
form of classification, and is better considered a kind of “incidental” or “implicit” typology
that was the naturally imposed by the inherited traditions of western theological thought.
Masuzawa frames this point helpfully, saying that due to the nature of the new global
ethnographies,
[it is not surprising that] early modern accounts seem far more interested in collecting
and enumerating empirical particularities and material details than in discovering any
organizational principle that might help systematize these particulars and details… As
such, [the items noted by early modern writers in connection with “religion”] are often
mixed up with a great many other “customs and ceremonies” which we today do not
consider necessarily or obviously religious. The titles of some of the texts betray this
peculiar conceptual disposition, which seems to us strangely haphazard and disorderly,
and certainly not very scientific.34
Yet formal scientific classification was not far off in Europe, and the epistemic shifts
underlying the modern scientific worldview had been gaining pace in learned circles since at
least the fifteenth century. I will come to that shortly. However, as the industry of
ethnography rumbled along and new peoples continually entered the horizon of thought,
the simple designation of “idolatry” started to become less and less sufficient. One major
factor at play was the rediscovery of the Greek and Roman heritage in the Renaissance.
While certain aspects of Greco-Roman thought had long been incorporated into Christian
theology, under the fourfold typology the increasingly familiar cultures of antiquity were still
varieties of idolatry, as were all of the major eastern cultures of which Europeans had
knowledge. But there was definitely a difference between these classical pagan cultures and
the idolatry of the primitive savages in Africa and America – wasn’t there? This was an
unsettling question with tremendous significance.
34
Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 61.
113
As Hodgen explains, “even though the tribes of the Red Man and Black Man were
sometimes little remarked in Europe, except as figures of curiosity or fun, there were at
least a few thoughtful scholars who saw in them a very disturbing and disconcerting
intellectual problem”.35 The problem arose in light of the fact that European thought was
structured by a strict, immutable hierarchy of being in which everything had a place in the
natural order: with God at the top, the angels beneath him, man beneath them, and
everything else beneath man (i.e. animals, plants, and inorganic matter).36 Man was
considered a unified whole, created by God but dispersed after the flood, existing in
different states of degeneracy. Thus, the question became: where do these primitive and
uncivilized peoples fit into the hierarchy? The first issue to settle was whether they
belonged to the class of man or animal. Three options presented themselves:
First, the savage could be accepted as a man like other men, and inserted into the scale
of being with European and other known men; second, he could be regarded as
something different from, and less than, European man, and inserted in the scale in a
secondary human category; or third, he could be interpreted as an animal, and given a
place, perhaps the highest, amongst the other animals.37
Although there were certainly voices claiming that the savage was an inferior man or an
outright animal, by far the majority position was the first option, that of Christian
orthodoxy: these were humans to be inserted into the scale of being.
Doctrinally, savages were men, first, last, and always – bestial and degenerate in their
behavior perhaps, but still men and thus children of God. This was the logical and
unavoidable conclusion from premises written down or logically implied in Genesis
concerning the Noachian period of sacred history.38
35 Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 359. As Hodgen notes, “Erasmus and Luther, leaders of the intellectual and
religious Reformation, were little concerned with the problems of New World ethnography. Their minds were
elsewhere.”
See the classic work by Arthur O. Lovejoy, The Great Chain of Being: A Study of the History of an Idea
(Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1936).
36
37
Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 405.
Ibid. This is, of course, the response that lay behind all attempts to account for the peoples of the New
World according to the degeneration narrative.
38
114
But Christian orthodoxy was swiftly losing its authority in determining such matters; and
owing to a number of factors, the monogenetic account of human origins found in Genesis
was soon displaced amongst learned men by a polygenetic theory that argued for the second
option: there were different kinds of humans, and Europeans were at the top of the scale.39
Hodgen continues that, as the secularized intellectual culture of the Enlightenment
emerged,
philosophical and ethnological opinion concerning the savage and his place in nature
departed from the Christian position. It no longer seemed possible to hold the mirror
up to European man and see in it the reflection of mankind as a whole. It came to be
believed that there were multiple kinds of men, each with his rightful place in the
natural order but inferior to European man.40
This idea would take shape with breathtaking force in the eighteenth and nineteenth
centuries, and served as one of the foundational assumptions on which attitudes of
European superiority were predicated. As will become clear below, this represents the
embryo of evolutionary ideas that would become crucial after 1859; but for the moment I
want to consider the first major articulation of this idea in one particular group of scholars
in the early eighteenth century: botanists – and especially the famous Swede, Carl
Linnaeus.41
39 Naturally I am not able to discuss the wide range of developments that led to the loosening of ecclesiastical
authority over the production of knowledge after the fifteenth century. But I would stress again that virtually
all such developments (the Reformation, the emergence of the state, the scientific revolution, the
Enlightenment, the formation of modern nation states) were all made possible at a fundamental level by the
new potential for communication enabled by print technology.
40
Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 408.
41 Here I skip over some of Linnaeus’ important forerunners: Sir William Petty’s Scale of Creatures (1676-77),
and Sir William Tyson’s Orang-outang, sive homo silverstris; or, the anatomie of a pygmie (1708). Although not
botanists, both precipitated Linnaeus’ move to spilt Man from a perfect whole into a gradation of varieties.
They are discussed in Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 418ff. The foundations for modern botanical taxonomy
were also laid a few generations before Linnaeus with John Ray’s Methodus Plantarum Nova (1682); see Morton,
A. G., History of Botanical Science: an account of the development of botany from ancient times to the present day (New York:
Academic Press, 1981), 194-214.
115
By 1600, over six thousand plant species had been described. By 1700, that number
had more than tripled, and although occasional efforts had been made over the centuries to
classify this data, the catalogue was in total disarray.42 Not only were some plants listed in
multiple locations, but different plants were also often given the same nomenclature.
Linnaeus’ Systema Naturae (1735) was designed to overcome these difficulties and provide a
single, comprehensive system of classification for the entire contents of the natural world.43
Using the categories of Kindgom, Class, Order, Genus, Species, and Variety, the Linnaean
taxonomy provided a ready-to-hand framework into which all specimens could be fit, both
existing ones and anything newly discovered.44 However, Linnaeus was not interested only
in plants, and the Systema Naturae also included minerals, animals, and humans within its
scope. Yet although the work had a rigorous scientific character, its structure was
nevertheless still heavily informed by the hierarchal order of being in which God, the
angels, and man were at the top, arranged “in conformity with the doctrine of immutable
design”.45 Thus Linnaeus straddled two worlds: for while he still “subscribed to the reality
42 Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 424. For a good overview of Linnaeus that points to his wide secondary
literature, see Morton, History of Botanical Science, 259-276. A richly illustrated account of botanical history
(focusing on the pre-Linnaen period) can be found in Anna Pavord, The Naming of Names: The Search for Order
in the World of Plants (London: Bloomsbury, 2005).
I have consulted the important tenth edition of the Systema Natuare, per Regna Tria Naturae (10th ed.;
Stockholm: Laurentius Salvius, 1758). The first edition was published in Leiden in 1735. It was in the tenth
edition of the work (along with the Species Plantarum [1753]), in which Linnaeus’ presented his binomenclatural
system in full (Takman, J., “Notes on Linnaeus”, Science and Society 21 [1957]: 193-209, here 198).
43
As Takman notes, (citing J. D. Bernal): “What Linnaeus gave science was precisely the fixed principles and
laws that were necessary if research was to be able to master the multiplicity of living nature. Linnaeus created
order, clarity and a fixed terminology. His system gave a logical, consistent and thoroughgoing division into
higher and lower categories with definite denotations; it was easy to understand, convincing and applicable in
practice. It was therefore new of its kind, no matter how much it was built on previously existing foundations”
(ibid.).
44
45 Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 424. It should be noted that Linnaeus’ stance on the evolution of species is a
complicated question. As Takman notes: “The first edition of the Systema Naturae (1735) contains what is
perhaps Linnaeus’ most famous sentence: ‘Species tot numeramus, quot diversae formae in principio sunt creatae’ (We
count as many species as the number of different forms created in the beginning). This is the doctrine of the
creation, and leaves no room for a development from lower to higher, from fewer to more numerous species.
Even in the Philosophia Botanica (1751) he denies that new species can come into being.” Yet Takman then goes
on to suggest that “his rigid standpoint in the Philosophia Botanica must have been a concession to the church”,
pointing to indications that Linnaeus did anticipate the principles of evolutionary theory as it would emerge in
the following century (see Takman, “Notes on Linnaeus”, 205). So while Linnaeus did for the most part
116
of fabulous, monstrous men”, and “was subservient to unexamined medieval ideas”, here
also the genus Homo was not the unified whole imagined by scholastic thought, but a genus
differentiated into two species and many varieties.46
This division was based partly on skin colour, and partly on cultural factors such as
social organization and attire.47 The classification ran as follows: the genus Homo was in the
Regnum Animale, under the Class Mammalia, then under the Order Primates, with Homo being
the first genus of that class (and in fact the first group treated in the whole Systema Naturae –
a clear intimation of the hierarchy at play in the work).48 Homo was divided into two
species: Homo sapiens, and Homo troglodytes, the latter effectively being a repository of mythical
and fabulous creatures. Of the first species, Homo sapiens, there were a number of varieties,
each with specific characteristics:
1. Wild Man (Homo Ferus): four-footed, mute, hairy.
2. American (Homo Americanus): copper-colored, choleric, erect. Paints self.
Governed by custom.
3. European (Homo Europaeus): fair, sanguine, brawny. Covered with close
vestments. Governed by laws.
4. Asiatic (Homo Asiaticus): sooty, melancholy, rigid. Covered with loose
garments. Governed by opinions.
consolidate the view of the immutability of species, a closer, contextualized reading would need to come to a
more nuanced evaluation of his position. On this tension, see also Morton, History of Botanical Science, 264ff.
46
Hodgen, Early Anthropology, 426.
47 This focus on observable differences (which we would now call cultural differences) is different from the
way in which Linnaeus treated plants, which he influentially categorized according to their reproductive
organs. See Morton, History of Botanical Science, 268ff.
I note that the current scientific taxonomy of our species is more complicated. Homo sapiens is now grouped
as follows: Kingdom: Animalia; Phylum: Chordata; Class: Mammalia; Order: Primates; Family: Hominidae; Tribe:
Hominini; Genus: Homo. Amongst the most authoritative recent treatments, see The First Humans: Origin and
Early Evolution of the Genus Homo (ed. F. Grine et al.; New York: Springer, 2009); and Patterns of Growth and
Development in the Genus Homo (ed. J. Thompson et al; Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2003). Other
works are noted in Chapter 5 below.
48
117
5. African (Homo Afer): black, phlegmatic, relaxed. Anoints self with grease.
Governed by caprice.49
This form of characterizing different human groups would echo throughout the following
centuries, and would soon serve as the basis of one of the most potent and pernicious ideas
of European modernity: the division of humanity by the category of race. Racial theory had
not yet crystalized, which would take place in the nineteenth century; but Linnaeus’ system
of classification provided formal scientific grounding for such theory as it was about to
emerge.50
But before coming to the nineteenth century, it will help to recap quickly on the
state of affairs up to this point regarding what all of these developments meant for the
classification of religions. Despite the fact that scientific and Enlightenment discourses had
established new intellectual agendas and displaced the hegemony of ecclesiastical authorities
on the production of knowledge, the fourfold typology of categorizing the world’s religions
was still widely used throughout the eighteenth century in all works of cross-cultural
ethnography.51 But the ground was shifting. The category of idolatry had become more
problematic since the increase in knowledge about primitive peoples and the realization of
their stark differences to the often-valorized pagan cultures of antiquity. This tension was
amplified by the influx of ancient texts from eastern religions that began streaming into
Europe in the late eighteenth century through the channels of colonial expansion – texts
49 I have reproduced Hodgen’s slightly abbreviated translation of this section of the Systema Natuare. Although
the translations themselves are generally correct, Hodgen somewhat skews the organization, making Homo
Monstrosus a separate species, even though it is clearly a specific variety of Homo upon examining Linnaeus’ text
– namely the sixth variety of Homo, which includes groups such as Alpini, Hottentoti, Chineses, and Canadeases. As
such, this final variety was simply a repository for groups that might have been fit into the other five varieties.
The other species is Homo Troglodytes, which included Homo Sylvestris (the Orang-outang described by Tyson, see
n. 41 above) and a certain Homo Nocturnus.
50 As Hodgen notes, “whatever the triumphs and blunders of Linnaeus as a botanist, the step taken by him in
inserting man into his catalogue, and its import for ethnological thought and future race relations, cannot be
overemphasized” (Early Anthropology, 425). I will note some connections between nineteenth-century race
theory and Linnaeus in the following section.
51
See Peter Gay, The Enlightenment (2 vols; New York: W. W. Norton & Co., 1995).
118
which made clear that, unlike the savage peoples, these ancient cultures possessed forms of
wisdom and culture that could command the respect of enlightened European moderns,
and thus needed to be grouped differently from the savages. As will be seen in what
follows, with this new profusion of textual data available, alternative organizational
principles began to take shape that moved firmly away from the fourfold scholastic
typology and opened up the categorization of religions according to quite different sets of
criteria than the framework provided by the Christian theological tradition. And one of the
most important features of these new models was the way in which they consolidated the
perception of a profound difference between primitive peoples and the civilizational cultures
of antiquity – a tendency which is still very much alive in the contemporary world religions
model and which underlies precisely the problems I am arguing pervade Hick’s work. But
this is moving a little too fast.
World Religions and Primitive Culture in the Nineteenth Century
As indicated above, the intention of this middle section is to chart two different intellectual
trajectories in the nineteenth century: those of philology and anthropology, which provided
the seedbed of two crucial categories in twentieth-century discourse on religion – “world
religions” and “primitive culture”. I begin with the first category, world religions, which is
the product of the “Science of Religion” inaugurated in the 1860s (an enterprise that would
come to be called “comparative religion”).52 But comparative religion was made possible by
a series of developments in the preceding century, so before coming to its formalization, a
little background is useful.
52
On the term “comparative religion”, see n. 2 above.
119
Comparative religion as an academic enterprise was made possible above all by a
single factor: an influx of religious texts from the east and the deciphering of the languages
in which they were written.53 As Raymond Schwab has written of this “Oriental
Renaissance”, “Only after 1771 does the world become truly round; half the intellectual
map is no longer blank”.54 Here Schwab refers to the watershed publication in 1771 of the
Zend Avesta by the adventurous Frenchman, Abraham Hyacinthe Anquetil-Duperron, which
“marks the first approach to an Asian text totally independent of the biblical and classical
traditions”, and represents “the first time anyone had succeeded in breaking into one of the
walled languages of Asia”.55 In his biography of Anquetil-Duperron, Schwab eloquently
describes the momentous changes that followed:
In 1759, in Surat, Anquetil finished translating the Avesta; in Paris in 1786, with his
translation of the Upanishads, he dug an isthmus between the hemispheres of the
human spirit and liberated the old humanism from the Mediterranean Basin … Before
him, Latin, Greek, Jewish, and Arab writers were the sole sources of knowledge about
the distant past of the planet. The Bible appeared as an isolated rock, a meteorite.
People believed that text contained the whole universe; hardly anyone seemed to
imagine the immensity of the unchartered territories. His translation marks the opening
of a discovery that then spiraled with the excavations of Central Asia, with languages
that arose after Babylon. He cast a vision of countless and ancient civilizations, an
enormous mass of literature into our schools, which to this day arrogantly keep the
door shut behind the narrow legacy of the Greek-Latin Renaissance; from now on, a
Given then limited scope of this chapter, I pass over the details of the Orientalist project, including the
watershed expansion of the British into India and the Napoleonic invasion of Egypt. See Edward Said,
Orientalism (2nd ed.; New York: Vintage Books, 2003 [1978]), esp. 31-110 on “The Scope of Orientalism”.
53
Schwab, R., The Oriental Renaissance: Europe’s Rediscovery of India and the East, 1680-1880 (trans. G. PattersonBlack & V. Reinking; New York: Columbia University Press, 1984 [1950]), 16. I leave to the side for now
Schwab’s claim that “half of the intellectual map no longer remained blank”, which replicates precisely the
form of civilizational exceptionalism being critiqued in this dissertation.
54
Ibid., 7. I describe Anquetil-Duperron as adventurous because unlike any other scholar in Europe, he
actually set of for India in order to translate the mysterious Zend Avesta, copies of which existed in Oxford
and Paris (ibid., 19). The resulting work was Zend Avesta, Ouvrage de Zoroastre (3 vols; Paris: Chez N. M. Tillard,
1771). This translation was, however, made from a modern Persian text, not the original Parsi version.
Europeans did not yet possesses the linguistic competencies for such work, although this soon began to
change following the famous declaration of Sir William Jones to the Asiatic Society of Calcutta (on February
2, 1786) about the clear relationship between Sanskrit and the European languages. For a useful discussion of
Jones’ work and its relation to the subsequent industry of Indo-European studies, see Bruce Lincoln,
Theorizing Myth (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1999), esp. 76-100. Jones is discussed by Schwab passim.
55
120
few European provinces are no longer the only ones that engrave their names in
history.56
The floodgates had been opened. While a dim awareness had been growing since the
discovery of the Americas that the world was bigger and more full than most Europeans
had imagined it, the events that followed from Anquetil-Duperron’s translation of the
Avesta and the Upanishads fuelled the final dissolution of the medieval worldview and set
the stage for the intellectual transformations of the nineteenth century. AnquetilDuperron’s translations, in combination with the newly attained understanding of Sanskrit
and other ancient languages by European scholars, gave rise to a veritable industry, and “the
written legacies of foreign cultures, which had long been a sealed book, were deciphered
one after another by Europeans and began to yield their contents”.57
Amongst the more important works to be published in this energized atmosphere
were the following: the Bhagavad Gita (Wilkins, 1784; the first major Sanskrit text to be
translated and published in Europe); Translation of the Persian Sassanid Texts (de Sacy, 1793; de
Sacy would soon found scientific linguistics); the Institutes of Hindu Law (Jones, 1794; this
work popularized Indian cosmogony); Report on the Deciphering of Egyptian Hieroglyphs
(Champillion, 1822; one of the most famous works of this period); Comparative Grammar of
Sanskrit, Zend, Greek, Latin, Lithuanian, Old Slavonic, Gothic, and German (Bopp, 1833; a crucial
text that consolidated the Indo-European paradigm); and Translation of Old Persian and Old
This quotation comes from Schwab’s 1934 biography of Anquetil-Duperron, and is cited in Hans
Kippenberg’s informative study, Discovering Religious History in the Modern Age (trans. B. Harshav; New Jersey:
Princeton University Press, 2002), 23-4.
56
57 Ibid., 25. Further treatment of this issue is not possible here, but again, see Schwab, Oriental Renaissance for
extensive documentation.
121
Babylonian Cuneiform Texts from Behistun (Rawlinson, 1847, 1850, 1851; which began to flesh
out the religious heritage of the first urban cultures).58
Even this highly selective sample illustrates the extent to which European
consciousness had moved, in only a matter of decades, from the parochial Mediterranean
outlook of the middle ages to the far more geographically expansive awareness that marks
European history from this point onwards.59 Schwab summarizes this remarkable period by
saying that “A whole world that had been entirely lost became, within a few years, entirely
known. For the first time the image of India regally entered the configuration of the
universe”.60
When Friedrich Max Müller announced the Science of Religion to the world in
1867, he was emphatic about how central the events just described were in making the new
discipline possible:
During the last fifty years the authentic documents of the most important religions of
the world have been recovered in a most unexpected and almost miraculous manner.
We have now before us the canonical books of Buddhism; the Zend-Avesta of
Zoroaster is no longer a sealed book; and the hymns of the Rig-veda have revealed a
state of religion anterior to the first beginnings of that mythology which in Homer and
Hesiod stands before us as a mouldering ruin. The soil of Mesopotamia has given back
the very images once worshipped by the most powerful of the Semitic tribes, and the
cuneiform inscriptions of Babylon and Nineveh have disclosed the very prayers
addressed to Baal or Nisroch. With the discovery of these documents a new era begins
in the study of religion.61
This is a highly selective list. It is reproduced from the list provided in Kippenberg, Discovering Religious
History, 25. See also Schwab, Oriental Renaissance, 51ff. under “The Arrival of the First Authentic Texts”. As
Schwab notes, Sanskrit claimed “the lion’s share of efforts at decipherment” (7).
58
The Mediterranean focus had, in fact, begun to shift northwards even in the fifteenth century with the
rediscovery of Tacitus’ Germania, which had brought into focus the northern parts of Europe and gave
“Germans, Scandinavians, Dutch, and Anglo-Saxons their first taste of the prestige derived from a deep and
noble past” (Lincoln, Theorizing Myth, 48). However the Oriental Renaissance certainly recalibrated European
consciousness to a profound degree.
59
60
Schwab, Oriental Renaissance, 7.
Max Müller, F., Chips From a German Workshop (3 vols; New York: Scribner, Armstrong, & Co., 1876 [1867]),
1: 373. Müller also discusses this in the Preface to the work, see xiff. Müller’s other seminal contribution to the
fledgling field was his Introduction to the Science of Religion (London: Longmans, Green, & Co., 1882 [1873]). The
latter text comprises four lectures given at the Royal Institute in 1870. On Müller’s inauguration of the
enterprise, see Sharpe, Comparative Religion, xi; on the content of his contribution, see 27-47.
61
122
But before coming to exactly what the Science of Religion meant for the classification of
religions, I want to quickly highlight some of the broader consequences of this textual
saturation, issues that are important both below and in the following chapters. A central
point to make is that because the decipherment and organization of the continually
emerging religious texts required highly specialized knowledge, philology and linguistics (or
rather, philologists and linguists) swiftly attained a near-total interpretive monopoly on the
production of knowledge generated from the material.62 Aside from giving these textually
oriented disciplines formal institutional consolidation (not to mention powerful political
influence),63 two specific things happened that are of especial interest in the story being
tracked at present.
Firstly, a number of independent traditions emerge out of the earlier shadow-zone
of “idolatry”, and by the mid-nineteenth century scholars could talk freely about entities
such as “Buddhism”, “Brahmanism”, “Zoroastrianism”, “Confucianism”, “Taoism” –
traditions that had hitherto never been distinguished so explicitly in European thought.64 It
is crucial to note here that every religious tradition that attained status as an independent entity in this
period is a religion with written texts that had been recovered, translated, and analyzed by European
scholars.65 Indeed, in his Introduction to the Science of Religion, Müller speaks warmly of the
I pass over the important relationship between philology and early comparative linguistics. See e.g. Maurice
Olender, The Languages of Paradise: Race, Religion, and Philology in the Nineteenth Century (trans. A. Goldhamer;
Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2008 [1992]).
62
As Olender notes, “One of the many functions of Indo-European research was to provide answers to a
series of questions that first became urgent in the nineteenth century, questions pertaining to the origins and
vocation of a Western world in search of national, political, and religious identity” (ibid., 139).
63
64 See e.g. Philip Almond’s instructive study, The British Discovery of Buddhism (Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press 1988). See also the collection of documents edited by P. J. Marshall in The British Discovery of Hinduism in
the Eighteenth Century (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press 1970). See further Harrison, ‘Religion’ and the
Religions, 174; and Cantwell Smith, The Meaning and End of Religion, 125-128.
65 On the importance of textuality in the discursive construction of these traditions, see e.g. Almond, The
British Discovery of Buddhism, 24-28; and Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 210-216. I approach the
prioritization of textual cultures in European historiography from a different perspective in Chapter 5.
123
“aristocracy
of
the
book
religions”
(Buddhism,
Brahmanism,
Zoroastrianism,
Mohommedanism, Christianity, Mosaism, the “religion of Confucius”, and the “religion of
Lao-Tse”) – even going so far as to say that “With these eight religions the library of the
Sacred Books of the whole human race is complete”, a task that had been accomplished by
the European mastery of Sanskrit, Pâli, Zend, Hebrew, Greek, Arabic, and Chinese.66
The second major outgrowth of the philological enterprise was the “discovery” of
an Indo-European heritage, and the corresponding discovery of the two primary linguistic
families: Aryan and Semitic.67 While it is not my intention to get sidetracked here by
exploring the importance of Indo-European studies in nineteenth-century history at large, a
few major points are worth noting: (1) the Indo-European idea consolidated the division of
humanity by “race” that had emerged with Linnaeus and the enterprise of scientific
classification;68 (2) this in turn was fed by the powerful currents of Volk-theory that had
been developed in the context of Romanticism (especially in Germany by figures such as
Herder, Schlegel, Schelling and Hegel) and the closely linked development of European
nationalism; (3) the idea of the Völker was underpinned by the idea that each Volk, i.e. each
“race” of people, had a specific, defining characteristic; and (4), due primarily to the
influence of Romanticism, language and religion were seen as reflecting the essential spirit
of a particular Volk. As such, when philologists had distinguished the Aryan and Semitic
Müller, Introduction to the Science of Religion, 54-6, quotation 56. I again note that Müller’s claim that such works
represents “the whole human race” is replicated even by Schwab (see above, n. 54).
66
For a detailed discussion of the Aryan/Semitic binary, see Olender, The Languages of Paradise. See also the
useful discussion of these issues Tomoko Masuzawa in The Invention of World Religions, 147-178.
67
For a discussion of Linnaeus in the context of European racial theory, see David Goldberg, Racist Culture:
Philosophy and the Politics of Meaning (Cambridge, MA: Blackwell, 1993), 206; and Said, Orientalism, 119f. The first
systematic treatise on race was offered by Artur, Comte de Gobineau, Essai sur l’inégalité des races humaines
(1853-55). On this work, see Goldberg, Racist Culture, 68f., and Lincoln, Theorizing Myth, 61. See also David
Spurr, The Rhetoric of Empire: Colonial Discourse in Journalism, Travel Writing, and Imperial Administration (Durham:
Duke University Press, 1993), 61-75.
68
124
language families, they had also distinguished Aryans and Semites as fundamentally different
peoples.69
These ideas all had a powerful influence on Müller. Trained as a historical linguist by
the greatest Indo-European scholars of his day (Franz Bopp and Eugène Burnouf), he was
deeply imbued with the categories supplied by what was then called “the Science of
Language” (i.e. historical comparative linguistics).70 Thus, although Müller strongly
repudiated the racist connotations that generally pertained to the Aryan/Semitic distinction,
these categories were still fundamental to his thought; and when he came to establish the
Science of Religion, he did so explicitly using the model of the Science of Language. This
played out as follows.
After eloquently describing the panorama of the world’s religions now available to
the scholar, Müller exhorted the need for a proper method of classifying these religions,
saying that: “All real science rests on classification, and only in case we cannot succeed in
classifying the various dialects of faith, shall we have to confess that a science of religion is
really an impossibility”.71 Although Müller diverged from other scholars in the approach he
took, with this fundamental point he articulated a new principle in academic scholarship
that established the study of religion as a formal, comparative enterprise. Moreover, what
one sees here is also a permanent shift away from the old fourfold typology that had
previously dominated European thought. From this point onwards, that mode of classifying
On Volk theory, see Olender, The Languages of Paradise, passim; Shawn Kelly, Racializing Jesus: Race, Ideology,
and the Formation of Modern Biblical Scholarship (London: Routledge, 2002), 33-39; and Lincoln, Theorizing Myth,
52-54.
69
70
See Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 208-209. See also Olender, The Languages of Paradise, 7.
71
Müller, Introduction to the Science of Religion, 68.
125
the religions of the world played no further part in serious academic scholarship, with
idolatry remaining a category only in theological and missiological work.72
Müller begins by expressing his dissatisfaction with the prevailing forms of
classification – which he lists as: (a) true v. false religion; (b) natural v. revealed religion; (c)
individual v. national religions; and (d) polytheistic, dualistic, and monotheistic religions –
all of which he regards as “unscientific” models for grouping the data.73 Then, fitting
squarely within the system of thought regarding language, race, and cultural identity
sketched out above, he argues instead that
the only scientific and truly genetic classification of religions is the same as the classification of
languages, [and that] there exists the most intimate relationship between language,
religion, and nationality … if this dependence of early religion on language is once
clearly understood, it follows, as a matter of course, that whatever classification has
been found most useful in the Science of Language ought to prove equally useful in
the Science of Religion. If there is a truly genetic relationship of languages, the same
relationship ought to hold together the religions of the world, at least the most ancient
religions.74
Müller then explains that the Science of Language has identified three chief linguistic
families: Aryan, Semitic, and Turanian;75 and – because of the link between language and
religion – he claims that we thus “really have clear evidence of three independent
For a list of early nineteenth-century works of comparative religion that still employ the category of idolatry,
see Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 59.
72
73
Müller discusses these forms of classification in Introduction to the Science of Religion, 68-82.
74 Ibid., 82, 90 (italics added). See Müller’s discussion of Schlegel and Hegel at 84, 87. Going beyond the
Romantics, Müller would say that “It is language and religion that make a people, but religion is even a more
powerful agent than language” (85).
Ibid., 91. As Müller explained elsewhere, Turaninan comprises “all languages spoken in Asia or Europe not
included under the Aryan and Semitic families, with perhaps the exception of Chinese and its dialects” (cited
in Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 230f.). Yet as Masuzawa notes, the term Turanian “never managed
to settle into a definitive meaning but remained malleable, now seeming to do one thing, now seeming to
another” (228; on the category, see 228-242). Given the empirical range the taxon was supposed to cover, this
instability is hardly surprising.
75
126
settlements of religion, the Turanian, the Semitic, and the Aryan, concomitantly with the three
great settlements of language”.76
Such was Müller’s attempt at classifying the world’s religions. Yet, perhaps for
understandable reasons, this heavily linguistic approach did not find many supporters, and
was ultimately a false start in the pursuit of a viable scientific taxonomy. While the broader
enterprise of comparative religion had been firmly established under Müller’s influence,
other scholars found his tripartite division of religions too constrained, and soon offered
different taxonomic models that were more explicitly oriented around a theme that had
been gathering great momentum in this period: the idea of development, construed as a
chronological and teleological story of progress.77 Although this idea had been brewing for
quite some time before the 1860s, it became extremely influential after that point (especially
in light of Darwin’s epoch-making publications), and forms of evolutionary thinking began
to dominate the new Science of Religion.78
While there were a number of scholars who applied developmental thinking to the
fresh corpus of religious material made available by philological scholarship, the most
important (even more so than Müller in this respect) was the Dutch Egyptologist, Cornelis
Petrus Tiele, whose entry on “Religions” in the ninth edition of the Encyclopaedia Britannica
76
Müller, Introduction to the Science of Religion, 91.
77 Again, without wishing to get sidetracked on the wider details of the evolutionary paradigm, I point to Mike
Hawkins’ Social Darwinism and European and American Thought. See also the following note.
78 The role of evolutionary perspectives in the nineteenth-century study of religion has been discussed by
many scholars. An important general point to make is that “developmental” models of cultural change long
predated Darwin, namely forms of cultural or social evolutionism. As George Stocking notes in his invaluable
study of nineteenth-century anthropology, while these earlier paradigms were important for biological
evolutionism, they were not exactly homologous with it (Stocking, G. W., Victorian Anthropology [New York:
Free Press, 1987], xv. He calls the former “classical evolutionism” and the latter “biological evolutionism”).
Indeed, as Adam Kuper notes, “early anthropologists were seldom Darwinians in the strict sense”, instead
adopting a more Lamarckian view (Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society, 3). The first chapter of Stocking’s
work (8-45) provides a detailed survey of the notion of “progress” in European thought up to 1850, all of
which was crucial for later comparative religion. For a useful history pre-nineteenth-century scholarship on
religion which foregrounds the increasing importance of the ideology of progress, see Frank E. Manuel, The
Eighteenth Century Confronts the Gods (Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1959). Eric Sharpe also
provides a useful discussion of evolutionary theory and comparative religion, see Comparative Religion, 47-71.
127
in 1884 articulated a paradigmatic statement of position regarding how European
scholarship now categorized and classified the various religions of the world.79
After introducing the reader to the mission and necessity of the science of religion
(much as Müller had done), Tiele lists the major groups of religion that can be discerned
from the data-set of the history of religions, which come under both linguistic and
geographical headings: Aryan, Semitic, African, Mongolian, Ural-Altaic, Chinese, Japanese,
Finnic, American, and Malayo-Polynesian. But he then addressed the question of how these
different families of religion are to be classified, and he directly disagrees with the suggestion
by Müller to use linguistic models, instead suggesting his own form of classification.80
Tiele dwells on a set of categories that Müller had mentioned but swept to the side,
namely the distinction between an “individual” religion (i.e. which has an individual
founder) and a “national” religion. Tiele says, explicitly contra Müller, that in fact “there is no
more marked distinction among religions than the one [between] race religion and religions
proceeding from an individual founder”.81 He then states the fundamental taxonomic
distinction between the two: the principle of race religions is that of “nature”, whereas the
principle of religions founded by an individual is “ethics”. Indeed, Tiele even goes so far as
to say that “there is nowhere in the whole history of the development of religion so distinct
a cleavage, so sharp a demarcation, as between what we have called the nature and the
ethical religions”.82
Tiele, C. P., “Religions” in The Encyclopaedia Britannica (9th ed.; Edinburgh: Adam and Charles Black, 1886),
358-371. Tiele’s other major works were Outlines of the History of Religion to the Spread of the Universal Religions
(London: Trübner, 1877 [1876]); and the published version of his 1896-8 Gifford Lectures, Elements of a Science
of Religion (2 vols; Edinburgh: Blackwood, 1897-1900). For a good overview of Tiele’s influential career, see
Arie Molendijk, “Tiele on Religion”, Numen 46 (1999): 237-268. At this stage, the detailed treatment of the
phenomenology of religion provided in Tim Murphy’s The Politics of Spirit: Phenomenology, Genealogy, Religion
(Albany: SUNY Press, 2010) becomes extremely useful. After establishing the early Hegelian basis of the
enterprise, Murphy discusses Tiele (101-131), then a number of other figures through to Eliade.
79
80
Tiele, “Religions”, 359.
81
Ibid., 366.
82
Tiele, Elements of a Science of Religion, 63.
128
This distinction is based upon Tiele’s specific conception of “religious
development”, by which he meant a series of different “stages” in the universal history of
religion, wherein ethical religions are developmentally superior to all natural/national
religions.83 The four stages ran as follows: 1) a primitive stage of “animism” during “the
childhood of the human race”; 2) polytheistic national religions; 3) “nomistic” religions,
founded upon a law or sacred writing, which “[subdue] polytheism more or less completely
by pantheism or monotheism”; 4) and “universal or world-religions, which start from
principles and maxims”.84
Tiele explains that stage one (primitive peoples) and stage two (the civilizational
cultures of antiquity) constitute the natural and national religions, while the latter two stages
constitute the ethical religions: Taoism, Confucianism, Brahmanism, Jainism, Mazdaism,
Moasism, Judaism, Islam, and Christianity – a list which represents more or less the same as
Müller’s “aristocracy” of the book religions, and which is also the same as most
contemporary lists of “world religions”. I emphasize again that this is a qualitative
hierarchy, underpinned by a teleological metanarrative in which the ethical (world) religions
are “higher” than the nature religions – i.e. they are more “fully developed” manifestations
of the phenomenon “religion”. It will be important to keep this in mind when looking at
how the twentieth century deals with this inheritance.
Yet it was not simply a matter of ethical religions being uniformly more developed
than natural religions, for amongst this group too there was a hierarchal division: the third
stage of “particularistic” or “nomistic” religions – Confucianism, Brahmanism, Jainism,
The notion of development is another non-biological form of evolutionary thought that was given new
currency after 1859 (cf. n. 78 above). Molendijk provides another useful overview in “Religious Development:
C. P. Tiele’s Paradigm of Science of Religion”, Numen 51 (2004): 321-351. However, Molendijk’s essay fails to
note the way in which Tiele’s reading of religious history was influentially structured by Hegelian philosophy, a
point crucial to grasp for the argument of this dissertation. For the Hegelian notion of Entwicklung, see
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 71ff.; for Tiele’s appropriation of the concept, see 102-108. These issues are
discussed more thoroughly in the following chapter.
83
84
Tiele, “Religion”, 367ff. “Animism” is discussed below.
129
Mazdaism, Judaism – ranked lower than the ultimate stage of “universalistic” or “world”
religions – Buddhism, Islam, and Christianity.85 And even within the latter elite group there
was a clear hierarchy: Islam was a “wild offshoot of Judaism and Christianity”, and
Buddhism, for all its nobility, had “never been victorious except where it had to contend
with religions standing on no very high degree of development”.86 Yet the appearance of
Christianity – fusing the Aryan with the Semitic and thus transcending all particularism –
inaugurated an entirely new epoch in the development of religion that all the streams
of the religious life of man, once separate, unite in it; and that religious development
will henceforth consist in an ever higher realisation of the principles of that religion.87
Tiele may not have been quite accurate in his prediction, but the main assumptions on
which the developmental narrative was predicated (such as the idea that the major textual
religions were “superior” to all minor and primitive religions, and that Christianity was the
“highest” of the major religions) were held by virtually all scholars of comparative religion,
including Müller.88
85 As mentioned in Chapter 1, this sense of “world religions” is different from the sense that developed in the
mid-twentieth century. This shift is discussed in more detail shortly. It is interesting to note that Tiele actually
advocates abandoning the term, as “Strictly speaking, there can be no more than one universal or world
religion” (“Religions”, 369). He instead advocates the more nuanced term “universalistic” (“not universal”), to
indicate the scope of the missionary ambition of Christianity, Islam, and Buddhism. Had later scholars
followed this suggestion, the classification of religions in the twentieth century may have taken a less
conceptually imprecise course.
As Philip Almond notes, although Buddhism was obviously found wanting in comparison to Christianity, it
“generally fared the best of all the non-Christian religions”, and it was “the active side of Buddhism, its ethics
especially, that the Victorians were particularly interested in, were most easy to assimilate, and in general to
endorse” (The British Discovery of Buddhism, 135, 131). Almond also notes that the Victorian image of Buddhism
was shaped to an important degree by anti-Catholic polemics of the period, which influenced both the
denigration of certain aspects of Buddhist practice as well as the more positive appraisals of Buddhism as
being the Protestantism of the east (73). This idealized form of Buddhism was also used by the British as a foil
for the continued denigration of Hindu religious practice (72). On Islam (and its denigration in nineteenthcentury scholarship), see Masuzawa’s chapter, “Islam, a Semitic Religion” in The Invention of World Religions,
179-206.
86
87 Tiele, Elements of a Science of Religion, 211-212. A similar comment is made in the Encyclopaedia Britannica entry,
in which he claims that “If religion really is the synthesis of dependence and liberty, we might say that Islam
represents the former, Buddhism the latter element only, while Christianity does full justice to both of them”
(369).
88 For Müller’s view of Christianity as “superior to all other religions”, see Olender, The Languages of Paradise,
90f.
130
One of the most prominent manifestations of this new paradigm was the landmark
World’s Parliament of Religions of 1893, which reflects three main tendencies of the
emergent world religions discourse that had been forming around the work of Müller, Tiele,
and others.89 The Parliament was in many senses a quite remarkable gathering, where
representatives from “what were considered to be the world’s ten great religions”
(Hinduism, Buddhism, Jainism, Zoroastrianism, Taoism, Confucianism, Shintoism,
Judaism, Christianity, and Islam) came together in an unprecedented congress in which each
made a comprehensive statement of their faith and the service it had rendered to mankind.90
In this list we see the first tendency of the nascent world religions discourse reflected by the
Parliament: its focus on the “great” religions, corresponding to the “aristocracy” promoted
by Müller and the “ethical” religions promoted by Tiele. While they were not yet called
“world religions” with any regularity at this stage (Tiele’s language as yet only applying to
three of them), these were the candidates for the label once it became more common.
Moreover, one also sees here an incipient mood of ecumenical pluralism in which all major
religions were positively affirmed, and an impassioned call was made by the chairman of the
Parliament for “uniting all religions against all irreligion”.91 This too would be a major
hallmark of the twentieth century study of religion.
Yet despite this apparent ecumenism, the Parliament also represented a second
tendency that had been clearly present in Müller, Tiele, and many other scholars of religion
89 On the Parliament, see Robert Seager, The World’s Parliament of Religions: The East/West Encounter
(Bloomington: Indian University Press, 1995). For the fullest documentation of speeches from the event, see
The Dawn of Religious Pluralism: Voices from the World’s Parliament of Religions, 1893 (ed. R. Seager; La Salle, IL:
Open Court, 1993). Neither Müller nor Tiele were present at gathering, although both sent addresses to be
read out at the Parliament (along with four other important scholars of the day). On the Parliament’s
important role in the comparative study of religion and the emerging world religions paradigm, see Masuzawa,
The Invention of World Religions, 265-274.
90 See Seager’s editorial introduction to The Dawn of Religious Pluralism, 1-12. An influential contemporary
textbook on comparative religion that echoed the Parliament’s organization was James Freeman Clarke’s Ten
Great Religions: A Comparison of all Religions (Boston & New York: Houghton, Mifflin, & Co.: 1883). On this
work, see Masuzawa, The Invention of World Religions, 77-79.
91
Seager, The Dawn of Religious Pluralism, xvii. The chairman of the Parliament was John Henry Barrows.
131
of the late-nineteenth century, namely the privileging of Christianity (almost invariably
meaning Protestant Christianity) as the most highly developed form of religion. This
superficially pluralist framework manifested itself quite clearly in the Parliament: for on the
one hand, the organizers hoped to inaugurate “a new epoch of brotherhood and peace”
amongst the religions of the world; on the other hand, the whole conference was
underpinned by an explicit Christian universalism, with the closing speech of the event even
bearing the title: “Christ the Unifier of Mankind”.92
The final tendency of the emerging discourse reflected in the Parliament was the
total exclusion of any tradition that was not one of the “ten great religions” from the field
of vision. This tendency was particularly conspicuous in the exclusion of all “savage”
religion from the proceedings of the Parliament – an especially symbolic fact being that not
even local Native American peoples were invited (although one “highly general” paper on
them was apparently presented by an academic anthropologist, even though it appears not
to have been preserved).93 Instead, “primitive” cultures were on display not in the
Parliament of Religions, but as a spectacle of amusement in another part of the Columbian
World’s Fair.94 This provides an unfortunately good reflection of the fate of these traditions
in the twentieth century discourse on religion; but in order to explain how the pluralistic
world religions paradigm effectively perpetuates this kind of racially based cultural
hierarchy, it is necessary to retrace the story for a moment and provide a little more detail
about the ideas that had been forming around the notion of “primitive culture” up to this
point.
92
Ibid., 453-475.
Ibid., 6f. Seager also notes other exclusions from the Parliament: Mormons were not invited, and the only
people of African descent were from Christian denominations. And whilst some liberal Protestant delegations
included female participants, the representatives of each tradition’s contingent were almost exclusively male.
93
94 For a good critique of the Parliament from this angle, see William Hutchison, Religious Pluralism in America,
(New Haven: Yale University Press, 2003), 171-179.
132
As discussed earlier, an important landmark had been reached in European thought when it
was admitted that the uncivilized peoples of Africa and America were in fact humans (even
if degraded and inferior specimens of the species). While their religion was generally
described as idolatry in the majority of ethnographic and missiological literature, another
category had also become popular in the eighteenth century to describe the lowest state of
religion, namely the label of “fetishism”. Coined by Charles de Brosses in 1760, the term
designated etymologically that this form of religion was centered around the worship of
“made” objects (as opposed to having reverence for the more “sublime” objects of
contemplation in the higher religions; cf. Tiele’s natural/ethical distinction).95
This term proved to be of lasting influence, such that most eighteenth and
nineteenth century thinkers understood fetishism as the chief form of idolatry.96 Yet from
the 1860s, a new image of primitive religion began to take shape, one that would be
bequeathed to the twentieth century. Two broad factors were at play in this change. The
first was the continued colonial expansion of European powers, and thus the increased
contact with peoples believed to be living in a still “primitive” state in Africa, Australia, and
elsewhere. In a sense, this threw up a renewed version of the same question that had
plagued thinkers such as Montaigne and Boemus in the sixteenth century – i.e., what does it
mean for our understanding of man if we admit that these crude, uncivilized savages are
also of the same species as Europeans? This question required serious mental gymnastics,
and in the latter stages of the nineteenth century the tradition of ethnography transmuted
De Brosses, C., Du Culte des Dieux Fétiches, ou parallèle de l'ancienne Religion de l'Egypte avec la religion actuelle de
Nigritie (Paris, 1760). See Randall Styers, Making Magic: Religion, Magic, & Science in the Modern World (New York:
Oxford University Press, 2004), 63; see also Sharpe 18f. Kippenberg provides a brief note on the etymology of
the term (Discovering Religious History, 51).
95
96 One of the most influential figures to adopt the notion that fetishism was the earliest form of religion
(following which came polytheism, then monotheism) was Auguste Comte in his six-volume Cours de
Philosophie Positive (1830-42). See Styers, Making Magic, 67, 74f.
133
into the discipline of anthropology, whose raison d’être was to address precisely this sort of
issue.
As discussed above, prior to the mid-nineteenth century, the dominant theory of
cultural difference was framed in terms of degeneration, i.e. the notion that “savages are, as a
general rule, only the miserable remnants of nations once civilized” (a view effectively
determined by the historical framework of the Genesis narrative).97 Yet it was at this time
that the new paradigm of development became dominant: i.e. the view that all cultures had
started from a state of primitive savagery, a state that was still present in certain groups of
humans. This idea, related to the larger concept of “progress”, was extremely influential in
the latter half of the nineteenth century, and was the second major factor changing
European conceptions of non-urban cultures.98 What effectively happened when the notion
of cultural evolutionism replaced degeneration theory was an epistemic flip in which certain
non-civilizational cultures (both past and present) moved from being considered the “most
degenerate” to the “least developed”.
I have already demonstrated the importance that the idea of development had
amongst philological scholars such as Tiele, where primitive religion was placed at the
bottom of the evolutionary ladder. Yet it was in the new discipline of anthropology –
influenced by advances in areas such as biology and geology – that work on primitive
culture was undertaken at its most serious level.99 Interestingly enough, the first stage of this
new interest was directed not towards the religion of primitive cultures, but towards their
97 The quotation comes from one of the most important figures of early anthropology, Sir John Lubbock, in
his seminal work, Prehistoric Times, as Illustrated by Ancient Remains and the Manners and Customs of Modern Savages
(Edinburgh: Williams & Norgate, 1865), here 337. This work is briefly discussed again in Chapter 5. In
addition to the material cited earlier with regard to degeneration theory, see also Margaret T. Hodgen, “The
Doctrine of Survivals”, American Anthropologist 33 (1931): 307-324, here 308f.
98
Although I omit wider discussion of the concept of progress here for reasons of scope, see n. 78 above.
99 On the rise of anthropology in the context of Darwinian thought, see Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society,
76ff, and Stocking, Victorian Anthropology, 144-185. These issues are discussed momentarily, and again in
Chapter 5.
134
political organization – represented most prominently in works such as Henry Maine’s
Ancient Law (1861) and Lewis Henry Morgan’s two works, System of Consanguinity (1871) and
Ancient Society (1877).100 The latter work, Ancient Society, is a particularly instructive example
to consider in the present context for the way in which Morgan articulates a principle that
was now operative across most fields of thought in this period:
It can now be asserted upon convincing evidence that savagery preceded barbarism in
all the tribes of mankind as barbarism is known to have preceded civilization. The
human race is one in source, one in experience, and in progress.101
Notice two things here: 1) that savagery, barbarism, and civilization are precise technical terms
that describe different stages of historical development within a given society; and 2) the
same universal laws of development apply to every single human society. As Adam Kuper
has noted, this served as the central presupposition of all thinkers in the period who
addressed the question of humanity’s long evolutionary history.102
One such figure was the influential Edward Burnett Tylor, the most important
scholar in carving out the initial discursive and institutional space of academic
anthropology.103 Tylor had come to prominence in 1865 with a work entitled Researches into
the Early History of Mankind and the Development of Civilization, although his most influential
100 Maine, H., Ancient Law: Its Connection with the Early History of Society and its Relation to Modern Ideas (London:
John Murray, 1861); Morgan, L. H., System of Consanguinity and Affinity of the Human Family (Washington DC:
Smithsonian, 1971); and Ancient Society: Researches in the Lines of Human Progress from Savagery through Barbarism to
Civilization (New York: Holt, 1877). See also n. 97 above on Lubbock, whose work first popularized the term
“prehistory”. On the initial framing of these researches as a branch of legal studies, see Kuper, The Invention of
Primitive Society, 3. Other important figures of the period passed over at present include Johann Jacob
Bachofen, Numa Denis Fustel de Coulanges, and John F. McLennan.
101
Morgan, Ancient Society, 6. See Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society, 65ff.
102
Ibid., 2.
Kuper sums up Tylor’s role here: “In 1871, the year of Primitive Culture, not yet forty years old, he was
elected a Fellow of the Royal Society. In 1875 Oxford awarded him an honorary degree. In 1881 he published
the first general textbook in English on the subject, his Anthropology, which for held the field for a generation.
In 1884 Oxford created a Readership in Anthropology for him, and in 1896 he was made a Professor by
personal title. By now the likes of Max Müller were talking of anthropology as ‘Mr Tylor’s science’” (Kuper,
The Invention of Primitive Society, 81). Further details are provided in Kippenberg, Discovering Religious History, 54f.
On the early stages of institutionalizing anthropology, see Stocking, Victorian Anthropology, 238-273.
103
135
contribution to the study of early humanity was his landmark Primitive Culture (1871), which
sought to account for the intellectual and cultural development of human society along
explicit evolutionary lines.104 Unlike other scholars whose focus was mainly social
institutions such as marriage and kinship structures of early human groups, Tylor gave
significant attention to religion, devoting the entire second volume of Primitive Culture to the
question.
Tylor called the earliest stage of religion “animism”, which he defined as “the theory
which endows the phenomena of nature with personal life”.105 This was an explicit attempt
to recast the concept of primitive religion, as he made clear:
The President de Brosses, a most original thinker of the last century, struck by the
descriptions of the African worship of material and terrestrial objects, introduced the
word Fétichisme as a general descriptive term, and since then it has obtained great
currency by Comte’s use of it to denote a general theory of primitive religion, in which
external objects are regarded as animated by a life analogous to man’s. It seems to me,
however, more convenient to use the word Animism for the doctrine of spirits in
general, and to confine the word Fetishism to that subordinate department which it
properly belongs to, namely, the doctrine of spirits embodied in, or attached to, or
conveying influence through, certain material objects.106
With this manoeuvre Tylor reframed the terms of debate regarding primitive religion, and
his theory that animism was the earliest stage of religious development became widely
104 Tylor, E. B., Researches into the Early History of Mankind and the Development of Civilization (London: John
Murray, 1865); and Primitive Culture: Researches into the Development of Mythology, Philosophy, Religion Language, Art
and Custom (2 vols; London: John Murray, 1871). The literature on Tylor is substantial. Amongst works already
cited, useful information can be found in: Stocking, Victorian Anthropology; Kuper, The Invention of Primitive
Society; Styers, Making Magic; Sharpe, Comparative Religion; Kippenberg, Discovering Religious History; Hodgen, “The
Doctrine of Survivals”; and Evans-Pritchard, Theories of Primitive Religion. On Tylor in relation other theories of
religion, see also the works of Pals, Thrower and Kunin cited in Chapter 2 (n. 5).
Tylor, “The Religion of Savages”, Fortnightly Review 6 (1866): 71-86, here 84. Space does not permit for a
proper examination of Tylor’s theory, but see the following note.
105
106 Tylor, Primitive Culture, 2: 144. Although Tylor expounded the theory of animism across numerous
publications (including “The Religion of Savages” and several other pieces noted in the bibliography), Primitive
Culture stands as his definitive statement on the issue. For a good discussion of the way that it “effectively
eclipsed” earlier theories of fetishism, see Styers, Making Magic, 74-9. However, this should not be taken to
mean that the details of Tylor’s position were completely original; and indeed, Kuper suggest that “His theory
of religious development owed a great deal to Comte, and his ‘animism’ is hardly to be distinguished from
Comte’s ‘fetichism’. Even his ideas about sacrifice owed much to the German biblical scholar Wellhausen”
(Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society, 81).
136
influential. Not only did it stand as the first stage in Tiele’s paradigmatic articulation of the
developmental view of religious history, and not only was Müller soon calling anthropology
“Mr Tylor’s science”, but Tylor’s view of early human religion became archetypal in western
thought for almost a century after his first publications (even though it underwent periodic
modification).107
Yet unlike Tiele, Müller, and the host of other philological scholars with a
theological agenda, Tylor was not a Christian triumphalist. His apologetic agenda was
different, and was situated within the wider context of emergent scientific modernity and its
challenge to the traditional Christian worldview. The biblical timeline of world history had
by now become untenable: geologists were beginning to understand the much older age of
the world, and archaeologists – armed with the new concept of “prehistory” – continued to
unearth findings that proved beyond doubt that humans had existed for much longer than
6000 years.108 Meanwhile, the Darwinian theory of evolution provided another blow by
challenging the view that the order of Creation was fixed, suggesting instead the idea of
evolution by natural selection. Darwin had skirted the question of the human in The Origin of
Species (1859), but rounded out his account in The Descent of Man by applying the theory of
evolution to explain the existence of the human species.109 The Descent of Man was published
in 1871 – the same year as Tylor’s Primitive Culture. As described by Adam Kuper,
[Tylor’s book] added what was a potentially devastating challenge to orthodox
Christians. He argued that even the earliest men had some form of religious belief.
Religions could be ranged in a series according to intellectual sophistication, but later
religions all derived from a primitive system of theology [i.e. animism], and retained
107 On Müller’s comment, see n. 103 above. Similarly, Tiele not only used the category of animism, but even
declared that “I cannot speak of it without mentioning the name of the author who first threw clear light on
the subject, I mean Dr E. B. Tylor, Professor in the university of Oxford” (Elements of the Science of Religion, 68).
108 The transformations of historical consciousness in the mid-nineteenth century are discussed more
substantially in Chapter 5. A useful summary is provided in Kippenberg, Discovering Religious History, 29-35.
Darwin, C., The Origin of Species by Means of Natural Selection (London: John Murray, 1859); and The Descent of
Man, and Selection in Relation Sex (London: John Murray, 1871).
109
137
traces of their origins. The clear implication was that classical Christianity might have
been outgrown by modern man. Increasingly, religious belief would yield place to
scientific theory.110
This apologetic orientation was made obvious through Tylor’s famous argument that all
forms of religion, even those in contemporary European society, were nothing other than
“survivals” from old cultural forms that ultimately found their root in the original, primitive
condition of mankind.111 Thus, as Randall Styers has shown in a penetrating study of the
category of “magic”, Tylor is representative of a number of figures in this period who used
primitive religion (and by implication all religion) as a foil for constructing the identity of
modern Europe as scientific and rational.112 This was a crucial difference between those
involved in philological scholarship and those engaged in the new “science of man”,
because virtually all scholars involved in anthropology, by the time they were writing, were
either agnostics or atheists.113 This was certainly not the case with the philologists.
This divide between the two fields also became manifest by the way in which
anthropology was constructed as an academic discipline that was clearly distinct from
philology in both its data and its methods. For although anthropology and philology shared
110
Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society, 79-80.
111 On survivals, see e.g. Primitive Culture, 1: 16, where Tylor defines the term as referring to “processes,
customs, opinions, and so forth, which have been carried on by force of habit into a new state of society
different from that in which they had their original home, and they thus remain as proofs and examples of an
older condition of culture out of which a newer has been evolved”. See also Hodgen, “The Doctrine of
Survivals”.
Given the limited focus of this chapter on the history of classification, I am not able to discuss issues
surrounding the politicized nature of the magic/religion binary. On the importance of Styers’ work in this
dissertation, see Chapter 1 above (n. 19).
112
This point was noted long ago by Evans-Pritchard. He went on to say that: “We should, I think, realize
what was the intention of many of these scholars if we are to understand their theoretical constructions. They
sought, and found, in primitive religions a weapon which could, they thought, be used with deadly effect
against Christianity. If primitive religion could be explained away as an intellectual aberration, as a mirage,
induced by emotional stress, or by its social function, it was implied that the higher religions could be
discredited and disposed of in the same way” (Evans-Pritchard, Theories of Primitive Religion, 15). See here Styers,
Making Magic, 10. Evans-Pritchard continued: “whether they were right or wrong is beside the point, which is
that the impassioned rationalism of the time coloured their assessment of primitive religions and has given
their writings, as we read them today, a flavour of smugness which one may find either irritating or risable”
(15).
113
138
a common point of departure with the developmental view of world history (and thus
overlapped occasionally), they effectively constituted two completely different fields for the
study of comparative religion. Eric Sharpe describes the situation well, saying that
The philologists were of course interested only in textual material, and their methods
as historians of religion were essentially those which had been developed for the
purpose of dealing with Semitic and Indo-European texts. Other data concerning the
earliest history of mankind, and man’s earliest religions, interested them hardly at all.114
The division of labour between philology (“history”) and anthropology (“prehistory”) was
an extremely durable one. A convenient illustration of this separation, which helps move
the discussion into the twentieth century, can be seen in a comparison of the two most
important early twentieth-century scholars of religion: Max Weber and Émile Durkheim,
who represent the trajectories of philology and anthropology surprisingly well.
Durkheim, although usually associated with the establishment of sociology, is in
many respects the culmination of nineteenth-century anthropological scholarship. His
analysis of Australian indigenous religion as “the most primitive and simple religion which
we can observe” was structured around the idea of “totemism”, an idea that had been
developed alongside Tylor’s animism by James Frazer and William Robertson Smith.115
Durkheim’s work was based on the ethnographic data that had constituted anthropology in
114
Sharpe, Comparative Religion, 47.
Durkheim, É., The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life (2nd ed.; trans. J. S. Swain; London: George Allen &
Unwin, 1976 [1912]), 23. I do not discuss totemism here, although the main figures who lie in the preDurkheimian background of the concept are John Ferguson McLennan, William Robertson Smith and James
Frazer. McLennan coined the term (under influence from Tylor’s early work) in “The Worship of Plants and
Animals”, Fortnightly Review 6-7 (1869-70): 407-582, 194-216. Robertson Smith expanded upon the concept in
his Lectures on the Religion of the Semites (Edinburgh: A. & C. Black, 1889). This in turn heavily influenced the
young Frazer, who had worked closely with Robertson Smith and whose first small book was called Totemism
(Edinburgh: A. & C. Black, 1887). But Frazer soon began to distance himself from totemism, and indeed from
Robertson Smith himself, which he made clear in the preface to the second edition of his influential classic,
The Golden Bough (2nd ed.; 3 vols; London: Macmillan, 1900 [1890]), 3. For a useful discussion of this trajectory,
see Kuper, The Invention of Primitive Society, 76-91. For a slightly wider discussion of the trajectory that better
illuminates the importance of Robertson Smith in Durkheim’s thought, see Kippenberg, Discovering Religious
History, 65-80. Kippenberg notes that Durkheim acknowledged in 1907 that it was only when he read the
lectures of Robertson Smith that he clearly saw the central role of religion in social life (80).
115
139
the nineteenth century, and he placed that data in a similar developmental framework. The
Elementary Forms of the Religious Life deals exclusively with primitive religion, and does not
engage any material regarding the world’s major textual religions.
Weber, by contrast, dealt exclusively with material from the major civilizational
cultures in his wide-ranging corpus of historical sociology, and represents the outgrowth of
textually focused history of religions scholarship, particularly from Germany.116 After
publishing his famous economic analysis of the relationship between Protestantism and
capitalism, Weber embarked on the more ambitious task of examining Die Wirtschaftsethik der
Weltreligionen (1915) – “the economic ethic of the world religions”, which became part of his
massive (but incomplete) Wirtschaft und Gesellschaft.117 The opening paragraph of his
introduction is indicative of the new logic that would soon culminate in the twentieth
century world religions paradigm:
By “world religions,” we understand the five religions or religiously determined
systems of life-regulation which have known how to gather multitudes of confessors
around them. The term is used here in a completely value-neutral sense. The
Confucian, Hinduist, Buddhist, Christian, and Islamist religious ethics all belong to the
category of world religion. A sixth religion, Judaism, will also be dealt with. It is
included because it contains the historical preconditions decisive for understanding
Christianity and Islamism, and because of its historic and autonomous significance for
the development of the modern economic ethic of the Occident … References to
Weber’s apparent non-engagement with any literature on primitive religion is noted by Evans-Pritchard,
who says “he appears to have read little about them” (Theories of Primitive Religion, 117). As Talcott Parsons has
said of Weber as a scholar of religion, “If the Protestant Ethic was Weber’s point of departure, his immediate
scholarly destination was the series of comparative monographs in the sociology of religion of which three
were completed, those of Chinese religion (Confucianism and Taoism), of Indian religion (Hinduism and
Buddhism), and of Ancient Judaism. … This series was left incomplete at Weber’s death. He had planned, at
the very least, comparable studies of Islam, of Early Christianity, and of Medieval Christianity” (Parsons, T.,
“Introduction” to Weber’s The Sociology of Religion [Boston: Beacon Press, 1964], xxix-lxxvii, here xxxi). Space
does not permit a proper discussion of Weber’s inheritance of nineteenth-century German scholarship. For a
useful treatment, see Kippenberg, Discovering Religious History, 113-124.
116
The work originally appeared as “Die Wirtschafts Ethik der Weltreligionen”, a portion of Weber’s massive
unfinished work, Wirtschaft und Gesellschaft (Tübingen: J. C. B Mohr, 1922). See the English translation, Economy
and Society: An Outline of Interpretive Sociology (2 vols; ed. G. Roth & C. Wittich; New York: Bedminster Press,
1968).
117
140
other religions will be made only when they are indispensible for historical
connections.118
Not only does this represent the first major shift in taxonomic logic from Tiele’s rigorous
definition of a “world religion” to the more theoretically vacuous twentieth-century
definition of the term, but the very different projects of Weber and Durkheim highlight just
how significantly the study of world religions had diverged from the study of primitive
culture by the start of the twentieth century. As I have been suggesting, the implications of
this are still playing out today.
The Consolidation of the World Religions Paradigm in the Twentieth Century
As the heady decades of the late nineteenth century came to a close, the “science of
religion” – now well-established as an independent conceptual field distinct from theology –
began to transmute into the “phenomenology of religion”, an enterprise that connected
closely with Tiele and the Dutch school. Tiele had already articulated the basic premise of
the enterprise: to study the essence of religion through its empirical manifestions, the
religions.119 This approach in fact stems back to Hegel, whose premise in The Phenomenology
of Spirit was that essence (Wesen) can be approached through a study of its manifestations
(Erscheinungen).120 This principle was taken up fully by Tiele, and is reflected in the two parts
of his Elements of a Science of Religion: (1) “morphological”, which was “concerned with the
constant changes in form resulting from an ever-progressing evolution”; and
118 Weber, “Die Wirtschaftsethik der Weltreligionen”. The essay appears in translation as “The Social
Psychology of the World Religions” in From Max Weber: Essays in Historical Sociology (ed. and trans. H. H. Gerth
& C. Wright Mills; New York: Oxford University Press, 1948) 267-301, here 267.
119 On Chantepie de la Saussaye, the other founder of the Dutch school, see Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 179206; Sharpe, Comparative Religion, 222. Useful background is also provided in Timothy Fitzgerald’s The Ideology of
Religious Studies (New York: Oxford University Press, 2000), 33-53.
120
See Sharpe, Comparative Religion, 221. I discuss Tim Murphy’s treatment of Hegel in the next chapter.
141
(2)“ontological”, which explores “the unalterable element in transient and ever-altering
forms––in a word, the origin and very essence of religion”.121
In Tiele’s wake, however, the the “essence and manifestation” paradigm began to
shift away from the overtly developmental model, and instead paid growing attention
simply to the task of discerning the essence of religion as a response to the threat of socialscientific “reductionism”. Understanding this subtle shift is crucial for my critique of the
twentieth-century world religions paradigm, so a little elaboration is in order.
The phrase “phenomenology of religion” was first coined by Dutch theologian P.
D. Chantepie de la Saussaye in 1887, who had been at Amsterdam before arriving at Leiden
in 1899, where Tiele had also been. In 1900, a successor to Tiele’s chair arrived at Leiden,
namely Wilhelm Brede Kristensen.122 In addition to Kristensen, the other major secondgeneration phenomenologist was Gerhardus van der Leeuw, both of whom were discussed
in Chapter 2 in the context of non-reductive theories of religion – van der Leeuw for
Religion in Essence and Manifestation (1933), which Murphy calls “the seminal statement of
classical phenomenology of religion”, and Kristensen for his articulation of the
(impoverished) cardinal rule of the discourse: the descriptive authority of the insider (i.e.
“the believer is always right”).123 The third generation of phenomenologists was dominated
by Mircea Eliade, the most important mid-twentieth-century scholar in carving out
autonomous disciplinary space for the study of religion.124
As discussed in the previous chapter, the phenomenological method of the
121
Tiele, Elements of a Science of Religion, 27. See Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 101ff.
122
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 179.
Ibid., 207. Eliade also called van der Leeuw “the first authoritative representative of the phenomenology of
religion” (The Sacred and the Profane The Nature of Religion [trans. W. Trask; Orlando, FL: Harcourt, 1959 (1957)]),
232.
123
Other important figures include Joachim Wach and Joseph Kitagawa, both of whom were at the University
of Chicago with Eliade. See Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 26f.
124
142
twentieth century was predicated on the notion of an ontological “sacred” or
“transcendent” reality that could not be grasped properly by other means of enquiry
(sociological, psychological, etc.), and could only be grasped by the hermeneutical method of
Eliadean-style “history of religions” scholarship.125 As discussed seveal times so far, one of
the driving motivations of the phenomenologists, along with related figures such as Rudolf
Otto, was to defend the sui generis nature of religion in the face of “reductive” naturalistic
and social-scientific theories. We can now see their arguments about the “essence” of
religion in a slightly broader context, something Murphy helps to emphasize:
The unity of this “school” was also at least somewhat self-conscious, as can be seen by a
trail of citations. Dilthey credited Schleiermacher and was influenced by Hegel; Otto
also edited Schleiermacher and was clearly influenced by him. In the opening lines of
The Sacred and the Profane, Eliade credits Otto; in the beginning of Patterns, he cites van
der Leeuw’s Phänomenologie der Religion; van der Leeuw cites Chantepie, “As regards
Phenomenology itself, Chantepie’s volume should be consulted.” Chantepie, in turn,
cites Hegel as well as Schleiermacher, but especially the former. This circle of
references indicates that the phenomenology of religion was, indeed, an intertextual
phenomenon.126
Given that I am arguing in this dissertation that Hick’s theory replicates a form of Hegelian
logic, seeing this chain of connections is vital in understanding how Hegel’s ideas flowed so
seamlessly into the late twentieth century. Yet as mentioned above, the major difference
between the late nineteenth-century (Tiele) and the mid-twentieth century (Eliade) is the
loss of emphasis on the idea of development that had been so dominant in the nineteenth
century.127 While the study of religion was still directed in large part towards the major
textual religions of the world, which reinforced the developmental logic that these
The terms “phenomenology of religion” and “history of religions” (as well as “Religionswissenschaft”) are
roughly equivalent, although there are certain subtle differences which I pass over here. See Murphy, The
Politics of Spirit, 27f.
125
126
Ibid., 29-30.
The examples of E. E. Evans-Pritchard and Claude Lévi-Strauss are enough to demonstrate that even well
into the twentieth century, “primitive” religion was the preserve of “anthropologists”, not “scholars of
religion” in the normal (i.e. philological) sense.
127
143
represented the highest or best forms of religion, the more explicit emphasis in the
twentieth century was not on ranking religions, but on discerning the essence of religion. In
other words, an important shift took place from a diachronic model of the relationship
between the religions, to a synchronic model – recall e.g. Eliade’s comment that the sacred “is
an element in the structure of consciousness, and not a stage in the history of
consciousness”.128
A related consequence of the new essentialist paradigm was that the overt Christian
triumphalism of scholars like Tiele and Müller began to recede into the background.
Although it is true that most phenomenologists of the early- and mid-twentieth century,
such as van der Leeuw and Kristensen, were Christian scholars with often explicit
theological agendas and motivations (as is clear from any analysis of their allegedly “nontheological” scholarship),129 it became much less common as the twentieth century
continued for scholars of religion to flatly assert the superiority of Christianity, at least
within the context of the new field of religious studies (now institutionally distinct from
theology).
These elements, in conjunction with the philological legacy and its focus on the
textually-based “great traditions” of the world, serve as the foundation of the world
religions paradigm of the late twentieth century. While elements of the world religions
paradigm had been brewing since the nineteenth century (witness e.g. the World’s
Parliament of Religions), it was not until around the 1960s that the paradigm became widely
entrenched in Euro-American discourse. As discussed at the outset of this work, a
watershed moment came with the 1958 publication of Huston Smith’s widely popular
128 I take the language of diachronic and synchronic from Murphy, whose study first drew my attention to this
important conceptual shift.
Aside from Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, the theological heritage of religious studies as an academic
discipline is analysed by the scholars cited in n. 131 below. Timothy Fitzgerald has been particularly strident
regarding the claim that religious studies is little more than “a disguised form of liberal ecumenical theology”
(The Ideology of Religious Studies, 6).
129
144
textbook, The Religions of Man, which resulted from a 1955 television series that Smith claims
reached over 100,000 people.130 Articulating the basic taxonomic model that would
dominate the second half of the twentieth century, Smith treats the seven canonical “great”
religions: Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism, Taoism, Islam, Judaism, and Christianity.
Notice the way in which this list of “world religions” remains virtually unchanged from the
list of “ethical” religions in the “upper” stages of development in the models of nineteenthcentury scholars like Tiele and Müller.
However the substantial difference between the world religions model and the
earlier developmental view is that the new paradigm was explicitly pluralistic. Being
structured around the essence/manifestation distinction that it had inherited from the
phenomenology of religion, the emerging model of world religions was one in which there
was avowedly no hierarchy. In other words, the synchronic shift had horizontalized the
relationship between the religions – again, something that “fitted” with the growing
liberalism of the post-WWII era.
However, an important consequence of this was that the discourse began to shift
away from the “origins of religion” debate, instead focusing with renewed ecumenical vigour
on the world’s living religions, i.e. major traditions with a visible, vibrant presence in the
modern world. Yet because of this, the old methodological separation between philology
and anthropology endured into the second half of the twentieth century, and with it the
implicit hierarchy between the great traditions and primitive culture. The Religions of Man is a
good illustration of this tendency, and the institutionalization of religious studies in the
Smith, H., The Religions of Man (New York: Harper, 1958). As noted, the work has since been repackaged
along more gender-inclusive lines as The World’s Religions: Our Great Wisdom Traditions (San Francisco: Harper
SanFrancisco, 1991). I discuss another important difference between the two editions in the Conclusion.
Smith makes the claim about the size of his television audience in the 1965 reprint of The Religions of Man (ix).
130
145
1960s created a wide market for works of a similar nature.131
Another important scholar in the story is Wilfred Cantwell Smith, who played a
major role in promoting the terminology of “world religions” through his involvement at
Harvard’s new Program in World Religions, inaugurated in 1960.132 Cantwell Smith is
especially instructive for the way he reflects the tendency of the new discourse to focus on
the “living religions”:
Whereas at the turn of the century a typical introductory course in this field would
emphasize “primitive religions,” and a typical book would address itself to the “nature
and origin of religion” (the phrase implicitly postulates that the reality or truth of
religion is to be found most purely or most surely in its earliest and simplest forms),
today it is normal to give chief or even sole attention to Hindus, Buddhists, and
Muslims, along with Christians and Jews – groups that between them constitute the
vast majority of today’s population, and between them claim most forcefully to
represent religion’s highest and truest development. And whereas once such attention as was
given to the great religions was primarily to their scriptures and historically to their early,
classical phases, today these religions are seen primarily as the faith of present-day
groups …
… [And, singling out The Religions of Man for specific attention, he continues that:] The
same omission of primitives and concern for the great religions is true of the recent
brilliant text of Huston Smith ... a luminous example of the treatment of religion as the
faith of persons ... This work is perhaps the first adequate textbook in world religions,
precisely because it treats religions as human.133
As noted below (see n. 140), the world religions textbook market is still thriving in the twenty-first century.
Of works already cited that deal with the formalization of religious studies as an academic discipline, see:
Sharpe, Comparative Religion (267-319); Young, “World Religions: A Category in the Making?”; Fitzgerald, The
Ideology of Religious Studies; Cox, From Primitive to Indigenous (33-52); McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion. See also
the essays collected in Smith, J. Z., On Teaching Religion (ed. C. Lehrich; New York: Oxford University Press,
2013); and Walter Capps, Religious Studies: The Making of a Discipline (Minneapolis: Fortress Press, 1995). Cox’s
chapter on “Essentialism and the World Religions Paradigm” (33-52) is particularly useful for its discussion of
the consolidation of religious studies in the British context. He notes the role of Ninian Smart in founding the
first UK religious studies department at Lancaster, as well as E. E. Kellett’s A Short History of Religions (rep.
1948), which began to popularize the world religions discourse at a popular level in a similar way to Huston
Smith’s Religions of Man in the US.
131
Young says that: “it was Smith, especially in his role as director of the Center from 1964, who gave
intellectual formulation to what may be termed a growing cultural fashion: focusing on the contemporary
aspect of certain religions” (115). She also notes the following (116): “Scrutiny of the various statements by
Wilfred Cantwell Smith suggests that his criteria for the category ‘world religions’ were (1) living, (2) major in
the sense that they involved the vast majority of today's population, and (3) great in the sense that they could
claim between them to represent religion’s highest and truest development.”
132
Cantwell Smith, W., “Comparative Religion: Whither––and Why?” in The History of Religions: Essays in
Methodology (ed. M. Eliade & J. Kitagawa; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1959), 31-59. The quotations
are from 37-38, although I have retained the instructive italics used by Young to highlight the emerging tropes
of the discourse (see “World Religions: A Category in the Making?”, 114).
133
146
It was in this context that Cantwell Smith called for a wholesale reappraisal of the study of
religion in the west, whereby its partisanship to Christianity was dropped in favour of a
model that grappled with “the total religious history of mankind”, in which all “faith” was
understood as reflecting differing patterns of “man’s variegated and evolving encounter
with transcendence”.134 And as also discussed, John Hick’s entire philosophical program
was explicitly an attempt to take up Cantwell Smith’s challenge by developing a
comprehensive theory of religion which did just that: describe the total religious history of
mankind as differing human “responses” to the same transcendent reality. I will come to
Hick and his relationship to this discursive history in the next chapter.135 But first, as a way
of providing a summary, it is important to clarify specifically what all of these developments
meant for the classification of religions in the new paradigm.
At the start of the twentieth century, the diachronic developmental model of
religious history, as articulated by Tiele, was broadly dominant in the enterprise of
comparative religion. Yet as the phenomenology of religion gained momentum, its
emphatically non-reductive focus shifted the model to a synchronic, essentialist one
whereby religions were not classed in “stages”, but were held to be manifestations of an
irreducible, sui generis reality – whether called “the Sacred” (Eliade), “the Holy” (Otto), “the
Transcendent” (Cantwell Smith), or “the Real” (Hick). Moreover, as I have also attempted
to show, this new essentialist model, whilst heavily indebted to early European and
Christian triumphalism, was almost invariably an explicit attempt to move beyond such
Eurocentrism and to affirm the value of all “religion”, regardless of its manifestation.
In this context, the term “world religions” acquired a very different meaning to the
134
See above, ch. 1, n. 4.
135 I pass over Hick’s relationship with a number of important British thinkers, not least Ninian Smart, whose
chair of Philosophy Hick filled at Birmingham when Smart moved to Lancaster. See Hick, J., John Hick: An
Autobiography, 143ff. See also n. 131 above.
147
one it had been given in the developmental model. Tiele had used the label of “world”
religion as the equivalent of a “universal” religion. Universal religions were the upper stage
of the ethical religions, and were the three religions with a genuinely “universalistic” (as
opposed to a “national” or “ethnic”) orientation. But in the essentialist model, especially
from the 1960s onwards, the notion of a “world religion” underwent a significant shift that
reflects the movement from teleology (Tiele) to essentialism (Eliade/Huston Smith). As
Jonathan Z. Smith describes,
Later scholars expanded the number of world religions to seven by collapsing Tiele’s
two classes of “ethical religions” in an odd venture of pluralistic etiquette: if
Christianity and Islam count as world religions, then it would be rude to exclude
Judaism (ironically, the original model for the opposite type, “national nomistic
religions”). Likewise, if Buddhism is included, then Hinduism cannot be ignored. And
again, if Buddhism, then Chinese and Japanese religions.136
This “pluralistic etiquette” defines the world religions paradigm: not just in its sense of
liberal ecumenism (“religion” is a good thing vis-à-vis secularism and disenchantment), but
also in the way that it reifies a theoretically impoverished mode of categorization (Smith
calls it methodologically “unprincipled”). Katherine K. Young makes several further cogent
observations about this terminology: (1) the period 1951-61 saw a marked increase of this
usage of the compound “world religions” and its cognates (“the world’s religions”, etc.); (2)
the term “world religions” had an air of natural self-evidency, to the point that it was
virtually never defined despite its vacuous theoretical nature; and (3), describing the broader
context I have touched upon several times so far,
Several reasons seem to have prompted the use of this term. (a) The desire by the West
to solve world problems, be good world citizens (especially in the wake of imperialism
and the world wars), and create a peaceful transition to religiously plural societies in the
West itself through understanding or dialogue. Hence the emphasis on living religions
Smith, J. Z., “Religion, Religions, Religious”, 191. Smith had made the same point two decades earlier in
Map Is Not Territory: Studies in the History of Religions (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1978), 289-309, see
295f. He comes at the issue again in “A Matter of Class: Taxonomies of Religion” in Relating Religion, 160-178,
see 169f.
136
148
practiced by large numbers of people. (b) The interest in successful religions in terms
of spread and continuity; hence the interest in “major” religions. (c) The wish for a
convenient selection principle for textbooks to enable a manageable number of
religions to be surveyed and give the appearance of being global.137
These critical remarks bring us back to the penetrating observation of J. Z. Smith discussed
at the beginning of this work:
It is impossible to escape the suspicion that a world religion is simply a religion like
ours, and that it is, above all, a tradition that has achieved sufficient power and
numbers to enter our history and form it, interact with it, or thwart it. We recognize
both the unity within and the diversity among the world religions because they
correspond to important geopolitical entities with which we must deal. All
“primitives,” by way of contrast, may be lumped together, as may the “minor
religions” because they do not confront our history in any direct fashion. From the
point of view of power, they are invisible.138
Smith has elsewhere described “primitive” and “minor” as “residual categories” for
religions not classifiable under the dominant system, and after discussing in particular his
experiences in dealing with this persistent issue as the general editor of The HarperCollins
Dictionary of Religion, he continues that
The category “Religions of Traditional Peoples” is the best illustration of my previous
remark that while we are capable of taking infinite pains at splitting “world religions”
in an endless dialectic of unity and diversity we tend to lump together so-called
‘primitive’ religions. … The fact is that there is no satisfactory way of classifying these
traditions. Neither geographical nor linguistic groupings have proved fruitful or gained
wide assent. Until such is developed, we will continue to use prescientific categories,
largely lumping these folk together by the putative absence among them of cultural
indicators we associate with ourselves (from clothes to writing to historical
complexity).139
137 Young, “World Religions: A Category in the Making?”, 117. Masuzawa goes even further than Young on
the administrative appeal of the world religions model: “In the unapologetic free market and entrepeneurial
climate pervading universities and colleges … it is clear that the consistently large enrollment figures in world
religions courses – as well as derivative courses, such as course in ‘Asian religions,’ ‘biblical traditions,’ and
‘religious diversity in America’, to name a few – has been the single most powerful argument and justification
for maintaining the steady budget line and faculty positions in the religious studies departments and
programs” (The Invention of World Religions, 9).
138
Smith, “Religion, Religions, Religious”, 191-2.
139
Smith, “A Matter of Class”, 171-2.
149
This circumscription plays out clearly in H. Simth’s The Religions of Man, which is
representative of most other books in the “world religions” genre.140 Not only did the first
edition of this work concern itself only with the seven “great faiths of man”, but Smith later
admitted that until his encounter with Native American culture in the 1970s, he had
“dismissed” all of the world’s tribal religions as “unimportant”, something also seemingly
advocated in Cantwell Smith’s insistence on the primacy of the “living” religions.141 This
effectively summarizes the logic of the world religions paradigm as it stood in the middle of
the twentieth century – the time that Hick was writing – and is a perfect illustration of J. Z.
Smith’s observation about what has “counted” as a world religion in western discourse.
Huston Smith “dismisses” all of the not-so-great religions of the world because the
discourse that supplied the formative logic to his thinking had been historically constructed
to do so. As we will see next chapter, Smith even admitted this later in his career.
Recent critics have amplified these concerns about the circumscription of the noncivilizational other, and to close out I want to start outlining the challenges to the world
religions model that have been offered from the perspective of postcolonial theory,
something that will be continued into the next chapter. One sustained attempt to address
the difficult issue of appropriate nomenclature for the religion of peoples from small-scale
oral societies has been James Cox’s advocacy of the category “indigenous”. While
recognizing the many problems (ethical, political, methodological) that attend the issue of
classification, Cox argues that, carefully defined, the category of indigenous offers a far
140 A useful survey of early world religions textbooks can be found in Young, “World Religions: A Category
in the Making?”. For other surveys with an even stronger critical focus, see the postcolonial critique of James
Lewis, “Images of Traditional African Religion in Surveys of World Religions”, Religion 20 (1990): 311-322;
and Religious Studies Review 31 (2005), a special issue comprising essays focused on the political implications of
the world religions paradigm (see esp. MacWilliams, M., et al. “Religion/s Between the Covers: Dilemmas of
the World Religions Textbook”, 1-36).
141 See A Seat At The Table: Huston Smith in Conversation with Native Americans on Religious Freedom (Berkeley:
University of California Press, 2006), 2. The 1991 edition of his textbook (The World’s Religions) included a
chapter on “primal religion”. I return to this episode in the Conclusion.
150
better conceptual rubric than previous categories, all of which he rightly notes are grounded
in the dynamics of either theological or imperialist marginalization.142 In addition to
advocating the use of indigenous as a category, Cox further advocates the inclusion of
indigenous religions in curricula of undergraduate and postgraduate degrees at an
international level, speaking even of western scholarship’s “intellectual duty” to do so.143 A
similar call has also been made by Richard King, who has argued that:
The introduction of a variety of indigenous epistemic traditions is, in my view, the
single most important step that postcolonial studies can take if it is to look beyond the
Eurocentric foundations of its theories and contest the epistemic violence of the
colonial encounter. 144
Concerns about their exclusion from such curricula were also a key point of criticism for
the contributors of Beyond Primitivism: Indigenous Religious Traditions and Modernity. As discussed
earlier, this work arose as the result of a conference in which scholars were called to
respond to “a perceptible lack in Western institutions in the study of ‘indigenous’ religions.”
To repeat, Olupona writes that:
This lack is especially indicated in the history of religion programs offered at many US
universities. Western religious scholarship, generally the world over, has privileged
“world” religions by an absolute linguistic separation into two classes of religious
studies: “indigenous” religions and “world” religions. This arbitrary and capricious
bifurcation of religious scholarship fails to acknowledge the universality of religious
systems of belief across the globe. It fails to acknowledge the very sacred spiritual
traditions of Africa, the Americas, Asia, and wherever indigenous people inhabit the
earth. … The privileging of “world” religions is largely informed by a particular
academic orientation of scholars, whose traditions developed out of the “axial age”
civilization paradigm.145
Cox, From Primitive to Indigenous, esp. 53-74 on “Defining Indigenous Scientifically”. While Cox’s proposals
are cogent in many respects, I remain unconvinced about the utility of “indigenous” as a serious category of
classification for broadscale cultural comparison. I leave this issue to the side for now, as it is discussed further
in the Conclusion.
142
143
See ibid., 169-171 (quotation 169).
144
King, Orientalism and Religion, 199.
145 For the reference, see above, ch. 1, n. 54. I note again that Olupona’s comment contains several tropes that
have been problematized by McCutcheon and other critics of the discourse on sui generis religion, especially the
statement regarding “the universality of religious systems of belief across the globe”. However I pass over
these issue now and simply point to McCutcheon’s works already cited. See also more recently William Arnal
151
This complaint articulates precisely the problem I have been attempting to highlight in this
chapter, namely the great-traditions-centrism of the world religions paradigm and the way in
which it reflects the geopolitical power structures of the preceding five centuries of
European global expansion. Even though the paradigm is an ostensibly pluralized structure
with no hierarchy, a silent economy of privilege is actually at play in which “world” religions
are considered (in Cantwell Smith’s words) as “religion’s highest and truest development”.
Again, Olupona’s complaint is particularly instructive because of the way it foregrounds the
way that this assumption continues to marginalize a wide range of contemporary human
communities, not just those from the archaic past.
The issues raised by Cox, King and Olupona are related to broader streams of
deconstruction of western regimes of knowledge that have been underway since the 1960s.
As Mary Louise Pratt describes, “In the last decades of the twentieth century, processes of
decolonization opened the meaning-making powers of empire to scrutiny, as part of a largescale effort to decolonize knowledge, history, and human relations”.146 Postcolonial theory
has especially focused on the “meaning-making powers” of western discourse, i.e. the
diffuse systems of representation through which images of the Other have been
constructed, as well as how these representations have functioned in the dialectic of
knowledge and power. Although it took some time for these concerns to receive serious
attention in the field of religious studies (dominated as it was in the twentieth century by the
theory-averse phenomenological approach), this critical agenda has now been well
established in the discipline and is becoming increasingly visible.
& Russell McCutcheon, The Sacred is the Profane: The Political Nature of “Religion” (New York: Oxford University
Press, 2013).
Pratt, M-L., Imperial Eyes: Travel Writing and Transculturation (2nd ed.; London: Routledge, 2008 [1992]), 3.
Richard King’s Orientalism and Religion is a good discipline-specific example of the project Pratt describes.
146
152
As Tim Murphy has demonstrated in by far the most thorough postcolonial reading
of the history of religions enterprise, “the structures of the discourse of the phenomenology
of religion are remarkably similar to the system of colonial representations as described by
postcolonial theory”.147 He further contends that
This narrative of Religious Studies [i.e. the pluralistic essentialist one] breaks down
when viewed from the perspective of postcolonial theory: the phenomenologists of
religion, it turns out, are engaged in the symbolic cultural subordination of peoples of
color by their metaphysical, teleological, and taxonomic views––unwittingly, in most
cases I would add, but not all.148
This is a good comment to bring the focus back to Hick, because it captures two separate
issues: (1) the fact that the modern paradigm of “world religions” is underpinned by
Eurocentric discourses that have their root in colonialist systems of representation; but (2)
that these assumptions are usually replicated “unwittingly” by most scholars. It is important
to recall that aside from the specific argument that Hick makes, the ethos animating his
work is a thoroughgoing rejection of all forms of Christian triumphalism and all forms of
racism. This is the ethos of theological pluralism and the world religions paradigm at large.
The fact that this paradigm is so deeply implicated in the intellectual formations that it seeks
to cast off is therefore surely problematic – morally problematic, because of its complicity
in the reproduction of colonial discourse; and methodologically problematic, because the
key assumptions about cultural difference on which it is predicated are now
incommensurable with contemporary historiographical standards. These new standards will
be discussed more fully in the final chapter; but first it is time to demonstrate how these
problems play out in Hick’s argument.
147
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 59.
148
Ibid.
153
Chapter 4
From Hegel to Hick: Pluralism and the Problem of the Axial Age
The previous chapter has established the broad character of the world religions paradigm,
which provided the organizational logic for the treatment of comparative religion in the
twentieth century. It was primarily concerned to demonstrate the way in which the
paradigm operated with a hierarchal relation between world religions and non-world
religions – religions variously called “primitive”, “savage”, “natural”, “national”, and more
recently, “indigenous”. It further attempted to show the way in which this paradigm had
been historically constituted to focus almost exclusively on the major civilizational religions,
with the consequence that small-scale traditions were almost invariably excluded from
major treatments of religious history, instead being left to anthropology and other
disciplines. And when they were included in global treatments of religion, for example in
introductory textbooks, they were lumped together as one generic phenomenon while the
world religions were subjected to detailed and sophisticated differentiation.1 I noted the
point at which Hick can be situated in this trajectory, namely occupying a position that built
explicitly upon the program of Wilfred Cantwell Smith, one of the principal architects of
the twentieth-century world religions model. The analysis in that chapter already goes a long
way to explaining why Hick’s theory – which purportedly set out to incorporate the
“experience and thought of the whole human race” – in fact only concerned itself with the
“great faiths of mankind” and therefore perpetuated the racist cultural hierarchies of the
nineteenth century, but without him ever realizing it.
This chapter returns to Hick with these concerns in mind, and subjects his argument
to a more critical reading than the exposition offered in Chapter 2. In particular, I want to
1 I note again on this issue James Lewis’ excellent article, “Images of Traditional African Religion in Surveys
of World Religions”, Religion 20 (1990): 311-322. See n. 52 below.
155
focus on the way that Hick uses the Axial Age as the central historical narrative
underpinning his theory, not only because this aspect of his argument has not been
sufficiently dealt with in the critical literature to date, but because it is here that his
replication of nineteenth-century discourses is most clear. In other words, the aim of this
chapter is to amplify the subtext of Hick’s argument in order to show that there exist a
number of major problems with his reading of religious history, ones that effectively
undermine his entire position.
The discussion begins by examining Jaspers’ original formulation of the Axial Age,
discussing (a) what Jaspers meant by the idea, (b) how it was grounded in a Hegelian
reading of world history, and then (c) how it was adopted by Hick without any substantive
changes. The following section demonstrates the way in which the hierarchal logic of the
Axial Age paradigm plays out in An Interpretation of Religion, identifying six standard tropes of
colonial discourse that structure Hick’s view of religious history. The chapter concludes by
emphasizing the degree to which this undercuts the entire program Hick was advocating.
Once this is in focus, I reflect on the question of why Hick wound up in this contradictory
tangle, suggesting that he only construes religious history in this way because of the logic of
his discourse, not because he is actually racist himself. As discussed earlier, this still leaves
open the important question of how else to explain the cultural transformations of the 1st
millennium BCE, but this will be the focus of the following chapter.
From Hegel to Hick: A Brief Genealogy of the Axial Age
Writing as of a philosopher of history, Karl Jaspers posited the existence of an “axis” in
world history. He said that “This axis would be situated at the point in history which gave
birth to everything which, since then, man has been able to be, the point most
156
overwhelmingly fruitful in fashioning humanity”.2 On Jaspers’ reading, “It would seem that
this axis of history is to be found around 500 BC, in the spiritual processes that occurred
between 800 and 200 BC. It is there that we meet the most deepcut dividing line in history
… For short we may style this the ‘Axial Period’ [die Achsenzeit]”.3 His first comments under
the heading “Characterization [Charakteristik] of the Axial Period” run as follows:
The most extraordinary events are concentrated in this period. Confucius and Lao-tse
were living in China, all the schools of Chinese philosophy came into being, including
those of Mo-ti, Chuang-tse, Lieh-tsu and a host of others; India produced the
Upanishads and Buddha and, like China, ran the whole gamut of philosophical
possibilities down to scepticism, to materialism, sophism and nihilism; in Iran
Zarathrusta taught a challenging view of the world as a struggle between good and evil;
in Palestine the prophets made their appearance, from Elijah, by way of Isaiah and
Jeremiah to Deutero-Isaiah; Greece witnessed the appearance of Homer, of the
philosophers – Parmenides, Heraclitus and Plato – of the tragedians, Thucydides and
Archimedes. Everything implied by these names developed during these few centuries
almost simultaneously in China, India, and the West, without any one of these regions
knowing of the other.4
Attention is drawn to the final words of this comment in order to highlight a fundamental
aspect of Jaspers’ thought about this period: namely that it was the independent emergence of
the various “axial” moments that proved this period to be “the manifestation of some
profound common element, the one primal source of humanity” rather than a mere
“historical coincidence”. Jaspers is at pains to emphasize this point. 5
The Axial Age narrative was also directed explicitly against Christian and
occidentalist readings of world history, such as those of Hegel and Leopold von Ranke, and
was intended to foster what his biographer describes as “an open attitude to spirituality”, an
2
Jaspers, K., On the Origin and Goal of History (trans. M. Bullock; London: Routledge & Kegan Paul, 1953), 1.
Ibid. The German terms have been provided from the original edition of the work, Vom Ursprung und Ziel der
Geschichte (Zurich: Artemis, 1949).
3
4
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 2 (italics added).
5
Ibid., 12. See 11-13 for Jaspers’ comments on the parallelism of the events.
157
attitude that dovetailed with Jaspers’ political liberalism.6 It is also worth emphasizing again
the specific context in which he put forth the thesis concerning the Axial Age – namely in
the immediate aftermath of WWII:
After experiencing totalitarianism in Germany, Jaspers’ emphasis on the ancient
sources of mankind’s civilization was an attempt to discover in the dim and nebulous
past an even deeper revival of the original openness that he applauded during the
‘axial’ period when tolerance seemed to be captured in a kind of Golden Age, with the
parallel awakening of the world’s religions.7
But to scrutinize Jaspers’ characterization of the Axial Age properly, especially the
distinction between “axial” and “pre-axial” cultures, it is essential to understand the
conceptual background he was working against. Although there were a number of
significant influences, the key figure underpinning this view of history is Hegel. As such, in
order to understand how Jaspers (and thus Hick) viewed the events of the 1st millennium
BCE, it is necessary to provide a short overview of Hegel’s influential understanding of
world history. Only once this is in place will it be possible to see the ways in which Jaspers
departed from Hegel – but also the ways in which he reproduced the Hegelian paradigm to
a very strong degree.8
Kirkbright, S., Karl Jaspers: A Biography: Navigations in Truth (New Haven: Yale University Press, 2004), 210. I
do not discuss Jaspers’ wider life in dissertation, although Kirkbright’s biography situates his work nicely in
relation to the events of his time. See also Karl Jaspers: Basic Philosophical Writings (ed. E. Ehrlich, L. H. Ehrlich,
& G. B. Pepper; Amherst, NY: Humanity Books, 1986) for a contextualization of Jaspers’ various
commitments and arguments.
6
7 Kirkbright, Karl Jaspers, 213. Kirkbright provides further useful contextualization: “To read the Bible in
Hitler’s Germany had been an act of verification about the hardship of surviving the inhuman force of a
brutal régime. In that turmoil, Gertrud and Karl Jaspers [who were confined to a single residence in
Heidelberg for their security during the hardest years of the war] found inner peace in the Old Testament
prophet, Jeramiah, in the Book of Job, and in Gospel teachings. Jaspers now discussed their Bible reading as a
striving for inner redemption that was to be set apart from the complex theological question of interpreting
the authority that the texts revealed” (202).
As noted in Chapter 1, I make no pretentions towards an exhaustive treatment of Hegel, nor even of Hegel’s
philosophy of history. My understanding of his influence on both Jaspers’ and the wider European study of
religion has been informed primarily by three works: Tim Murphy, The Politics of Spirit: Phenomenology, Genealogy,
Religion (Albany: SUNY Press, 2010); Shawn Kelly, Racializing Jesus: Race, Ideology and the Formation of Modern
Biblical Scholarship (London: Routledge, 2002); and the volume Hegel and History (ed. W. Dudley; Albany: SUNY
Press, 2009). The only other work I will cite at present is Michael Inwood, A Hegel Dictionary (Oxford:
8
158
For Hegel, “history” is not everything that has happened, but is rather everything that has
played a part in the actualization of freedom. Michael Inwood describes the “core notion”
of Hegel’s use of freedom (Freiheit) as follows: “something, especially a person, is free if,
and only if, it is independent and self-determining, not determined by or dependent upon
something other than itself”.9 The desire for freedom, Hegel argues, is the constitutive
feature of humanity, and that all humans therefore seek to establish the conditions in which
they can be free. Over the course of time, freedom has been understood in various ways by
various peoples, who have thus produced a variety of cultures. As Will Dudely summarizes,
Hegel attempts to make sense of this cultural variety by ordering the possible
understandings of freedom from the least to the most adequate, from those that grasp
the truth only partially (or abstractly) to those that grasp it most fully (or concretely).
He then identifies cultures that have actualized these understandings of freedom in
their legal, moral, social, economic, political, aesthetic, religious, and philosophical
endeavors. Hegel employs the resulting mapping of cultures onto understandings of
freedom to define historical epochs. These epochs, he concludes, are constitutive of
the historical process through which human beings have gradually come to understand
the freedom that is their own defining characteristic, and in so doing have been able to
achieve an increasingly complete liberation.10
This process of historical development (Entwicklung) is underpinned by Hegel’s famous
notion of Geist – variously rendered in English as “Spirit” or “reason”.11 In Hegel’s system,
Geist is the transcendental force that pervades and structures history. He calls it “the law of
the world”.12 It is in and through the progressive self-revelation of Geist that history is
propelled toward its goal, viz. the actualization of freedom. The self-revelation of Geist is, in
Blackwell, 1992), which I have found particularly useful in coming to grips with Hegel’s obfuscating
vocabulary.
9
Inwood, A Hegel Dictionary, 110 (s.v. “freedom”).
10
Dudley, W., “Introduction” in Hegel and History, 1-12, here 2.
On Geist, see Inwood, A Hegel Dictionary, s.v. “spirit” (274-277). Cf. also the discussion of Tiele and
Entwicklung above in Chapter 3.
11
12
See Kelly, Racializing Jesus, 40.
159
effect, the self-realization of Geist. Therefore Geist has manifested itself most fully in those
cultures which have attained the highest levels of self-reflexivity and creative philosophical
thinking.13
Recall that Hegel is interested in ordering the actualizations of freedom as these
have occurred in various cultures throughout time, from the least to the most adequate.
Dudley thus continues that:
The agents of reason, those whose deeds do the most to further the actualization of
freedom, Hegel calls “world historical” individuals and peoples. In the course of time,
they have inspired and lead humanity to fulfill its potential for self-determination.
Hegel traces the path of this fulfillment from East to West, asserting that the
consciousness of freedom and its objectification in the world first appeared in Asia and
then spread to Europe, intensifying in ancient Greece before culminating in modern
Germany.14
This is what Shawn Kelly calls “the myth of the west”, which takes the following narrative
form.15 Hegel divides world history into four stages: (1) the Oriental; (2) the Greek; (3) the
Roman; and (4) the Germanic. The first stage, which Hegel calls “the childhood of history”,
begins in China, moving westward through India and then the Near East.16 In a statement
from his Lectures on the Philosophy of History, which Hegel repeats throughout his corpus, he
says: “Orientals do not yet know that Spirit––Man as such––is free. And because they do
not know it, they are not free”, going on to assert in the vein of classical Orientalism that
they instead have only despotic culture and are marked by servility and sensuality (a view
13 I pass over the complex trinitarian dialectic that Hegel posited for the Entwicklung of Geist, noting in what
follows only the basic details. For good treatments of Hegel’s system, see Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 69-82;
and Kelly, Racializing Jesus, 33-63.
14
Dudley, “Introduction”, 3.
See Kelly, Racializing Jesus, 42ff. Kelly provides a detailed discussion of the way that Greek thought in
particular was venerated by Hegel and other nineteenth-century figures involved in discourses of aesthetic
nationalism. His critique is strongly influenced by Martin Bernal’s provocative work, Black Athena: The
Afroasiatic Roots of Classical Civilization: The Fabrication of Ancient Greece 1785-1985 (New Brunswick: Rutgers
University Press, 1987). I pass over these issues here, although they would be important to consider in a more
detailed study of Jaspers’ valorization of Greek thought.
15
16
See Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 75ff. The quotation is from the Lectures on the Philosophy of History (1833).
160
which, as seen in the previous chapter, had been already codified into European scientific
knowledge with Linnaeus).
Hegel then evaluates the following three stages:
The consciousness of freedom first arose amongst the Greeks, and therefore they were
free; but they, like the Romans, knew only that a few are free, and not man as such …
Therefore the Greeks not only had slaves to whom their lives and their beautiful
freedom was tied, but their freedom was itself only an accidental or contingent,
undeveloped, passing and limited flower, involving a harsh servitude of the human and
humanitarian sentiments. Only the Germanic nations have in and through Christianity
achieved the consciousness that man qua man is free, and that freedom of the spirit [die
Frieheit des Geistes] constitutes his very nature.17
For Hegel, the trajectory of world history thus followed the path of the sun, although with
one crucial difference:
The history of the world travels from East to West, for Europe is absolutely the end of
History, Asia the beginning … [But] although the Earth forms a sphere, History
performs no circle round it, but has on the contrary a determinate East, viz., Asia.
Here rises the outward physical sun, and in the West it sinks down: here
constantaneously rises the sun of self-consciousness, which diffuses a nobler
brilliance.18
This captures in nuce the teleological structure of the Hegelian metanarrative. Modern
Europe – which is to say Enlightened, Protestant, Germanic Europe – triumphantly
represents the culmination of history and the apex of Man.
As is clear, this view of history is thoroughly grounded in the nineteenth-century
Volk theory that was discussed in the previous chapter, and Hegel was a key figure in this
trajectory.19 Recall that the idea of the Völker was underpinned by the idea that each Volk
had a specific, defining characteristic that was held to be their essence – such as how
Orientals and Semites were static and conservative, while Aryans were dynamic and
17
See Kelly, Racializaing Jesus, 49.
18
See Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 75.
19
See Chapter 3, n. 69.
161
progressive (cf. again the Linnaean taxonomy). Recall also that within the frame of
Romanticism, religion was held to be the quintessential reflection of the essence of a Volk.
This means that Hegel’s understanding of religious history is a direct analogue to the
metanarrative of Geist. Because each religion is nothing less than the manifestation of a
Volk’s essential character, then the trajectory of religious Entwicklung follows the trajectory
of Geist – from Asia, through the Near East, Greece, Rome, and ultimately to the Protestant
West. “Religion” gradually becomes more and more “authentic”, “pure”, “perfect”, and
“closer to the Absolute” as it develops dialectically with Geist. And because modern
Europeans have attained the highest levels of self-reflexivity – which can be seen in their
science, philosophy, art, and political arrangements – then Christianity, and Protestantism in
particular, is the most highly developed form (or manifestation, Erscheinung) of religion. This
is the basic pattern later followed by Tiele and Otto.
Having established this outline (and I stress that it is no more than an outline),
consideration must also be given to the other major structural element that enables Hegel,
and those who follow him, to conceptualize human history in this way: namely the
distinction between Geist and Natur – between “spirit” and “nature”. The best way of
approaching this is looking at Hegel’s view of “Africa”, which effectively stands for any
culture that falls outside the civilizational sweep of Geist’s trajectory. In his Lectures on the
Philosophy of History, Hegel stated that:
Historical movements in [Africa] … belong to the Asiatic or European world … Egypt
… does not belong to the African Spirit. What we properly understand by Africa, is
the Unhistorical, Undeveloped Spirit, still involved in the conditions of mere nature, and which
had to be present here only as on the threshold of the World’s History. Having
eliminated this introductory element, we find ourselves for the first time on the real
theatre of History.20
20
See Kelly, Racializing Jesus, 50 (italics added).
162
The story of Geist, which begins in Asia, is thus the story of Geist’s progressive
emancipation from Natur. Kelly continues, stating that:
Hegel’s narrative has no place in it for the indigenous populations of Africa and
elsewhere … His own racial convictions, which reflect the values of his day, preclude
him from including the African in his narrative of the development of consciousness,
rationality, and history. This is no mere oversight on his part, no accidental omission
… Hegel chose to expel Africa from his narrative … because he, like virtually all of his
contemporaries … did not credit Africans fully with humanity, rationality, civilization,
or history. The Orient may represent an early stage in the process of civilization, but
Africa and its descendants reside outside of civilization entirely.21
In his detailed exposition of the Hegelian paradigm, Tim Murphy has spelled out the
implications of this view:
“History” is a history of human beings forming the state, or an objective rational
structure, and moving toward the self-conscious realization of freedom. As such, there
is an “inside” and an “outside” to history: some people are “in” history and some lack
the sufficient development of Geist to contribute to the progressive realization of
history and so are not “in” history … The taxonomic distinction between
“ethnographic” studies of peoples “who have no history” and “history” as peoples
who have formed a civilization is a direct reflection of this conception of history –
which is predicated on a qualitative distinction between Geist and Natur. This is an idea,
formulated in different ways, that runs throughout the discourse of the
phenomenology of religion.22
The fact that this metanarrative was constitutive of the discourse on religion in the
nineteenth and twentieth centuries was made clear in the last chapter: it is evident in Tiele’s
affirmation that “there is nowhere in the whole history of the development of religion so
distinct a cleavage, so sharp a demarcation, as between what we have called the nature and the
ethical religions”, and this distinction remained in place even deep into the twentieth century
on account of the sharp methodological demarcation between philology (the study of
historical religions) and anthropology (the study of nature religions). Murphy continues:
21
Ibid., 51.
22
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 80.
163
one of the heinous outcomes of … the structural relation between Nature and Spirit
becomes evident when it is applied to human beings, some of whom are classified as
Naturvölker, while the correlation between Kultur and objektiv[er] Geist is elevated to both
a methodological and a metaphysical principle. The result is that ‘civilized’ peoples are
inherently free [even if in different gradations], while Naturvölker, like Nature/Matter
itself, are inherently dependent, having their telos and purpose outside of themselves.
This, of course, is a legitimation for the colonization and subordination of the latter by
the former. 23
Murphy is emphatic about the way in which the opposition between Geist and Natur “is
used as a qualitative and normative differentiation between human beings of different
cultures and different historical periods”.24 Hegel characterizes those in whom Geist is
insufficiently developed as “wild”, “barbarous”, “unfree”, superstitious”, and “fearful”,
grouping all of these peoples under the rubric of Naturvölker, the lowest level of humanity,
who stand outside reason, Spirit, and the sweep of history. As Murphy notes with regard to
the continued prevalence of this idea:
This metanarrative is the structural principle for Hegel’s history of religion, a structure
that has so influenced the constitution of the idea of “world religions” that many
textbooks on the subject in the twenty-first century still implicitly follow this basic
pattern.25
Murphy’s comment is clearly confirmed by the discussion of the previous chapter. But
before coming to what Jaspers does with this way of thinking, I want to close the treatment
of Hegel by summarizing these problems from the perspective of postcolonial theory. A
good way to do this is to consider Rudolf Otto. Although Otto was appropriated and
popularized by phenomenologists such as Eliade, who operated with a synchronic notion of
the sacred and thus made “the Holy” seem like a non-developmental concept, Murphy
demonstrates that Otto’s narrative of religious history is quintessentially Hegelian, and that
23
Ibid., 13.
24
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 85.
25
Ibid., 86. See again Lewis, “Images of Traditional African Religion in Surveys of World Religions”.
164
it thus “conforms nearly perfectly with the structures of colonial discourse as this has been
discussed and analyzed by theorists such as Jacques Derrida and Edward Said”.26 He
provides some firm but appropriate critique:
A poststructuralist-postcolonial reading of Otto allows us to translate his abstract,
metaphysical dichotomies, such as a priori/a posteriori, Spirit/Nature, sense/reason, into
a kind of veiled speech about historically real social groups: Indians, Chinese, Africans,
Native Americans and so forth. … [Now,] If the matter were merely academic, or a
matter of an abstract system of concepts, this would be one thing. However, applied to
real human groups as Otto does, the metanarrative of Geist, whether articulated
diachronically or synchronically, is simply and factually a narrative of the supremacy –
Otto’s term, not mine – of white, Christian Europe over black, ‘primitive’ Africa and a
movement away from brown or yellow ‘despotic’ Asia. It moves from the South to the
North; away from the East to the West. It moves out of Asia, through Greece and into
the heart of Europe. It moves away from ‘nature’ to ‘spirit’; out of bondage to
freedom, it transcends ‘law’ and culminates in ‘love’, and goes beyond ‘sensualism’ to
‘pure reason’. And this narrative, this metaphysics [of peoples] … works thus whether
or not its ‘articulator’ is ‘personally’ racist or prejudiced, whether or not they are, in any
sense of the terms, ‘liberal’ or conservative, whether or not they are believers or
atheists, whether or not they consider themselves theologians or historians, whether or
not they praise Hegel or damn him … This is a racist, colonialist discursive structure,
more virulent at times, less at others admittedly, but racist nonetheless. It professes a
universalism; but, in the end, time and again, uses that very same universalism to
marginalize the already marginal and denigrate the already denigrated in the silent-soall-the-more-insidious constant reiteration of its logocentric, Eurocentric, and
Christocentric colonialist hegemony. When its core, constitutive, structural oppositions
are unmasked, it is seen to be the vicious, self-aggrandizing, and monstrously
narcissistic ideological formation that it is, not only potentially heinous in its practical
effects, but also, from a scientific point of view, patently false.27
It is precisely this sort of arrogant western triumphalism that Jaspers tries to move beyond
when he comes to write Vom Ursprung und Ziel der Geschichte. This is made clear on the very
first page of the work:
In the Western World the philosophy of history was founded on the Christian faith. In
a grandiose sequence of works ranging from St. Augustine to Hegel this faith visualised
Murphy, T., “Religionswissenschaft as Colonialist Discourse: The Case of Rudolf Otto”, Temenos 43 (2007): 727, here 7. This article is an earlier version of chapter 6 of The Politics of Spirit. It has been reworked with only
minor changes, but the following long quotation packs more punch in the article.
26
Murphy, “Religionswissenschaft as Colonialist Discourse”, 25-6. Murphy is also scathing about the still
dominant tendency in religious studies to “valorize Otto and even depoliticize him”, noting in particular the
recent study of Melissa Raphael, Rudolf Otto and the Concept of Holiness (Oxford: The Clarendon Press, 1997). See
The Politics of Spirit, 178.
27
165
the movement of God through history. God’s acts of revelation represent the decisive
dividing line.
… But the Christian faith is only one faith, not the faith of mankind. This view
of universal history therefore suffers from the defect that it can only be valid for
believing Christians.28
Jaspers continues by saying, specifically with reference to Hegel, that his own view of
history does not hold to the notion of progressive stages of development:
Our thesis involves something altogether different. It is precisely this series of stages
from China to Greece whose reality we deny; there is no such series, either in time or
in meaning. The true situation was rather on of contemporaneous, side by side
existence without contact.29
As noted above, this fact was crucial for Jaspers, because the independent nature of the
various axial moments was not only proof of the fundamental unity of the human spirit, but
the similarity of insights about the human condition delivered by the axial prophets and
philosophers had established the basis for genuine cross-cultural, supranational
communication – something that was of especial relevance in the years after the Second
World War.30
Jaspers did consider himself a Christian, but an extremely liberal one; and although
pluralist language had not yet crystallized, Jaspers’ form of faith is effectively that of
pluralist orthodoxy. Consider the following comment:
The claim to excessive possession of truth, that tool of fanaticism, of human arrogance
and self-deception through the will to power, that disaster for the West – most
especially so in its secularized forms, such as the dogmatic philosophies and the socalled scientific ideologies – can be vanquished by the very fact that God has
manifested himself historically in several fashions and has opened up many ways
towards Himself.31
28
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 1.
29
Ibid., 10.
30
See Kirkbright, Karl Jaspers, 337f., n. 23.
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 19-20. A good snapshot into Jaspers’ perspective on Christianity can
be found in the fascinating exhange between him and Rudolf Bultmann published in Myth and Christianity: An
Enquiry into the Possibility of Religion without Myth (trans. N. Guterman; New York: Noonday, 1954). The German
31
166
Jaspers even pronounces the chief pluralist dogma: “That which binds all men together …
cannot be revelation but must be experience.”32 It is this orientation that makes him so
appealing to Hick.
A final salient point of difference between Hegel and Jaspers was the greater mass
of information at Jaspers’ disposal with which to evaluate and compare the cultures of the
ancient world. Hegel was writing in the early stages of the Oriental Renaissance, when
knowledge of the religious and philosophical thought of Eastern cultures was still highly
limited. By contrast, Jaspers was able to draw on more than a century of rich comparative
studies, none being more important than those of Max Weber, whose broadly pluralistic
treatment of the Weltreligionen provided much of the empirical base for Jaspers’
understanding of comparative religious history (something which also explains Jaspers’ total
lack of focus on non-world religions, again reflecting the consequences of the divide
between history and anthropology).33
Yet while it is easy to see Jaspers’ pluralism on display through the pages of his
work, shining through in equal measure is his strongly Hegelian sense of what counts as
“history”. To highlight this, below are some of the other ways in which Jaspers describes
the events of the 1st millennium BCE. Immediately following his first comments on the
Charakteristik of the Axial Age (cited above), he continues thus:
What is new about this age, in all three areas of the world, is that man becomes
conscious of his Being as a whole, of himself and his limitations. He experiences the
terror of the world and his own powerlessness. He asks radical questions. Face to face
with the void he strives for liberation and redemption. By consciously recognising his
title of the work, Der Frage der Entmythologisierung, shows the link to Bultmann’s famous agenda of
“demythologizing” the New Testament.
32
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 19.
33
See above, ch. 3, n. 116. See also Chapter 1 on Jaspers’ veneration of Weber more generally (n. 83).
167
limits he sets himself the highest goals. He experiences absoluteness in the depths of
selfhood and in the lucidity of transcendence.
All this took place in reflection. Consciousness became once more conscious of itself, thinking
became its own object.
The Mythical Age, with its tranquility and self-evidence, was at an end. The Greek,
Indian, and Chinese philosophers were unmythical in their decisive insights, as were
the prophets in their ideas of God. Rationality and rationally clarified experience
launched a struggle against the myth (logos against mythos); a further struggle developed
for the transcendence of the One God against non-existent demons, and finally an
ethical rebellion took place against the unreal figures of the gods. Religion was
rendered ethical, and the majesty of the deity thereby increased.34
Jaspers continues by saying that “For the first time philosophers appeared”, and stressed that
this represents the emergence of speculative, critical thought – the point at which the
unquestioned self-evidency of the world was lost and humanity began to ask “radical
questions” (something emphasized in Arnaldo Momigliano’s subsequent description of the
period as “the age of criticism”).35 Jaspers even describes pre-axial cultures (including those
of Babylon and Egypt) as “appear[ing] in some manner unawakened”, saying that
Measured against the lucid humanity of the Axial period, a strange veil seems to lie
over the most ancient cultures preceding it, as though man had not yet really come to
himself.36
He even asserts in quite Hegelian fashion that “This overall modification of humanity may
be termed spiritualization”. And in what is probably his most memorable formulation of the
Axial Age, he states that in the Axial Age “Man, as we know him today, came into being” –
a sentiment he echoes later when saying that “only with the beginning of history did man
become truly human”. 37 While it would be easy to continue, this much makes clear that
34
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 2-3 (italics added in the first paragraph).
35
Momigliano, A., Alien Wisdom: The Limits of Hellenization (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1975), 9.
36
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 6-7.
37
Ibid., 3, 1, 47.
168
Jaspers shared Hegel’s conviction that history begins with civilizational culture, and that the
birth of history equates to the birth of self-reflexive thought.
Before moving to Hick, let me summarize the nature of the Axial Age narrative as
presented by Jaspers. To put it succinctly, Jaspers pluralizes the Hegelian version of world history
without altering its fundamental structure. He actively repudiates the Eurocentric and Christiantriumphalist structure of Hegelian thought, particularly the notion that there has been a
developmental progression from China to Europe. But beyond this, Jaspers is a quite
orthodox Hegelian. In effect, Jaspers is saying that there are no stages of Geist, because Geist
manifested itself in the Axial Age once and for all. Thus he still accepts a fundamental
dividing line between history and prehistory, and held the standard view that “History
extends as far back as linguistic [i.e. written] evidence … History has therefore lasted about
5000 years” (with the implication that “man as such” has only existed for the same time).38
Africa still resides outside of the historical process, and all non-civilizational peoples are still
involved “in the conditions of mere nature”, unable to contribute to the progress of Geist.
Jaspers thus follows precisely the structure of textocentric historiography that
underlies not just the world religions paradigm, but the entire historiographical tradition of
Euro-American scholarship. That textocentrism is, in turn, grounded in the aggressive
Eurocentric race theory of the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, which was one of the
most important conceptual ballasts in the justification of European colonial expansion.
While in many respects it is not surprising that Jaspers thought in these terms – this was
simply the view at the time, even for sophisticated academic professionals with a liberal
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 28. It is worth noting here that, unlike Hegel, Jaspers was aware that
the world was millions of years old, and that a long process of biological evolution had taken place (even
though he stresses that the axial shift is more than a matter of biology). What is particularly interesting here is
the way that Jaspers thus represents a point in time at which the broadscale understanding of human and
cosmological history had become well instituted in western scientific discourse, but when historiographical
paradigms had not yet transformed much from the days of Hegel. As discussed in Chapter 5, only in recent
decades has western historical discourse begun to move beyond the documentary paradigm of history.
38
169
orientation – the problem is that these ideas still play a significant role in the discourse on
religion even into the present day.
Amplifying the Subtext: Beneath the Positive Affirmations of Pluralism
The discussion up to this stage leaves things well placed to finally demonstrate the major
point of this dissertation: the way in which Hick’s explicitly anti-racist and egalitarian
reading of history still remains heavily structured by racially-grounded, Eurocentric tropes
about cultural difference. Much of this critique has already been implied in the discussion of
Hegel and Jaspers, as well as in the previous chapter. But I now want to be explicit about
the problems with Hick’s argument when focus is placed upon the Axial Age narrative.
Hick adopts the idea of the Axial Age from Jaspers almost wholesale, although he
does give it a more theological inflection in comparison to Jaspers’ more traditionally
philosophical view of the period. As discussed earlier, for Hick the Axial Age is the moment
which sees the transition “from archaic religion to the religions of salvation and liberation”.
Like Jaspers, Hick emphasizes that whereas the culture of pre-axial peoples is that of
unquestioning world acceptance, the primary characteristic of the post-axial cultures is a
new focus on “transcendence”, and the corresponding vision of a “limitlessly better future”.
It is important to note that Hick seems to have a sense of the problems I have been
describing. Early in An Interpretation of Religion he says:
Before turning to the post-axial forms of religion … may I remind the reader that no
religious stigma should be attached to the term ‘archaic’. It is not implied that it is
better, from a religious point of view, to be literate rather than pre-literate, or to live
within a contemporary rather than a now extinct way of life.39
39
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 28.
170
Yet unfortunately, this sentiment has not penetrated Hick’s thinking in any meaningful way.
Let me demonstrate the superficiality of this concession by first revisiting the comment
from 1980 discussed in Chapter 1, which I repeat here:
We may say of the early twilight period that men had, in virtue of the natural religious
tendency of their nature, a dim and crude sense of the Eternal One, an awareness
which took what are, from our perspective as Jews or as Christians, at best childish and
at worst appallingly brutal and bloodthirsty forms, but which nevertheless constituted
the womb out of which the higher religions were to be born. Here, I would say, there
was more human projection than divine disclosure. … There was at this stage no
startlingly challenging impact of the Eternal One upon the human spirit, but rather
that minimum presence and pressure which was to provide a basis for positive
moments of revelation when mankind was ready for them.40
This follows precisely the logic of Hegel’s comment that Africa stands only upon “the
threshold of world history” – it reflects Tiele’s claim about the fundamental “cleavage”
between textual and non-textual religions – and it echoes closely Otto’s comments about
the “abrupt, capricious, and desultory character of the earliest form of numinous
emotion”.41 And although Hick had begun to use different language by the time of his
major publication, the idea remained fundamentally the same. This is how he describes preaxial religion in An Interpretation of Religion:
Pre-axial religion has both psychological and sociological dimensions. Psychologically
it is an attempt to make stable sense of life, and particularly of the basic realities of
subsistence and propagation and the final boundaries of birth and death, within a
meaning-bestowing framework of myth. This serves the social functions of preserving
the unity of the tribe or people within a common world-view and at the same time of
validating the community’s claims upon the loyalty of its members. The underlying
concern is conservative, a defence against chaos, meaninglessness and the breakdown
of social cohesion. Religious activity is concerned to keep fragile human life on an even
keel; but it is not concerned, as is post-axial religion, with its radical transformation.42
40
Hick, J., God Has Many Names (Philadelphia: Westminster Press, 1980), 44f.
41
Otto, The Idea of the Holy, 133. Other citations provided earlier.
42
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 23.
171
While this may seem like a less derogatory characterization, it nevertheless restates Jaspers’
view that the Axial Age represents a spiritualization of religion, a world-historical “discovery
of transcendence”. As evidence for this, Hick cites the characterization of Australian
Aboriginal religion by W. E. H. Stanner, saying that “for the Australian aborigines there is
‘no notion of grace or redemption; no whisper of inner peace and reconcilement; no
problems of worldly life to be solved only by a consummation of history …’”.
43
Hick
implies that this is characteristic of all “pre-literate forms of religion”, some of which have
even “existed down to our own day in parts of Africa, the Americas, Indonesia, Australasia
and the Pacific Islands”.44 He also notes that this form of religion, which had a “basic
concern” for the “absence of change”, continued in the “national religions of the ancient
world”, albeit in “much more complex” ways.45 Citing Egypt and the Near East as other
examples of the “essentially conservative, rather than revolutionary, nature of the archaic
religious outlook”, he stresses that in pre-axial religion “There was no thought of
renouncing the goods of this life to realise a limitlessly better future”.46
To appreciate the full significance of these comments, let us return to the
“Criteriological” section of An Interpretation of Religion, where Hick discusses the criteria for
claiming the soteriological and ethical equivalence of the great traditions. Hick states that
“Within our pluralistic hypothesis salvation/liberation is defined as the transformation of
human existence from self-centredness to Reality-centredness”, and that behind all of the
world religions “there lies a soteriological concern”. This is in contrast to the way that pre-
43 Ibid., 24. Hick cites Stanner, W. E. H., “The Dreaming” in Cultures of the Pacific (ed. T. Harding & B.
Wallace; New York: Free Press, 1970 [1956]).
44
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 23.
45
Ibid., 24.
46
Ibid., 26.
172
axial religion is primarily about “keeping life on an even keel”.47 He can thus posit the
following:
[Because] the function of post-axial religion is to create contexts within which the
transformation from self-centredness to Reality-centredness can take place … the basic
criterion must be soteriological. Religious traditions and their various components –
beliefs, modes of experience, scriptures, rituals, ethics and lifestyles, social rules and
organisations – have greater or lesser value according as they promote or hinder the salvific
transformation.48
The implication is clearly that because pre-axial religions do not engage in the salvific
transformation, they rank qualitatively lower than the post-axial, soteriologically oriented
world religions. Thus, despite Hick’s concession that “no religious stigma is attached” to
not belonging to one of the soteriological world religions, his entire argument is in fact
predicated on a hierarchy in which “the great faiths of mankind” rank qualitatively higher
than all other religions, past and present.
To demonstrate further the way in which this hierarchal structure operates, particularly with
regard to small-scale oral cultures, I want to now highlight the way in which Hick’s
argument is based upon some of the major tropes of European discourse regarding the
“primitive”, non-civilizational other. Firstly, Hick conflates all pre-axial cultures throughout
history as being the same – from the distant stone age right through to the present day – via
a discursive mechanism that Johannes Fabian has called allochronism, or “the denial of
coevalness”. Fabian describes this as
a persistent and systematic tendency to place the referent(s) of anthropology in a Time
other than the present of the producer of anthropological discourse.49
47
Ibid., 303, 300.
48
Ibid., 300 (italics added).
Fabian, J., Time and the Other: How Anthropology Makes its Object (2nd ed.; New York: Columbia University
Press, 2002 [1983]), 31ff. As described in Matti Bunzl’s useful foreword to the new edition, Fabian’s work had
a major impact in shaping subsequent critical debates within anthropology.
49
173
This was a central feature of nineteenth-century anthropological discourse, as discussed
earlier with reference to Tylor and other founders of the field – particularly the way in
which they regarded even contemporary savages (usually called the “lower races”) as
specimens of paleolithic humanity.50 Fabian also describes how the denial of coevalness
turned from “an explicit concern” in Victorian anthropology, “into an implicit theoretical
assumption” in the twentieth century.51 As James Lewis has noted in an excellent critical
article on the problems associated with the world religions paradigm from a pedagogical
point of view, this trend is particularly evident in the portrayal of “African religions” in
surveys of world religions, especially those in world religions textbooks.52
The Axial Age paradigm is, I would argue, another classic example of the
allochronic tendency because of how its two chief taxonomic categories operate: post-axial
religions equate to the “world religions” or “the great faiths”; pre-axial cultures are
necessarily everything else. Therefore, pre-axial cultures are not only those that existed
before the 1st millennium BCE, but they are all cultures in which “the axial discovery of the
transcendent did not take place”, including those “pre-literate” religions that Hick notes
have “existed down to our own day”.53 In other words, any and all of the cultural traditions
that are not members of the elite world religions group are classed as pre-axial or non-axial
– even contemporary traditional, indigenous, and small-scale religions, all of which are
50 In addition to the discussion of Chapter 3, see also Tylor, E. B., “On The Tasmanians as Representatives of
Paleolithic Man”, The Journal of the Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 23 (1894): 141-152; and
“The Philosophy of Religion among the Lower Races of Mankind”, The Journal of the Ethnological Society of
London 2 (1870): 369-381.
51
Fabian, Time and the Other, 39.
52 Lewis notes several themes that recur throughout such textbooks: “the tendency of authors to (1)
emphasize sensationalistic items of information, (2) treat different religions unevenly, and (3) arrange religions
into implicit evolutionary hierarchies” (“Images of Traditional African Religion in Surveys of World
Religions”, 313).
53
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 23.
174
regarded in allochronic fashion as belonging to another time. It is precisely this sort of
clumsy taxonomic logic that J. Z. Smith so penetratingly took issue with in the comments
about what has “counted” as a world religion in western discourse, and the “residual”
categories that have been used to lump the rest together. As noted, this problem persists
even into the twenty-first century through the world religions textbook industry, where
temporal conflation is still a regular feature in the often awkward treatment of “traditional
religions” (recall also Murphy’s comments above about the way in which the Geist/Natur
binary still structures such textbooks).54
This is related to the second trope active in Hick’s argument, namely the notion of
primitive stasis. We have seen this play out in Hick and Jaspers’ conception of non-historical
cultures as static and immobile, and critics have long pointed out that this is another central
component of European discourse about the non-European other. As such critics have also
pointed out, the conception of these cultures as static – and its corollary that the west is
“progressive”, “dynamic” – was crucial in legitimating the European imperialist enterprise.55
This way of thinking thus maps on seamlessly to Hegel’s view that it is “historical” peoples
who are the agents of reason, the agents of change, the agents of Geist. This is an aspect of
Hegelian thinking that remains unchanged in Jaspers and Hick. Even though both of them
reject the developmental logic with regard to the relation between civilizational cultures,
they nevertheless view all “non-historical” cultures as trapped within the rhythms of nature
and unable to instigate meaningful, dynamic change through their own agency. Perhaps they
would reject this claim if faced with it explicitly, but this is the clear implication of the
argument.
54 As Masuzawa suggests of the numerous terms that have now taken the place of “primitive” to describe
small-scale oral cultures: “The restless shifting of appellations may be a measure of the discomfort felt by
contemporary scholars of religion in their effort not to appear condescending to those peoples who used to be
referred to as savages” (The Invention of World Religions, 4).
On the denial of historical agency to primitive peoples in western discourse, see Spurr, The Rhetoric of Empire,
98ff., 156-169.
55
175
Thirdly, this way of conceptualizing history means that religions and cultures are
ranked in a clear developmental, evolutionary hierarchy.56 The way in which this hierarchy worked
was outlined in the previous chapter when discussing Tylor and the presuppositions of
anthropology, as well as Tiele and the notion of development from natural religions to
ethical religions. Although it is certainly a legitimate analytic question to address the
differences between cultures possessing different levels of technological capacity and
different forms of political organization,57 the problem with the developmental view from a
postcolonial perspective is that, using the conceptual scaffolding of allochronism,
“traditional” non-urban peoples are effectively held to be fossils (“survivals”, in Tylor’s
parlance) from a much earlier stage in human history. Jaspers even noted how any traditions
that were not swept up in the transformations of the Axial Age remained “primitive” and
“continued to live that unhistorical life which had been going on for tens of thousands or
even hundreds of thousands of years”.58 Therefore, Homo axialis is held to be the fullest
representation of what it is to be human. Everything else is praeparatio, not yet having
entered, in Hegel’s words, “the theatre of history”.
Fourthly, the developmental logic has the corollary that primitive peoples (even
contemporary ones, in the allochronic view) represent “the childhood of the human race”.
This is the trope of infantilization.59 Hick uses this language in the quotation from 1980
supplied above (“at best childish forms of religion”); and even though that language is
sanitized in An Interpretation of Religion his basic perspective remains unchanged, suggesting
See Stocking, Victorian Anthropology; Spurr, The Rhetoric of Empire; and Lewis, “Images of Traditional African
Religion in Surveys of World Religions”.
56
One of the more notable recent examples of this is Jared Diamond, Guns, Germs, and Steel: The Fate of Human
Societies (New York: W. W. Norton & Co., 1999).
57
58
Jaspers, One the Origin and Goal of History, 7.
59 Spurr treats this in the chapter “Naturalization: The Wilderness in Human Form” (The Rhetoric of Empire,
156-169).
176
that “the Axial Age could even be seen as the fall of humanity from a state of religious
innocence”.60 As David Spurr discusses in detail, one of the primary functions of
infantilization was the justification that it provided for the paternalistic intervention of the
“civilizing” European powers.61
Fifth, the infantilization trope is also grounded in the view that non-civilizational
peoples are not only childlike, but they are irrational.62 In the ideology of progress, reason
was active in history in the same way as Geist: through the channel of the world historical
peoples. All those who reside outside of history, i.e. the Naturvölker, have therefore not
developed the faculties of reason. Obviously this is linked to other tropes such as the
notion of primitive stasis, which held that non-civilizational cultures remained within the
conditions of mere nature and had not achieved the “breakthrough” to self-reflexive
thought. Hick reproduces this idea in An Interpretation of Religion (recalling that, for him, the
Axial Age is more of a “spiritual” than a philosophical moment), saying that while the preaxial period did see occasional insights into the human condition, “in comparison with the
new insights of the Axial Age, which have shaped so much of the religious life of humanity
since, these seem like hillocks in comparison with great mountains”.63
60
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 28.
61
See Spurr’s chapter “Appropriation: Inheriting the Earth” (The Rhetoric of Empire, 28-42).
A good representative of the view that primitive thought was governed by “emotion” not “reason” is
Lucien Lévy-Bruhl, whose work sparked debates about “primitive rationality” that survived into the late
twentieth century. Without reviewing this important history, see Robin Horton, Patterns of Thought in Africa and
the West: Essays on Magic, Religion and Science (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1993), esp. chapter 3,
“Lévy-Bruhl, Durkheim and the Scientific Revolution” (63-104). See also Robert Segal, “Relativism and
Rationality in the Social Sciences: A Review Essay of Lucien Lévy-Bruhl’s How Natives Think”, in Religion and
the Social Sciences: Essays in the Confrontation (Atlanta: Scholars Press, 1989), 167-180.
62
63
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 35, n. 10.
177
The final troublesome trope reproduced in Hick’s argument is what I will call the
Hobbesian dystopia – the idea that “non-civilized” life is brutal, bloodthirsty, and unethical.64
The feral, barbarous nature of primitive culture has been a part of the European
ethnographic imagination for as long as ethnography has existed, and only intensified
during the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries. This maps onto the view, both Hegelian
and Victorian, that civilization – i.e. the State, an “objective rational structure” – is
necessary for the cultivation of ethics, to bring man out of his “natural” barbarous state.65
In Jaspers’ thought, this trope manifested itself in his view that through the shifts of the
Axial Age, “religion was rendered ethical”. For Hick, this transmutes into the fact that all
post-axial religions share “the common ethical ideal”, whereas pre-axial cultures were
devoid of true ethics. He even describes how “the archaic images of a blood-thirsty superpower who demands human and animal sacrifices is clearly morally defective” compared to
the compassionate ethics enshrined in the great traditions.66
The view of primitive culture as unethical has particularly important implications for
Hick’s classification of religions because of the role of the “ethical criterion” in his
evaluative ranking of the world’s religions – for he went to great lengths in arguing that “the
transformation of human existence which is called salvation or liberation shows itself in its
spiritual and moral fruits”; that “no one tradition stands out” as superior in this respect; and
As the classic quote runs, the lives of savages are “solitary, poor, nasty, brutish, and short. The savage
people in many places of America … live this day in that brutal manner” (cited in Hodgen, Early Anthropology,
206, n. 51).
64
I pass over here the important counter-discourse of the so-called “noble savage”, represented by figures
such as Montaigne and Rousseau, whose idealized constructions of early human life served as a rhetorical foil
in their contributions to social, political, and moral philosophy. See Spurr, The Rhetoric of Empire, 125-140. See
also Ter Ellington’s detailed study, The Myth of the Noble Savage (Berkeley: University of California Press, 2001).
65
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 339. On the revulsion with which “primitive” cultures were often regarded,
see Patrick Brantlinger, “Victorians and Africans: The Genealogy of the Myth of the Dark Continent”, Critical
Inquiry 12 (1985): 166-203. See also Spurr on the various rhetorical strategies of “debasement” that recur in
colonial discourse (The Rhetoric of Empire, 76-91).
66
178
that the moral parity of the great traditions is demonstrated by the fact that their doctrines
all embody the Golden Rule.67 Hick is emphatic about this, saying
It is not possible, as an unbiased judgment with which all rational persons could be
expected to agree, to assert the overall moral superiority of any one of the great
religious traditions of the world.68
But apparently, according to the logic of the argument, it is possible to assert the overall
moral superiority of the world religions over all “national” and “natural” pre-axial religions
– which we have seen Hick describe as “at best childish and at worst appallingly brutal and
bloodthirsty”, and whose vision of gods that demand human and animal sacrifice are
“clearly morally defective”.69 As such, the logic of Hegel and much of the nineteenth
century – the idea that ethics began with the “historical” religions – can still be seen in place
in the late twentieth century, even in arguments that were designed to overcome the
racialized structures of these discourses.
One could continue performing an inventory of colonial tropes about the non-European
other that are at play in both the world religions paradigm and arguments such as Hick’s.
But the six tropes just detailed are a good representation of that fact. They are all
interrelated, and they all intersect – e.g. primitives are unethical because they lack reason;
they lack reason because they lack civilization; they lack civilization because they are static
and their cultures do not change; and because they lack civilization they have no hope of
moral progress, leaving them in the savage, uncultivated world of the Hobbesian dystopia.
67
Ibid., 301.
68
Ibid., 337.
A similar implication follows from the somewhat selective way in which Hick applies his perspectivist
epistemology – for while he is at pains to stress that all religions are different, culturally conditioned responses
to the same divine reality (in the same way that there is no hierarchy of languages), it nevertheless turns out
that some culturally conditioned responses to Ultimate Reality are more equal than others.
69
179
All of this boils down to a view of the non-European other, especially the non-civilizational
other, that not only justified and legitimated the paternalistic intervention of European
powers, but even allowed them to construe their intervention as necessary.
It needs to be stressed that what is particularly problematic about this paradigm is
not simply the fact that it is grounded in racist views of the non-civilizational other that
have been used towards pernicious ends – but also, more importantly, the fact that those
negative views are based on empirically dubious assumptions about non-textual cultures. But before
justifying this claim, I want to highlight the other major problem with how Hick construes
his reading of religious history – the problem of what might be called flimsy idealism. As
demonstrated, the Axial Age is grounded in a thoroughly idealist view of history, which sees
the period as the dawning not just of history, but of authentic, self-reflexive consciousness
– it is the birth of Geist, the birth of reason, the birth of “Man as such”. But this view pays
absolutely no attention whatsoever to the material factors at play in the cultural
transformations of the period. Jaspers does at least give sociological factors a brief
consideration, but he quickly concludes that they “merely illuminate the facts and do not
provide a causal explanation of them”.70 Hick likewise does not give any consideration to
material factors, and simply makes comments such as: “in marked contrast to relatively
simple world-acceptance of pre-axial religion … in the axial age the human mind began to
stand back from its encompassing environment to become conscious of itself as a distinct
reality with its own possibilities”.71 Because no other factors are considered, the idea is that
it could be nothing but the dawning of authentic religious consciousness, the “breakthrough”
to a vision of transcendence.
70
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 18.
71
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, 32.
180
This way of looking at history therefore pays no attention to how the “worldrejecting” character of post-axial religion might be related to new tensions between various
social groups that arose within the emerging context of empire and urbanization, a context
that entailed drastically different existential pressures from life in non-urban situations. Nor
does it draw any attention to how the “critical”, “non-mythical” character of post-axial
thought might be understood differently by focusing on how the technology of writing
reshaped the dynamics of intellectual activity in large urban societies, leading to radically
different forms of engagement with inherited traditions.72
The fact that Hick pays no attention to the material causes of the Axial Age is
rendered even more problematic because of the fact that he does pay attention to important
contextual details when comparing the different character of some of the world religions –
such as in his detailed examination of how the substantial differences between the New
Testament and the Qur’an (particularly the much more extensive social and legal framework
presented in the latter) can be attributed to the different social contexts in which the texts
were produced.73 Hick also states elsewhere when discussing the issue of modernity that
to compare a West which has emerged from its medieval phase with an East which is
now only in the throes of emerging, attributing the wealth and productivity of the one
to Christianity and the poverty and economic backwardness of the other to Hinduism,
Buddhism and Islam, is to ignore the immensely important non-religious factors in
history.74
But where is an awareness of “the non-religious factors of human history” when it comes
to discussing the religious transformations of the 1st millennium BCE? It is a question that
does not even get raised, despite Hick’s concession that “the whole subject of the axial age,
See Jan Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age” in The Axial Age and its Consequences
(ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas; Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2012), 366-407. This is one of the central
points of focus in the following chapter.
72
73
See An Interpretation of Religion, 331ff.
74
Ibid., 329.
181
its causes, nature and consequences, is ripe for further investigation”.75 Here, at least, Hick
is correct, and Chapter 5 will explore some of the lines that this investigation might take.
However a few final words are in order.
The Discourse Made Him Do It
When all of the subtextual implications of this form of history are brought to the
foreground, Hick’s argument begins to look rather less pluralistic than he intended. His
theory was grounded in the belief that one had to take into account “the experience and
thought of the whole human race”. In both his work and his broader life, he denounced the
racist legacy of European thought and fought actively against manifestations of it in the
modern world. He was a proud proponent of inter-religious dialogue and inter-cultural
understanding, and dedicated his life to a global vision of social justice and faith in many
forms. Yet when the pluralist theory of religions is scrutinized properly, it is clearly based
upon a view of religious history that has its genesis in the racist cultural hierarchies of the
nineteenth century. Moreover, it is a theory that remains completely structured around
forms of religiosity that developed in textual, urban cultures – i.e. the post-axial cultures –
making these the normative form of religion and leaving all other cultural traditions on the
periphery. While the “great traditions” may represent a majority of human beings in recent
millennia, they represent a tiny minority of the ideational communities that have existed
throughout human history. This represents too great a tension for someone with such a
clearly stated global vision.
Why then did Hick articulate a comprehensive theory of religion that reinforced the
racially-based Eurocentric narrative of world history that he was trying to overcome, a
75
Ibid., 31.
182
narrative whose implications are completely counter to the ethos of his life and work? The
answer I have been suggesting throughout this analysis is: the discourse made him do it. The
intellectual formations inherited by Hick – his great-traditions-centrism, the developmental
view of world history, non-civilizational cultures as static and unethical – all of these
inherited formations caused him to think this way, and made his theory seem like an
unproblematic and even egalitarian reading of history. This is a perfect example of how
discourse works, which Foucault describes as diffuse, interlocking systems of representation
that “impose on an author, without his realizing it, postulates, operational schemata,
linguistic rules, [and sets] of affirmations and fundamental beliefs”, and which therefore
structure thought below the level of explicit awareness.76
To emphasize this, I pose the question: Would Hick, a man deeply committed to
inter-religious dialogue, have made the same comment about the childish and bloodthirsty
nature of pre-axial religions – would he have given that same reading of history – had he
been speaking to an audience of indigenous Australians? It is an open question, but I
suspect that he would be following many other contemporary pluralists who are now
championing the cause of indigenous religions. I refer again to the example of Huston
Smith that was discussed earlier – and this is a good point to at which to elaborate Smith’s
comments a little, because they effectively confirm my contention about why Hick
articulated ideas so contrary to the broader message he was advocating.
In discussing his appearance at the 1999 World’s Parliament of Religions with the
American Indian delegation, Smith said
The Parliament vividly brought back to me a string of memories relating to my
discovery of the place of Native Americans (and through them indigenous religions
generally) in the history of religions. The discovery took place during the 1970s, the
decade when I taught at Syracuse University, in upstate New York. When I accepted
Foucault, M., The Archaeology of Knowledge and the Discourse on Language (trans. A. M. Sheridan Smith; New
York: Pantheon Book, 1972), 150.
76
183
the invitation to teach there I didn’t even know that the Onondaga Reservation is only
five miles from the university. As the decade progressed, I found myself spending
more and more of my weekends hanging out with the chiefs. Up until then I had
dismissed the whole family of indigenous religions—namely, the tribal and the oral—
as unimportant.77
After recounting a number of specific encounters that caused him to revise his old
perspectives on oral cultures, Smith explains that
these moments, along with innumerable others, were major factors in inducing me to
bring out a second edition of my book The World’s Religions. So thirty-five years after
the first edition had appeared, I added a chapter about the primal religions, making it
eight, instead of seven, religions covered in the book [notice the allochronic principle
here]. There are still other important religions, such as Sikhism and Shinto, not
included, but I didn’t want to make the book just a catalog. I wanted to provide space
to go more deeply. I knew I had to do that because the religions I had dealt with in the
first edition were all part of the field we call “historical religions,” which have sacred
text and histories recorded in writing. But these religions are only the tip of the iceberg.
They are only about four thousand years old, whereas the primal, tribal, oral religions
can be traced back archeologically into the twilight zone of prehistory, perhaps forty or
fifty thousand years ago. To omit them from the first edition of my book was
inexcusable, and I am glad I will not go to my grave with that mistake uncorrected.
The added chapter honors the primal religions as fully equal to the historical ones.78
I leave to the side for now Smith’s allochronic conflation of all indigenous religion as
“primal” religion, and also the way in which his declaration that primal religions are “fully
equal” to historical religions is an assertion made without any historical or theoretical
justification. These issues will be revisited in the Conclusion.
Instead, I want to focus on a comment that has salience with regard to Hick and my
contention that the discourse made him do it. The comment comes when Smith reflects on
why he formerly dismissed indigenous religions as unimportant:
I blame my teachers for this, for they dismissed them. After all, they said, they can’t (or
until recently couldn’t) even write, so what did they know? I was young and
Smith, A Seat At The Table: Huston Smith in Conversation with Native Americans on Religious Freedom (Berkeley &
Los Angeles: University of California Press, 2006), 2.
77
78
Ibid., 4.
184
impressionable. I simply accepted what they said until my Onondaga friends set me
straight, and I will never be able to adequately repay the gift they gave me.
… I was taught that tribal religions were “primitive,” with a pejorative [sic] built
solidly into that word. I went into the first fifty-five years of my teaching with that
prejudice instilled in me. Students are young and impressionable; they just believe what
their teachers tell them. Great danger! I might have stayed in that mode if I hadn’t
moved to Syracuse. Those ten years in the shade of the Onondaga Reservation
absolutely transformed my view of indigenous religions.79
This is as clear an admission as possible that Smith did not actively devalue oral cultures, but
that his inherited discourse was structured by these assumptions. This is why such racially based
tropes remained invisible, which is precisely the case with Hick. It is also, incidentally,
another example that supports the claim I made in Chapter 1 that theological pluralism has
typically been the result of actual encounters with other traditions, and that its positive
affirmations are almost invariably attempts to explain a perceived sense of unity. In other
words, Smith’s positive valuation of indigenous traditions came about in the same way that
Hick was led to developing the pluralistic hypothesis.
As mentioned earlier, Hick never faced the same pressure to address the question of
indigenous traditions. But it seems impossible to me that, faced with comments such as
those made by Huston Smith, Hick would have continued to assert that Smith was wrong,
and that “primal” religions were in fact magical, bloodthirsty, and irrational.80
Yet if this is the case, then the whole Axial Age narrative breaks down, because the
concession that indigenous traditions are “fully equal” with the historical traditions
effectively removes the qualitative distinction between axial religions and non-axial
79 Ibid., 2, 5. This is an interesting reversal of the traditional academic gesture of thanking others while taking
full responsibility for one’s conclusions, and a fascinating admission for the discourse-analyst to chew on.
80 I have not so far discussed the term “primal” religion. Briefly, it gained currency around the 1970s as
“primitive” was finally cast aside (although cf. the way it lingered into the 1960s with Evans-Pritchard’s
Theories of Primitive Religion). It became standard until the end of the twentieth century, and appeared in
textbooks, university curricula, as well as academic works. It has since been superseded by “indigenous”. On
this history, see Cox, From Primitive to Indigenous, 22-26. The most recent work I am aware of to use this term in
a sustained manner is Arvind Sharma, A Primal Perspective on the Philosophy of Religion (Dordrecht: Springer,
2006). Although Sharma opens with a detailed justification for his use of the term (1-4), few scholars seem to
have followed him recently. “Indigenous” is in the discursive ascendency at present.
185
religions. Therefore while this leaves all traditions in a position of parity, it also becomes a
view that is unsupported by any historical metanarrative. In other words, whilst it is an
admirable sentiment to place all religions on the same footing, this is usually done without
any theoretical or historical justification, and it therefore remains fundamentally at odds
with the critical standards elsewhere advocated by people such as Jaspers, Hick, and Smith.
But before closing this chapter and addressing those concerns, let me reiterate that I am not
accusing Hick of racism. Rather, I am charging that his argument reproduces racist
discourse, and is untenable as such. These are different accusations, and it is important to
maintain a distinction. By focusing on the fact that it is the discourse that is the problem, a
productive new set of questions arise. Most pressingly: what happens to the emplotment of
the 1st millennium BCE when the key ideological and rhetorical components of the Axial
Age narrative have been rejected? What kind of metanarrative might be developed that
could plausibly account for their emergence in ways that are not predicated on the racist
hierarchies of the nineteenth century? There is no question that the 1st millennium BCE
represents a fascinating and transformative time in human history, and that it is a rich
ground for comparative historical study. The problem is the way that the events of the
period have traditionally been emplotted, i.e. within an idealist and developmental framework
that is no longer tenable. It is untenable at a moral level because its representation of the
non-European and non-civilizational other remains grounded in the racist tropes of the
nineteenth century; and it is untenable at the methodological and empirical level because it
is based upon a textocentric paradigm of historiography that operates with spurious and
demonstrably false assumptions about the character of non-urban, non-textual human
communities.
186
While my contention at the end of this dissertation will be that this problem seems
insurmountable as long as one remains within the framework of theological essentialism –
even if it is expanded well beyond the great-traditions-centrism of someone like Hick – this
will only be possible after discussing how the 1st millennium BCE might be viewed
differently using some of the new evolutionary perspectives on human history that have
been developed in recent decades.
187
Chapter 5
Beyond the Great Traditions:
Towards a Redescription of the Axial Age
The main concern of this study has been to demonstrate the way that John Hick’s theory of
religion is grounded in a view of history that perpetuates the intellectual legacy of the
nineteenth century despite his clear intention to the contrary. To recap, the main problems
with the Axial Age construct are (1) that it operates with an outdated methodological divide
between history and prehistory, equating “culture” and “religion” only with literate, urban
societies; and (2) that it is correspondingly structured by a number of tropes regarding the
non-European other that have their root in nineteenth-century race theory, in justifications
of imperialism, and in other notions of European exceptionalism. These problems run
counter (a) to Hick’s methodological concern to include “the whole human race”; and (b) to
his ethical concern to overcome the racist legacy of European thought. A further charge
was that reading of history underpinning the Axial Age is guilty of what I termed “flimsy
idealism”, whereby material factors are neglected as agents of historical change. Jaspers even
says that the period “is in the nature of a miracle, in so far as no really adequate explanation
is possible within the limits of our present knowledge”.1
Yet as indicated at the outset, the aim of this dissertation is not to be merely
deconstructive. If Hick and Jaspers’ reading of humanity’s religious history is untenable,
then surely alternative explanatory paradigms must be suggested. But throughout the last
chapter, the forms of representation inherent in the Axial Age construct were simply taken
for granted as problematic in relation to contemporary historiographical standards. In this
chapter, I want to make clear why the traditional reading of the 1st millennium BCE is so
problematic in relation to these standards. Not only will this allow for suggestions at the
1
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 18.
189
end of the chapter about possible ways of redescribing the transformations of the period,
but the issues covered will also leave the discussion well placed to return to theological
pluralism in the Conclusion and argue that not just the Axial Age, but any form of historical
emplotment predicated on theological essentialism is almost impossible to maintain in
relation to the basic facts about long-term human history that have been established in
recent decades.
I work towards this goal in three sections, tracking several different trajectories that
outline how the “written record” view of history has been superseded in western historical
discourse since the mid-twentieth century. The first section focuses on movements in social
history and critical theory that demoted written documents to merely one type of source
material, including the development of discourse-analytical forms of historiography that
brought to the foreground the political nature of all of narrative emplotment. The second
section focuses the array of intellectual, archaeological, and scientific developments that
eroded the old conceptual barrier between “history” and “prehistory” and have thus recast
human history into a much larger evolutionary framework. I will be particularly concerned
to highlight the new agenda of what has variously been called “big” or “deep” history,
which bring these developments together in an attempt to formalize a new historiographical
paradigm for treating human history in the long-term view – again, surely something that is
necessary for anybody today genuinely concerned to treat “the experience and thought of
the whole human race”. The third section then explores developments in what I am calling
“communications history”, particularly focusing on scholarship that can help to
reconceptualize the differences traditionally held to exist between large urban societies and
smaller oral cultures. The reader is reminded that the discussion will range quite widely
before returning to the Axial Age, but the final section brings focus squarely back to this
question in order to make explicit why the tropes of the Axial Age are intellectually
190
indefensible, and to suggest some of the redescriptions of the 1st millennium BCE that are
implied by this critique.
The Demotion of the Document
A lot has been said in this work about the “textocentric”, “documentary”, or “civilizational”
mode of historiography. As discussed in Chapter 3, texts were the central component of the
European philological enterprise and its construction of western knowledge about nonEuropean religions, with forms of religion that had produced written documents being
regarded as qualitatively higher than those that had not – something for example reflected
in the hierarchy of “ethical” religions (Müller’s “aristocracy of the book religions”), over
“natural” and “national” religions. Chapter 4 further showed how this played out in Karl
Jaspers’ conceptualization of the 1st millennium BCE, for which he used a paradigm that
explicitly equated the birth of history with the birth of writing, thus perpetuating the view
that religions having produced large textual corpora were more “authentic” manifestations
of “religion” than the cultural products of oral societies.
Whilst Hegel represented an idealist trajectory that had a primarily philosophical
orientation, a positivist current also developed in Germany that sought to cast history as a
“scientific” discipline. The paragon of positivist documentary historiography was Leopold
von Ranke, whose argument that history must be a discipline constituted exclusively by
textual analysis was extremely influential in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries.2 Ranke
2 In what follows I have largely employed the helpful survey of Elizabeth Clark, History, Theory, Text: Historians
and the Linguistic Turn (Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2004). On Ranke and the tradition of
historical objectivism in the twentieth century, see 9-28. See also Peter Novick, That Noble Dream: The
“Objectivity Question” and the American Historical Profession (Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1988); and
Leopold von Ranke and the Shaping of the Historical Discipline (ed. G. Iggers & J. Powell; Syracuse: Syracuse
University Press, 1990).
191
believed that the historian had to “extinguish himself” before “the facts” in order to arrive
an objective, factual, and even scientific account of the past, and has long been (in)famous
for his assertion that the historian’s task was bloß zu zeigen, wie es eigentlich gewesen – “simply to
show how it really was”.3 Whilst not all scholars in his wake were so naïve with regard to
the role of interpretation in historical writing (though many of them were), virtually every
professional historian who followed him agreed with the methodological dictum that “no
documents, no history”.4 For Ranke, this meant that prehistory was not “real” history, and
he regarded forms of history from India and China as only marginally better.5 Rankean
documentary history is thus clearly (and unsurprisingly) predicated on the same logic as
Hegel, one that denied “culture” – and indeed any form of meaningful historical agency –
to all societies that had not risen to sufficient levels of political, philosophical, and
technological complexity. This was obviously related to the tropes discussed in the previous
chapter, particularly the notion of non-civilizational stasis and the view that it was modern
European cultures (with their roots in classical Greece) who were the true, dynamic “agents
of history”.
Whilst many of these presuppositions dominated professional historiography until
well into the twentieth century (and their vestiges are by no means entirely gone even in the
twenty-first), the documentary view of history received its first serious challenge with the
emergence of the Annales school in France. Initiated by Marc Bloch and Lucien Febvre in
1929, the Annalistes adopted a macrohistorical focus that focused both on human affairs as
3 Ranke, L., History of the Latin and Teutonic Nations, 1494-1514 (trans. G. R. Dennis; London: G. Bell, 1915
[1824]), vii. On Ranke’s “realism”, see Hayden White, Metahistory: The Historical Imagination in Nineteenth-Century
Europe (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1973), 163-190.
4 See Clark, History, Theory, Text, 10. For a similar (but more polemical) discussion of Ranke and documentary
history, see Daniel Lord Smail, On Deep History and the Brain (Berkeley: University of California Press, 2008),
45ff.
5
Clark, History, Theory, Text, 198, n. 6.
192
well as “deeper” phenomena shaping the flow of history, particularly environmental ones.6
In explicit contrast to the regnant positivist view that the historian should “submit” to the
documents, Febvre claimed that “There is no history; there are only historians”, anticipating
one of the major critical concerns of later generations.7 The Annalistes also rejected what
they saw as “event history” – war, politics, and the pursuits of great men – in favour of a
model that was concerned with long-term social, economic, and environmental trajectories.
This is what Fernard Braudel famously called la longue durée.8 A final salient feature was the
determined interdisciplinarity of Annales scholarship: unlike documentary historiography,
whose domain was textual artefacts alone, the Annalistes drew on a wide variety of
resources, from the social sciences to archaeology to the natural sciences. This was another
movement that prefigured the reconstruction of the disciplinary boundaries of professional
historiography in the late twentieth century.
Whilst these developments were taking place in France, Anglophone historiography
underwent a similarly substantive set of transformations beginning in the 1960s. British
Marxist historians began the movement by championing a form of “history from below”,
where the “below” was firmly centred around class struggle, power, and questions of
human agency.9 The most famous work produced in this context was E. P. Thompson’s The
Making of the English Working Class (1963), which proved a catalyst for subsequent
generations of leftist historians.10 As feminist critique also gained pace in academic
Bloch, M. & Febvre, L., “La Vie scientifique: sur les routes de l’entr’aide”, Annales d’histoire économique et social
9 (1937): 75-76 (cited in Clark, History, Theory, Text, 235, n. 19).
6
7
See Clark, History, Theory, Text, 65ff.
Braudel, F., “History and the Social Sciences: the Longue Durée” (1958; cited in Clark, History, Theory, Text,
236, n. 27).
8
9
Clark, History, Theory, Text, 79.
10 Ibid., 80 (see 246, n. 161 for the impact of the work). See E. P. Thompson, The Making of the English Working
Class (rev. ed.; Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1980 [1963]).
193
discourse, challenges to androcentric and textocentric modes of historiography became
louder. Feminist critics called to attention, among other things, the way in which the sexism
and gender hierarchies of European society had their counterpart in the near-total
relegation of women from western historiographical attention. In a manner somewhat
analogous to how civilizational cultures were held to be the agents of history while primitive
cultures were trapped in the cycles of “mere nature”, so too were men held to be the
rational, guiding agents of history while women were equated with irrationality and
unchanging, biological patterns.11
Social historians also joined the critical clamour, represented especially by works
such as Eric Wolf’s Europe and the People Without History (1982) and Peter Burke’s Popular
Culture in Early Modern Europe (1978).12 Both Wolf and Burke were explicit about the fact
that the peoples they sought to integrate into European history were the peoples who were
traditionally the province of anthropology or folklorists, and that these projects “emerged
from the intellectual reassessments that marked the late 1960s”.13 Wolf sums up the agenda
of the times well:
Such rethinking must transcend the customary ways of depicting Western history, and
must take account of the conjoint participation of Western and non-Western peoples
in this worldwide process. Most of the groups studied by anthropologists have long
been caught up in the changes wrought by European expansion, and they have
contributed to these changes. We can no longer be content with writing only the
history of victorious elites, or with detailing the subjugation of dominated ethnic
groups. Social historians and historical sociologists have shown that the common
people were as much agents in the historical process as they were its victims and silent
witnesses. We thus need to uncover the history of “the people without history”––the
11 See the detailed discussion in Josine Blok, “Sexual Asymmetry: A Historiographical Essay” in Sexual
Asymmetry: Studies in Ancient Society (ed. J. Blok & P. Mason; Amsterdam: G. C. Gießen, 1987), 1-57.
12 Burke, P., Popular Culture in Early Modern Europe (rev. ed.; Aldershot: Scolar Press, 1994 [1978]); Wolf, E.,
Europe and the People without History (2nd ed.; Berkeley: University of California Press, 1997 [1982]). Wolf in
particular stands in the tradition of Marxist historiography, although he distinguishes his approach as
“Marxian” rather than strictly “Marxist”, wisely wishing to draw a line between “the analyst and the prophet”
(xi).
13
Ibid., xvi.
194
active histories of “primitives,” peasantries, laborers, immigrants, and besieged
minorities.14
The intellectual reassessments of the 1960s also generated new streams of critical theory
that came in the wake of French structuralism, i.e. the cluster of theoretical trends generally
grouped under the rubric of post-structuralism. The most important figures, as far as
historiography was concerned, were Roland Barthes, Hayden White, and Michel Foucault.
Many of the early debates were about the nature of narrative in historical writing. Since
Ranke, objectivist historians rejected the notion that history could be equated with literature
or narrative, being instead the presentation of “facts” rather than a form of literary artifice.
Since structuralism, however, thinkers like Paul Ricoeur acknowledged the important
differences between history and literature, but stressed that emplotment in historical writing
was nonetheless based upon the chronological and episodic form of narrative.15 Critics
further stressed that narrative was not a “neutral” form, but an always ideologically
freighted device for imposing continuity on fragmentary images of the past. Barthes
addressed these issues in a famous essay of 1967 called “The Discourse of History”, where
he critiqued the problem of historians thinking that they were innocent of interpretation,
such that history “seems to be telling itself all on its own”.16
Hayden White describes Barthes’ project as “nothing less than the dismantling of
the whole heritage of nineteenth-century ‘realism’”, something towards which White also
exerted considerable effort.17 Influenced heavily by structuralism and literary theory, White
argued that every historical narrative presupposes a full-blown philosophy of history. Given
14
Ibid., xv-xvi.
15
On “narrative and history”, see Clark, History, Theory, Text, 86-105.
16
Barthes, R., “The Discourse of History” (1967), cited in Clark, History, Theory, Text, 257, n. 82.
17
Ibid., 97.
195
the inherently fragmentary nature of source material, historians always operate with
metahistorical presuppositions and varying strategies of “explanation, emplotment, and
ideological implication” in order to create narratives that make sense of the fragments of
the past.18 These strategies, whether conscious or not, shape the narrative from start to
finish. The historian’s interpretation always involves a “web of commitments”, the use of an
“explanatory paradigm”, and an ethical choice about how to draw out a narrative’s
ideological implications.19 White thus insisted that all historical writing “entails ontological
and epistemic choices with distinct ideological and even specifically political implications”,
and that correspondingly there is no “politically innocent historiography”.20 Frank
Ankersmit offers a good summary of White’s goal, one that also addresses the oftenlevelled charge of relativism:
Precisely by focusing on and by problematizing the historian’s language, White
demonstrates not the impossibility of getting hold of past reality, but the naivete of the
kind of positivist intuition customarily cherished in the discipline for how to achieve
this goal.21
This paradigm shift towards greater representational self-reflexivity was propelled with even
greater influence by Foucault. Foucault not only continued to focus on the way in which
power pervaded all forms of discourse, but as Elizabeth Clark describes, his “challenge to
the presumed ‘naturalness’ of such concepts of madness and sexuality has been of signal
importance to the reconceptualization of history”.22 Foucauldian scholar Paul Rabinow
provides a good articulation of the commitments that such historicization entails:
18
White, Metahistory, 431.
White, H., “Interpretation in History” in The Tropics of Discourse: Essays in Cultural Criticism (Baltimore: Johns
Hopkins University Press, 1978), 51-80, here 69-71.
19
20
See Clark, History, Theory, Text, 103 (262, nn. 147f.).
21
See Ibid., 101.
22
Ibid., 117.
196
We need to anthropologize the West: show how exotic its constitution of reality has
been; emphasize those domains most taken for granted as universal (this includes
epistemology and economics); make them seem as historically peculiar as possible;
show how their claims to truth are linked to social practices and have hence become
effective forces in the social world … we must pluralize and diversity our approaches
[and] avoid the error of reverse essentializing; Occidentalism is not a remedy for
Orientalism.23
Aside from sexuality and madness, Foucault also pronounced “the death of man”, by which
he meant that the human sciences had never discovered a “human essence”.24 This is an
important issue when considering the problems with the Axial Age idea, and I will suggest
later that it can be bolstered by perspectives from the new evolutionary view of human
history.
In the midst of these theoretical developments, the publication of Edward Said’s
Orientalism in 1979 heralded the start of the postcolonial turn.25 Said explicitly acknowledged
his debt to Foucault’s notion of discourse analysis at the start of Orientalism, and thereby
expanded the gaze of critical theory to the rhetorical strategies employed by western
discourse in its construction of the non-European other. This has led to a call similar to the
one Wolf made about the peoples without history, although this time with a more global
focus on the manifold groups that had been marginalized throughout western history, both
politically and discursively.26
23 Cited in Richard King, Orientalism and Religion: Postcolonial Theory, India, and ‘The Mythic East’ (London:
Routledge, 1999), 5 (219, n. 3).
24 Foucault made these comments in a 1978 interview, translated as “Adorno, Horkheimer, and Marcuse: Who
Is a ‘Negator of history’?” (see Clark, History, Theory, Text, 116 [273, n. 99]).
25
Said, E., Orientalism (2nd ed.; New York: Vintage Books, 2003 [1978]). See 3 for his debt to Foucault.
Two of the more influential recent works in postcolonial studies are Dipesh Chakrabarty, Provincializing
Europe: Postcolonial Thought and Historical Difference (2nd ed.; New Jersey: Princeton University Press, 2007 [2000]);
and Mary-Louise Pratt, Imperial Eyes: Travel Writing and Transculturation (2nd ed.; London: Routledge, 2008
[1992]). See also King, Beyond Orientalism, 187-218.
26
197
The Changing Shape of Prehistory
These developments alone are enough to call the textocentric logic of the Axial Age into
serious question, but there have been other important intellectual transformations in recent
times that are necessary to take account of in such a critique, especially the complete
reconfiguration of the notion of “prehistory” in western imagination. Colin Renfrew writes
that:
Two centuries ago, prehistory did not exist … the very notion of ‘prehistory’, in the
sense of a broad stretch of time going back before the dawn of written history, had not
been formulated. There was absolutely no notion that the human past involved tens of
thousands of years of development and change.27
In what follows, I want to provide an outline of how that view has changed in the last two
centuries, concluding with a discussion of the new intellectual paradigms of the most recent
decade that have arisen to make sense of human history within the vast framework of
evolutionary history.
As discussed earlier, until the mid-nineteenth century the European historical
imagination was structured by a biblical perspective on the age of the world. A few major
changes had taken place, especially the shift to a heliocentric cosmology and the
development of a genuinely planetary consciousness that began after the fifteenth century.
But regarding the reach of human history beyond written records, the very idea was
inconceivable. Even Ranke’s pronouncement that with no documents there could be no
history was not just a denial of historical agency to non-civilizational cultures, but was
grounded in the belief that the period before written history was completely unknowable.
However, archaeological finds had begun surfacing in the eighteenth century which
strongly suggested that humans had at the very least existed for tens of thousands of years,
27
Renfrew, C., Prehistory: The Making of the Human Mind (London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 2007), 3.
198
such as the discovery by John Frere in 1797 of flint implements that were twelve feet below
the ground and associated with the bones of extinct animals.28 In the same period,
geological studies had also begun to formulate the notion of a long-term, gradual
environmental history that stretched far beyond the biblical framework, with James
Hutton’s Theory of the Earth; or an Investigation of the Laws Observable in the Composition,
Dissolution and Restoration of Land Upon the Globe (1785) being one of the earliest works to
scientifically dismiss the idea of the Deluge in favour of a model which posited a much
longer process according to laws that were “natural to the globe”.29 This gradualist
approach found its culmination half a century later with Charles Lyell’s groundbreaking
Principles of Geology, Being an Attempt to Explain the Former Changes of the Earth’s Surface by
Reference to Causes Now in Action (1830-33), one of the first works to argue that the world was
at least 300 millions years old.30
As discussed in Chapter 3, the year 1859 was a watershed for European views about
human history. The growing archaeological record was confirming for a growing number of
scholars that humans had existed for much longer than previously thought, and in that year
papers were delivered to both the Royal Society and the London Society of Antiquities that
argued for the “Antiquity of Man” – a view that received general acceptance, establishing
what would soon be called “prehistory” as a legitimate field of intellectual inquiry.31
Ibid., 9-10. In addition to Renfrew, a useful discussion of pre-nineteenth-century understandings of the
biological history of humans, see Andre Leroi-Gourhan, Gesture and Speech (trans. A. B. Berger; Cambridge,
MA: The MIT Press, 1993 [1964]), 6-13.
28
29
Cited in Renfrew, Prehistory, 8.
Lyell, C., Principles of Geology, Being an Attempt to Explain the Former Changes of the Earth’s Surface by Reference to
Causes Now in Action (3 vols; London: John Murray, 1830-33). The work was a major influence on Darwin, and
went through no less than 12 editions (the last published in 1875).
30
Ibid., 10. The phrase “the antiquity of man” had wide currency in the mid-nineteenth century, and appears
for example in the works of Tylor, Lubbock, and Lyell. For a good summary of these developments, see
Kippenberg, Discovering Religious History in the Modern Age (trans. B. Harshav; New Jersey: Princeton University
Press, 2002), 29-35.
31
199
In the same year came Darwin’s epochal On the Origin of Species, which for the first
time made possible a coherent narrative of human history that could be fit within the new
scientific paradigm established by Lyell and Hutton – allowing that human history, just like
geological history, could be explained with reference to uniform natural laws of
development and change. Darwin soon followed On the Origin of Species with a work that
explicitly dealt with the human trajectory of natural selection, namely his 1871 work The
Descent of Man.32
However, Darwin was by no means the only scholar to begin rethinking the long
trajectory of human history, and a new industry arose around the question. The most
important work was John Lubbock’s Prehistoric Times (the work that first popularized the
term “prehistory”), which sought “to elucidate, as far as possible, the principles of
prehistoric archaeology; laying special stress upon the indications which it affords of the
conditions of man in primeval times”.33 Similar works were also produced shortly thereafter,
two of the most notable being E. B. Tylor’s Primitive Culture and Lewis Henry Morgan’s
Ancient Society, whose importance was also documented in Chapter 3. Whilst all of these
works had an almost exclusively European focus and posited a far-too-linear model of the
trajectory from savagery, through barbarism, to civilization, they nevertheless completely
recast the study of human history – which now included theoretically the entirety of the
species, past and present, rather than simply urban cultures that had produced written
32 Darwin, C., The Origin of Species by Means of Natural Selection (London: John Murray, 1859); and The Descent of
Man, and Selection in Relation Sex (London: John Murray, 1871). Darwin was given a copy of Lyell’s Principles of
Geology by the captain of the Beagle. It formed the basis for his thoughts about biological evolution, and he
famously described how he saw the earth “through Lyell’s eyes” on his global journeys. See Janet Brown,
Charles Darwin: A Biography. Volume 1: Voyaging (2 vols; New Jersey: Princeton University Press, 1995-2003), 1:
183-190.
33 Lubbock, J., Prehistoric Times, as Illustrated by Ancient Remains and the Manners and Customs of Modern Savages
(Edinburgh: Williams & Norgate, 1865), vi. This was also one of the first works to split the deep human past
into “paleolithic” and “neolithic” stages (see Renfrew, Prehistory, 12f.).
200
documents (the strict disciplinary separation between philology and anthropology
notwithstanding).
These paradigm shifts inaugurated a new phase of archaeological work in which the
early history of European culture and other civilizational societies were areas of intense
industry, often undertaken within an explicit Marxian (i.e. materialist) framework.34 Such
research quickly established a rich database of information, even though most work was still
undertaken with a narrowly regional focus rather than a global or systematic one. One
scholar who did begin to piece together a more general overview (though still only of
Europe) was the industrious archaeologist V. Gordon Childe, whose work The Dawn of
European Civilisation (1925) provided the first integrated perspective for the neolithic and
bronze ages of Europe, which “was to form the basis of the accepted view of European
prehistory for the next forty years”.35 Childe was also one of the first scholars to explore in
detail both the “neolithic revolution” and the “urban revolution”, and the consequences of
these massive shifts in human culture.
Despite these advances, the focus was still very much on neolithic archaeology, with
paleolithic researches being little pursued outside of France and hardly integrated into the
wider corpus of archaeological theory.36 As such, Renfrew has argued that “It seems fair to
say that, over much of the period from the revelations of 1859 until the aftermath of the
Second World War around 1950, archaeological theory did not develop very far”, and that it
is possible to think of this as “the long sleep of archaeological theory, with little radical
34 Renfrew provides a brief discussion of the influence of Marx and Engels in the study of prehistory in the
early twentieth century, particularly in Soviet Russia (Prehistory, 34f.). Engels’ work The Origins of the Family,
Private Property, and the State (1884) was, in turn, heavily influenced by Lewis Henry Morgan’s Ancient Society :
Researches in the Lines of Human Progress from Savagery through Barbarism to Civilization (New York: Holt, 1877).
Renfrew, Prehistory, 33. Renfrew notes that Childe was also heavily influenced by Marxist views of early
human history.
35
36
On the French origins of paleolithic archaeology, see ibid., 17f., and Leroi-Gourhan, Gesture and Speech, 9-18.
201
nature of the discussion of prehistory”.37 One of the major problems of this period was that
despite the mass of detailed archaeological findings, the theory of human cultural
development still revolved broadly around a nineteenth-century theory of cultural
“diffusion” which had by no means accepted – or even seriously considered, in many cases
– the view that human history began in Africa, instead operating with nineteenth-century
notions of a diffusion of culture “from the light of the East” (ex Oriente lux), which Childe
described as “the irradiation of European barbarism by Oriental civilisation”.38
Another major problem was that despite the growing fossil record, which now
included human remains from Africa, Europe, and Asia, there was no method of absolute
dating, and thus no chance of asserting the priority of any single location as the “origin” of
the human species. Yet the second half of the twentieth century saw massive changes in the
conception of prehistory, which were initially underpinned by the so-called “radiocarbon
revolution”.39 As Renfrew describes, the development of radiometric dating methods,
especially radiocarbon dating, allowed the construction of an absolute (rather than relative)
chronology of prehistory for every part of the world, thereby opening up a completely new
form of world prehistory that could finally move out of its geographically constrained focus
on single regions. This necessitated the rewriting of global prehistory by totally reworking
older views about the cultural diffusion of “civilized culture”, with early recognitions being
that the megalithic structures of northern Europe were far older even that the Egyptian
37
Renfrew, Prehistory, 37.
38
Ibid., 32, 33.
Ibid., 41-52. Renfrew had earlier published one of the first works to popularize the results of radicarbon
dating in Before Civilization: The Radiocarbon Revolution and Prehistoric Europe (London: Jonathan Cape, 1973).
David Christian has more recently referred to this as the “chronometric revolution”; see e.g. “The Return of
Universal History”, History and Theory, 49 (2010): 6-27, here 17 (see 18 for other methods that enable dating
beyond the 50,000 year range of radiocarbon analysis). For elaboration of the issues, see Christian, D., Maps of
Time: An Introduction to Big History (Berkeley: University of California Press, 2004), 65-67, 494-495.
39
202
pyramids, and that metallurgy had been practised for at least 6000 years, often outside
“major” urban centres.40
New methodologies in the physical sciences also arose that complemented these
dating techniques, such as paleoethnobiology (the study of plant remains) and
archaeozoology (the study of animal remains), as well as important methods of climate
science that greatly expanded upon the work of geological work of Lyell and pushed
environmental history into its current scale of hundreds of millions of years. Not only have
these established absolute dates for the age of earth and a typology of the various
environmental epochs of the world, but even this framework has now been expanded to
place the natural history of the earth into a much longer cosmological story beginning
roughly 14 billion years ago (a story I will not delve into here).41 As Renfrew notes, these
advances in geological knowledge all provided “an indispensible background to the study of
human activity during the paleolithic period, when climatic conditions were key
determinants for the human population”.42
The first work to use the new insights of radiocarbon dating at a systematic, global
level came in 1961 with Graham Clarke’s World Prehistory: An Outline.43 Clarke offered the
first synthesis that included not only the traditional regions of archaeological inquiry, but he
also brought regions such as south-east Asia and the Pacific into his global survey. Yet this
new paradigm threw up difficult questions of its own, especially regarding the longer-term
history of the species Homo sapiens – particularly the question of human origins, something
that could not be sufficiently understood with only the use of radiometric dating
40
See Renfrew, Prehistory, 53-75.
For a detailed survey of current consensus on cosmological history, see Eric Chaisson, Epic of Evolution:
Seven Ages of the Cosmos (New York: Columbia University Press, 2006). See also Christian, Maps of Time, 17-75.
41
42
Renfrew, Prehistory, 51.
43
Clarke, G., World Prehistory: An Outline (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1961).
203
techniques, nor even with then-current forms of evolutionary theory, which were not yet
able to employ genetic analysis.
By the late twentieth century, the fossil record strongly suggested that hominids –
i.e. members of the genus Homo, of which Homo sapiens is the most recently differentiated
species – had existed for millions of years, and had probably originated in Africa.44
Artefactual evidence suggesting similar conclusions had also accumulated, and the earlier
conception of a “neolithic revolution” soon came to be replaced with a view that despite
the profound shifts that occurred with agriculture and sedentism, hominid history is in fact
marked by a much deeper evolutionary feedback loop between the intentional use of
objects and physio-cognitive change – especially the stone tools that took place of actions
such as cutting and crushing, altering earlier hominid physiology and eventually leading to
modern Homo sapiens.45 But it was not until the discovery of DNA and the development of
associated analytical techniques that these speculations could be put on firm scientific
footing.
The DNA double-helix was first discovered in 1953 by Francis Crick and Jim
Watson, a revolutionary finding that finally offered scholars a clear mechanism through
which Darwin’s theory of biological evolution could be confirmed and properly
understood.46 This gave rise to the new fields of molecular genetics, which began analysing
Amongst he most up-to-date specialized discussions of human evolution that I am aware of are:; Rethinking
the Human Revolution: New Behavioural and Biological Perspectives on the Origins and Dispersal of Modern Humans (ed. P.
Mellars et al.; Cambridge: The McDonald Institute, 2007); The First Humans: Origin and Early Evolution of the
Genus Homo (ed. Frederick Grine et al.; New York : Springer, 2009); and Patterns of Growth and Development in
the Genus Homo (ed. Thompson, J. et al.; Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2003). See also the four
volume series The Human Fossil Record (ed. Schwartz & Tattersall et al.), listed in the bibliography.
44
45 The evolutionary dialectic between “Brain and Hand” is brought out in fascinating detail in LeroiGourhan’s Gesture and Speech. See also Deep History: The Architecture of Past and Present (ed. D. Smail & A.
Shyrock; Berkeley: University of California Press, 2011), 67-75. See further The Evolution of Hominin Diets:
Integrating Approaches to the Study of Paleolithic Subsistence (ed. J. Hublin & M. Richards; New York: Springer,
2009).
46 The discovery was announced in Watson J. & Crick F., “A Structure for Deoxyribose Nucleic Acid”, Nature
171 (1953): 737–738. See also Renfrew, Prehistory, 88ff.
204
human biological diversity using rigorously scientific methodologies (as opposed to the
quasi-scientific methods based upon nineteenth-century race theory). These fields were
initially very limited in the light they could shed on the deep past, although with the
application in 1987 of DNA analysis to mitochondrial DNA (i.e. the maternally inherited
DNA of the mitochondrion of the cell, rather than the nucleus), new research directions
were opened up that enabled the development of archaeogenetics, the study of biological
transformation over millions of years.
These results were recently summarized by the geneticist Peter Forster in 2004,
based on studies that have accumulated from 1992 onwards in conversation with
archaeological and other scientific research. On the basis of mtDNA, it has become certain
that all living humans are closely genetically related and have descended from ancestors
living in Africa roughly 200,000 years ago.47 It has also been demonstrated using genetic
evidence that the principal dispersal of Homo sapiens out of Africa took place roughly 60,000
years ago, a conclusion supported by the fact that the earliest fossil remains of Homo sapiens
in places such as Indonesia and Australia are dated to around 45,000 years ago.
But the new constellation of scientific techniques and the continually expanding
fossil record have also allowed the story of human evolution to be significantly expanded
into the frame of hominid evolution. As a very brief overview, the current scientific
consensus now places the emergence of the genus Homo roughly 2.6 million years ago with
Homo habilis, an emergence characterized by the first significant increase in brain size since
the split with primates over 5 million years ago, and the first widespread use of stone tools
(although I note that bipedalism, a crucial physiological factor in increased cranial
capacity, seems to have become regular in the close evolutionary ancestors of hominids, the
47 Forster, P., “Ice Ages and the mitochondrial DNA chronology of human dispersals: a review”, Philosophical
Transaction of the Royal Society 359 (2004): 255-264.
205
australopithecines).48 The next stage of species differentiation came with Homo erectus and Homo
ergaster around 1.8 million years ago, something discerned by shifts in physiology (such as
larger brain size) as well as the first production of “Acheulian” hand axes produced by a
more sophisticated “flaking” technique than earlier tools.49 These varieties of hominid were
also the first to migrate out of Africa, a claim supported by fossils found in Georgia, Java,
and Israel that have been dated to over 1.5 million years.50 By one million years ago, erectus
and ergaster appear to have mostly displaced other hominid species, and by 700,000 years
ago there is evidence of them existing not just in Africa, but also in regions of southern Asia
parts of Eurasia.51 Following this came another species differentiation, in which Homo
neaderthalis began to split from the ancestors of modern Homo sapiens (something that
modern genetics suggests took place 550,000-700,000 years ago), making neanderthals more
like cousins of early humans rather than direct evolutionary ancestors. Neanderthals
populated Eurasia from at least 400,000 years ago, marking the second major hominid
dispersal from Africa.52 Then around 200,000 years ago, the archaeological record shows
that there was another stage of refinement in the complexity of stone tool technologies,
implying further cultural and physiological change, with current consensus placing
anatomically modern humans somewhere in this period, existing exclusively in Africa (cf.
For a measured discussion of bipedalism, see Christian, Maps of Time, 154f. See further Ian Tattersall,
Becoming Human: Evolution and Human Uniqueness (New York: Harcourt Brace, 1998), 121. Leroi-Gourhan states
that “the brain was not the cause of developments in locomotory adaptation but their beneficiary”. This is
why he considers locomotion to be “the determining factor of biological evolution” in Homo sapiens (Gesture
and Speech, 26).
48
See Renfrew, Prehistory, 57-60. See also Deep History: The Architecture of Past and Present, 67-75. See also n. 82
below on Acheulian tools.
49
50
Ibid., 57, 58.
51 Christian, Maps of Time, 163ff. Renfrew also notes that “In all discussion about early hominid fossils, the
archaeologist is very much at the mercy of the changing terminologies” devised by biologists and
anthropologists (Prehistory, 58).
52
Ibid., 165-168.
206
the above reconstruction by Forster) and then migrating from Africa throughout the rest of
the world in the third major hominid dispersal, beginning roughly 60,000 years ago.53
Whilst this represents a remarkable new status quaestionis regarding the history of our
species (especially vis-à-vis earlier accounts of human origins), many scholars have
recognised that a serious issue remains unexplained in this trajectory: the reasons
underpinning the massively increased rate of change in the history of Homo sapiens
compared to every other species on earth, including even our hominid relatives.
I will address this question shortly, but I want to interject here and note the way in
which these changes in understanding about the deep past have impacted upon western
historiography. As discussed above, challenges to the documentary form of historiography
came in the first significant instance from the Annales school, who emphasised the longue
durée over traditional “event history” (represented especially by Braudel’s sweeping history
of the Mediterranean). One of the first Anglophone works with a similarly expanded frame
of reference (one in fact larger than Braudel’s) was William McNeill’s The Rise of the West.
Here McNeill sought to place the modern ascendency of Europe into a much larger
historical pattern beginning with paleolithic culture, thereby attempting to reject all forms of
European exceptionalism by demonstrating how Europe’s relatively recent global
supremacy was contingent upon a very long trajectory of interrelations between various
human cultures, rather than because of any inherent superiority of European culture.54 The
studies mentioned above that dealt with the depth of human prehistory underlay McNeill’s
work, as did the Annalistes and many others, all of which provided strong propulsion for the
continued restructuring of the European historiographical imagination at a wider level.
53
See Forster, “Ice Ages and the mitochondrial DNA chronology of human dispersals”.
McNeill, W., The Rise of the West: A History of the Human Community (Chicago: Chicago University Press,
1963). McNeill notes that the book was conceived as early as 1936. Amongst more recent works, see Robert
Marks, The Origins of the Modern World: A Global and Ecological Narrative (Lanham: Rowman & Littlefield, 2002).
54
207
The industry of what might loosely be termed “evolutionary studies” has accelerated
significantly in recent decades. It is not my aim here to provide a catalogue of those wideranging developments, suffice it to say that they have been undertaken in an array of
academic disciplines and have created new ones in the process.55 However, it was not until
the 1990s that the insights provided by archaeology and the sciences came to be integrated
into research agendas that amounted to new historiographical (rather than simply scientific)
paradigms. While McNeill continued to advocate a vision of history that unified scientific
and humanistic perspectives, scholars such as David Christian began to argue for the
necessity of changing “world” history (generally a globally oriented perspective on the last
6000-10,000 years) into the notion of “universal” history, placing the events of human
history and natural history into a large-scale narrative encompassing the entire history of the
universe.56 In 2004, Christian published his landmark work, Maps of Time: An Introduction to
Big History, which attempts to provide “a unified account of how things came to be the way
they are”, integrating cosmological, geological, biological and cultural trajectories into an
over-arching narrative.57
A similar agenda promoting the idea of “deep history” has recently been pursued by
Daniel Lord Smail and Andrew Shyrock, whose work is particularly useful for the way in
For a useful survey of evolutionary studies, see the various works employed by David Christian in Maps of
Time, 79-203.
55
Christian announced his program in “The Case for ‘Big History’”, The Journal of World History 2 (1991): 223238. See most recently Christian, D., “The Return of Universal History”, History and Theory 49 (2010): 6-27.
Christian has been a strong advocate of expanding big history into the realm of high-school education, and
has even forged a high-profile partnership with Bill Gates to promote the development and use of an open big
history syllabus for this purpose. See The Big History Project (www.bighistoryproject.com/home; last
accessed June 13, 2013). As the website currently states, “The Big History Project is a collaboration designed
to bring big history to life for high school students. It is entering the second year of a pilot program designed
to create and refine a world class curriculum and online experience that will ultimately be freely available to
schools worldwide.”
56
Christian, Maps of Time, 2. McNeill wrote an appreciative foreword to the work, and Christian in turn
acknowledges McNeill’s influence on his thought (xxi). The big history paradigm has often come under
criticism. Although some of this criticism is warranted, Christian has provided a good defence of the paradigm
vis-à-vis four of the most common complaints (Maps of Time, 8-11). I pass over these debates here.
57
208
which it places specific focus on the human aspects of long-term history.58 In an interesting
continuity with the historiographical shifts described in the first section of this chapter, they
also note that “The logic that makes Neanderthals and other early hominins [sic] visible to a
deep history is the same logic that has made subalterns everywhere visible to modern
historical praxis”.59 Smail says elsewhere that
In light of these arguments, deep history is a natural extension of historiographical
trends that began in the mid-twentieth century. The goal of the social history of this
era, after all, was to uncover the world of the people without history. This move was
seconded by branches of world and postcolonial history that sought to apply the same
logic to colonial peoples deemed historyless before the arrival of the Western colonial
and imperial enterprise.60
It is for this reason that I am focusing on evolutionary perspectives on human history, and
it will soon become clear how this approach pays off. Whilst the big history perspective is
not intended to supplant older forms of historical analysis (a fact often overlooked by its
critics), the agenda represented by Christian and Smail centres around an explicit call for
two things. Firstly, they argue that it is only with such a large-scale focus that patterns of
human history can be discerned that remain invisible when working within the traditional
timeframes of European historiography, even forms of social history that had moved away
from the documentary approach. As Christian puts it,
A return to universal history will show that there are indeed “simplifying perspectives”
that reveal a profound orderliness in human history [vis-à-vis the “chaotic” character it
has when viewed in smaller timeframes]. However, the large patterns can be seen
clearly only at scales of many millennia, or at the even larger scales of human history as
a whole … At large scales, the pixels of human action generate clear patterns, and
awareness of these patterns will inevitably change how we think about history at
smaller scales.61
58
See Smail, On Deep History and the Brain; and Deep History (ed. Smail & Shyrock).
59
Smail & Shyrock, Deep History, 15.
Smail, Deep History and the Brain, 54. This work is a polemical advocation of deep history that highlights how
deeply entrenched the documentary view of history has remained even to the present day.
60
61
Christian, “The Return of Universal History”, 20-21.
209
Secondly, in light of this view, they place a strong emphasis on the need to reintegrate
forms of intellectual inquiry that became fragmented into isolated academic fields over the
course of twentieth century.62 Christian puts it as follows:
A revival of universal history will affect the context of historical scholarship much
more than its practice. After all, rigorous empirical research is the meat and drink of
scholarship in all fields including the natural sciences. So I suspect that for most
historians “normal history” will carry on regardless. But the context of historical
research will be transformed. Seeing human history as part of a much larger story will
affect how historians think about research, the questions they ask, the ways they
collaborate, and the way they judge the significance of scholarship.63
Again, thinking about new forms of intellectual cross-fertilization is central to the way I am
viewing the Axial Age and its redescription, and I agree with Christian that “Excessive
respect for disciplinary boundaries has hidden many possibilities for intellectual synergy
between disciplines”.64 But before coming to that, this is a good point to return to the
question left open above about how one can account for the remarkable intensification of
change in human history of the last 100,000 years, and especially in the 10,000 years during
which agriculture, sedentism, and urbanization became such catalystic forces. Christian
frames the issue well: “What makes human history different from the history of, say, our
biological cousins, the great apes? After all, as individuals they are just about as clever as we.
Why do we have a rich history of long-term change when they, apparently, don’t?”. He
continues that:
Darwin’s great achievement was to explain how species [change] through the
mechanism of natural selection. But the patterns we see in human history are different.
On the intellectual fragmentation of institutionalized disciplines, see e.g. Christian, “The Return of
Universal History”, 13ff. Eric Wolf also discusses this fragmentation in detail, see Europe and the People without
History, 7-19.
62
63
Ibid., 19 (italics added).
64
Christian, Maps of Time, 9.
210
Humans do not just adapt, they keep adapting, and at a pace that cannot be explained
by natural selection alone. Continuous adaptation provides the species as a whole with
more resources than are needed simply to maintain a demographic steady state.
Something unusual is going on. … How can we explain this remarkable capacity for
sustained and accelerating adaptation that seems to be a new emergent property of our
species and the primary driver of change in human history?65
Renfrew pursues a similar line of questioning. He notes that a child born today, in the
twenty-first century, “would be very little different in its DNA – i.e., in the genotype, and
hence in innate capacities – from one born 60,000 years ago”. Therefore, “the differences in
human behaviour that we see now, when contrasted with the more limited range of
behaviours then, are not to be explained by any inherent or emerging genetic differences”.66 We must, in
other words, find an explanation for the rapidity of cultural change in the human species
that involves more than just the longer-term mechanisms of natural selection.
In effect, scholars are now asking: if we reject Hegel’s Geist as the driving force of
historical change – or indeed any other transcendental entity – how then are we to account
for that change? This is a question of the utmost importance, and although it has received
growing attention across the field of evolutionary studies, in my view the most attractive
answer is something like the one proposed by David Christian – the key lies in the nature of
human language and its capacity for collective learning:
the key is the remarkable precision and fluency of human language, which allowed
humans alone to share learned knowledge so precisely and in such volume that it could
accumulate with minimal degradation within the memory banks of entire communities.
Human language linked humans into highly efficient information networks through
which the learning of each individual could be shared, added to, and passed on to
future generations. The slow mechanism of genetic inheritance was overlaid by the much faster
mechanism of knowledge transfer. The long-term trends that make human history so
different are driven, in other words, by a new and more rapid adaptive mechanism that
we can call “collective learning.” As a species we cannot help accumulating new
knowledge by exchanging it. That explains our remarkable plasticity, the astonishing
variety of behaviors that we find in individuals and in different human societies, and
the extreme difficulty we have in trying to pin down any single “human nature.” Yet
65
Christian, “The Return of Universal History”, 19-20, 23-4.
66
Renfrew, Prehistory, 92-3 (italics added).
211
behind this variety there is one constant: our propensity for sharing the insights of
each individual, thereby generating a collective capacity for sustained adaptation. It is
this propensity that seems to have driven human societies with radically different
cultures and in very different environments along broadly similar paths, and ultimately
toward greater control of resources, larger populations, and greater social complexity. 67
This argument is so convincing because the correlation between technologies of
communication and the rapidity of cultural (rather than genetic) change is a pattern visible
across the full span of human history. This can be highlighted by noting four key examples
which provide a snapshot of Christian’s point. Firstly, the emergence of language, and the
inter-generational symbolic/informational networks it enabled. This new capacity
underpinned the ability of Homo sapiens to collaborate to such a high degree that they
drastically expanded the ecological niches in which they could survive, leading to the
successful global dispersal of the species.68 As Roy Rappaport has similarly pointed out,
When social organization and rules for behaviour are stipulated in conventions
expressed in words rather than specified in genes and inscribed on chromosomes they
can be replaced within single lifetimes, even sometimes, overnight. This has made it
possible for a single interbreeding species to enter, and even dominate, the great
variety of environments the world presents without having to spend generations
transforming itself into a new range of species.69
Secondly, the invention of writing and other forms of graphic notation involved in the
processes of urbanization. Although writing was a consequence and not a cause of
urbanization, it was crucial not only in enhancing the capacity to administer the increasingly
large populations supported by agricultural technologies, but more importantly in
underpinning the new symbolic universes that arose when cultural texts began to be
codified in the more fixed medium of writing (rather than the perishable medium of oral
67
Christian, “The Return of Universal History”, 24 (italics added).
68
See Christian, Maps of Time, 171-175 and 182-184.).
69
Rappaport, R., Ritual and Religion in the Making of Humanity (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1999),
6.
212
discourse).70 As will become clear shortly, this is of central relevance for understanding the
transformations of the 1st millennium BCE (not to mention earlier changes in Egypt in
Mesopotamia).
A third major example of how changes in the capacity for collective learning spur
major cultural changes can be seen in the invention of typography, especially European
alphabetic typography in the fifteenth century.71 Without going into detail, it was the ability
for the mass production and dissemination of uniformly repeatable texts – something
impossible in chirographic (i.e. manuscript) culture – that underpinned such major events as
the Protestant Reformation, the scientific revolution, and the Enlightenment, something
amply demonstrated in works such as Elizabeth Eisenstein’s The Printing Press as an Agent of
Change.72 As Walter Ong has similarly demonstrated in his remarkable study of the
sixteenth-century educator Peter Ramus, the typographic revolution also had major
epistemological consequences on European thought as intellectual debate and collaboration
began to take place much more extensively outside of oral discourse.73 One of the most
70 See e.g. Assmann, J., “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age” in The Axial Age and its Consequences
(ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas; Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2012), 366-407; and Cultural Memory and
Early Civilization: Writing, Remembrance, and Political Imagination (ET; Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
2012 [1992]). See also Harold Innis, Empire and Communications (ed. D. Godfrey; Toronto: Press Porcépic, 1986
[1950]). As noted in Chapter 1, despite the importance of writing in cultural history, it is important to stress
that it was not the cause of urbanization, but its consequence; see Hans J. Nissen, The Early History of the
Ancient Near East, 9000-2000 B.C. (trans. E. Lutzeier & K. J. Northcott; Chicago: University of Chicago Press,
1988 [1983]), esp. 14, 129-164.
71 I leave aside discussion of typography in China and Korea (Chinse printing techniques in particular
predating European ones), suffice it to say that they did not alter forms of culture as drastically or as quickly as
the emergence of print in Europe. For an overview of print in the eastern context, see Henri-Jean Martin, The
History and Power of Writing (trans. L. Cochrane; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1994 [1988]), 224-226.
Eisenstein, E., The Printing Press as an Agent of Change: Communications and Cultural Transformations in EarlyModern Europe (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1979).
72
73 Ong, W., Ramus, Method, and the Decay of Dialogue: From the Art of Discourse to the Art of Reason (2nd ed.; Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 2002 [1958]).
213
important consequences of this was the intensification of the notion of “objective
knowledge” because of the way in which writing separates “the knower from the known”.74
A final example in this brief overview is the new information networks opened up
by electric and now digital technologies of communication, which from the early nineteenth
century have begun to link the world into a “global nervous system”, obliterating the longstanding barriers of time and space marking all previous human epochs. Indeed, the
telegraph was so revolutionary because it was the first time in human history that a message
could travel faster than a messenger, the consequences of which hardly need spelling out
here. This connectivity has intensified at a quite astonishing pace in the last two centuries,
especially with the rise of information technology in the twentieth century and the digital
revolution we are experiencing in the twenty-first. This is a trajectory charted well in James
Gleick’s The Information: A History, a Theory, a Flood.75
All of these shifts, whilst always in a constant dialectic with other forces and not
supreme causal agents in themselves, are clearly involved in the most significant periods of
human cultural change. They therefore offer strong support for arguments such as David
Christian’s that the most profound reorganizations of human society throughout history
have resulted from finding new ways to transmit and store information.76 This is also a
good example of Christian’s view that only with a truly long-term historical perspective can
one begin to see patterns of human history that remain invisible when operating within the
more traditional chronological frameworks of western historiography. But given that these
issues are crucial for my critique of the Axial Age, I need to expand the discussion in order
74
See Ong, W., Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word (London: Routledge, 1982).
75
Gleick, J., The Information: A History, a Theory, a Flood (London: Fourth Estate, 2011).
76 References for works in all of the above areas are provided in the supplementary bibliography on
communications history, several with brief annotations.
214
to demonstrate how they can allow scholars to emplot the transformations of the 1st
millennium BCE in a manner completely different from Jaspers and Hick.
Communications History
Recognizing the fundamental role of collective learning in human cultural change entails
focusing on a variety of academic fields. I group them here somewhat loosely under the
rubric of “communications history”, even though the fields of scholarship noted above
(and discussed below) are yet to be integrated in any substantive way. Moreover, these
perspectives will be very useful when returning to what this all means for an evaluation of
the Axial Age as a narrative of human religious history, as some of the major recent
contributions to communications history have been offered by scholars closely associated
with the new phase of Axial Age scholarship. While the works surveyed here could be split
up in many ways, I will focus on three broad groups: 1) evolutionary studies of language
and human culture; 2) anthropological studies of modern oral cultures; and 3) historians of
early civilization who help to understand the significance of writing in the symbolic
universes of large urban societies.
As far as evolutionary studies of language are concerned, the two most important
scholars in the present context are Terrence Deacon and Merlin Donald, both of whom
explore the trajectory and the consequences of human language development over the full
period of hominid evolution. I will consider them in turn. Deacon’s major work is The
Symbolic Species: The Co-evolution of Language and the Brain, which has provided the benchmark
study on the evolution of language and symbolic thought for scholars such as David
215
Christian.77 By focusing on cognitive and physiological changes that began accumulating
roughly with the appearance of Homo habilis over 2 million years ago, Deacon argues that
the key difference between human and non-human forms of communication is the human
capacity for symbolic thought – complex and abstract associations that allow the human
plane of meaning to extend well beyond the basic communicative capacities of other
primates. The arguments and evidence surrounding the preconditions and possible early
stages of hominid language are extremely complicated, and I will not go into them here. It is
however worth pointing out a few salient features of Deacon’s view:
The first symbolic systems were almost certainly not full-blown languages, to say the
least. We would probably not even recognize them as languages if we encountered
them today, though we would recognize them as different in striking ways from the
communication of other species. In their earliest forms, it is likely that they lacked both
the efficiency and the flexibility that we attribute to modern language. Indeed, I think it
is far more realistic to assume that the first symbolic systems would have paled in
efficiency and flexibility in comparison to the rich and complex endowment of vocal
calls and nonverbal, nonsymbolic gestural displays exhibited by many of our primate
cousins. The first symbol learners probably still carried on most of their social
communication through call-and-display behaviors much like those of modern apes
and monkeys. Symbolic communication was likely only a small part of social
communication.78
Notice that Deacon here suggests that symbolic cognition goes back further than language,
a point with major implications for evaluating and explaining the intellectual development
of modern humans. To get a better handle on the evolution of language in the context of
collective learning, I turn here to Merlin Donald’s view on the stages of human cognitive
development. This is instructive not only for thinking about the concept of collective
learning generally, but also because Donald’s framework has been employed as the
fundamental evolutionary perspective in Robert Bellah’s new treatment of religious history
Deacon, T., The Symbolic Species: The Co-evolution of Language and the Brain (New York: W. W. Norton & Co.,
1997). For Christian’s use of Deacon, see Maps of Time, 171-175.
77
78
Deacon, The Symbolic Species, 378.
216
in Religion in Human Evolution, and will thus be extremely useful when addressing the issue of
how the 1st millennium BCE might be redescribed in light of contemporary scholarship.79
Donald argues that human culture, since its early mammalian origins, has undergone
four distinct stages of cognitive development: episodic culture, mimetic culture, mythic
culture, and theoretic culture. He begins with what he calls “episodic” culture, drawing
examples primarily from nonhuman primates. Speaking of the great apes, he says
Their behavior, complex as it is, seems unreflective, concrete, and situation bound.
Even their uses of signing and their social behavior are immediate, short-term
responses to the environment. … the word that seems best to epitomize the cognitive
culture of apes (and probably many other mammals as well… ) is the term episodic. …
Where humans have abstract symbolic representations, apes are bound to the concrete
situation or episode; and their social behavior reflects this situational limitation.80
Episodic culture provides the cognitive platform of all complex mammalian species, and
was apparently still the primary (if not exclusive) cognitive state of the close bipedal
ancestors of the hominid genus, the australopithecines. With the emergence of Homo habilis,
and then particularly with Homo erectus, a new stage began in hominid cognitive evolution
that was critical for the later development of language in Homo sapiens. This is the stage that
Donald calls “mimetic culture”, from Greek mimesthai, to imitate. It is worth quoting
Donald at some length to explain the importance of mimetic culture, which helps to flesh
out the implications of Deacon’s claim that symbolic thought began before language:
The first breakthrough in our cognitive evolution was [not language, as many scholars
have argued, but rather] a radical improvement in voluntary motor control that
fortuitously provided a new means of representing reality. Homo erectus’s great gift to
humanity was mimetic skill, a revolutionary improvement in voluntary motor control,
Donald’s two major works are Donald, Origins of the Modern Mind: Three Stages in the Evolution of Culture
(Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1991); and A Mind So Rare: The Evolution of Human Consciousness
(New York: Norton, 2001). Bellah’s engagement with Donald begins at p. 117 of Religion in Human Evolution. I
note also that Bellah frames his narrative with relation to the work of Smail and Christian, calling their works
“signs of the time”, and agreeing with them that “any distinction between history and prehistory is arbitrary”
(xi).
79
80
Donald, Origins of the Modern Mind, 149. See 124-161.
217
leading to our uniquely human talent for using the whole body as a subtle
communication device. … This talent, [even] without language, could have supported a
culture that was much more powerful, in terms of its toolmaking abilities, refinements
of skill, and flexible social organization, than any known ape culture.
For a variety of reasons, mimetic skill logically precedes language, and remains
fundamentally independent of truly linguistic modes of representation. It is the basic
human thought skill, without which there would not have been the evolutionary
opportunity, much later, to evolve language as we know it. Pure mimesis is an
intermediate layer of knowledge and culture, and is the first evolutionary link between
presymbolic knowledge-systems of animals and the symbolic systems of modern
humans. Basically, mimesis is based on a memory system that can rehearse and refine
movement voluntarily and systematically, in terms of a coherent conceptual model of
the surrounding environment. It … allows any action of the body to be stopped,
replayed, and edited, under conscious control.81
In the archaeological record, the mimetic stage is most clearly evident in the complex
technical procedures used by Homo habilis in the creation of early stone tools, and then with
the intensification of technical sophistication visible with Homo erectus, especially in the
industry of Acheulian tools.82 But more than enhanced technical sophistication, mimetic
culture had drastic consequences for the development of symbolic representation in
hominid societies:
as in many evolutionary adaptations, mimetic skill would have unforeseen
consequences: now hominids had a means of re-presenting reality to themselves and
others, by the use of voluntary action. This means that hominids could do much more
than rehearse and refine existing movement patterns … and they could re-enact events
and scenarios, creating a sort of gestural proto-theatre of everyday life. The body itself
became a tool for expression, as in acting or mime; it was just a matter of discovering
the social utility of this possibility.
… Such a culture was based on improved voluntary motor skill, extensive use of
imitation for pedagogy, and a much more sophisticated range of voluntary facial and
vocal expressions, along with public-action metaphor, the basis of most custom and
ritual.83
81 Donald, M., “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature” (n. d.; lecture given at the
University of Arkansas), 15. Paginated transcript available at http://psyc.queensu.ca/faculty/donald/selpubs.html (last accessed June 8, 2013). I have utilized this lecture because it provides a handy summary of
Donald’s more developed argument.
82 Donald, Origins of the Modern Mind, 179f. He notes that “The stone tools of erectus required expert fashioning;
archaeologists require months of training and pratice to become good at creating Acheulian tools”.
Donald, “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature”, 16-7. See Origins of the Modern Mind,
162-200.
83
218
The implications here are important, for if Donald’s reading of the evolutionary archive is
even broadly correct, then the basis of distinctly human culture – i.e. symbolic
representation – begins well before the emergence of modern language. It also means that
story, in its rudiments, is a prelinguistic form, and that stories were thus first codified not in
linguistic narratives, but in ritual – i.e. embodied, socially shared performative
representations that helped to constitute “social conventions, a moral order, a sense of the
sacred, and a relationship to the cosmos, including beliefs about what lies behind the
empirical cosmos”.84
From this point, Donald discusses the origins of modern language. Against the view
of a “language instinct” or a “universal grammar” in human cognitive architecture (as
argued by figures such as Stephen Pinker and Noam Chomsky), Donald suggests that the
evolutionary development of language stems from “a deep drive for conceptual
clarification”, and therefore that “modern humans developed language in response to pressure to
improve their conceptual apparatus, not vice versa”.85 He continues:
Evolutionary pressures favouring a very powerful representation device like speech
would have been much greater once mimetic communication reached a critical degree
of complexity; mimesis is inherently an ambiguous way of representing reality, and
words are an effective means of disambiguating mimetic messages … [Unlike
mimesis,] it employs true symbols and constructs narrative descriptions of reality.
Spoken language provided humans with a second form of retrievable knowledge
and a much more powerful way to format their knowledge. The natural product of
language is narrative thought, that is, storytelling. Storytelling had a forerunner in
mimetic event-reenactment, but it is very different in the means by which it achieves its
goal, and much more flexible in what it can express.86
Bellah, Religion in Human Evolution, 145. Bellah is here discussing the work of Roy Rappaport, Ritual and
Religion in the Making of Humanity, who has argued the case for “taking ritual as humanity’s basic social act”. I
am not able to explore further the implications of these perspectives regarding the old question about the
priority of “myth or ritual” in the origins of religion; but as Bellah notes, if the views of Deacon and Donald
are even broadly correct, then “the argument is at last over. Ritual clearly precedes myth” (135f.).
84
85
These comments are stitched together from A Mind So Rare (283f.) and Origins of the Modern Mind (215).
Donald, “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature”, 19. On narrative in the context of
evolution, see also the excellent work of Brian Boyd, On the Origin of Stories: Evolution, Cognition, and Fiction
(Cambridge, MA: University Press, 2009), which came to my attention too late to be incorporated. See the
supplementary bibliography.
86
219
Donald therefore terms the era after the emergence of language “mythic culture”,
etymologically from Greek mythos, story. He defines it as follows:
Mythical thought, in our terms, might be regarded as a unified, collectively held system
of explanatory and regulatory metaphors. The mind has expanded beyond the episodic
perception of events, beyond the mimetic reconstruction of events, to a
comprehensive modeling of the entire human universe. Causal explanations,
prediction, control––myth constitutes an attempt at all three, and every aspect of life is
permeated by myth.87
In terms of collective learning, the emergence of language is so significant not just because
it greatly increased the repository of technical knowledge in early human cultures, allowing
their successful expansion across almost the entire globe (the aspect that most interests
scholars such as Christian), but also because the enhanced capacity for the storage of
cultural memory enabled by language gave a new inter-generational dynamic to the
construction of identity in early oral societies.
Yet for all its vitality and transformative potential, forms of cultural memory that
were only mimetic and oral were subject to rigid constraints. Donald explains:
Early humans, like their predecessors, depended on their natural or biological memory
capacities. Thus, even though language and mimetic expression allowed humans to
accumulate a considerable degree of collective knowledge shared in culture, the actual
physical storage of that knowledge depended ultimately on the internal memory
capacities of the individual members of a society. Thought was carried out entirely
inside the head; whatever was heard or seen had to be remembered and rehearsed
orally or visualized in imagination.88
At this stage Donald’s evolutionary trajectory can be integrated with the work of
anthropologists and other scholars of oral cultures, something that I believe illustrates
Christian’s point about the potential for new forms of intellectual cross-fertilization. Let me
87
Donald, Origins of the Modern Mind, 214.
88 Donald, “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature”, 21; see also Ong, Orality and Literacy,
33-77 (“Some Psychodynamics of Orality”).
220
stress that this is important if the original formulation of the Axial Age is to be challenged,
because it forces us to rethink the nature of the differences traditionally posited between
large urban societies and small-scale oral societies.
One of the most important theorists to approach this question from the perspective
of the history of technology was British anthropologist Jack Goody, whose work on literacy
in traditional societies in the 1960s was foundational in bringing about a paradigm shift
from older, pejorative views of non-urban culture, to views that were more sensitive to the
material factors underpinning cultural difference.89 Goody’s fundamental premise was that
European social and anthropological thought had been structured by a set of pervasive,
ethnocentric, and empirically dubious binary categories for the description and comparison
of cultures, which he lists as follows:90
primitive –– advanced
savage –– domesticated
traditional –– modern
‘cold’ –– ‘hot’ [cf. Lévi-Strauss]
closed –– open [cf. Popper]
developing –– developed
pre-logical –– logical [cf. Lévy-Bruhl]
mythopoeic –– logico-empirical
Goody argues three things about these categories: (a) that these binaries reduce to little
more than ethnocentric “us and them” dichotomies, something many other theorists of
modernity have pointed out; (b) that this dichotomous treatment is inadequate for dealing
with the complexity of human development and cultural difference; and (c) that scholars
have almost invariably proposed no reasons for the differences between such societies. He
therefore suggests that instead of these “somewhat vague” dichotomies, almost all aspects
of cultural difference implied in such categories can instead be related to “changes in the
89
Several of Goody’s works are listed in the supplementary bibliography.
90
Goody, J., The Domestication of the Savage Mind (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1977), 146f.
221
mode of communication, especially writing”.91 Goody was also emphatic that he was not
suggesting a monocausal theory of change, nor a deterministic account where technological
shifts always have the same result and conscious agency has no role; and he was clear that
such a perspective could not operate with a “Great Divide” theory between “oral” and
“literate” forms of culture, and must instead operate with a carefully nuanced awareness of
the ever-shifting technological landscapes in which cultural activity plays out.92
Such perspectives have gained increasing traction since the 1960s. With regard to
oral cultures, one of the scholars to have built on Goody’s insights most productively is the
historian of technology, Walter Ong. Ong had already made a major contribution to
communications history with his work on sixteenth-century educational reformer Peter
Ramus and the way in which typographic technologies revolutionized European thinking
even at the most fundamental epistemological levels (as noted above). This work had
strongly influenced Goody, and in turn Goody’s work on traditional societies allowed Ong
to write one of the most important treatments of the issue, Orality and Literacy: The
Technologizing of the Word. By adopting the approach Goody had advocated, Ong attempted
to plot out the characteristics typical of “primary oral” thought, i.e. thought in cultures
where even the very concept of visual language does not exist.
Without surveying Ong’s entire list, which includes features such as the “formulaic”
composition of important knowledge in oral societies (whether technical or other
knowledge), the most important feature in the context of the present discussion is what
Ong and Goody call the homeostatic dynamic of cultural ideation that plays out in a purely oral
context:
91
Ibid., 16.
92
See ibid., 46ff.
222
By contrast with literate societies, oral societies can be characterized as homeostatic.
That is to say, oral societies live very much in a present which keeps itself in
equilibrium or homeostasis by sloughing off memories which no longer have present
relevance.
The forces governing homeostasis can be sensed by reflection on the condition
of words in primary oral setting … The meaning of each word is controlled by what
Goody and Watt call “direct semantic ratification”, that is, by the real-life situations in
which the word is used here and now. Words acquire their meaning only from their
always insistent actual habitat, which is not, as in a dictionary, simply other words, but
also includes gestures, vocal inflections, facial expressions, and the entire human
existential setting in which the real, spoken word always occurs.93
Goody and Watt argue that this homeostatic dynamic is particularly visible when observing
the reproduction of genealogies in oral cultures. They document a case from the Gonja
people of Ghana. Records made in the early twentieth century show that Gonja tradition
presented Ndewura Jakpa as the founder of the Gonja. Ndewura Jakpa was said to have
had seven sons, each of whom was ruler of one of the seven territorial divisions of Gonja
territory.94 But sixty years later, when the traditions were recorded again by another
generation of anthropologists, the territorial boundaries of the Gonja had been
reconfigured into five divisions. In the later genealogies, the story of Ndewura Jakpa was
now told with him having only five sons. For Goody and Watt, this is a telling example of
the way that
genealogies often serve the same function that Malinowski claimed for myth; they act
as “charters” of present social institutions rather than as faithful historical records of
times past. They can do this more consistently because they operate within an oral
rather than a written tradition and thus tend to be automatically adjusted to existing
social relations … a similar process takes place with regard to other cultural elements
as well, to myths, for example, and to sacred lore in general. Deities and other
supernatural agencies which have served their purpose can be quietly dropped from
93 See Orality and Literacy, 33-77 (“Some Psychodynamics of Orality”), here 46. Ong cites Goody and Watt’s
important article, “The Consequences of Literacy”, Comparative Studies in Society and History 5 (1963): 304-345.
The formulaic nature of oral narrative was first explored by Milman Parry and Albert Lord, who analysed
modern oral cultures in the Balkans in light of a growing scholarly interest in the oral composition of the
Homeric epics; see Ong, Orality and Literacy, 16-30 for a good intellectual history of the topic. See the
supplementary bibliography for the relevant works of Lord and Parry.
94 I leave to the side here reflection on the political and ethical dimensions of colonialism and the production
of knowledge, suffice it to say that I use the present examples with an awareness of the difficult nature of the
question.
223
the contemporary pantheon; and as the society changes, myths too are forgotten,
attributed to other personages, or transformed in their meaning. … The [Gonja] have
their genealogies, others their sacred tales about the origin of the world and the way in
which man acquired his culture. But all their conceptualisations of the past cannot help
being governed by the concerns of the present, merely because there is no body of
chronologically ordered statements to which reference can be made. The [Gonja] do
not recognise any contradiction between what they say now and what they said fifty
years ago, since no enduring records exist for them to set beside their present views. …
the elements in the cultural heritage which cease to have a contemporary relevance
tend to be soon forgotten or transformed; and as the individuals of each generation
acquire their vocabulary, their genealogies, and their myths, they are unaware that
various words, proper-names and stories have dropped out, or that others have
changed their meanings or been replaced.95
While orally based thought could be discussed in more detail, the above is a useful outline
of some of its important features. And whilst all of these insights are admittedly based on
contemporaneously documented oral cultures (rather than the ancient ones which are
claimed to have been similar), they remain persuasive at a general level because of the way
in which they keep attention on the dynamics of knowledge when it cannot be given the permanence of
written language. We have no direct evidence for the vanished symbolic world of pre-graphic
humanity, but this model is far more defensible than the old binary models of cultural
comparison.
In a move of major importance for the discursive reconfiguration advocated by
Goody, Ong uses these perspectives to redescribe the designations of “prelogical”,
“irrational”, and “savage” simply as “oral”. And in my view, almost every feature of oral
thought that has been denigrated in European scholarship – especially its alleged
“irrationality”, its lack of “abstract” thinking, and its “total immersion in the present” – can
instead be seen as what intelligent human thought looks like when embodied only in small
societies that do not have recourse to externalized systems of memory.
95
Goody and Watt, “The Consequences of Literacy”, 310-311.
224
With these considerations in mind, we are well placed to return to the fourth and final stage
in Donald’s evolutionary scheme, which he calls “theoretic culture”. Theoretic culture is
based on the most important change in the human capacity for communication since the
emergence of language, namely the externalization of memory. Donald explains the importance
of this shift in evolutionary terms:
External memory is a critical feature of modern human cognition, if we are trying to
build an evolutionary bridge from Neolithic to modern cognitive capacities or a
structural bridge from mythic to theoretic culture. The brain may not have changed
recently in its genetic makeup, but its link to an accumulating external memory
network affords it cognitive powers that would not have been possible in isolation.
This is more than a metaphor; each time the brain carries out an operation in concert
with the external symbolic storage system, it becomes part of a network.96
Although cultural memory had become increasingly encoded in ritual and mimetic
behaviour; although perishable forms of graphic representation certainly existed amongst
oral cultures (lines in the dirt, notches on wood); and although language served as a
powerful and malleable vehicle for the transmission of human thought; the most important
technology for the externalization of memory was writing. While writing developed very gradually at
first, initially not prompting any major cognitive changes, its long-term effects were
enormous:
[Symbolic technologies] liberate consciousness from the limitations of the brain’s
biological memory systems. … Because of the limitations of biological memory,
conscious thought was enormously difficult when contained entirely inside the brain
box. External storage changed this and gave thinkers new strategic options.97
96
Donald, Origins of the Modern Mind, 312; see 269-360.
97
Donald, A Mind So Rare, 306
225
Donald and others have described this shift in terms of distributed cognition.98 As will become
clear shortly, the first major consequences of the move from the mythic to the theoretic
stage are effectively located in the cultural transformations which Jaspers described as the
Axial Age. But to stay at the more general level for now, the theoretic stage can also be
integrated with the work of other scholars, this time in ways that highlight the impact of
writing on cultural change.
A great deal of ink has been spent on the invention and impact of writing, but I
want to focus on the work of Jan Assmann, who is not only one of the most important
theorists on the topic, but has also been a key contributor to the new phase of Axial Age
scholarship. Assmann begins by making the cogent distinction between writing systems and
writing cultures. A writing system is a form of graphic notation: it can be ideographic,
logographic, syllabic, alphabetic, etc. Aside from Mesoamerican graphism, all other major
scripts throughout history have stemmed either from the scripts of the ancient Near East or
the scripts of ancient China.99
The first development involved in the invention of writing was what Assmann calls
“sectorial literacy” (closely corresponding to Eric Havelock’s earlier notion of “craft
literacy”), in which a small social group is trained in the skill of graphic notation for
practical purposes.100 In this stage, writing is used exclusively in the sectors of cultural
activity for whose needs it had been invented. In virtually all instances, these sectors were
initially economic and administrative, and Assmann cautions that “We must not forget that
98 See Renfrew, Prehistory, 119f. For an interesting take on the issues in the context of the contemporary
computer revolution, see also Andy Clarke, Supersizing the Mind: Embodiment, Action, and Cognitive Extension
(New York: Oxford University Press, 2011).
99 On the history of scripts, see the indispensible compendium The World’s Writing Systems (ed. P. Daniels and
W. Bright; New York: Oxford University Press, 2006). On the cultural history of writing, see the sweeping
work of Henri-Jean Martin, The History and Power of Writing.
See Havelock, E., Preface to Plato (Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1963), noted in the
supplementary bibliography.
100
226
writing was invented to record the non-mnemophilic, the contingent data in economy and
administration, which no human memory can keep for a long period of time”.101 Bearing in
mind Ong and Goody’s insights on the dynamics of oral thought, the fact that writing was
first used for these purposes is of little surprise.
Graphic representation was soon extended into other fields of cultural practice,
especially relating to political, funerary, and other cultic activity. These form the base of the
shift from sectorial literacy to what Assmann calls “cultural literacy”. This occurs
when writing penetrates into the central core of a culture that we (Aleida Assmann and
myself) call “cultural memory”. This is a question not of a system of writing but a culture
of writing. What matters here is not whether we are dealing with an alphabetic
(consonantic or vocalized) alphabet or with a syllabic, logographic, or ideographic
script, [a point on which many earlier communications historians, such as McLuhan
and Havelock, have placed misguided emphasis]. What matters is whether or not
writing is used for the composition, transmission, and circulation of “cultural texts”.102
The first place this discernibly occurred was the end of the third millennium BCE when the
sagas of the Gilgamesh story were first collected into a continuous epic.103 Egypt was not
far behind in its production of what Assmann calls “the world’s first truly literate texts”, i.e.
those not initially composed in conditions of orality.104 By the term “cultural memory”
Assmann means
that form of collective memory that enables a society to transmit its central patterns of
orientation in time, space, and divine and human worlds to future generations and by
doing so to continue its identity over the sequence of generations. Cultural memory
provides a kind of connective structure in both the social and temporal dimensions.
… With the literatization of significant parts of cultural memory and the
production of cultural texts that are conceptually literate (requiring writing already for
101
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 384.
Ibid., 383. Aleida Assmann’s work, Cultural Memory and Western Civilization: Functions, Media, Archives
(Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2011 [1999]) provides the modern European complement to J.
Assmann’s Cultural Memory and Early Civilization.
102
See also Jeffery Tigay, The Evolution of the Gilgamesh Epic (Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press,
1982).
103
104
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 383.
227
composition and addressing a reader), a writing culture changes from sectorial to
cultural literacy. Only at this point do the techniques of writing and reading affect the
connective structure of a society.105
Thinking about this temporal reconfiguration of cultural memory along with the insights
about the homeostatic nature of oral thought is again in line with the analytic shifts
advocated by Ong and Goody. Assmann sums this up elsewhere by saying:
Writing is a technology that makes cultural creations possible that would otherwise
never exist, and that preserves cultural creations in memory, making accessible to later
recourse what would otherwise be forgotten and have vanished. Writing, in short, is a
factor of cultural creativity and cultural memory.106
Obviously this had major consequences in relation to the emergence of textualized
historical and political records that began appearing as literate traditions took root in
various urban societies. Not only did this bestow new temporal horizons on cultures who
could engage in different forms of dialogue with their inherited traditions, but the
permanence of writing also lent an increasingly authoritative aura to knowledge presented in
permanent visual format (recalling, of course, that writing only emerged in agricultural
societies with centralized forms of political authority).
But aside from enhanced administrative methods enabled by the invention of
writing, the reconfiguration of the connective structures of cultural memory had especially
important consequences in the realm of religion, particularly with the emergence of the
textually-based “axial” or “world” religions”. However I will discuss this shortly when
summarizing how these perspectives entail a redescription of the 1st millennium BCE.
Ibid., 383f., 385. Assmann is explicitly building upon the earlier work of Maurice Halbwachs, On Collective
Memory (trans. L. Coser; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1992 [1941]). See also Assmann, Cultural
Memory and Early Civilization (21-33) for another discussion of Halbwachs.
105
106
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 380.
228
A final point to note is that while Donald defends his view that the externalization
stage entailed a genuine shift in cognitive operations, he is also clear that unlike the mimetic
and mythic layers that structure human life, the theoretic stage has by no means been a
universal development over the last seven thousand years. It is not a genetic development,
but rather a development related to power and the capacity for resource acquisition:
Theoretic culture is dominated by a relatively small elite with highly developed literacydependent cognitive skills, and its principal instruments of control, such as codified
laws, economic and bureaucratic management, and reflective scientific and cultural
institutions, are external to the individual memory system. This type of representation
has gradually emerged as the governing level of representation in some modern
societies. Although it dominates science, engineering, education, government, and the
management of the economy, it includes only a minority of humanity, and even in that
minority, its influence is somewhat tenuous.107
This is yet another approach that allows us to redescribe the “critical” traditions of
European thought not as inherently “superior” to “primitive” cultures, but as being enabled
by vast networks of externalized knowledge resources.
Recall that the discussion was moved to Donald specifically in response to the
question posed by David Christian and Colin Renfrew about how one can account for the
startling pace of change in human history over the past 60,000 years in spite of the fact that
our basic cognitive architecture has remained almost unchanged over that period. Thus, if
we are looking for a paradigm for explaining historical change and cultural difference that
does not rely on Geist, then the arguments of people such as Christian, Donald, Goody and
Assmann surely provide one of the most compelling candidates: a multifaceted focus on the
dynamics of communication and cultural memory in the long-term perspective.
107 Donald, M., “An Evolutionary Approach to Culture: Implications for the Study of the Axial Age” in The
Axial Age and Its Consequences (ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas; Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2012), 4776, here 67. See also Chapter 1 above regarding Donald’s view that we are “hybrid minds” (n. 104).
229
Unstitching the Axial Age: Elements of a Redescription
This has been a long excursus, and much more could be said. But to get things back on
track, I now want to be explicit about how the developments that described in this chapter
problematize virtually all of the major assumptions on which the Jasperian version of the
Axial Age is predicated. I will approach this by focusing on the tropes identified in the last
chapter, but it is first necessary to address several other problems that suggest themselves
from the foregoing discussion.
An initial problem is something not yet mentioned, but which has been raised by a
number of other scholars, Assmann being one of them. This is the synchronicity of the axial
shifts in Jaspers’ original view, all of which he held to have occurred in the period 800-200
BCE. This is problematic primarily because it excludes Egypt from the sphere of axiality,
even though Assmann convincingly demonstrates that Egyptian religious thought displayed
the kind of “transcendence” that was supposed to characterize axial cultures vis-à-vis preaxial ones.108 Moreover, Jaspers also included Zoroaster within the axial frame, whereas
modern scholarship now places him in the second millennium BCE, and there is by no
means consensus that such a figure even existed at all.109 This consideration leads Assmann
to state that “My impression is that time matters too much in the theoretical debates on the
Axial Age”, even though some contemporary scholars continue to dwell on it.110
108
See e.g. Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 395ff.
This point was made to me in firm fashion by Bruce Lincoln upon asking his opinion about the issues: “[I]
have never paid the slightest attention to discussions of the scholarly myth/fantasy of some ‘Axial Age.’ In
brief, the chronology posited for it is demonstrably wrong, since Zarathustra – if ‘he’ existed at all – was five
centuries or more before the time said theories assign to him, in a misguided attempt to bring him into
conjunction with Moses and Buddha, thereby construing ‘evidence’ for a Big Pattern and a Big Story. Why
Jaspers & Co. want to do this is beyond me and it’s never seemed important enough to probe the question.
I’m content simply to ignore a trend that strikes me as foolish, even if relatively influential.” (Personal
communication, November 11, 2012. Reproduced with permission.)
109
110
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 375.
230
But the synchronicity issue is little more than a technicality compared to most of the
other problems with the Axial Age construct. One of the most over-arching of these is the
category of “man” that structures Jaspers’ discourse, for he called the Axial Age the point at
which “Man, as we know him today, came into being”. This can be problematized from two
angles. Firstly, the new evolutionary paradigm of history has made clear that there is no
such thing as a “stable” human nature, either biologically or cognitively. As Smail notes, the
human body is “the product of an unbroken genealogy that extends back far beyond the
earliest hominins. Where, in this genealogy, is there ever a moment when we can point to
the ‘natural’ human body?”.111 Smail elsewhere says that “Darwinian natural selection, after
all, has a fundamentally anti-essentialist epistemology. That is the whole point. Species,
according to Darwin, are not fixed entities with natural essences imbued by the creator”.112
Clearly this is a view that echoes Foucault’s claim about “the death of man”.
Using Donald’s insights, one can extend this question to human cognitive capacities
and ask when “truly human” thought began. Jaspers and many others have lauded the
“critical” thought of axial cultures over the “world-accepting” thought of cultures that did
not undergo the shift. But as Donald and Assmann help us to see, the cultural shifts of the
1st millennium BCE are completely related to the new technologies of externalized memory
that were made possible by the invention of writing. Whilst these were integral for other
processes of urbanization, Assmann makes clear that one of the most important
consequences of writing was the way in which it altered the connective structures of cultural
memory in societies where it occurred, giving them new temporal horizons for
understanding the past, thus completely altering their relationship to the inherited traditions
that constituted their identities. And as Donald has made clear, the cultural shifts associated
111
Smail & Shyrock, Deep History, 68.
112
Smail, Deep History and the Brain, 124.
231
with the theoretic stage of human cognitive history are by no means universal or an
anthropological necessity. They are what happens when human cognition can be performed
in vast externalized networks of information, and when cultural ideation takes place within
urban contexts rather than the very different existential situation of small-scale foraging
societies. Thus, if Jaspers wanted to say that the 1st millennium BCE was the point at which
the human relationship to the past began to be radically restructured through the use of
external memory systems, and that this has been characteristic of much of the world since
that time, then that would be one thing. But it is untenable to simply say that this was the
point at which “authentic” humanity began to flourish.
Moreover, the political and ideological nature of the category of “man” has been
systematically exposed by feminist and post-structuralist criticism. In much of the western
tradition, “man” was simply a shorthand for the white, educated, modern, self-reflexive,
heterosexual European male, and this kind of “man” was held to be the fullest
representation of what it was to be human.113 It has therefore been against this standard that
non-Europe and non-urban cultures have historically been regarded as “inferior” to
European thought and culture.
Jaspers was explicitly trying to move beyond this kind of Hegelian Eurocentrism –
but just as he only managed a pluralized version of the metanarrative of Geist, so he only
achieves a pluralized version of “man”, who he construes as the “self-reflexive” thinker
with historical agency. It is a view of humanity which still posits a sharp dividing line
between cultures that engage in the expansive critical reflection enabled by traditions of
literacy, and cultures whose traditions are structured more heavily by orally-constituted
forms of thought. This point has also been made by Johann Arnason, who has drawn
113 For a treatment of this issue in relation to both post-structuralist critique as well as the European study of
religion, see Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, esp. 275-316.
232
attention to the fact that Jaspers’ “most condensed statement” of the Axial Age – i.e. the
view that “man becomes conscious of Being as a whole, of himself and his limitations”,
experiencing “absoluteness in the depths of selfhood and the lucidity of transcendence” – is
remarkably similar to Jaspers’ own version of existential philosophy.114 It is for this reason
that Assmann has argued that
The theory of the Axial Age is the creation of philosophers and sociologists, not of
historians and philologists on whose research the theory is based. It is an answer to the
question for the roots of modernity … [and] is not so much about “man as we know
him” and his/her first appearance in time, but about “man as we want him to be” and
the utopian goal of a universal civilized community.115
In addition to these issues, we can now return to the tropes reproduced by Hick and Jaspers
and be clear about why they are untenable in light of the intellectual changes that have been
described. The first trope I will address is the view of non-civilizational culture as living in a
Hobbesian dystopia, which in Hobbes’ classic formulation meant that primitive life was
“solitary, poor, nasty, brutish, and short”.116 As noted in the previous chapter, this is of
particular importance for Jaspers’ narrative, because of the way in which the Axial Age is
seen to be the birth of ethics (cf. the affinity of this view with the fact that the “world”
religions were formerly considered to be the “ethical” religions). This is also important in
Hick’s argument, because he spends a great deal of time establishing that the “ethical
criterion” of his pluralistic hypothesis is that a society may be “judged by its moral fruits”.
This allows Hick to rank the post-axial religions as “higher” than non-axial religions.
Arnason, J., “The Axial Age and Its Interpreters: Reopening a Debate” in Axial Civilizations and World
History (ed. J. Arnason, B. Wittrock, & S. Eisenstadt; Leiden: Brill, 2005), 19-49, here 31f. The Jaspers citation
is from On the Origin and Goal of History, 2.
114
115
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 366 and 401.
116
See above, ch. 4, n. 64.
233
It goes without saying that there are a number of problems with this view. Firstly,
the lessons from communications history, especially regarding oral cultures, should make us
alert that just because a culture’s ethical or moral views were never systematically codified in written texts,
this does not mean that they did not exist. Moreover, in recent anthropological studies it has been
well acknowledged that non-urban cultures are not marked by unethical opportunism, but
rather richly collaborative social networks that always includes ideas about proper behaviour
and social responsibilities – the cornerstone of ethics – which become codified at multiple
levels across a society’s collective representations (especially in myths and rituals). Indeed,
the intensely collaborative nature of our species has been widely recognized as constituting
one of our key evolutionary advantages.117 This advantage was accelerated with the
emergence of language, which via the mechanism of narrative began to codify social
obligations into the fabric of communal thought, eventually leading to the ethical
prescriptions that were written down in the early textual religions. “Ethics” is therefore part
of a universal pattern of human sociality, and not the preserve of the world’s major
religions.
Secondly, the lack of ethics before civilization was also tied to the notion that the
political state was a necessary institution for the cultivation of morality, and that it was the
prime force in cleansing humanity of its animalistic barbarism to produce “rational man”.
This view was never primarily grounded in empirical observation, and was rather a product
of the discursive strategies of European imperialism employed in the justification of global
political expansion. Whether it was the advancement of Geist or the spread of “civilization”,
viewing non-European others as devoid of ethical awareness was a key part of legitimating
attempts at worldwide political hegemony.
117
See most recently Edward O. Wilson, The Social Conquest of Earth (New York: Liveright, 2012).
234
This leads the two other closely related tropes of allochronism and primitive stasis. As
noted, the allochronic tendency highlighted by Johannes Fabian was a constitutive part of
European anthropology from its inception. In what Fabian called “the denial of
coevalness”, anthropologists systematically removed themselves from their ethnographic
accounts and presented the peoples under study as relics of a bygone age, even though the
anthropologist’s
contact
with
such
cultures
implied
an
important
degree
of
contemporaneity. This is related to the idea of primitive stasis because of the way that it
assumes the “unchanging” nature of all small-scale, oral, non-urban cultures. Like Tylor and
Lubbock’s view, the primitive was taken to be a fossilized representation of stone age
humanity. This was also tied to the pervasive notion that the true agents of history were
urban, civilized societies, who were the only ones able to break out of the biological cycles
of “mere nature” and take control of their fate. This denial of historical agency was another
essential element in justifying the aggressive advance of European culture throughout the
world, not to mention the justification it provided for slavery and other forms of economic
and social subordination.
Before explaining the problem with these ideas, it is important to note that they do
contain at least some degree of validity. It is first necessary to bear in mind that while the
view of the primitive as static is, to contemporary eyes, a gross oversimplification, scholars
in the nineteenth century had extremely little evidence to go on, and nothing in the way of
genetic analysis or absolute chronometry in which to ground their speculations. Whilst they
could hypothetically have made more favourable judgements about the moral and ethical
qualities of anthropologically documented peoples, it is unrealistic to seriously expect that
they should have done so.
Also, it would be bad scholarship not to recognize that Tylor was at least somewhat
correct when he equated Australian Aboriginal culture with the conditions of stone age
235
humanity. They appear not to have developed any form of sedentary agriculture (even if
they did have well established and highly effective traditions of ecological management),118
nor did they develop any of the complex technologies that were constitutive of the shift to
the highly populated urban societies that arose in worldzones at the centre of important
trade networks. Moreover, are not contemporary scholars also doing a similar thing to Tylor
when they use contemporary oral cultures to speculate about the lifeways of paleolithic
humanity? I will address that shortly.
Notwithstanding these important concessions, the view of non-urban cultures as
static is untenable in the new frame of human history. The rapid spread of human societies
in the period since the African migration, and the intensity of the process of cultural
differentiation across the world – which was infinitely greater than the slow pace of change
even in early hominid culture – attest to the dynamic vitality of orally-constituted cultures.
Even though oral thought is well documented as being necessarily “conservative” due to
the limitations imposed by biological memory capacities and small populations, oral cultures
changed. Smail laments that “Paleohistorians do daily battle with the assumption that human
prehistory is marked by long periods of behavioral fixity and cultural stasis, not variety and
change”, noting that this tendency continued well into the latter part of the twentieth
century in most textbooks on “the history of civilization”.119 Smail says elsewhere that
When the past is simply a repository of the “natural,” it is not a historical past: it is
instead a mythical or cosmological past, providing yet another mirror in which
humanity can search for its own reflection. Such an understanding of the past has no
room for contingency, no room for change, and no way to understand the pathdependent nature of variation within systems.120
118
See e.g. Tim Flannery, The Future Eaters: An Ecological History of the Australasian Lands and People (Chatswood,
N.S.W.: Reed, 1995); and Stephen Pyne, World Fire: The Culture of Fire on Earth (2nd ed.; Seattle: University of
Washington Press, 1997), 9-44.
119
See Smail, Deep History and the Brain, 34, 99; and Smail & Shyrock, Deep History, 13.
120
Smail & Shyrock, Deep History, 12.
236
The host of insights generated in the new evolutionary paradigms of history therefore
completely undermine the myth of prehistoric stasis. Furthermore, when scholars today use
examples of oral cultures to speculate about the possible conditions of pre-urbanized
human culture, they do so with important caveats that explicitly deny any exact comparison
between contemporary oral cultures and paleolithic ones. A representative caveat can be
seen in Robert Bellah’s comment about the Walbiri nation, an indigenous Australian society
that he uses as an example of Donald’s “mythic” (i.e. oral) stage of consciousness:
I am not claiming that the Walbiri represent the ancient, unchanging, “true” Aboriginal
tradition – everything we know about Aboriginal culture suggests that it was, like all
other cultures, always open to continuous change – but rather that the Walbiri and
other central desert tribes probably tell us most about what the continent-wide
Aboriginal culture was like 200 years ago, on the verge of contact.121
The problem of primitive stasis is also closely related to the developmental evolutionary hierarchy
that was implied by the Eurocentric ideology of progress, in which Europe was treated as
the apex of humanity. In other words, the real problem with Tylor’s view of Aboriginal
culture as representative of paleolithic humanity is the metanarrative in which it was framed.
Again, there is no denying the significant differences between small-scale oral cultures and
more complex agricultural and industrial societies. But in the new evolutionary paradigm of
human history, the unilinear narrative of progress has been replaced with a non-teleological
approach, one that accounts for historical change with a much firmer focus on the material
factors underpinning human cultural diversity and does not take any kind of cultural
formation to be “normative humanity” (cf. again the “death of man” issue). Therefore, in
this view European exceptionalism is seen as a fanciful myth, because all of Europe’s recent
121
Bellah, Religion in Human Evolution, 146.
237
achievements are the result of a deep history of global inter-cultural collaboration, rather
than because there was anything inherently “superior” about European culture.122
Even though Jaspers explicitly denied both the stages of development suggested by
Hegel and the European triumphalism of the progress narrative, his division between
historical and non-historical peoples nevertheless operates with a clear developmental
hierarchy of human cultures. In this hierarchy, civilizational cultures with “spiritualized”
traditions of “critical” thought rank as the highest representative of what it is to be human,
whereas cultures without writing are explicitly denied historical agency. The Axial Age is a
still a Hegelian narrative, and has only been pluralized with regard to other major
civilizational cultures. This remains the case with Hick.
The final trope that needs to be problematized is the view that orally based thought
was irrational. This is closely correlated with the view that historical agency began with the
emergence of civilization, and is closely tied with the view that only in civilizational cultures
did the “modern” traditions of critical thought and spiritual reflection begin. Put bluntly,
this is another gross oversimplification that has resulted from the textocentric biases that
underpin the entire history of modern European thought. Using the insights of figures such
as Donald, Ong, Assmann, and Eisenstein (and the many others listed in the supplementary
bibliography), a very different perspective can be taken on the differences between orallyconstituted cultural traditions and cultural tradition based on the use of written documents.
This perspective pertains to all of the problems so far discussed, and could be framed
roughly as follows.
122 On this issue, see Jack Goldstone, Why Europe? The Rise of the West in World History, 1500-1850 (New York:
McGraw-Hill, 2009).
238
The cultural memory of orally based cultures is subject to firm biological constraints.
Thought cannot be contained outside the body, except in limited degree in collective
embodied traditions, in the mnemonics of place, and in the small vocabularies of languages
unsupported by external media (which were typically no larger than a few thousand words
and subject to the dynamics of homeostasis as described by Ong and Goody).123 This means
that what is learned has to be remembered assiduously, encoded as well as possible in
collective, mnemophilic forms such as narrative, song, and ritual. This accounts (a) for the
conservative nature of orally-constituted thought and the tight controls typically imposed
on innovation; (b) for the apparent historical horizon in oral cultures of only several
generations, before which point the past is conceptualized as a primordial realm; and (c) for
the perceived lack of traditions of criticism, a lack which has historically provided the
cornerstone for the view that they were not rational. Moreover, the perishability of purely
verbal language means that historians have no access whatsoever to any preliterate forms of
thought that may have offered strident critiques of existing social orders or posed
revolutionary ideas about the nature of the cosmos.124 Again, the rapid cultural
differentiation of human groups suggests that far from unchanging, orally-constituted
symbolic universes were regularly subjected to revision. This is further suggested by the fact
that humans have had the same cognitive architecture for at least 60,000 years, if not
considerably longer, and have thus had very similar capacities for symbolic imagination
during that period.
On the mnemonics of place, see e.g. Keith Basso, Wisdom Sits in Places: Landscape and Language Among the
Western Apache (Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1996). See further Senses of Place (ed. S. Feld &
K. Basso; Santa Fe, NM: School of American Research Press, 1996). See also Bellah, Religion in Human
Evolution, 148 (citing Fred Meyers on the Australian Pintupi people). On the role played by ritual in cultural
mnemonics, see also ibid., 132 (citing Donald on mimetic culture); J. Z. Smith, To Take Place: Toward Theory in
Ritual (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1987); and Roy Rappaport, Ritual and Religion in the Making of
Humanity.
123
In this connection, I note the fascinating volume Becoming Human: Innovation in Prehistoric and Spiritual Culture
(ed. C. Renfrew & A. Morely; Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2009).
124
239
Therefore, the major differences between “world religions” and “primitive”
religions – i.e. between orally-constituted thought and cultural traditions supported by
written language – is based most fundamentally on the different media through which the construction and
maintainance of their cultural identity could play out. The externalization of memory enabled by
writing revolutionized the human relationship to the past in societies where it occurred, and
was the fundamental precondition for the forms of “critical” thought that have been so
valorized in the history of European scholarship. Moreover, writing only occurred in
urbanized agricultural societies, which entailed entirely different existential pressures from
smaller oral societies and therefore produced different kinds of philosophical thought,
further accounting for the “world rejecting” character of the world religions vis-à-vis the
different character of cultural traditions from smaller oral societies.
Assmann has demonstrated the impact of writing on the connective structures of
cultural memory in the first civilizations where it emerged, which helps to account for the
“historical” and “critical” character of the axial cultures, who were in conversation with past
traditions in a way impossible where such traditions were not preserved in writing. Thus,
contra the traditional view that the rise of the world religions coincides with “the birth of the
individual” or “the discovery of transcendence”, Assmann instead suggests with more
nuance that
writing is a technology that restructures not only thought but also, under certain
cultural circumstances, the whole network of relations between human beings, man
and society, man and cosmos, man and god, and god and cosmos.125
Ong has convincingly uncovered the unconscious epistemological biases inherent in highly
textualized social world, which further helps to understand why orally-based thought has
been so consistently denigrated in the European imagination; and in doing so, he has
125
Assmann, “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age”, 395.
240
suggested much more nuanced ways of articulating the differences between orallyconstituted thought and thought that employs external memory systems. Eisenstein helps
us to realize just how fundamental technologies of communication were in the development
of European modernity – it was not some “genius” inherent in the “European spirit” that
brought about the scientific revolution and the Enlightenment, but the enhanced
informational networks enabled by the invention of typography. And using the insights of
Donald and Christian, we can see all of these changes as part of the long-term patterns of
collective learning that have been the evolutionary hallmark of Homo sapiens.
These insights allow the argument that the thought of literate cultures is not “more
rational” than the thought of oral cultures, nor was it more ethical, nor was it more
authentically religious, as Jaspers, Hick, and many others have argued. This is a naïve and
oversimplified view when the above factors are taken into consideration. Rather, the
differences between small-scale oral cultures and urbanized literate cultures should be
viewed in relation to the fact that literate cultures had access to increasingly massive
archives of accumulated knowledge to which they could devote their intellectual and
spiritual energies, and that this in turn shaped their thoughts about the world.
In other words, the 1st millennium BCE is not the flourishing of “true” humanity,
and it is not the singular “axis” of world history – it is simply one of many flashpoints in the
fascinating dialectic between distributed cognition and cultural memory, a process that has
been going on for millions of years. Donald provides a fascinating redescription of the 1st
millennium BCE in line with these different perspectives:
The Axial Age was, above all, a period when … Humanity, or rather, that part of
humanity confronted with the need to solve the problems of an increasingly urban and literate society,
was experimenting with novel ways to view the human world. For some time, these
societies had been trying to cope with a new way of life that was different from
anything that had come before. The old visions and worldviews were apparently not
adequate to the task of carrying people through these new times. Perhaps old ideas
failed to make societies cohere as they had in the past, in simpler tribal structures.
241
Perhaps they failed in the important task of keeping the peace or establishing an
enduring social order. These stresses all present cognitive challenges to the basic
assumptions that people make when they live in a community and share resources.126
Even though one could frame the issues in a different way from that of Donald, this way of
viewing the 1st millennium BCE effectively unstitches the idealist version Axial Age. Jaspers
obviously made many legitimate sociological observations about the similarities between the
religious traditions that took root in the 1st millennium BCE. But the narrative in which he
emplotted those events was predicated on a transcendental spark of consciousness that awoke
humanity and set it on the path of history – and virtually all of the assumptions that sustain
this view are indefensible in the context modern historical scholarship. On the one hand, it
takes textual cultures as the fullest representation of what it is to be human; on the other
hand, it is based on views about non-textual cultures that have their root in the racially
grounded categories of nineteenth-century thought. Not only are such assumptions counter
to the pluralistic ethos that animated Hick and Jaspers, but they are in most cases
demonstrably false.
This is why a different way of emplotting the changes of the Axial Age is required
that does not rely on a deus ex machina “breakthrough” into “reflexive” consciousness and
historical agency. I believe that a plausible alternative paradigm is provided by the one
developed in this chapter. Having now made this argument, I turn in the Conclusion to
what all of this means for evaluating Hick’s pluralist theory of religions, and what it means
for the premises of theological pluralism in general vis-à-vis the critical standards of
contemporary scholarship.
126
Donald, “An Evolutionary Approach to Culture”, 74 (italics added).
242
Conclusion
Don’t Say All Religions Are Equal Unless You Really Mean It:
Theological Pluralism and the Academic Study of Religion
As has been stressed throughout this dissertation, Jaspers and Hick were scholars who
advocated the highest standards of critical scholarship. Even though their arguments were
primarily philosophical, they were also intended to be persuasive at a broad historical level.
Hick declared his attempt to “take full account of the data and theories of the human
sciences”, thus inviting critique from non-theological perspectives, and Jaspers likewise
attempted to ground his reading of the 1st millennium BCE within the fullest frame of
scientific and historical knowledge available in the mid-twentieth century.
Yet importantly, as highly intelligent scholars who were well aware that new
information was continually coming to light, both acknowledged the potential need to
revise their arguments. Jaspers stated that:
I should like to maintain an awareness of the dependence of our cognition
upon current standpoints, methods, and facts and, thereby, of the particularity
of all cognition; [and] I should like to hold the question open and leave room
for possible new starting-points in the search for knowledge, which we cannot
imagine in advance.1
Hick makes a similar concession in the preface of An Interpretation of Religion, the first
sentence of which is particularly revealing in light of the foregoing chapters:
In concentrating on the ‘great world religions’ I have given primal religion less
attention than I ought to have. However the aim has not been to produce
something complete or definitive, but to make a preliminary exploration of a
range of problems that are only now entering the purview of western
philosophy of religion, and to suggest a possible approach to them. Those
who find this approach inadequate or misleading will I hope feel under
obligation to propose another, so that the various options can be progressively
clarified and their merits considered.2
1
Jaspers, On the Origin and Goal of History, 18.
2
Hick, An Interpretation of Religion, xiii.
245
In my view, the analysis of this dissertation makes clear that the arguments of Jaspers and
Hick are indeed “inadequate” readings of human history, and that changes in the state of
knowledge have unquestionably necessitated the “new starting points” of which Jaspers
spoke (particularly with regard to the notion of an “axial” dividing line in history). It should
also be clear by now that this study has largely been an attempt to take up Hick’s challenge
of suggesting alternative explanatory approaches to religious history should his own
argument be found wanting, something evident particularly in the extended discussion of
Chapter 5. This was undertaken not just as a matter of good academic practice – i.e.
because the rejection of any argument should always include an attempt to suggest
alternative approaches to the question at hand – but also because, in the present case,
suggesting ways of re-narrativizing the 1st millennium BCE has the potential to bring
together many strands of contemporary scholarship and help move the academic study of
religion in promising new directions, both at a research level and in the classroom.
I will expand on this claim shortly. But first, as a way of summarizing the results of
this study, it is important to provide a final statement about the problems inherent in the
“great traditions” model of theological pluralism represented by figures such as Jaspers and
Hick. Recalling Hick’s comment, cited numerous times in this work, that a contemporary
philosopher of religion must today take account of “the experience and thought of the
whole human race”, the unavoidable conclusion is that his theory is deficient in this regard.
This is because by focusing so heavily on the post-axial “great world religions” Hick makes
normative a certain form of religion – one that arose in the context of urbanization and
empire, and, moreover, one underpinned by the technology of writing – thereby making
this the measuring stick of “authentic” religion. Again, while the “great traditions” may
represent a majority of human beings in recent millennia, they represent a tiny minority of
the ideational communities that have existed throughout the long stretch of human history.
246
Moreover, beyond the way that these issues conflict with his self-imposed
methodological parameters, Hick’s focus on the post-axial traditions – and particularly his
arguments for their superiority – also conflict at a fundamental level with his intention to
move beyond Eurocentric paradigms for the treatment of religious history. As was made
clear in Chapters 3 and 4, behind Hick’s seemingly positive focus on the “great” traditions
lies a wide-ranging (and largely unarticulated) set of assumptions about non-urban cultures
that are not only empirically dubious, but which are also the legacy of the racialized
structures of European discourse. This is, of course, true for the world religions paradigm
at large. These assumptions therefore remain intimately tied to the logic that sustained the
ideology of European exceptionalism that Hick and Jaspers were trying to overcome. Even
though Hick attempted to diffuse any negative implications with regard to “archaic” and
“pre-literate” traditions, stressing that he attached “no religious stigma” to them, I
demonstrated that the logic of his argument clearly suggests otherwise, and that this is,
unfortunately, a superficial concession that has not penetrated his thinking in any
meaningful way. As such, Hick’s concession that he gave “primal religion less attention that
he ought” can now be seen as a rather drastic understatement of a problem that, when
scrutinized properly, undermines his whole argument.3
However another claim I have been making throughout this work is that Hick was
certainly not racist himself, and that he only argued the way he did because of his inherited
discourses – i.e. because of the historically constituted assumptions of the world religions
paradigm and other European traditions of historical and anthropological thought. The fact
that the negative implications of these assumptions remained invisible to Hick (and indeed
to most of his contemporaries) is thus a perfect illustration of the way that discourse
functions as analysed by scholars such as Foucault. I also suggested in Chapter 1 that when
3
On the term “primal” religion, see above, ch. 4, n. 80.
247
the pluralist paradigm began to crystalize across parts of western culture in the period after
the 1960s, it was suffused with a highly-charged liberal, democratic sensibility that I called
“the affective sentiment of pluralism”, something reflected in the pluralist emphasis on
non-triumphalist theological discourses that prioritize experience over doctrine in the
question of religious diversity.
Another example that supports these considerations is the fact that, as borne out by
Hick’s autobiography, the impetus for his argument came directly from his encounter with
people from other major religious traditions. Whereas Huston Smith had experienced first-hand
the religion of an indigenous culture, and thus counted “primal” religions in the same
category as the major textual religions from the 1970s onwards, Hick never had such an
immediate encounter.
In my view, these factors explain why someone like Hick – who actively opposed
racism in both word and deed – was able to consider the argument of An Interpretation of
Religion an egalitarian reading of history, despite the fact that it clearly perpetuates many of
the Eurocentric assumptions that he was trying to move beyond. The same applies to
Jaspers, Cantwell Smith, and many other liberal religionists.
Be that as it may, however, I am not trying to rescue the pluralist argument. I am
simply attempting to understand a contradiction that struck me as intriguing early in my
research, and it is hoped that the results of this curiosity have generated productive insights
into an important strand of contemporary religious discourse. Indeed, far from wishing to
rescue Hick, it is surely the case that the great traditions model of pluralism – including the
Axial Age narrative – is totally irredeemable in the context of modern scholarship (albeit
not for the reasons surveyed in Chapter 2), and that it can only be regarded as the relic of
an intellectual era before evolutionary and postcolonial questions had properly begun to
impose themselves on the agenda of studying long-term religious history.
248
So then, what’s the moral of the story? Although a somewhat playful question, my
suggestion would be that if one treats the example of Hick as a cautionary tale about not
getting so easily swept up in warm and fuzzy pluralistic constructs like the Axial Age
without more thorough critical scrutiny (a lesson that many scholars today would still do
well to heed), then the moral is as follows: don’t say all religions are equal unless you really
mean it.
This deliberately provocative answer, however, obviously begs the question of what it
actually means to say that “all religions are equal”. While I have no intention of approaching
this question philosophically or theologically, reflecting on it is a useful way of
springboarding from my appraisal of Hick into some of the wider methodological issues
that have been broached in this dissertation.
Consider again the example of Huston Smith. As noted, Smith’s form of pluralism
was somewhat different from Hick’s. Although the original 1958 edition of The Religions of
Man was structured by an Axial Age/world religions logic, by the time a new edition
appeared in 1990 as The World’s Religions, the work also included a chapter on “primal”
religions. To repeat a portion of the comment cited in Chapter 4, Smith said:
I knew I had to do that because the religions I had dealt with in the first edition were
all part of the field we call “historical religions,” which have sacred text and histories
recorded in writing. But these religions are only the tip of the iceberg. They are only
about four thousand years old, whereas the primal, tribal, oral religions can be traced
back archeologically into the twilight zone of prehistory, perhaps forty or fifty
thousand years ago. To omit them from the first edition of my book was inexcusable,
and I am glad I will not go to my grave with that mistake uncorrected. The added
chapter honors the primal religions as fully equal to the historical ones.4
The claim that such religions are “fully equal” is certainly a more encompassing position
than Hick’s original theory (even if Hick might now agree with Smith). However, even this
4
Smith, A Seat At The Table, 4. See also The World’s Religions (x, xi) for similar statements.
249
expanded pluralism remains problematic in relation to several critical issues in the academic
study of religion, particularly those sketched out in Chapter 1 concerning theological
essentialism and the notion of an irreducible, sui generis sacred. This is important to note
given the wide salience of the pluralist mood across contemporary culture, especially
because H. Smith’s more expanded form of pluralism seems to represent the position of a
growing number of people in the twenty-first century.5
To recap the critique of essentialism, Russell McCutcheon and others have argued
that the claim that “religion” is somehow a unique, sui generis domain of existence is a
rhetorical strategy that was primarily deployed in response to the perceived threat of
“reductionist” explanations of religion (a strategy still prevalent today). The claim was made
famously by Friedrich Schleiermacher in response to Kant and the Enlightenment, and
received influential rearticulation a century later by Schleiermacher’s disciple, Rudolf Otto,
who stressed throughout Das Heilige that the Holy was a totally sui generis phenomenon. This
served as the de facto motto of the phenomenological tradition represented by figures such
as Gerhardus van der Leeuw, Wilhelm B. Kristensen, and of course Mircea Eliade, whose
perspective was the dominant one in the field of religious studies in the second half of the
twentieth century.
However, because the claim had this reactionary character, its proponents rarely
attempted to defend it from a rigorous historical perspective. Instead, they simply assumed
the ontological reality of the sacred as an a priori fact, usually relying as evidence on the
notion that certain “experiences” are somehow “unmistakably” religious. The question of a
metanarrative of religious history did at least receive some attention in the days of Tiele and
I note Jacob Olupona’s comment about “the very sacred spiritual traditions of Africa, the Americas, Asia,
and wherever indigenous people inhabit the earth” (Olupona, J., “Preface” in Beyond Primitivism, xiv). To me
this seems like a good representation of many contemporary religious liberals, given that the postcolonial
agenda has asserted itself in a general enough way to render the “great traditions” model of pluralism
somewhat unpalatable, even for those not familiar with critical academic debates.
5
250
Otto, although this is because they subscribed to various forms of the Hegelian paradigm of
world history at a time when the classification of religions was made against the background
of the developmental progress narrative (which posited a move from animist religion to
ethical religion, culminating in Protestant Christianity). As discussed in Chapter 3, this
diachronic view of religious history was replaced in the mid-twentieth-century with a
synchronic view whereby religion did not “develop”, but was instead universal across time
and space. Because of this assertion of universality, the question of providing a plausible
historical account largely fell off the agenda. Correspondingly, the emphasis of
synchronically oriented essentialists began to shift away from speculating about the origins
of religion (typically a “reductive” exercise, in their view) to focusing on the “living world
religions”. Aside from the other discursive currents already described, this is another factor
that led Huston Smith to his earlier view that primal religion was “unimportant” (a view, let
us not forget, even praised at one point by Wilfred Cantwell Smith).6 And even after H.
Smith’s turn towards oral cultures in the 1970s, he then simply agreed with Eliade that “If
God does not evolve, neither, it seems, does homo religiosus, not in any important respect”.7
In other words, within the essentialist tradition (particularly since the synchronic
view became dominant) there have been few attempts to historically justify claims about the
sui generis nature of the beliefs and practices that modern westerners call “religious”. This
problem has become all the more pressing today given the substantial changes in our
understanding of the deep evolutionary history of humanity, as suggested by the discussion
of Donald and others in Chapter 5 (a discussion which, I might add, barely scratched the
surface of literature now available on the topic). Despite this, however, the academic study
of religion has remained largely structured around the premise that religion is a unique
6
See above, ch. 3, p. 146.
7
Smith, H., The World’s Religions, 368.
251
domain of human life, and that it should be treated differently from how scholars treat
other forms of human behaviour. When demonstrating this assertion, critics usually point
not only to the early influence of Eliade and others on the formation of the discipline, but
also to the overwhelming prevalence since that time of descriptive, phenomenological
approaches in the field of religious studies at both a pedagogical level and in the
professional associations of the field. As they argue, this is still broadly the case even in the
twenty-first century.8
However Eliade himself, it must be noted before continuing, is an important
exception to the general lack of historical focus amongst synchronic essentialists. While his
most widely read works, The Sacred and the Profane and Patterns in Comparative Religion, are
based upon his command of a vast set of data concerning the history of religions, they are
ahistorical in their presentation and seek to demonstrate the universality of the sacred, not
its historical development. But in his three-volume History of Religious Ideas, Eliade offered an
impressively detailed presentation of religious history spanning from the depths of the
paleolithic until the Reformation.9 This makes his claims about the universality of the sacred
more complex.
Given that a major problem with most essentialist arguments has been a neglect to
seriously engage the question of the evolutionary origins of religion, the first chapter of A
History of Religious Ideas is particularly interesting. Entitled “In the Beginning…: Magico See e.g. McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion; Timothy Fitzgerald, The Ideology of Religious Studies; and Bruce
Lincoln, “The (Un)disipline of Religious Studies” in Gods and Demons, Priests and Scholars: Critical Explorations in
the History of Religions (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2012), 131-136. J. Z. Smith also notes a 1961
announcement from scholars in the History of Religions field at the University of Chicago that “It is the
contention of the discipline of the History of Religions that a valid case can be made for the interpretation of
transcendence as transcendence.” Smith elsewhere notes in a similar connection that “I find the language of
transcendence distressingly vague” (both quotations from On Teaching Religion, respectively: “Are Theological
Studies and Religious Studies Compatible?” [76]; and “‘Religion’ and ‘Religious Studies’: No Difference at All”
[84]).
8
Eliade, M., A History of Religious Ideas (3 vols; trans. W. R. Trask [1-2]; A. Hiltebeitel & D. ApostolosCappadona [3]; Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1978-1985). Eliade indicated that he planned a final
volume on the “archaic and traditional religions of America, Africa, and Oceania”, though it never appeared
(3: xi). See the bibliography for full references.
9
252
Religious Behavior of the Paleanthropians”, Eliade states that ever since the domestication
of fire around half a million years ago – which for him marks “the definitive separation of
the Paleanthropians from their zoological predecessors” – humans have had some form of
religion:
The first technological discoveries – the transformation of stone into instruments for
attack and defense, the mastery over fire – not only insured the survival and
development of the human species; they also produced a universe of mythico-religious
values and fed the creative imagination.10
Yet despite this nuanced consideration of material factors at play in the development of
human cognition, Eliade’s view remained ultimately ahistorical. This is made clear at the
outset of volume 1, where he summarized his perspective by saying: “In short, the ‘sacred’
is an element in the structure of consciousness, and not a stage in the history of
consciousness”.11 In many respects, this represents the ultimate statement of the view that
religion is a human universal – the manifestation of an unchanging, atemporal, Platonic
reality that is qualitatively distinct from the “profane” level of existence.
Therefore despite Eliade’s incorporation of an extremely wide set of data, both crossculturally and cross-temporally, his key assumptions nevertheless remain in fundamental
tension with contemporary social-scientific scholarship and contemporary theoretical
paradigms.12 This tension has only become greater in recent decades as scholarship on the
evolutionary origins of Homo sapiens has continued to problematize the notion of human
exceptionalism, particularly with regard to the lack of any clear point at which “the human”
Eliade, M., A History of Religious Ideas, 1: 4. Eliade is also clear about degree of speculation entailed by the
paucity of evidence from the period, see esp. 5-8.
10
11 Ibid., xiii. It is also worth noting (as scholars like McCutcheon complain) that Eliade never defined “the
sacred” throughout his entire career, with the closest being his circular definition that it is “the opposite of the
profane” (The Sacred and the Profane, 10; see McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 51f.). It is little wonder that J.
Z. Smith finds this kind of talk “distressingly vague”.
12
McCutcheon provides a detailed demonstration of this claim in Manufacturing Religion.
253
emerges on the evolutionary stage (e.g.: do “humans” begin with language, or with fire?).
And given that Eliade’s position also reflects the general pluralist claim that all religions are
responses to a “transcendent” reality, and that this is “universal” across humanity – a view
widely held both inside and outside the academy – then again, recognizing this tension is
particularly important.
All of this again comes back to the question of methods for the study of religion in a nontheological context. As the foregoing chapters make clear, I fall squarely on the side of
McCutcheon and others who argue that “religion” is a label used by contemporary
westerners to conceptually group together a set of ordinary human behaviours, and that
correspondingly these behaviours do not require a qualitatively unique mode of
understanding. To me this is the unavoidable implication of contemporary scholarship –
not simply with regard to the natural and human sciences, but also in light of the new
standard of critical awareness regarding our inherited modes of inquiry.
In other words, for anybody concerned to reconcile their views about religious
history with the current scope of knowledge – admittedly something in which not all people
are interested, but a standard to which all professional scholars should be held – then the
only way to see “all religions as equal” (i.e. to posit no qualitative hierarchy between the
cultural traditions that make up the “religions” of the world) is surely to see them all as
discursively constructed socio-symbolic systems whose similarities can be accounted for by
the fact of humanity’s common cognitive architecture (and therefore our common
capacities for symbolic representation), and whose differences can be accounted for by the
complicated dynamics of the formation of cultural identity over time. This way of looking
at the question does not require the existence of something “extra” beyond the normal
pressures imposed on human behaviour and cognition. Correspondingly, “religion” needs
to be treated like any other set of human behaviours, a commitment which entails the
254
development of complex theoretical paradigms that move well beyond claims about the
nature of reality contained within most cultural traditions – and indeed beyond Hick’s or
Eliade’s non-reductive essentialism.
However, when surveying religious studies as an academic field (to say nothing of the
wider public discourse on religion), it is clear that this perspective remains significantly
marginal.13 Perhaps this is because to follow through on the implications of this perspective
would, in many cases, radically undermine the central assumptions in most people’s selfunderstanding, particularly when those views are based upon the idea that there is a
“transcendent” dimension of human life.14 In this sense, I feel that McCutcheon is on the
mark when he argues that the discourse on sui generis religion is motivated ultimately by “the
politics of nostalgia” in a world of rapid change.
While I accept that this is a loaded evaluation of the situation, it is not offered as a
definitive assertion; it is simply offered as summation of the position I have come to over
the course of this study. But as noted above, my aim here is to remain focused on
methodological issues, not philosophical ones; so exploring this claim further would take
things in an inappropriate direction. As such, I want to close the discussion by reflecting on
some of the methodological directions that I think are implied by the analysis of this
dissertation, both at a research level (i.e. the level of knowledge produced by professional
academics in books, articles, and the like), as well as in pedagogical contexts.
13 As Michael Stausberg notes, most contemporary theories of religion come from outside the discipline itself
(“Prospects in Theories of Religion”, Method and Theory in the Study of Religion 22 [2010]: 223-238).
14 Jacques Monod captures something of what I mean when he says that the implications of modern
knowledge “[subvert] every one of the mythical or philosophical ontongenies upon which the animist
traditions, from the Australian aborigines to the dialectical materialists, has based morality, values, rights,
duties, prohibitions.” (Monod, J., Chance and Necessity [London: Fontana, 1974], 160; cited in Bellah, Religion in
Human Evolution, 48.) As Monod rightly suggests here, the implications also have the potential undermine
worldviews that are not “religious” in the normal sense of term – another example of which I would contend
being certain contemporary liberal discourses that employ the notion of a universal “human nature” as the
basis of ethical and moral judgement.
255
At a research level, one of the most immediate requirements within the critical sector of
religious studies is to provide a comprehensive deconstruction of the Axial Age paradigm.
Many other discursive components of the history of western scholarship on religion have
received thorough genealogical treatment, including the world religions paradigm, the trope
of “experience”, the discourse on sui generis religion, and indeed the category of “religion”
itself, to name only a few. Tim Murphy has even mapped out a comprehensive genealogy of
the discipline of religious studies which stretches from Hegel to the twenty-first century,
allowing one to see better how the aforementioned discursive components fit together.
Many other works complement this perspective, notably those of Tomoko Masuzawa,
Brent Nongbri, J. Z. Smith, and Bruce Lincoln. Yet while these studies are all extremely
important, the Axial Age has not featured in any of the literature.15
In my view, Chapter 4 represents the necessary starting point of this endeavour by
focusing on Jaspers’ original formulation of the Axial Age construct. But a more thorough
treatment needs to trace how the concept has been developed in the alternative trajectory
first established by Schmuel Eisenstadt, which is now represented in Robert Bellah’s new
work, Religion in Human Evolution (and its companion volume, The Axial Age and Its
Consequences). As demonstrated through the engagement with Donald and Assmann, two of
Bellah’s key interlocutors, the framework that he has established for the evolutionary
treatment of cultural history – even if one would contest certain elements of it – presents a
rich opportunity for productive redescriptions of periods such as the 1st millennium BCE.
Conversely, however, as suggested in Chapter 1, the fact that the discourse remains
15 I have discovered a few disparate pieces which challenge the logic of the Axial Age paradigm, e.g. Antony
Black, “The ‘Axial Period’: What Was It and What Does It Signify?”, The Review of Politics 70 (2008): 23-39; and
John Boy & John Torpey, “Inventing the Axial Age: the Origins and Uses of a Historical Concept”, Theory and
Society 42 (2013): 241–259. However, while both are interesting essays (the latter especially providing a
thorough intellectual history of the concept and a good recognition of the problems), neither are engaged with
the “method and theory” sector of religious studies, which in my view is the discursive site best equipped to
deconstruct the original Jasperian paradigm.
256
structured around the concept of an “axial” age represents a significant problem that has
not been sufficiently addressed, and shows that several of Jaspers’ original assumptions still
linger in the background.16
A similar assessment of Bellah’s work was also suggested by J. Z. Smith at the 2011
American Academy of Religion meeting, where he discussed Religion in Human Evolution at a
public forum in uncommonly praiseworthy terms, even calling it one of the most “complex,
comprehensive, and provocative” achievements in the contemporary study of religion.17 But
Smith also expressed a number of concerns, particularly with regard to the continued use of
the Axial Age paradigm and the typology of religions that it implies. Although he could only
broach the issue quickly given the format, he did at least suggest the need for establishing
better taxonomic criteria by which to group religious traditions, ones that:
[organize] the data more comprehensively than appeals to such ahistorical elements as
“critical spirit,” “theoretic culture,” and the like. This latter observation holds not only
for Mesopotamia, but even more urgently with respect to non-writing, traditional
cultures.18
It is also important to stress that the Jasperian version of the Axial Age has contemporary currency beyond
academic debates. The most prominent example is Karen Armstrong’s The Great Transformation: The Beginning of
Our Religious Traditions (New York: A. A. Knopf, 2006), which effectively argues that “compassion” first arose
properly in the Axial Age. The work was even published in German with the title Die Achsenzeit: Vom Ursprung
der Weltreligionen (Berlin: Siedler, 2006). Another work aimed at a non-specialist audience (published by the
same house) is Stephen S. Hall, Wisdom: From Philosophy to Neuroscience (New York: A. A. Knopf, 2010), whose
blurb declares that Hall “gives us a dramatic history of wisdom, from its sudden emergence in four different
locations (Greece, China, Israel, and India)”. See 23f. for Hall’s brief mention that Jaspers lies at the base of
his thinking about the period.
16
17 Indeed, Smith said that: “This new work is superlative in its range and readings of data and theoretical
proposals; in the boldness and fruitfulness of its connections and comparisons”; and also that “Bellah has
attained that rarest of academic achievements, his work is a damned good read!”. He went on to say that “it
will take much more than the past month’s reading and re-readings to take its measure fully. I have read
enough to know that such an effort, on our part, is both required and fully justified … we must all be grateful
for Bellah’s unimaginable labours on behalf of all students of religion.” Smith, J. Z., “Conversation with
Robert Bellah on Religion in Human Evolution”, AAR Annual Meeting, San Francisco, November 20, 2011. I
was present at the session, although I have cited the text from a copy that was (thankfully!) scanned and put
online (http://blogs.ssrc.org/tif/2011/12/21/a-damned-good-read/); last accessed June 3, 2013. See Chapter
1 above for my evaluation of Bellah’s work vis-à-vis other recent evolutionary studies of religion (n. 85).
18
Ibid.
257
Smith’s comments align well with the results of this dissertation – for as I have attempted
to demonstrate, there is nothing “axial” about the 1st millennium BCE when viewed within
the larger context of human history.19 As such, Bellah’s typology of “tribal”, “archaic”, and
“axial” religions remains deeply unsatisfying. Although he does, prima facie, emphatically
repudiate any notion of a hierarchy between these groups, his tripartite classification
nevertheless fails to capitalize on the potential redescriptions that his wider framework
allows.20 Moreover, a close reading of Religion in Human Evolution reveals that Bellah still
views the 1st millennium BCE as an “axial” dividing line in history in a manner that is
surely at odds with the implications of his analysis.21 This represents the major lacuna in the
contemporary Axial Age debate: namely, a lack of proper critical engagement with the
central categories by which the paradigm is structured, particularly the way in which these
categories might be analysed from postcolonial and other post-structuralist perspectives.22
Were this to be undertaken, I am convinced that new ways of discussing religious and
cultural history would emerge that are more in line with other fields of contemporary
scholarship.
19 Another comment in Smith’s address that aligns with the concerns of this dissertation is his statement: “I
must confess that, early on, I was troubled by Jaspers’ lack of a convincing causal formulation … As Jaspers
described it, the ‘Age’ appeared to be more of a miracle than an event.”
20 A statement representative of Bellah’s disavowal of any hierarchy is: “religious evolution does not mean a
progression from worse to better. We have not gone from ‘primitive religion’ that tribal peoples have had to
‘higher religions’ that people like us have had” (Religion in Human Evolution, xxii-xxiii).
21 One particular comment that sounds uncomfortably close to Jaspers is: “The cultural effervescence of this
period led to new developments in religion and ethics but also in the understanding of the natural world, the
origins of science. For these reasons we call this period axial” (xix). Bellah elsewhere describes “the primary
concern of this book” as being “the transition from archaic to axial” (255). This position is rendered more
explicable if one notes that Bellah’s original view of religious history, offered in his widely read 1964 essay
“Religious Evolution”, was effectively a summary of the Jasperian narrative. In the essay, he even pronounced
that with the Axial Age “it is for the first time possible to conceive of man as such” (“Religious Evolution” in
Beyond Belief: Essays on Religion in a Post-Traditional World (New York: Harper & Row, 1970). For a useful reading
of the differences between Bellah’s early essay and his recent Religion in Human Evolution, see José Casanova,
“Religion, the Axial Age, and Secular Modernity in Bellah’s Theory of Religious Evolution” in The Axial Age
and Its Consequences, 191-221 (see 193-198).
I note again in this connection Jack Tsonis, “Review: The Axial Age and Its Consequences” in the Alternative
Religion and Spirituality Review 3 (2012): 262-267. See above, ch. 1, n. 86 (see also the following note of Chapter
1 for the critical asides that have been made from within the Axial Age debate itself).
22
258
Proposing alternative terms of classification is, admittedly, a much more difficult task
than pointing out the need to do so. Throughout this work I have employed categories such
as “small-scale oral cultures” and “large urban societies” in order to draw attention to
specific differences that were salient in the context of the issues being explored; yet these
categories are hardly sufficient to group together all ideational communities throughout
history, nor would they necessarily be appropriate if one set about comparing cultural
traditions with different analytical interests.23
But what they do suggest, I think, is that at the very least scholars should move away
from classifying cultural traditions according to such criteria as self-reflexive thought (“axial”
religions), universality (“world” religions), development (“primal” religions), and, for that matter,
place (“indigenous” traditions).24 This is particularly the case for any treatment such as
Bellah’s that attempts to understand modern human cultural practice within a deep
evolutionary context, but the lesson could be well applied across the board. As Smith
emphasized at the AAR, any long-term approach should be one “in which
It is not possible to discuss the complex methodological and theoretical dimensions of comparison,
although I note as one of the most insightful discussions on this topic J. Z. Smith’s “A Matter of Class:
Taxonomies of Religion” in Relating Religion, 160-178. See also the useful essays in the volume A Magic Still
Dwells: Comparative Religion in the Postmodern Age (ed. C. Patton & B. Ray; Berkeley: University of California
Press, 2000). The title echoes another of J. Z. Smith’s seminal pieces, “In Comparison a Magic Dwells” (in
Imagining Religion, 19-35), which set the agenda for the contributions and is reproduced as a prologue.
23
24 I have several reservations about the term “indigenous”. Chief among them is that using “indigeneity” as a
comparative criterion does not imply fruitful ways of grouping other traditions that are not deemed to fit this
category – it is too ad hoc and does not allow for any systematic reconstruction of other of categories by
which cultural traditions are classified. For example, there is no discernable way to alter the category of a
“world” religion by using the same logic from which “primal” was shifted to “indigenous”. The latter term is
well entrenched in public discourse, and does have value in certain academic and political contexts; but as an
analytic category deployed in the interests of comparison, it does not seem to be particularly helpful. It could
also be argued that the label somewhat clumsily brings together a very wide variety of cultural groups, many of
whom have long histories of migration and conflict, and are thus often not “indigenous” to a place in the
somewhat simplistic way that is implied at present. All of these comments are made, I must add, having
considered James Cox’s rigorous attempt at justifying the category. While his approach is extremely well
thought out, and productive in many respects, I am still not convinced that “indigenous” is the best label for
the social and cultural groups he is talking about (see From Primitive to Indigenous, 53-74). The main problem, in
my view, is that scholars pushing for the discursive inclusion of indigenous traditions (such as Cox and
Olupona) are focused almost exclusively on contemporary cultural groups. Were there a more thoroughgoing
attempt to devise categories in light of the fuller scope of human history, then I believe more dynamic
language would emerge.
259
‘microdistinctions’ prevail (as opposed to ‘quantum leaps,’ ‘revolutions’ and the like)”. In
the case of Bellah’s narrative, a new model needs to be established that categorizes human
cultural groups using a far more differentiated and theoretically robust set of primary taxa
than “tribal”, “archaic” and “axial”. While the former two, tribal and archaic, do at least
have some utility as qualifiers in more complicated descriptions (archaic especially), the
notion of “axiality” has no place whatsoever in high level academic scholarship on religion,
and its continued usage is almost something of an embarrassment.
Instead, the tentative categories employed in this work attempt to direct comparative
focus towards the relation between material circumstances and the construction of cultural
identity. Expanding this approach would not simply be a matter of devising new labels to
smoothly replace old categories; rather, it would entail developing a complex theoretical
vocabulary with which scholars could more adequately deal with and represent the
“microdistinctions” in cultural difference to which Smith rightly directs us.
Making a further case for this approach is not possible here, as it would require
detailed discussion of both a wide range of material and a complicated set of
methodological proposals. Perhaps beginning any act of broadscale cultural comparison by
first thinking in terms of whether a group’s cultural identity is maintained orally or
supported by externalized forms of memory provides a useful starting point; perhaps not.
In the end, it depends on the questions one brings to the data and the story one wants to
tell.
Yet Smith also related his concerns with the Axial Age scheme of classification to the
equally important realm of pedagogy, so looking at these issues is a good way of
transitioning to my final comments. Speaking of his long experience in teaching an
introductory college course that serves as a survey of religions in western civilization, Smith
stressed that “One prerequisite for any teacher of such a course is some sort of typology of
260
religions that both enables and grows out of comparative interests”. Given the above
problems (which for him also include issues regarding the classification of Mesopotamian
religions), he concludes that “For me, this has been a sufficient reason to exclude the
notion of an ‘Axial Age’ on pragmatic as well as pedagogical grounds”.
Smith has laid out alternative pedagogical strategies in numerous publications, many
of which have recently been collected in the edited volume, On Teaching Religion. Without
being able to go into detail, one particularly relevant piece is “Basic Problems in the Study
of Religion”, in which a syllabus is reproduced for a course of the same name. Most
interesting to me is Smith’s use of categories similar to the ones suggested above – e.g. the
Gilgamesh epic is presented as an “Introduction to religion of an archaic, urban, agricultural
culture”; the Ainu bear festival is treated as an example of an “archaic hunting culture”; and
the Tempasuk Dusuns of Borneo are introduced under the heading “archaic agricultural
materials, Tuber and paleo-Asiatic rice culture”. Moreover, Smith also directs sustained
focus throughout the unit to the methodological question addressed in week 1: “what is a
text?”, a question reframed in the final sessions by asking “what is a tradition?”.25
The need for restructuring the academic study of religion at a wider level has also
been discussed by scholars such as Russell McCutcheon, Richard King, Tim Fitzgerald, and
Tim Murphy. Different interests aside, their proposals all centre around the claim that
religious studies needs to be substantively reconfigured at an institutional level as a form of
social-scientific cultural studies. McCutcheon, for example, argues that first-year
introductory units should dispense with the “Introduction to World Religions” model, and
move towards an “Introduction to Studying Religion” approach.26 The former unit is the
The syllabus is reproduced in “Basic Problems in the Study of Religion”, On Teaching Religion, 24-26.
Another useful essay on syllabi and course structure is “The Introductory Course: Less is Better” (11-19).
25
26 McCutcheon, R., Studying Religion: An Introduction (Sheffield: Equinox, 2007). A similar example is Craig
Martin, A Critical Introduction to the Study of Religion (Sheffield: Equinox, 2012).
261
hallmark of the non-theoretical, descriptive approach that has been broadly dominant since
the 1950s, and typically offers a basic “history and beliefs” survey of several major
traditions. The latter unit, by contrast, still presents students with a wide range of material
that would be covered in a normal survey of “world religions” (though perhaps including
more small-scale oral cultures), but it also includes a tightly integrated theoretical
component that introduces students to the methodological operations by which scholars
organize their data. Such an approach is deliberately intended to problematize many of the
common assumptions about “religion” with which students enter the classroom,
assumptions which are pervasive throughout wider public realm.27
Recalling the description/redescription debate discussed in Chapter 2, and in light of
the fact that McCutcheon is interested in treating religion as normal aspect of human social
behaviour, the introductory unit he proposes (and indeed teaches) does not aim
simply to reproduce the classification scheme, value system, and hence socio-political
world of one’s informants (i.e., the so-called religious people themselves), but to bring
a new language to bear, a language capable of redescribing the indigenous accounts of
extraordinariness, privilege, and authority as being ordinary rhetorical efforts to make
that extraordinariness, privilege, and authority possible.28
At a wider disciplinary level, rejecting the notion that religion is a sui generis domain of life
also means that scholars have a responsibility to
[develop] interdisciplinary connections with their colleagues in the social sciences,
[investigate] the theoretical basis for their scholarly interests, and [communicate] to
their undergraduate and graduate students the situated, polymethodic, and
polytheoretical nature of scholarly discourses.29
As James Lewis notes: “A lifelong exposure to popular media has tended to implant crude, negative
stereotypes about unfamiliar cultures in the minds of most American students … World religions courses
provide one of the few institutionalized avenues through which these negative images can be overcome,
although this potential is seldom realized in practice” (“Images of Traditional African Religions”, 312).
27
28
McCutcheon, The Discipline of Religion, 146.
29
McCutcheon, Manufacturing Religion, 210.
262
In a similar vein, Richard King has suggested that:
‘religious studies’ might avoid some of the problems traditionally associated with its
methodology by redefining itself as a specific form of ‘cultural studies’. Such an
approach constitutes, I would argue, a reconceptualization of the notion of ‘religion’ in
such a way that it no longer remains bound to the peculiar orientations of Christian
theological speculation.30
King naturally does not deny the legitimacy of theological approaches and their need for
representation in intellectual discourse; but as with McCutcheon, the primary issue is that
the historical relationship between the discipline of religious studies and the broadly
apologetic agenda of the phenomenology of religion has meant that a field of study located
within secular, public universities is still heavily structured by a host of implicit theological
assumptions. The contest, in other words, is one of discursive and disciplinary boundaries.
As Tim Fitzgerald has said in this connection: “[my] argument is not antitheological. It is an
argument against theology masquerading as something else”.31
The other area to which King rightly draws attention is the lingering heritage of
Eurocentrism in the paradigms that still dominate religious studies. In his lengthy discussion
of how critical scholarship at large might continue to move “Beyond Orientalism”, King
argues that:
The introduction of a variety of indigenous epistemic traditions is, in my view, the
single most important step that postcolonial studies can take if it is to look beyond the
Eurocentric foundations of its theories and contest the epistemic violence of the
colonial encounter … The task of creating space for recovering indigenous
perspectives and practices in a postcolonial age has barely begun.32
King, Orientalism and Religion, 53. King’s comments about the Christian theological heritage of the discipline
apply more to UK religious studies departments, out of which they grew and to which they are still often
attached. The equivalent heritage in the US comes from Eliade and the phenomenological school. For a
detailed elaboration of these issues that likewise ends with a call for religious studies to become a form of
cultural studies, see Timothy Fitzgerald’s The Ideology of Religious Studies.
30
31
Fitzgerald, The Ideology of Religious Studies, 20.
King, Orientalism and Religion, 199, 60. This is obviously one of the major concerns also animating Cox’s
important recent work on small-scale cultures in the study of religion.
32
263
As noted above, I remain unpersuaded about the utility of “indigenous” as a serious
category of classification; but if this were rephrased as a call for greater empirical and
methodological consideration of epistemic traditions in groups whose socio-symbolic
universes are constituted without recourse to externalized forms of cultural memory
(especially groups that have been politically marginalized over the course of European
history), then I would certainly agree with King. Indeed, if we are concerned (in Rabinow’s
words, which King cites) to “anthropologize the West” and “to show how exotic its
constitution of reality has been” – that is, to rigorously historicize our own standards of
judgement and forms of cultural practice – then juxtaposing the dynamics of knowledge
and identity in oral cultures with those dynamics in cultures that employ externalized
memory systems is clearly an approach that can make an important contribution to the task
set by J. Z. Smith three decades ago:
the historian of religion, like the anthropologist, will continue to gain insight from the
study of materials and cultures which, at first glance, appear uncommon or remote. For
there is extraordinary cognitive power in what Victor Shklovsky termed
“defamiliarization” – making the familiar seem strange in order to enhance our perception of
the familiar. The success of any historian of religion’s work depends upon a judgment as
to whether this enhancement has taken place.33
However the strongest challenge to the colonial heritage of religious studies has been
offered, perhaps unsurprisingly, by Tim Murphy, whose words forcefully sum up the
practical implications of the above discussion, and indeed of this whole dissertation:
If [the genealogical reading in The Politics of Spirit] is correct, a radical revision of the
entire basis of Religious Studies will be necessary: from the textbooks we use, the
language by which our field is put into effect, the way in which we taxonomize our job
categories, award positions, organize our departments, and the way in which – and
most definitely the institutions in which – we train the professionals who assume those
positions … [A] revolution in our thinking in Religious Studies is necessary if it is
going to be intellectually viable and if it is going to extricate itself from its role in
re/producing colonialist representations.34
33
Smith, J. Z., Imagining Religion, xiii. Emphasis in original.
34
Murphy, The Politics of Spirit, 42. Emphasis in original.
264
Although many people would contest Murphy’s view, it is nevertheless a good assessment
of the scope of the challenges facing those in the academy committed to pursuing the
postcolonial agenda at a serious level. While there is a growing “postcolonial sensibility”
across much of western culture, particularly as minority groups continue to assert their
political rights ever more visibly thanks to global media channels, the deeply embedded
nature of these discursive and institutional structures has been made clear throughout this
work. This again represents a core challenge for scholars working to push the academic
study of religion into more theoretically nuanced and intellectually justifiable terrain.
Ultimately, however, these issues are part of a debate that is much wider than the main
argument advanced in this dissertation regarding the problematic contradictions in John
Hick’s theory of religion. That theory, as I hope to have shown, has value only as an item of
intellectual history, not as a viable explanation of cultural difference. But regardless of the
stance one takes on the methodological, pedagogical and philosophical implications of this
situation, or the counter-arguments that one might offer, the most basic lesson that seems
to come through from all of this is that we always have a duty to pay attention to our
subtext.
265
Bibliography
Abbott, Walter. The Documents of Vatican II. New York: Guild, 1966.
Abhayanada, S. History of Mysticism: The Unchanging Testament. 3rd ed. 2007 [1987]. (The
2007 ebook version I possess appears to be self-published.)
Allen, M., Rees, V. & Davies, M. (ed.) Marsilio Ficino: his Theology, his Philosophy, his Legacy.
Leiden: Brill, 2002.
Almond, Philip. “Wilfred Cantwell Smith as Theologian of Religions.” Harvard Theological
Review 76 (1983): 335-342
Almond, Philip. Rudolf Otto: An Introduction to His Philosophical Theology. Chapel Hill:
University of North Carolina Press, 1984.
Almond, Philip. The British Discovery of Buddhism. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press
1988.
Althaus, Horst. Hegel: An Intellectual Biography. Trans. M. Tarsh. Cambridge: Polity Press,
2000 [1992].
Anquetil-Duperron, Abraham Hyacinthe. Zend Avesta, Ouvrage de Zoroastre. 3 vols. Paris:
Chez N. M. Tillard, 1771.
Asad, Talal. Genealogies of Religion: Disciplines and Reasons of Power in Christianity and Islam.
Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1993.
Assmann, Jan. “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age.” Pages 366-407 in The
Axial Age and Its Consequences. Ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas. Cambridge, MA: The
Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2012.
Assmann, Jan. Cultural Memory and Early Civilization. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 2012 [German original 1992].
Assmann, Aleida. Cultural Memory and Western Civilization: Functions, Media, Archives.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2011 [German original 1999].
Armstrong, Karen. The Great Transformation: The Beginning of Our Religious Traditions. New
York: Alfred A. Knopf, 2006. Published in German as Die Achsenzeit: Vom Urspring
der Weltreligionen. Berlin: Siedler, 2006.
Armstrong, Karen. Review: “Tariq Ramadan’s ‘Quest for Meaning’.” The Financial Times
Online. http://www.ft.com/cms/s/2/85ac8582-9b62-11df-823900144feab49a.html#axzz1PGBzaDFS. July 31 2010. [Last accessed June 24,
2013].
267
Arnason, Johann. “The Axial Age and Its Interpreters: Reopening a Debate”. Pages 1949 in Axial Civilizations and World History. Ed. J. Arnason, B. Wittrock & S.
Eisenstadt. Leiden: Brill, 2005.
Atran, Scott. In Gods We Trust: The Evolutionary Landscape of Religion. New York: Oxford
University Press, 2002.
Basso, Keith. Wisdom Sits in Places: Landscape and Language Among the Western Apache.
Alberquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1996.
Basso, K. & Feld, S. (ed.) Senses of Place. Santa Fe, NM: School of American Research
Press, 1996.
Bellah, Robert. “Religious Evolution.” Pages 20-50 in Beyond Belief: Essays on Religion in a
Post-Traditional World. New York: Harper & Row, 1970.
Bellah, Robert. Religion in Human Evolution: From the Paleolithic to the Axial Age.
Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2011.
Bellah, R. & Joas, H. (ed.) The Axial Age and Its Consequences. Cambridge, MA: The
Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2012.
Berger, P. & Luckmann, T. The Social Construction of Reality. New York: Anchor Books,
1966.
Berger, Peter. The Sacred Canopy. New York: Anchor Books, 1967.
Berger, Peter. The Heretical Imperative: Contemporary Possibilities of Religious Affirmation. New
York: Anchor Books, 1979.
Berger, Peter. “The Desecularization of the World: A Global Overview.” Pages 1-18 in
The Desecularization of the World: Resurgent Religion and World Politics. Ed. P. Berger.
Ethics and Public Policy Centre: Washington, 1999.
Bernal, Martin. Black Athena: The Afroasiatic Roots of Classical Civilization: The Fabrication of
Ancient Greece 1785-1985. New Brunswick: Rutgers University Press, 1987.
Black, Antony. “The ‘Axial Period’: What Was It and What Does It Signify?” The Review
of Politics 70 (2008): 23-39.
Bloch, M. & Febvre, L. “La Vie scientifique: sur les routes de l’entr’aide.” Annales
d’histoire économique et social 9 (1937): 75-76.
Blok, Josine. “Sexual Asymmetry: A Historiographical Essay.” Pages 1-57 in Sexual
Asymmetry: Studies in Ancient Society. Ed. J. Blok & P. Mason. Amsterdam: G. C.
Gießen, 1987.
268
Boemus, Johann. The Fardle of Façions; conteining the aunciente maners, customs, and lawes, of the
peoples enhabiting the two parts of the earthe, called Affrike and Asie. London: Jhon
Kingstone & Henry Sutton, 1555.
Boy, J. & Torpey, J. “Inventing the Axial Age: the Origins and Uses of a Historical
Concept.” Theory and Society 42 (2013): 241–259.
Boyd, Brian. On the Origin of Stories: Evolution, Cognition, and Fiction. Cambridge, MA: The
Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2009.
Boyer, Pascal. Religion Explained: The Evolutionary Origins of Religious Thought. New York:
Basic Book, 2001.
Brantlinger, Patrick. “Victorians and Africans: The Genealogy of the Myth of the Dark
Continent.” Critical Inquiry 12 (1985): 166-203.
Braudel, Fernand. Civilization and Capitalism: 15th – 18th Century. Trans. S. Reynolds. 3
vols. London: Fontana, 1981-1984 [1979].
Brown, Janet. Charles Darwin: A Biography. 2 vols. Volume 1: Voyaging. Volume 2: The
Power of Place. New Jersey: Princeton University Press, 1995-2003.
Brerewood, Edward. Enquiries Touching the Diversity of Languages and Religions through the
Chiefe Parts of the World. London: Printed for S. S, J. M., & H. H, 1674 [1614].
Burke, Peter. Popular Culture in Early Modern Europe. Rev. ed. Aldershot: Scolar Press,
1994 [1978].
Capps, Walter. Religious Studies: The Making of a Discipline. Minneapolis: Fortress Press,
1995.
Casanova, José. “Religion, the Axial Age, and Secular Modernity in Bellah’s Theory of
Religious Evolution.” Pages 191-221 in The Axial Age and Its Consequences. Ed. R.
Bellah & H. Joas. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University
Press, 2012.
Cavanaugh, William T. “‘A Fire Strong Enough to Consume the House’: The Wars of
Religion and the Rise of the State.” Modern Theology 11 (1995): 397-420.
Cavello, C. & Chartier, R. (ed.) A History of Reading in the West. Amherst: University of
Massachusetts Press, 1999.
Chaisson, Eric. Epic of Evolution: Seven Ages of the Cosmos. New York: Columbia University
Press, 2006.
Chakrabarty, Dipesh. Provincializing Europe: Postcolonial Thought and Historical Difference. 2nd
ed. New Jersey: Princeton University Press, 2007 [2000].
269
Chidester, David. Savage Systems: Colonialism and Comparative Religion in Southern Africa.
Charlottesville, VA: University of Virginia Press.
Christian, David. “The Case for ‘Big History’.” The Journal of World History 2 (1991): 223238.
Christian, David. Maps of Time: An Introduction to Big History. Berkeley: University of
California Press, 2004.
Christian, David. “The Return of Universal History.” History and Theory 49 (2010): 6-27.
Clarke, James Freeman. Ten Great Religions: A Comparison of all Religions. Boston & New
York: Houghton, Mifflin, & Co.: 1883.
Clarke, Grahame. World Prehistory: An Outline. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press
1961.
Clark, Elizabeth. History, Theory, Text: Historians and the Linguistic Turn. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press, 2004.
Clarke, Andy. Supersizing the Mind: Embodiment, Action, and Cognitive Extension. New York:
Oxford University Press, 2011.
Cornille, C. & Corigliano, S. (ed.) Interreligious Dialogue and Cultural Change. Eugene, OR:
Wipf & Stock, 2012.
Cox, James. From Primitive to Indigenous: The Academic Study of Indigenous Religions.
Hampshire: Ashgate, 2007.
Cox, James. A Guide to the Phenomenology of Religion: Key Figures, Formative Influences, and
Subsequent Debates. London: Continuum, 2006.
Cox, James. An Introduction to the Phenomenology of Religion. London: Continuum, 2010.
Watson, J. & Crick, F. “A Structure for Deoxyribose Nucleic Acid.” Nature 171 (1953):
737–738.
Crouter, Richard. “Introduction.” Pages 1-73 in his English translation of
Schleiermacher’s On Religion: Speeches to its Cultured Despisers. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1988.
Crouter, Richard. Friedrich Schleiermacher: Between Enlightenment and Romanticism.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2005.
Darwin, Charles. The Origin of Species by Means of Natural Selection. London: John Murray,
1859.
270
Darwin, Charles. The Descent of Man, and Selection in Relation Sex. London: John Murray,
1871.
Deacon, Terrance. The Symbolic Species: The Co-evolution of Language and the Brain. New
York: W. W. Norton & Co., 1997.
D’Costa, Gavin. (ed.) Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1990.
D’Costa, Gavin. “Preface.” Pages vii-xxii in Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered. Ed. G.
D’Costa. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1990.
D’Costa, Gavin. The Meeting of Religions and the Meeting of the Trinity. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis,
2000.
De Brosses, Charles. Du Culte des Dieux Fétiches, ou parallèle de l'ancienne Religion de l'Egypte
avec la religion actuelle de Nigritie (Paris, 1760).
Dennett, Daniel. Breaking the Spell: Religion as a Natural Phenomenon. New York: Penguin,
2006.
Diamond, Jared. Guns, Germs, and Steel: The Fate of Human Societies. New York: W. W.
Norton & Co., 1999.
Donald, Merlin. Origins of the Modern Mind: Three Stages in the Evolution of Culture and
Cognition. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1991.
Donald, Merlin. A Mind So Rare. New York: Norton, 2001.
Donald, Merlin. “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature.” Lecture
given at the University of Arkansas. No date. Transcript available at
http://psyc.queensu.ca/faculty/donald/sel-pubs.html [last accessed June 8, 2013].
Dreijmanis, J. (ed.) Karl Jaspers on Max Weber. Trans. R. J. Whelan. New York: Paragon,
1989.
Dudley, Will. (ed.) Hegel and History. Albany: SUNY Press, 2009.
Dupuis, Jacques. Toward A Christian Theology of Religious Pluralism. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis,
1999.
Durkheim, Émile. The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life. 2nd ed. Trans. J. S. Swain.
London: George Allen & Unwin, 1976 [1912].
Ehrlich, E., Ehrlich, L. & Pepper, G. (ed.) Karl Jaspers: Basic Philosophical Writings.
Amherst, NY: Humanity Books, 1986.
271
Eisenstadt, Schmuel. Revolution and Transformation of Societies: A Comparative Study of
Civilizations. New York: Free Press, 1978.
Eisenstadt, Schmuel. “The Axial Age: The Emergence of Transcendental Visions and
the Rise of Clerics.” European Journal of Science 23 (1982): 294-314.
Eisenstadt, Schmuel. (ed.) The Origins and Diversity of Axial Age Civilizations. Albany:
SUNY Press, 1986.
Eisenstadt, Schmuel. (ed.) Kulturen der Achsenzeit. 5 vols. Frankfurt am Main: Suhrkamp,
1987-1992.
Eisenstadt, S., Arnason, J. & Wittrock, B. (ed.) Axial Civilizations and World History.
Leiden: Brill, 2005.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. The Printing Press as an Agent of Change: Communications and Cultural
Transformations in Early-Modern Europe. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1979.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. “Clio and Chronos: an Essay on the Making and Breaking of
History-Book Time.” History and Theory 6 (1966): 36-64.
Eliade, Mircea. Patterns in Comparative Religion. Trans. R. Sheed. New York: Sheed &
Ward, 1958 [1949].
Eliade, Mircea. The Sacred and the Profane: The Nature of Religion. Trans. W. Trask.
Orlando, FL: Harcourt & Brace, 1959 [1957].
Eliade, Mircea. Shamanism: Archaic Techniques of Ecstacy. Bollingen Series LXXVI:
Princeton University Press, 1964.
Eliade, Mircea. A History of Religious Ideas. Volume 1: From the Stone Age to the Elusinean
Mysteries. Trans. W. R. Trask. Volume 2: From Gautama Buddha to the Triumph of
Christianity. Trans W. R. Trask. Volume 3: From Muhammad to the Age of Reforms.
Trans. A. Hiltebeitel & D. Apostolos-Cappadona. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press, 1978-1985 [1976-1983].
Ellington, Ter. The Myth of the Noble Savage. Berkeley: University of California Press,
2001.
Elliot, J. H. The Old World and the New: 1492-1650. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1970.
Evans-Pritchard, Edward Evan. Theories of Primitive Religion. Oxford: Oxford University
Press, 1965.
Fabian, Johannes. Time and the Other: How Anthropology Makes its Object. 2nd ed. New
York: Columbia University Press, 2002 [1983].
272
Febvre, L. & Martin, H–J. The Coming of the Book: the Impact of Print 1450–1800. Trans. D.
Gerard. London: Verso, 1997 [1958].
Feuerbach, Ludwig. The Essence of Christianity. Dover Publications: New York, 2008
[1841]. Translation from the second edition of Das Wesen des Christentums by
George Eliot in 1881.
Fitzgerald, Timothy. The Ideology of Religious Studies. New York: Oxford University Press,
2000.
FitzGerald, T. E. The Ecumenical Movement: an Introductory History. Westport, CT: Praeger,
2004.
Flannery, Tim. The Future Eaters: An Ecological History of the Australasian Lands and People.
Chatswood, N.S.W.: Reed, 1995.
Forster, Peter. “Ice Ages and the mitochondrial DNA chronology of human dispersals: a
review.” Philosophical Transaction of the Royal Society 359 (2004): 255-264.
Foucault, Michel. Power/Knowledge: Selected Interviews and Other Writings 1972-1977. Ed. C.
Gordon. Trans. C Gordon, L. Marshall, J. Mepham & K. Soper. New York:
Vintage, 1980.
Foucault, Michel. The Archaeology of Knowledge and the Discourse on Language. Trans A. M. S.
Smith. London: Routledge, 2002 [1972].
Frazer, James G. Totemism. Edinburgh: A. & C. Black, 1887.
Frazer, James G. The Golden Bough. 2nd ed. 3 vols. London: Macmillan, 1900 [1890].
Gay, Peter. Deism: An Anthology. Princeton, NJ: D. van Nostrand, 1968.
Gay, Peter. The Enlightenment. 2 vols. New York: W. W. Norton & Co., 1995.
Gillis, Chester. “John Hick: Theologian or Philosopher of Religion?”. Pages 137-151 in
Religious Pluralism and the Modern World. Ed. S. Sugirtharajah. New York: Palgrave
Macmillan, 2012.
Glacken, Clarence. Traces on the Rhodian Shore: Nature and Culture in Western Thought from
Ancient Times to the End of the Eighteenth Century. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1973.
Gleick, James. The Information: A History, a Theory, a Flood. London: Fourth Estate, 2011.
Goldberg, David. Racist Culture: Philosophy and the Politics of Meaning. Cambridge, MA:
Blackwell, 1993.
273
Goldstone, Jack. Why Europe? The Rise of the West in World History, 1500-1850. New York:
McGraw-Hill, 2009.
Goody, J. & Watt, I. “The Consequences of Literacy.” Comparative Studies in Society and
History 5 (1963): 304-345.
Goody, Jack. The Domestication of the Savage Mind. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1977.
Grafton, Anthony. New Worlds, Ancient Texts: The Power of Tradition and the Shock of
Discovery. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1992.
Griffin, David Ray. “Religious Pluralism: Generic, Identist, and Deep.” Pages 3-39 in
Deep Religious Pluralism. Ed. D. R. Griffin. Louisville: Westminster John Knox
Press, 2005.
Grine, F., Fleagle, J. & Leakey, R. (ed.) The First Humans: Origin and Early Evolution of the
Genus Homo. New York: Springer, 2009.
Guthrie, Stewart. Faces in the Clouds: A New Theory of Religion. New York: Oxford
University Press, 1993.
Halbwachs, Maurice. On Collective Memory. Trans. L. Coser. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1992 [1941].
Hall, Stephen S. Wisdom: From Philosophy to Neuroscience. New York: Alfred. A. Knopf,
2010.
Harrison, Peter. ‘Religion’ and the Religions in the English Enlightenment. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1990.
Harrison, Peter. The Fall of Man and the Foundations of Science. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2007.
Hawkins, Mike. Social Darwinism in European and American Thought: Nature as Model and
Nature as Threat. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1997.
Hick, John. Faith and Knowledge. London: Macmillan, 1957.
Hick, John. God and the Universe of Faiths. New York: St Martins, 1973.
Hick, John. Death and Eternal Life. London: Macmillan, 1976.
Hick, John. (ed.) The Myth of God Incarnate. London: SCM, 1977.
Hick, John. God Has Many Names: Britain’s New Religious Pluralism. Philadelphia:
Westminster Press, 1980.
274
Hick, John. Problems of Religious Pluralism. London: Macmillan, 1985.
Hick, J. & Knitter, P. (ed.) The Myth of Christian Uniqueness: Towards a Pluralistic Theology of
Religions. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1987.
Hick, John. “The Non-Absoluteness of Christianity”. Pages 16-36 in The Myth of
Christian Uniqueness: Towards a Pluralistic Theology of Religions. Ed. J. Hick & P.
Knitter. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1987.
Hick, John. An Interpretation of Religion. New Haven & London: Yale University Press,
1989 [2nd ed. 2004]. Being the published version of Hick’s 1986-87 Gifford
Lectures.
Hick, John. John Hick: An Autobiography. Oxford: Oneworld, 2002.
Hillar, Marrian. The Case of Michael Servetus (1511-1553): The Turning Point in the Struggle for
Freedom of Conscience. Lewiston, N.Y: Edwin Mellen Press, 1997.
Hillar, Marrian. “Sebastian Castellio and the Struggle For Freedom of Conscience.”
Essays in the Philosophy of Humanism 10 (2002): 31-56.
Hillar, Marrian. “The Legacy of Servetus: Humanism and the Beginning of Change of
the Social Paradigm. On the Occasion of the 450th Anniversary of His
Martyrdom.” A Journal from The Radical Reformation, A Testimony to Biblical
Unitarianism 11 (2003): 34-41.
Hodgen, Margaret T. “The Doctrine of Survivals.” American Anthropologist 33 (1931):
307-324.
Hodgen, Margaret T. Early Anthropology in the Sixteenth and Seventeenth Centuries.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1964.
Horton, Robin. Patterns of Thought in Africa and the West: Essays on Magic, Religion and Science.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1993.
Hutchison, William. Religious Pluralism in America. New Haven: Yale University Press,
2003.
Iggers., G. & Powell, J. Leopold von Ranke and the Shaping of the Historical Discipline.
Syracuse: Syracuse University Press, 1990.
Innis, Harold. Empire and Communications. Ed. D. Godfrey. Toronto: Press Porcépic,
1986 [1950].
Inwood, Michael. A Hegel Dictionary. Oxford: Blackwell, 1992.
275
James, William. The Varieties of Religious Experience. Pages 1-477 in William James: Writings
1902-1910. Library of America: New York, 1987 [1902].
Jameson, Fredric. The Political Unconscious: Narrative as a Socially Symbolic Act. London:
Routledge, 1981.
Jaspers, Karl. Vom Ursprung und Ziel der Geschichte. Zurich: Artemis, 1949.
Jaspers, Karl. On the Origin and Goal of History. Trans. M. Bullock. London: Routledge &
Kegan Paul, 1953.
Jaspers, K. & Bultmann, R. Myth and Christianity: An Enquiry into the Possibility of Religion
without Myth. Trans. N. Guterman. New York: Noonday, 1954.
Joas, Hans. “The Axial Age Debate as Religious Discourse.” Pages 9-29 in The Axial Age
and Its Consequences. Ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press
of Harvard University Press, 2012.
Kant, Immanuel. The Critique of Pure Reason. Trans. N. K. Smith. London: Palgrave
Macmillan, 2007 [1929; German original 1781].
Kärkkäinen, Veli-Matti. An Introduction to the Theology of Religions: Biblical, Historical, and
Contemporary Perspectives. Illinois: InterVarsity Press, 2003.
Kelly, Shawn. Racializing Jesus: Race, Ideology and the Formation of Modern Biblical Scholarship.
London: Routledge, 2002.
King, Richard. Orientalism and Religion: Postcolonial Theory, India, and ‘The Mythic East’.
London: Routledge, 1999.
Kippenberg, Hans. Discovering Religious History in the Modern Age. Trans. B. Harshav. New
Jersey: Princeton University Press, 2002.
Kirk, Andrew. “Religious Pluralism as an Epiphenomenon of Postmodern
Perspectivism.” Pages 430-442 in Theology and the Religions: A Dialogue. Ed. V.
Mortensen. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans, 2003.
Kirkbright, Suzanne. Karl Jaspers: A Biography: Navigations in Truth. New Haven: Yale
University Press, 2004.
Knitter, Paul. No Other Name?: A Critical Survey of Christian Attitudes Toward the World
Religions. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 1985.
276
Knitter, Paul. “Preface.” Pages vii-xii in The Myth of Christian Uniqueness: Towards a
Pluralistic Theology of Religions. Ed. J. Hick & P. Knitter. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis,
1987.
Kristensen, Wilhelm Brede. Religionshistorisk Studium. Oslo: O. Norli, 1954. Translated
by John Carman as The Meaning of Religion: Lectures in the Phenomenology of Religion.
The Haugue: Martinus Nijhoff, 1971.
Kunin, Seth. Religion: The Modern Theories. Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University
Press, 2003.
Kuper, Adam. The Invention of Primitive Society: Transformations of an Illusion. London:
Routledge, 1988.
Leroi-Gourhan, Andre. Gesture and Speech. Trans. A. B. Berger. Cambridge, MA: The
MIT Press, 1993 [1964].
Lewis, James. “Images of Traditional African Religion in Surveys of World Religions.”
Religion 20 (1990): 311-322.
Lincoln, Bruce. Discourse and the Construction of Society: Comparative Studies of Myth, Ritual, and
Classification. New York: Oxford University Press, 1989.
Lincoln, Bruce. Theorizing Myth. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1999.
Lincoln, Bruce. “Theses On Method.” Pages 1-3 in Gods and Demons, Priests and Scholars:
Critical Explorations in the History of Religions. Chicago: University of Chicago Press,
2012 [1996].
Lindbeck, George. The Nature of Doctrine: Religion and Theology in a Postliberal Age.
Philadelphia: The Westminster Press, 1984.
Linnaeus, Carolus. Systema Natuare, per Regna Tria Naturae. 10th ed. Stockholm:
Laurentius Salvius, 1758 [1735].
Livi-Bacci, Massimo. A Concise History of World Population. Cambridge, MA: Blackwell,
1992.
Lovejoy, Arthur O. The Great Chain of Being: A Study of the History of an Idea. Cambridge,
MA: Harvard University Press, 1936.
Lubbock, John. Prehistoric Times, as Illustrated by Ancient Remains and the Manners and Customs
of Modern Savages. Edinburgh: Williams & Norgate, 1865.
Lyell, Charles. Principles of Geology, Being an Attempt to Explain the Former Changes of the
Earth’s Surface by Reference to Causes Now in Action. 3 vols. London: John Murray,
1830-33.
277
MacWilliams, M., et al. “Religion/s Between the Covers: Dilemmas of the World
Religions Textbook.” Religious Studies Review 31 (2005): 1-36.
Maddox, Marion. For God and Country: Religious Dynamics in Australian Federal Politics.
Canberra: Department of the Parliamentary Library, 2001.
Maine, Henry. Ancient Law: Its Connection with the Early History of Society and its Relation to
Modern Ideas. London: John Murray, 1861.
Marks, Robert. The Origins of the Modern World: A Global and Ecological Narrative. Lanham:
Rowman & Littlefield, 2002.
Manuel, Frank E. The Eighteenth Century Confronts the Gods. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press, 1959.
Marshall, P. J. (ed.) The British Discovery of Hinduism in the Eighteenth Century. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press 1970.
Martin, Henri-Jean. The History and Power of Writing. Trans. L. Cochrane. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 1994 [1988].
Martin, Craig. A Critical Introduction to the Study of Religion. Sheffield: Equinox, 2012.
Martin, Craig. “William James in Late Capitalism: Our Religion of the Status Quo.”
Pages 177-196 in Religious Experience: A Reader. Ed. C. Martin & R. McCutcheon.
Sheffield, Equinox 2012.
Masuzawa, Tomoko. The Invention of World Religions: Or, How European Universalism was
Preserved in the Language of Pluralism. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2005.
McLennan, John Ferguson. “The Worship of Plants and Animals.” Fortnightly Review 6-7
(1869-70): 407-582, 194-216.
McCutcheon, Russell. Manufacturing Religion: The Discourse on Sui Generis Religion and the
Politics of Nostalgia. New York: Oxford University Press, 1997.
McCutcheon, Russell. (ed.) The Insider/Outsider Problem in the Study of Religion: a Reader.
London: Cassell, 1999.
McCutcheon, Russell. Critics not Caretakers: Redescribing the Public Study of Religion. Albany:
SUNY Press, 2001.
McCutcheon, Russell. The Discipline of Religion: Structure, Meaning, Rhetoric. New York:
Routledge, 2003.
McCutcheon, Russell. “‘It’s a Lie. There’s No Truth in It! It’s a Sin!’: On the Limits of
the Humanistic Study of Religion and the Costs of Saving Others from
Themselves.” Journal of the American Academy of Religion 74 (2006): 720-750.
278
McCutcheon, Russell. Studying Religion: An Introduction. Sheffield: Equinox, 2007.
McCutcheon, R. & Arnal, W. The Sacred is the Profane: The Political Nature of “Religion”.
New York: Oxford University Press, 2013.
McNeill, William. The Rise of the West: A History of the Human Community. Chicago:
Chicago University Press, 1963.
Mellars, P., Boyle, K., Bar-Yosef, O. & Stringer, C. Rethinking the Human Revolution: New
Behavioural and Biological Perspectives on the Origins and Dispersal of Modern Humans.
Cambridge: The McDonald Institute, 2007.
Momigliano, Arnaldo. Alien Wisdom: The Limits of Hellenization. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1975.
Monod, Jacques. Chance and Necessity. London: Fontana, 1974.
Morgan, Lewis Henry. System of Consanguinity and Affinity of the Human Family.
Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian, 1971.
Morgan, Lewis Henry. Ancient Society: Researches in the Lines of Human Progress from Savagery
through Barbarism to Civilization. New York: Holt, 1877.
Morton, A. G. History of Botanical Science: an account of the development of botany from ancient
times to the present day. New York: Academic Press, 1981.
Müller, Friedrich Max. Introduction to the Science of Religion. London: Longmans, Green, &
Co., 1882 [1873]. Being four lectures given at the Royal Institute in 1870.
Müller Friedrich Max. Chips From a German Workshop. 3 vols. New York: Scribner,
Armstrong, & Co., 1876 [1867].
Molendijk, Arie. “Tiele on Religion.” Numen 46 (1999): 237-268.
Molendijk, Arie. “Religious Development: C. P. Tiele’s Paradigm of Science of
Religion.” Numen 51 (2004): 321-351.
Murphy, Tim. “Religionswissenschaft as Colonialist Discourse: The Case of Rudolf Otto.”
Temenos 43 (2007): 7-27.
Murphy, Tim. The Politics of Spirit: Phenomenology, Genealogy, Religion. Albany: SUNY Press,
2010.
Nasr, Seyyed Hossein. (ed.) The Essential Frithjof Schuon. Indiana: World Wisdom, 2005.
Netland, Harold. Encountering Religious Pluralism: The Challenge to Christian Faith and Mission.
Downers Grove, IL: InterVarsity Press, 2001.
279
Newbigin, Leslie. The Gospel in a Pluralist Society. London: SPK, 1989.
Nissen, Hans J. The Early History of the Ancient Near East, 9000-2000 B.C. Trans. E.
Lutzeier & K. J. Northcott. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1988 [1983].
Nongbri, Brent. Before Religion: A History of a Modern Concept. New Haven: Yale University
Press, 2013.
Novick, Peter. That Noble Dream: The “Objectivity Question” and the American Historical
Profession. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1988.
Olender, Maurice. The Languages of Paradise: Race, Religion, and Philology in the Nineteenth
Century. Trans. A. Goldhamer. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2008
[1992].
Olupona, Jacob. “Preface.” Pages xiv-xvi in Beyond Primitivism: Indigenous Religious
Traditions and Modernity. Ed. J. Olupona. New York: Routledge, 2004.
Ong, Walter. Ramus, Method, and the Decay of Dialogue: From the Art of Discourse to the Art of
Reason. 2nd ed. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2002 [1958].
Ong, Walter. Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word. London: Routledge, 1982.
Otto, Rudolf. Das Heilige: Über die Irrationale in der Idee des Göttlichen und sein Verhältnis zum
Rationalen. Breslau: Trewendt und Gramier, 1917. Translated by J. Harvey as The
Idea of the Holy. New York: Galaxy, 1960 [1923].
Pals, Daniel. Seven Theories of Religion. New York: Oxford University Press, 1996.
Parsons, Talcott. “Introduction.” Pages xxix-lxxvii in Max Weber, The Sociology of Religion.
Boston: Beacon Press, 1964.
Patton, C. & Ray, B. (ed.) A Magic Still Dwells: Comparative Religion in the Postmodern Age.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 2000.
Pavord, Anna. The Naming of Names: The Search for Order in the World of Plants. London:
Bloomsbury, 2005.
Plantinga, Richard. Christianity and Plurality: Classic and Contemporary Readings. Oxford:
Blackwell, 1999.
Pratt, Mary-Louise. Imperial Eyes: Travel Writing and Transculturation. 2nd ed. London:
Routledge, 2008 [1992].
280
Preus, Samuel J. Explaining Religion: Criticism and Theory From Bodin To Freud. New Haven:
Yale University Press, 1987.
Preus, Samuel J. Spinoza and the Irrelevance of Biblical Authority. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2001.
Prothero, S. God Is Not One: The Eight Rival Religions That Run The World. New York:
HarperOne, 2010.
Purchas, Samuel. Purchase His Pilgrimage: Or, Relations of the World and the Religions Observed in
all Ages and in all Places Discovered, from the Creation unto this Present; In Foure Parts. This
first containeth a theologicall and geographicall historie of Asia, Africa, and America, with the
ilands adjacent. Declaring the ancient religions before the Floud, the Heathnish, Jewish, and
Saracenicall in all Ages since, in those parts professed, with their severall Opinions, Idols,
Oracles, Temples, Priests, Fasts, Feasts, Sacrifices, and Rites Religious: Their beginnings,
Proceedings, Alterations, Sects, Orders and Successions. With briefe descriptions of the countries,
nations, states, discoveries, private and publike customes, and the most remarkable rarities of
nature, or humane Industrie, in the same. London: Printed by William Stansby for
Henrie Fetherstone, 1614 [1613].
Pyne, Stephen. World Fire: The Culture of Fire on Earth. 2nd ed. Seattle: University of
Washington Press, 1997 [1995].
Race, Alan. Christians and Religious Pluralism. London: SCM, 1983.
Ramadan, Tariq. The Quest for Meaning: Developing a Philosophy of Pluralism. London: Allen
Lane, 2010.
Ranke, Leopold von. History of the Latin and Teutonic Nations, 1494-1514. Trans. G. R.
Dennis. London: G. Bell, 1915 [1824].
Raphael, Melissa. Rudolf Otto and the Concept of Holiness. Oxford: The Clarendon Press,
1997.
Rappaport, Roy. Ritual and Religion in the Making of Humanity. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1999.
Renfrew, Colin. Before Civilization: The Radiocarbon Revolution and Prehistoric Europe.
London: Jonathan Cape, 1973.
Renfrew, Colin. Prehistory: The Making of the Human Mind. London: Weidenfeld &
Nicolson, 2007.
Renfrew, C. & Morely, A. (ed.) Becoming Human: Innovation in Prehistoric and Spiritual
Culture. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2009.
Rowland, Ingrid. Giordano Bruno: Philosopher/Heretic. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press, 2008.
281
Said, Edward. Orientalism. 2nd ed. New York: Vintage Books, 2003 [1978].
Schleiermacher, Friedrich. Über die Religion: Reden an die Gebildeten unter ihren Verächtern.
1799, 1806, 1821. Translated by Richard Crouter as On Religion: Speeches to its
Cultured Despisers. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1988.
Schlette, Heinz R. Towards a Theology of Religions. New York: Herder & Herder, 1965.
Schmidt-Leukel, Perry. “Exclusivism, Inclusivism, Pluralism: The Tripolar Typology––
Clarified and Reaffirmed.” Pages 13-27 in The Myth of Religious Superiority. Ed. P.
Knitter. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 2003.
Schwab, Raymond. The Oriental Renaissance: Europe’s Rediscovery of India and the East, 16801880. Trans. G. Patterson-Black & V. Reinking. New York: Columbia University
Press, 1984 [1950].
Seager, Robert. The World’s Parliament of Religions: The East/West Encounter. Bloomington:
Indians University Press, 1995.
Seager, Robert. (ed.) The Dawn of Religious Pluralism: Voices from the World’s Parliament of
Religions, 1893. La Salle, IL: Open Court, 1993.
Segal, Robert. “In Defence of Reductionism.” Pages 5-36 in Religion and the Social Sciences:
Essays on the Confrontation. Atlanta: Scholars Press, 1989.
Segal, Robert. “Relativism and Rationality in the Social Sciences: A Review Essay of
Lucien Lévy-Bruhl’s How Natives Think.” Pages 167-180 in Religion and the Social
Sciences: Essays on the Confrontation. Atlanta: Scholars Press, 1989.
Sharf, Robert. “Experience.” Pages 94-115 in Critical Terms for Religious Studies. Ed. M.
Taylor. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1998.
Sharma, Arvind. A Primal Perspective on the Philosophy of Religion. Dordrecht: Springer,
2006.
Sharpe, Eric. Comparative Religion: A History. 2nd ed. London: Duckworth, 1986 [1975].
Sinhababu, S. “Interview with J. Z. Smith.” The Chicago Marron, June 2, 2008.
http://chicagomaroon.com/2008/06/02/full-j-z-smith-interview/ [Accessed May
21, 2013].
Skinner, Quentin. The Foundations of Modern Political Thought. 2 vols. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 1978.
Smail, Daniel Lord. On Deep History and the Brain. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 2008).
282
Smail, D. L. & Shyrock, A. (ed.) Deep History: The Architecture of Past and Present. Berkeley:
University of California Press, 2011.
Smart, Ninian. “Foreword.” Pages ix-xix in the reissue of van der Leeuw’s Religion in
Essence and Manifestation. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 1986 [1933].
Smith, Huston. The Religions of Man. New York: Harper, 1958. (Rep. as The World's
Religions: Our Great Wisdom Traditions. San Francisco: Harper SanFrancisco, 1991.)
Smith, Huston. Forgotten Truth: The Primordial Tradition. New York: Harper & Row, 1976.
Smith, Huston. “Introduction to the Revised Edition”. Pages ix-xxxiv in Frithjof
Schuon, The Transcendent Unity of Religions. Wheaton, IL: Quest, 1984.
Smith, Huston. A Seat At The Table: Huston Smith in Conversation with Native Americans on
Religious Freedom. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2006.
Smith, Jonathan Z. Map Is Not Territory. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1978.
Smith, Jonathan Z. Imagining Religion: From Babylon To Jonestown. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1982.
Smith, Jonathan Z. To Take Place: Toward Theory in Ritual. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press, 1987.
Smith, Jonathan Z. Relating Religion: Essays in the Study of Religion. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 2004.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “A Matter of Class: Taxonomies of Religion.” Pages 160-178 in
Relating Religion: Essays in the Study of Religion.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “Religion, Religions, Religious.” Pages 179-196 in Relating Religion:
Essays in the Study of Religion.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “Conversation with Robert Bellah on Religion in Human Evolution.”
Panel discussion at the American Academy Of Religion Annual Meeting, San
Francisco, November 20, 2011. Transcript available at
http://blogs.ssrc.org/tif/2011/12/21/a-damned-good-read/ [Last accessed June
3, 2013].
Smith, Jonathan Z. On Teaching Religion. Ed. C. Lehrich. New York: Oxford University
Press, 2012.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “The Introductory Course: Less is Better.” Pages 11-19 in On
Teaching Religion.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “Basic Problems in the Study of Religion.” Pages 20-27 in On
Teaching Religion.
283
Smith, Jonathan Z. “Connections.” Pages 49-63 in On Teaching Religion.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “Are Theological Studies and Religious Studies Compatible?” Pages
73-76 in On Teaching Religion.
Smith, Jonathan Z. “‘Religion’ and ‘Religious Studies’: No Difference at All.” Pages 7790 in On Teaching Religion.
Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. “Comparative Religion: Whither and Why?” Pages 31-59 in The
History of Religion: Essays in Methodology. Ed. J. Kitigawa & M. Eliade. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 1959.
Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. The Faith of Other Men. New York: Harper & Row, 1962.
Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. The Meaning and End of Religion. New York: Harper & Row,
1978 [1962].
Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. Questions of Religious Truth. New York: Charles Scribner’s Sons,
1967.
Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. Towards a World Theology: Faith and the Comparative History of
Religion. Philadelphia: The Westminster Press, 1981.
Smith, William Robertson. Lectures on the Religion of the Semites. Edinburgh: A. & C. Black,
1889.
Spurr, David. The Rhetoric of Empire: Colonial Discourse in Journalism, Travel Writing, and
Colonial Administration. Durham: Duke University Press, 1993.
Stanner, W. E. H. “The Dreaming.” In Cultures of the Pacific. Ed. T. Harding & B.
Wallace. New York: Free Press, 1970 [1956].
Stark, Rodney. “Secularization, R.I.P.” Sociology of Religion 60 (1999): 249-273.
Stausberg, Michael. (ed.) Contemporary Theories of Religion: A Critical Companion. London:
Routledge, 2009.
Stausberg, Michael. “There is Life in the Old Dog Yet: An Introduction to
Contemporary Theories of Religion.” Pages 1-21 in Contemporary Theories of Religion:
A Critical Companion. Ed. M. Stausberg. London: Routledge, 2009.
Stausberg, Michael. “Prospects in Theories of Religion.” Method and Theory in the Study of
Religion 22 (2010): 223-238.
Stocking, Gregory W. Victorian Anthropology. New York: Free Press, 1987.
Styers, Randall. Making Magic: Religion, Magic, & Science in the Modern World. New York:
Oxford University Press, 2003.
284
Sugirtharajah, Sharada. (ed.) Religious Pluralism and the Modern World: An Ongoing Engagement
with John Hick. New York: Palgrave Macmillan, 2012.
Surin, Kenneth. “A‘Politics of Speech’: Religious Pluralism in the Age of the
McDonald’s Hamburger.” Pages 199-212 in Christian Uniqueness Reconsidered. Ed.
G. D’Costa. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis, 2000.
Schwartz, J. H., Tattersall, I., et al. (ed.) The Human Fossil Record. 4 vols. Volume One:
Terminology and Craniodental Morphology of Genus Homo (Europe). Volume Two:
Craniodental Morphology of Genus Homo (Africa and Asia). Volume Three: Brain
Endocasts: The Paleoneurological Evidence. Volume Four: Craniodental Morphology of Early
Hominids (Genera Australopithecus, Paranthropus, Orrorin) and Overview. New York:
Wiley-Liss, 2002-2005.
Takman, John. “Notes on Linnaeus.” Science and Society 21 (1957): 193-209.
Tattersall, Ian. Becoming Human: Evolution and Human Uniqueness. New York: Harcourt
Brace, 1998.
Thompson, E. P. The Making of the English Working Class. Rev. ed. Harmondsworth:
Penguin, 1980 [1963].
Thompson, J. L., Krovitz, G. E. & Nelson, A. J. Patterns of Growth and Development in the
Genus Homo. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2003.
Thrower, James. Religion: The Classical Theories. Washington, D.C.: Georgetown
University Press, 1999.
Tillich, Paul. Christianity and the Encounter of the World Religions. New York: Columbia
University Press, 1963. Being the publication of lectures given in 1961/2.
Tillich, Paul. “The Significance of the History of Religions for the Systematic
Theologian.” Pages 80-94 in The Future of Religions. Ed. J. C. Brauer. New York:
Harper & Row, 1966.
Tiele, Cornelis Petrus. Outlines of the History of Religion to the Spread of the Universal Religions.
London: Trübner, 1877 [1876].
Tiele, Cornelis Petrus. Elements of a Science of Religion. 2 vols. Edinburgh: Blackwood,
1897-1900. Being the published version of Tiele’s 1896-8 Gifford Lectures.
Tiele, Cornelis Petrus. “Religions” in Encyclopaedia Britannica: A Dictionary of Arts, Sciences,
and Letters. Vol. 20. 9th ed. Boston: Little, Brown, & Co., 1886. Vol. XX, pages
358-371.
Tsonis, Jack. “Review: The Axial Age and Its Consequences.” Alternative Religion and
Spirituality Review 3 (2012): 262-267.
285
Twiss, Sumner B. “The Philosophy of Religious Pluralism: A Critical Appraisal of John
Hick and His Critics.” The Journal of Religion 70 (1990): 533-568.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. Researches into the Early History of Mankind and the Development of
Civilization. London: John Murray, 1865.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. “The Religion of Savages.” Fortnightly Review 6 (1866): 71-86.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. “The Philosophy of Religion among the Lower Races of
Mankind.” The Journal of the Ethnological Society of London 2 (1870): 369-381.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. Primitive Culture: Researches into the Development of Mythology,
Philosophy, Religion Language, Art and Custom. 2 vols. London: John Murray, 1871.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. “On the Limits of Savage Religion.” The Journal of the
Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 21 (1892): 283-301.
Tylor, Edward Burnett. “On The Tasmanians as Representatives of Paleolithic Man.”
The Journal of the Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 23 (1894): 141-152.
Upton, Christopher. A History of Birmingham. Hampshire: Philimore & Co., 2011.
van der Leeuw, Gerhardus. Religion In Essence and Manifestation. 2 vols. New York:
Harper & Row, 1963 [1933].
Vatican. “Resource Library.” www.vatican.va [Last accessed June 25, 2013].
Volf, Miroslav. “A Voice of One’s Own: Public Faith in a Pluralistic World.” Pages 271281 in Democracy and the New Religious Pluralism. Ed. T. Banchoff. New York:
Oxford University Press, 2007.
Voegelin, Eric. Order and History. 5 vols. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press,
1956-1987.
Wallerstein, Immanuel. The Modern World System. 4 vols. 2nd ed. Berkeley: University of
California Press, 2011 [1974].
Weber, Max. “Die Wirtschafts Ethik der Weltreligionen.” In Wirtschaft und Gesellschaft.
Tübingen: J. C. B Mohr, 1922. An English translation (“The Social Psychology of
the World Religions”) can be found in pages 267-301 of From Max Weber: Essays in
Historical Sociology. Ed. and trans. H. H. Gerth & C. Wright Mills. New York:
Oxford University Press, 1948.
286
Weber, Max. Economy and Society: An Outline of Interpretive Sociology. 2 vols. Ed. G. Roth &
C. Wittich. Multiple translators. New York: Bedminster Press, 1968)
White, Hayden. Metahistory: The Historical Imagination in Nineteenth-Century Europe.
Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1973.
White, Hayden. “Interpretation in History.” Pages 51-80 in The Tropics of Discourse: Essays
in Cultural Criticism. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1978.
Wiebe, Donald. The Politics of Religious Studies: the Continuing Conflict with Theology and the
Academy. New York: St Martin’s Press, 1999.
Wilson, Edward O. The Social Conquest of Earth. New York: Liveright, 2012.
Wittrock, Björn. “The Axial Age in Global History: Cultural Crystallizations and Societal
Transformations.” Pages 102-125 in The Axial Age and Its Consequences. Ed. R.
Bellah & H. Joas. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University
Press, 2012.
Wolf, Eric. Europe and the People without History. 2nd ed. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1997 [1982].`
Woodward, David. “Cartography and the Renaissance: Continuity and Change.” Pages
3-25 in vol. 3.1 of The History of Cartography. Full details of the series are provided in
the supplementary bibliography.
Young, Katherine K. “World Religions: A Category in the Making?” Pages 111-130 in
Religion in History: The Word, the Idea, the Reality. Ed. M. Despland & G. Vollée.
Ontario: Wilfred Laurier University Press, 1992.
287
A Note on the Supplementary Bibliography
This supplementary bibliography provides references for topics discussed under the
rubric of “communications history” in Chapter 5 (see pp. 211-229 above). The discussion
of communications history was undertaken primarily with reference to David Christian’s
proposal that the rapidity of cultural change in Homo sapiens, compared with all other
species on earth, is due to the powerful capacity for “collective learning” inherent in
modern human language. As suggested, this has important implications for debates about
the cultural transformations of the 1st millennium BCE. However, as noted in the
chapter, there is yet to be any sustained theoretical integration of the various fields of
scholarship that were addressed in the discussion, even though they clearly have the
potential to inform each other if brought together with the same set of questions in
mind. Although Christian maps out collective learning well at the broad scale, there has
been little explicit integration by big historians with studies of more tightly focused
historical periods. The reverse also applies, mutatis mutandis, with the plethora of
important microstudies on communications history rarely brought in concert with an
evolutionary perspective (admittedly something that has only become possible in recent
decades).
As such, in lieu of any authoritative bibliography to which the reader might be
directed, this supplementary list of references is intended to begin mapping out a set of
connections between areas of scholarship often not considered in the same context. I
stress that the list is not exhaustive, and instead represents works that have informed my
basic perspective over the course of researching this dissertation, but which were not
cited in the main text. I largely omit journals and journal articles for the sake of space. I
also stress that this is not a bibliography on the wider area called “the cultural history of
technology”, of which communications history (i.e. the history of communications
technologies) is only a subset.
The items below include both historical material and works of media theory.
Given that this supplement is intended to serve as a useful guide to a range of disparate
literature, many of the items are annotated to indicate their point of relevance,
particularly those not discussed in the main text. A small number of the items appear in
the main bibliography, but they are reproduced here for the sake of completeness.
289
Supplementary Bibliography on
Communications History
Anderson, Benedict. Imagined Communities: Reflections on the Origins and Spread of Nationalism.
Revised ed. London: Verso, 2006 [1983].
– Anderson’s landmark study highlights the role of the printing press in the political
configurations of modern Europe.
Assmann, Jan. “Cultural Memory and the Myth of the Axial Age.” Pages 366-407 in The
Axial Age and Its Consequences. Ed. R. Bellah & H. Joas. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press, 2012.
Assmann, Jan. Cultural Memory and Early Civilization. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 2012 [German original 1992].
Assmann, Aleida. Cultural Memory and Western Civilization: Functions, Media, Archives.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2011 [German original 1999].
Basso, Keith. Wisdom Sits in Places: Landscape and Language Among the Western Apache.
Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1996.
Basso, K. & Feld, S. (ed.) Senses of Place. Santa Fe, NM: School of American Research
Press, 1996.
Bellah, Robert. Religion in Human Evolution: From the Paleolithic to the Axial Age.
Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2011.
Blanton, Ward. Displacing Christian Origins: Philosophy, Secularity, and the New Testament.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2007.
– A study of nineteenth-century biblical scholarship informed by a sophisticated use of media
theory.
Boyarin, Jonathan. (ed.) The Ethnography of Reading. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1993.
– An excellent set of essays about reading practices, working on the premise that “writing, the
subject of much innovative scholarship in recent years, is only one half of what we call literacy.”
Boyd, Brian. On the Origin of Stories: Evolution, Cognition, and Fiction. Cambridge, MA: The
Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press, 2009.
– An extremely useful supplement to Merlin Donald and the role of narrative in modern human
thought. To my knowledge, Boyd’s study is the current benchmark for evolutionary treatments of
expressive art. This work came to my attention too late to be incorporated into the argument.
290
Briggs, A. & Burke, P. A Social History of the Media: From Gutenberg to the Internet.
Cambridge: Polity, 2009.
– One of the most comprehensive treatments of the social history of communications technologies,
which synthesizes a range of the perspectives cited in this supplementary bibliography. Its focus,
however, is entirely European. Comparable studies of other periods or cultures would be welcome.
Carpenter, Kenneth. (ed.) Books and Society in History. New York: R. R. Bowker, 1983.
Carr, David. Writing on the Tablet of the Heart: Origins of Scripture and Literature. New York:
Oxford University Press, 2005.
– Highly useful survey of textuality in antiquity, from the ancient Near East to the Hellenistic
period. A good complement to Jan Assmann’s work.
Carter, J. & Muir, P. (ed.) Printing and the Mind of Man: The Impact of Print on Five Centuries of
Western Civilization. London: Cassell & Co.: 1967.
– A descriptive catalogue of items displayed at the 1963 International Printing Machinery and
Allied Trades Exhibition in London, which contained works printed from the fifteenth to the
twentieth century. It is particularly useful for its discussion of works in the first two centuries after
Gutenberg, and its synoptic, chronological treatment makes it a handy reference work for early
modern intellectual history.
Cavello, C. & Chartier, R. (ed.) A History of Reading in the West. Amherst: University of
Massachusetts Press, 1999.
Chartier, Roger. The Order of Books. Trans. L Cochrane. Stanford: Stanford University
Press, 1994 [1992].
– Chartier heads the newest generation of French book historians, in the line of Henri-Jean
Martin. This work explores the systems of regulation and classification developed to organize and
manage the ever-burgeoning knowledge of the post-Gutenberg era. A useful complement to D. F.
McKenzie (see below).
Christian, David. Maps of Time: An Introduction to Big History. Berkeley: University of
California Press, 2004.
Christian, David. “The Return of Universal History.” History and Theory 49 (2010): 6-27.
Clanchy, M. T. From Memory to Written Record: England 1066-1307. Revised ed. Oxford:
Blackwell, 1993 [1979].
– Important study of the slow introduction of written documents in the medieval period,
particularly in England. Provides essential background context for understanding the explosion of
print technology in the fifteenth century. Useful in combination with the works of Brian Stock and
Malcolm Parkes (see below).
Clarke, Andy. Supersizing the Mind: Embodiment, Action, and Cognitive Extension. New York:
Oxford University Press, 2011.
291
Daniels, P. & Bright, W. (ed.) The World’s Writing Systems. New York: Oxford University
Press, 2006.
– An unrivalled handbook for the history of writing. Excellent complement to flesh out HenriJean Martin’s narrative of the cultural history of writing.
Darnton, Robert. The Business of Enlightenment: A Publishing History of the Encyclopédie
1775-1800. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard University Press,
1979.
– Darton is one of the leading scholars on the history of the book and the social history of ideas.
This is his landmark work. A good complement to Eisenstein.
Darnton, Robert. Revolution in Print: The Press in France, 1775-1800. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 1989.
Darnton, Robert. The Case for Books: Past, Present, and Future. New York: Public Affairs,
2010.
Davis, Eric. TechGnosis: Myth, Magic and Mysticism in the Age of Information. New York:
Harmony, 1998.
Deacon, Terrance. The Symbolic Species: The Co-evolution of Language and the Brain. New
York: W. W. Norton & Co., 1997.
Debray, Régis. Transmitting Culture. Trans. E. Rauth. New York: Columbia University
Press, 2000 [1997].
– An interesting work of media theory that advocates for the notion of “mediology” as a “an
original sector of research”, one “dedicated to the facts of cultural transmission as an object of
study in its own right”. Debray’s proposals are certainly stimulating, but not always convincing.
Derrida, Jacques. Of Grammatology. Trans. G. Spivak. Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins
University Press, 1974 [1967].
– Although obfuscating from any perspective, Derrida’s classic work of literary theory takes on
greater practical meaning when utilized (in concert with other works here listed) as a work of
media theory. Derrida was influenced by Leroi-Gourhan, even though the debt is not particularly
explicit (see e.g. 83-86).
Dean, Carolyn. A Culture of Stone: Inca Perspectives on Rock. Durham: Duke University
Press, 2010.
– A good supplement to Keith Basso’s work on the mnemonics of place and the relationship
between cultural identity and external-but-non-written forms of cultural memory.
Delano Smith, Catherine. “Why Theory in the History of Cartography?” Imago Mundi
48 (1996): 198-203.
Diamond, Jared. Guns, Germs, and Steel: The Fate of Human Societies. New York: W. W.
Norton & Co., 1999.
292
Donald, Merlin. Origins of the Modern Mind: Three Stages in the Evolution of Culture and
Cognition. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1991.
Donald, Merlin. A Mind So Rare. New York: Norton, 2001.
Donald, Merlin. “Cognitive Evolution and the Definition of Human Nature.” Lecture
given at the University of Arkansas. No date. Transcript available at
http://psyc.queensu.ca/faculty/donald/sel-pubs.html [last accessed June 8, 2013].
Eliot, S. & Rose, J. (ed.) A Companion to the History of the Book. West Sussex: WileyBlackwell, 2009.
– Excellent survey of a wide field. An essential reference work.
Eisenstadt, Schmuel. “The Axial Age: The Emergence of Transcendental Visions and
the Rise of Clerics.” European Journal of Science 23 (1982): 294-314.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. “Clio and Chronos: an Essay on the Making and Breaking of
History-Book Time.” History and Theory 6 (1966): 36-64.
– Eisenstein’s “working hypothesis” is that “all views of history have been fundamentally shaped
by the way records are duplicated, knowledge transmitted, and information restored and retrieved”.
This work thus serves as a useful complement to the work of Assmann.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. The Printing Press as an Agent of Change: Communications and Cultural
Transformations in Early-Modern Europe. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1979.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. “An Unacknowledged Revolution Revisited.” The American
Historical Review 107 (2002): 87-105.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. “How to Acknowledge a Revolution: A Reply.” The American
Historical Review 107 (2002): 126-128.
Eisenstein, Elizabeth. The Printing Revolution in Early Modern Europe. 2nd ed. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press, 2004 [1983].
– An abridged and illustrated edition of The Printing Press as an Agent of Change. This
would be useful in an undergraduate or other introductory context.
Fabian, Johannes. Time and the Other: How Anthropology Makes its Object. 2nd ed. New
York: Columbia University Press, 2002 [1983].
– In his critique of the allochronic tendency of anthropological discourse, Fabian offered a
politicized theoretical expansion of Walter Ong’s analysis of the role of “visualism” in modern
European thought.
293
Febvre, L. & Martin, H–J. The Coming of the Book: the Impact of Print 1450–1800. Trans. D.
Gerard. London: Verso, 1997 [1958].
Foley, John Miles. (ed.) Oral Traditional Literature: A Festschrift for Albert Bates Lord.
Columbus: Slavica Press, 1981.
Gamble, Harry. Books and Readers in the Early Church: A History of Early Christian Texts.
New Haven: Yale University Press, 1995.
Gleick, James. The Information: A History, a Theory, a Flood. London: Fourth Estate, 2011.
Goldschmidt, E. Medieval Texts and their First Appearance in Print. London: Oxford
University Press, 1943.
Goody, J. & Watt, I. “The Consequences of Literacy.” Comparative Studies in Society and
History 5 (1963): 304-345.
Goody, Jack. (ed.) Literacy in Traditional Societies. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
1968.
Goody, Jack. Technology, Tradition and the State in Africa. London: Oxford University Press,
1971.
Goody, Jack. “Alphabets and Writing.” Pages 106-26 in The World of Human
Communication. Ed. R. Williams. London: Thames and Hudson, 1981.
Goody, Jack. The Domestication of the Savage Mind. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1977.
Goody, Jack. The Logic of Writing and the Organization of Society. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1986.
Goody, Jack. The Interface Between the Written and the Oral. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1987.
Goody, Jack. “The Anthropologist and the Tape Recorder.” The Minpaku Anthropology
Newsletter 1 (1996): 2-4.
Graham, William. Beyond the Written Word: Oral Aspects of Scripture in the History of Religions.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1987.
– Excellent study for understanding the interaction between oral and written communication,
especially in religious contexts. Graham insists upon the deeply oral nature of all ancient
interaction with sacred texts. A multicultural focus, although he mainly considers Islam and
Christianity.
294
Gronbeck, B., Farrell, T. & Soukup, P. (ed.) Media, Consciousness, and Culture: Explorations
of Walter Ong’s Thought. Newbury Park, CA: Sage, 1991.
– A good companion to and expansion of Ong’s work, particularly from the theoretical
perspective.
Halbwachs, Maurice. On Collective Memory. Trans. L. Coser. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1992 [1941].
Harman, Graham. Prince of Networks: Bruno Latour and Metaphysics. Melbourne: re.press,
2009.
– A useful survey of Bruno Latour’s wide-ranging work, which is important in the context of
media/network theory.
Harley, J. B. The New Nature of Maps: Essays in the History of Cartography. Ed. P. Laxton..
Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University Press, 2001.
– Important work for understanding the theoretical issues surrounding cartographic history and
practice. See also Catherine Delano Smith above.
Harris, William. Ancient Literary. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1989.
– An older benchmark still useful for its references, although theoretically outdated in comparison
with Johnson & Parker (ed.), Ancient Literacies (see below).
Hartley, John. //the_uses_of_digital_ literacy// St Lucia: University of Queensland Press,
2009.
– Provides a good update of Richard Hoggart’s pioneering study of literacy and popular culture,
with a focus on the new era of multimedia.
Havelock, Eric. Preface to Plato. Cambridge, MA: The Bellknap Press of Harvard
University Press, 1963.
– Groundbreaking theoretical application of anthropological/folkloric insights to classical studies.
Influenced Ong, Goody, and others.
Hoggart, Richard. The Uses of Literacy. London: Chatto & Windus, 1957.
– Seminal study of literacy and modern popular culture. See John Hartley above.
Hooker, J. T. (ed.) Reading the Past: Ancient Writing from Cuneiform to the Alphabet. New
York: Barnes & Noble (for the Trustees of the British Museum) 1990.
– Good introduction to the ancient writing systems of the Near East. Lacks information on early
Chinese writing. See Daniels & Bright (ed.) above fore a more comprehensive treatment.
Horton, Robin. Patterns of Thought in Africa and the West: Essays on Magic, Religion and Science.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1993.
– A good complement to other anthropological works with a theoretical focus on the dynamics of
oral thought, such as Ong and Goody.
295
Hublin, J-J. & Richards, M. (ed.) The Evolution of Hominin Diets: Integrating Approaches to the
Study of Paleolithic Subsistence. New York: Springer, 2009.
– Invaluable new collection regarding the dietary (and thus social) practices of the evolutionary
ancestors of Homo sapiens.
Hughes, Thomas. Networks of Power: Electrification in Western Society. Baltimore: The Johns
Hopkins University Press, 1983.
– Crucial background context for the spread of the telegraph and later electronic-based forms of
communication.
Innis, Harold. Empire and Communications. Ed. D. Godfrey. Toronto: Press Porcépic,
1986 [1950].
Innis, Harold. The Bias of Communication. Toronto: University of Toronto Press, 1951.
– Far-sighted early theoretical study of the role of the medium on not just the form but the content
of information. Direct influence on McLuhan, amongst many others. Complements Innis’
historical study in Empire and Communications.
Iverson, Kelly. “Orality and the Gospels: A Survey of Recent Research.” Currents in
Biblical Research 8 (2009): 71-106.
– A handy survey of the wide-ranging use of theories of oral transmission and oral performativity
in biblical studies. See also Werner Kelber’s similar overview below.
Jaffee, Martin S. Torah in the Mouth: Writing and Oral Tradition in Palestinian Judaism, 200
BCE–400 CE. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2001.
Johns, Adrian. The Nature of the Book: Print and Knowledge in the Making. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 1998.
Johnson, William. “Toward a Sociology of Reading in Classical Antiquity.” American
Journal of Philology 121 (2000): 593-627.
Johnson, W. & Parker, H. (ed.) Ancient Literacies: The Culture of Reading in Greece and Rome.
Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2009.
– Excellent series of essays on more sophisticated ways to think about the concept of “literacy” in
the ancient world. Serves as a much needed update of W. V. Harris’ Ancient Literacy (see
below).
Kaplan, Robert. The Nothing That Is: A Natural History of Zero. London: Penguin, 1999.
– Kaplan’s study of zero highlights the radically expanded potential of mathematics when
supplemented by technologies of externalization. An extremely readable global overview.
296
Kelly, Kevin. What Technology Wants. New York: Viking, 2010.
– Interesting theoretical reflections on technology. Useful for broad thinking about the relationship
between humans and what they make.
Kelber, Werner. “Orality and Biblical Studies: A Review Essay.” Review of Biblical
Literature 12 (2007). Available online via http://www.bookreviews.org.
– Important survey of major works in biblical studies on questions of orality and literacy. See also
the similar review of Kelly Iverson.
Kittler, Friedrich. Gramaphone, Film, Typwriter. Trans. G. Winthrop-Young & M. Wutz.
Stanford: Stanford University Press, 1999 [1986].
– Dense but stimulating work of media theory. Treats the period at which the printed word began
to give way to other forms of electronically-based culture.
Lanham, Richard. The Electronic Word: Democracy, Technology, and the Arts. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 1993.
– Surveys the impact of electronic forms of communication on twentieth-century culture and politics.
Leroi-Gourhan, Andre. Gesture and Speech. Trans. A. B. Berger. Cambridge, MA: The
MIT Press, 1993 [1964].
– Important for its evolutionary perspective on the connections between communication,
embodiment, and materiality. Not often cited in Anglophone scholarship, but see Derrida above.
Levinson, Paul. Digital McLuhan: A Guide to the Information Millennium. London:
Routledge, 1999.
Lewis, P. & Booth, J. The Invisible Medium: Public, Commercial, and Community Radio.
London: Macmillan, 1989.
– A good treatment of an important but generally neglected topic in the modern history of
communications technologies.
Livi-Bacci, Massimo. A Concise History of World Population. Cambridge, MA: Blackwell,
1992.
Lord, Albert B. The Singer of Tales. 2nd ed. Ed. S. Mitchell & G. Nagy. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press, 2000 [1960].
Marks, Robert. The Origins of the Modern World: A Global and Ecological Narrative. Lanham:
Rowman & Littlefield, 2002.
Marrou, Henri-Irénée. A History of Education in Antiquity. Trans G. Lamb. New York:
Sheed & Ward, 1956 [1948].
297
Martin, Henri-Jean. The History and Power of Writing. Trans. L. Cochrane. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, 1994 [1988].
– A good complement to Daniels & Bright (ed.) above. Solid global survey.
Mauss, Marcel. Techniques, Technology, and Civilisation. Ed. N. Schlesinger. New York:
Berhahan Books, 2006.
– An Important collection of Mauss’ writings on technology, which lie behind Andre LeroiGourhan’s more expansive evolutionary treatment. Also contains pieces from Durkheim and
Hubert, as well as an excellent editorial introduction on Mauss and the study of techniques in the
French social sciences.
McClellan, J. & Dorn, H. Science and Technology in World History: An Introduction. Baltimore:
The Johns Hopkins University Press, 1999.
– A big-history style survey. Useful particularly in the undergraduate context.
McKenzie, D. F. Bibliography and the Sociology of Texts. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press, 1999.
– Important work of media theory. A useful complement to Roger Chartier (see above).
McLuhan, Marshall. The Gutenberg Galaxy: The Making of Typographic Man. London:
Routledge & Kegan Paul, 1962.
– The original media guru, although sometimes he seems completely mad. This work is a nonlinear “mosaic” of various historical musings on the impact of print on human consciousness.
McLuhan, Marshall. Understanding Media: Extension of Man. New York: McGraw-Hill,
1964.
– This work secured McLuhan’s widespread reputation. It introduced the phrase “global village”
as well as his aphorism “the medium is the message”.
McLuhan, M. & Fiore, Q. The Medium is the Massage: An Inventory of Effects. New York:
Penguin, 1967.
– An experimental format. Apparently (not explicitly) designed to explore the epistemological
dissonance of the information overload of the electronic mediasphere. Stimulating on account of its
novelty, but only if one already understands what McLuhan was getting at.
McNeill, William. The Rise of the West: A History of the Human Community. Chicago:
Chicago University Press, 1963.
Misa, Thomas. Leonardo to the Internet: Technology and Culture from the Renaissance to the Present
Day. Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University Press, 2004.
– A handy, more widely focused counterpart to Briggs and Burke’s social history of the media (see
above), providing deeper context for the role of communications technologies in cultural change.
Miller, D. & Horst, H. Digital Anthropology. London: Berg, 2012.
– Important new work of theory on digital technologies and shifting forms of cultural practice. The
first major work in what will no doubt become a growing field in coming decades.
298
Mumford, Lewis. Technics and Civilization. 2nd ed. with new introduction. New York:
Harbinger, 1963 [1934].
– A classic study in the cultural history of technology.
Niditch, Susan. Oral World and Written Word: Ancient Israelite Literature. Louisville:
Westminster John Knox, 1996.
Nissen, Hans J. The Early History of the Ancient Near East, 9000-2000 B.C. Trans. E.
Lutzeier & K. J. Northcott. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1988 [1983].
Olsen, David. The World on Paper: The Conceptual and Cognitive Implications of Writing and
Reading. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994.
Olsen, D. & Cole, M. (ed.) Technology, Literacy, and the Evolution of Society: Implications of the
Work of Jack Goody. London: Psychology Press, 2006.
Ong, Walter. The Presence of the Word: Some Prolegomena for Cultural and Religious History.
New York: Simon and Schuster, 1967.
– Useful discussion of how the epistemological primacy of aural knowledge engenders a different
mode of experiencing the world. In this work Ong blends communications history with Salvation
history in one of the more explicit manifestations of his Jesuit commitments.
Ong, Walter. Ramus, Method, and the Decay of Dialogue: From the Art of Discourse to the Art of
Reason. 2nd ed. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 2002 [1958].
Ong, Walter. Ramus and Talon Inventory: A short-title inventory of the published works of Peter
Ramus (1515-1572) and of Omer Talon (ca. 1510-1562) in their original and in their
variously altered forms, with related material. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press,
1958.
– Conjointly published with Ramus, Method, and the Decay of Dialogue. Provides a
meticulously documented catalogue and analysis of the diffusion of Ramist texts. The dedication
reads: “For Herbert Marshall McLuhan, who started all this”.
Ong, Walter. “Ramist Method and the Commercial Mind.” Studies in the Renaissance 8
(1961): 155-172.
– A good example of the intersection between communications history and other forms of social
history.
Ong, Walter. Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word. London: Routledge, 1982.
Ong, Walter. “Orality, Literacy, and Medieval Textualization.” New Literary History 16
(1984): 1-12.
299
Parkes, Malcolm. Pause and Effect: A History of Punctuation in the West. Aldershot: Scolar
Press, 1992.
– Fascinating study of the evolution of written language in the west, from antiquity to the early
post-Gutenberg era. Serves as an excellent frame for the works of Stock, Clanchy, and Eisenstein.
Parry, Milman. The Making of Homeric Verse: The Collected Papers of Milman Parry. Ed. A.
Parry. Oxford: The Clarendon Press, 1971.
Rosenthal, Raymond. (ed.) McLuhan: Pro & Con. Baltimore: Penguin, 1968.
Rosenzweig, Roy. Clio Wired: The Future of the Past in the Digital Age. New York: Columbia
University Press, 2011.
– Excellent historiographical essays on the transforming nature of writing, recording, and accessing
history in the age of digital communications.
Rüegg, W. & de Rider-Symoens, H. (ed.) A History of the University in Europe. 4 vols.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1992-2011.
– A detailed multivolume history of the institutional centres of learning of Europe from the twelfth
century onwards. An important reference work for the social history of European scholarship.
Ruppel, Aloys. Johannes Gutenberg: Sein Leben und sein Werk. Berlin: Verlag Gebr. Mann,
1939.
– Authoritative and detailed treatment of Gutenberg.
Ryan, Johnny. A History of the Internet and the Digital Future. London: Reaktion, 2010.
– Good history of the emergence of the internet, an essential topic for cutting-edge theories of
collective learning.
Sher, Richard. The Enlightenment and the Book: Scottish Authors & Their Publishers in
Eighteenth-Century Britain, Ireland, & America. Chicago: University of Chicago Press,
2006.
Smail, Daniel Lord. On Deep History and the Brain. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 2008).
Smail, D. L. & Shyrock, A. (ed.) Deep History: The Architecture of Past and Present. Berkeley:
University of California Press, 2011.
Small, Jocelyn Penny. Wax Tablets of the Mind: Cognitive Studies of Memory and Literacy in
Classical Antiquity. New York: Routledge, 1997.
300
Staudenmeier, John. Technology’s Storytellers: Reweaving the Human Fabric. 2nd ed.
Cambridge, MA: The MIT Press, 1989 [1985].
– An informative study of “the history of technology” as a coherent intellectual discipline.
Stock, Brian. The Implications of Literacy: Written Language and Models of Interpretation in the
Eleventh and Twelfth Centuries. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 1987.
– Explores the influence of literacy on eleventh and twelfth-century life and thought. Argues that
Medieval literacy did not simply supersede oral discourse but created a new type of interdependence
between the oral and the written. Important in complicating the “great divide” theory of orality and
literacy. Useful particularly in combination with M. T Clanchy and Malcolm Parkes.
Stock, Brian. Listening for the Text: On the Uses of the Past. Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins
University Press, 1990.
– Links Medieval studies to contemporary theory on orality and literacy.
Taylor, Mark. C. The Moment of Complexity: Emerging Network Culture. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press, 2001.
– Useful study of the networked nature of contemporary society. Important context for reflections
on collective learning and cultural change.
Taylor, M. & Saarinen, E. Imagologies: Media Philosophy. New York: Routledge, 1994.
Thomas, Rosalind. Literacy and Orality in Ancient Greece. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 1992.
– Useful study of orality, literacy and culture in classical Greece. Informed by figures such as
Goody. Complements the work of Havelock, Lord, Innis, et al.
White, Lynn. Medieval Technology and Social Change. London: Oxford University Press,
1962.
White, Lynn. Medieval Religion and Technology: Collected Essays. Berkeley: University of
California Press, 1978.
Wilson, Edward O. The Social Conquest of Earth. New York: Liveright, 2012.
Wilson, E. O. & Hölldobler, B. The Superorganism: The Beauty, Elegance, and Strangeness of
Insect Societies. New York: W. W. Norton & Co.: 2009.
– A remarkable study of social insects, which provides an expansive, evolutionary frame of
reference for understanding sociality and collective learning in human societies.
301
Woodward, D. & Harley, J., et al. (ed.) The History of Cartography. 3 vols. Volume 1:
Cartography in Prehistoric, Ancient and Medieval Europe and the Mediterranean. Volume 2,
Book 1: Cartography in the Traditional Islamic and South Asian Societies; Book 2:
Cartography in the Traditional East and Southeast Asian Societies; Book 3: Cartography in
the Traditional African, American, Arctic, Australian, and Pacific Societies. Volume 3:
Cartography in the European Renaissance, Part 1; Cartography in the European Renaissance,
Part 2. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1987-2007. Three further volumes
are projected at present, covering up to the twentieth century.
Yates, Frances. The Art of Memory. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul, 1966.
– A useful complement to Ong’s work on the transition from aural to visual economies of
knowledge in early modern Europe.
302